Fix gdb.cp/anon-struct.cc with -std=c++11.
[gcc.git] / gcc / dwarf2out.c
1 /* Output Dwarf2 format symbol table information from GCC.
2 Copyright (C) 1992-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 Contributed by Gary Funck (gary@intrepid.com).
4 Derived from DWARF 1 implementation of Ron Guilmette (rfg@monkeys.com).
5 Extensively modified by Jason Merrill (jason@cygnus.com).
6
7 This file is part of GCC.
8
9 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
10 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
11 Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option) any later
12 version.
13
14 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
15 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
16 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
17 for more details.
18
19 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
20 along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see
21 <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
22
23 /* TODO: Emit .debug_line header even when there are no functions, since
24 the file numbers are used by .debug_info. Alternately, leave
25 out locations for types and decls.
26 Avoid talking about ctors and op= for PODs.
27 Factor out common prologue sequences into multiple CIEs. */
28
29 /* The first part of this file deals with the DWARF 2 frame unwind
30 information, which is also used by the GCC efficient exception handling
31 mechanism. The second part, controlled only by an #ifdef
32 DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO, deals with the other DWARF 2 debugging
33 information. */
34
35 /* DWARF2 Abbreviation Glossary:
36
37 CFA = Canonical Frame Address
38 a fixed address on the stack which identifies a call frame.
39 We define it to be the value of SP just before the call insn.
40 The CFA register and offset, which may change during the course
41 of the function, are used to calculate its value at runtime.
42
43 CFI = Call Frame Instruction
44 an instruction for the DWARF2 abstract machine
45
46 CIE = Common Information Entry
47 information describing information common to one or more FDEs
48
49 DIE = Debugging Information Entry
50
51 FDE = Frame Description Entry
52 information describing the stack call frame, in particular,
53 how to restore registers
54
55 DW_CFA_... = DWARF2 CFA call frame instruction
56 DW_TAG_... = DWARF2 DIE tag */
57
58 #include "config.h"
59 #include "system.h"
60 #include "coretypes.h"
61 #include "tm.h"
62 #include "rtl.h"
63 #include "hash-set.h"
64 #include "machmode.h"
65 #include "vec.h"
66 #include "double-int.h"
67 #include "input.h"
68 #include "alias.h"
69 #include "symtab.h"
70 #include "wide-int.h"
71 #include "inchash.h"
72 #include "real.h"
73 #include "tree.h"
74 #include "fold-const.h"
75 #include "stringpool.h"
76 #include "stor-layout.h"
77 #include "varasm.h"
78 #include "hashtab.h"
79 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
80 #include "function.h"
81 #include "emit-rtl.h"
82 #include "hash-table.h"
83 #include "version.h"
84 #include "flags.h"
85 #include "regs.h"
86 #include "rtlhash.h"
87 #include "insn-config.h"
88 #include "reload.h"
89 #include "output.h"
90 #include "statistics.h"
91 #include "fixed-value.h"
92 #include "expmed.h"
93 #include "dojump.h"
94 #include "explow.h"
95 #include "calls.h"
96 #include "stmt.h"
97 #include "expr.h"
98 #include "except.h"
99 #include "dwarf2.h"
100 #include "dwarf2out.h"
101 #include "dwarf2asm.h"
102 #include "toplev.h"
103 #include "md5.h"
104 #include "tm_p.h"
105 #include "diagnostic.h"
106 #include "tree-pretty-print.h"
107 #include "debug.h"
108 #include "target.h"
109 #include "common/common-target.h"
110 #include "langhooks.h"
111 #include "hash-map.h"
112 #include "is-a.h"
113 #include "plugin-api.h"
114 #include "ipa-ref.h"
115 #include "cgraph.h"
116 #include "ira.h"
117 #include "lra.h"
118 #include "dumpfile.h"
119 #include "opts.h"
120 #include "tree-dfa.h"
121 #include "gdb/gdb-index.h"
122 #include "rtl-iter.h"
123
124 static void dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int, const char *, int, bool);
125 static rtx_insn *last_var_location_insn;
126 static rtx_insn *cached_next_real_insn;
127 static void dwarf2out_decl (tree);
128
129 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
130 int vms_file_stats_name (const char *, long long *, long *, char *, int *);
131
132 /* Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the directory specifications
133 which are output in the debug info should end with a separator. */
134 #define DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR 1
135 /* Define this macro to evaluate to a nonzero value if GCC should refrain
136 from generating indirect strings in DWARF2 debug information, for instance
137 if your target is stuck with an old version of GDB that is unable to
138 process them properly or uses VMS Debug. */
139 #define DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET 1
140 #else
141 #define DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR 0
142 #define DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET 0
143 #endif
144
145 /* ??? Poison these here until it can be done generically. They've been
146 totally replaced in this file; make sure it stays that way. */
147 #undef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
148 #undef DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
149 #if (GCC_VERSION >= 3000)
150 #pragma GCC poison DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
151 #endif
152
153 /* The size of the target's pointer type. */
154 #ifndef PTR_SIZE
155 #define PTR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
156 #endif
157
158 /* Array of RTXes referenced by the debugging information, which therefore
159 must be kept around forever. */
160 static GTY(()) vec<rtx, va_gc> *used_rtx_array;
161
162 /* A pointer to the base of a list of incomplete types which might be
163 completed at some later time. incomplete_types_list needs to be a
164 vec<tree, va_gc> *because we want to tell the garbage collector about
165 it. */
166 static GTY(()) vec<tree, va_gc> *incomplete_types;
167
168 /* A pointer to the base of a table of references to declaration
169 scopes. This table is a display which tracks the nesting
170 of declaration scopes at the current scope and containing
171 scopes. This table is used to find the proper place to
172 define type declaration DIE's. */
173 static GTY(()) vec<tree, va_gc> *decl_scope_table;
174
175 /* Pointers to various DWARF2 sections. */
176 static GTY(()) section *debug_info_section;
177 static GTY(()) section *debug_skeleton_info_section;
178 static GTY(()) section *debug_abbrev_section;
179 static GTY(()) section *debug_skeleton_abbrev_section;
180 static GTY(()) section *debug_aranges_section;
181 static GTY(()) section *debug_addr_section;
182 static GTY(()) section *debug_macinfo_section;
183 static GTY(()) section *debug_line_section;
184 static GTY(()) section *debug_skeleton_line_section;
185 static GTY(()) section *debug_loc_section;
186 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubnames_section;
187 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubtypes_section;
188 static GTY(()) section *debug_str_section;
189 static GTY(()) section *debug_str_dwo_section;
190 static GTY(()) section *debug_str_offsets_section;
191 static GTY(()) section *debug_ranges_section;
192 static GTY(()) section *debug_frame_section;
193
194 /* Maximum size (in bytes) of an artificially generated label. */
195 #define MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES 30
196
197 /* According to the (draft) DWARF 3 specification, the initial length
198 should either be 4 or 12 bytes. When it's 12 bytes, the first 4
199 bytes are 0xffffffff, followed by the length stored in the next 8
200 bytes.
201
202 However, the SGI/MIPS ABI uses an initial length which is equal to
203 DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE. It is defined (elsewhere) accordingly. */
204
205 #ifndef DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
206 #define DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? 4 : 12)
207 #endif
208
209 /* Round SIZE up to the nearest BOUNDARY. */
210 #define DWARF_ROUND(SIZE,BOUNDARY) \
211 ((((SIZE) + (BOUNDARY) - 1) / (BOUNDARY)) * (BOUNDARY))
212
213 /* CIE identifier. */
214 #if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64
215 #define DWARF_CIE_ID \
216 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? DW_CIE_ID : DW64_CIE_ID)
217 #else
218 #define DWARF_CIE_ID DW_CIE_ID
219 #endif
220
221
222 /* A vector for a table that contains frame description
223 information for each routine. */
224 #define NOT_INDEXED (-1U)
225 #define NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED (-2U)
226
227 static GTY(()) vec<dw_fde_ref, va_gc> *fde_vec;
228
229 struct GTY((for_user)) indirect_string_node {
230 const char *str;
231 unsigned int refcount;
232 enum dwarf_form form;
233 char *label;
234 unsigned int index;
235 };
236
237 struct indirect_string_hasher : ggc_hasher<indirect_string_node *>
238 {
239 typedef const char *compare_type;
240
241 static hashval_t hash (indirect_string_node *);
242 static bool equal (indirect_string_node *, const char *);
243 };
244
245 static GTY (()) hash_table<indirect_string_hasher> *debug_str_hash;
246
247 /* With split_debug_info, both the comp_dir and dwo_name go in the
248 main object file, rather than the dwo, similar to the force_direct
249 parameter elsewhere but with additional complications:
250
251 1) The string is needed in both the main object file and the dwo.
252 That is, the comp_dir and dwo_name will appear in both places.
253
254 2) Strings can use three forms: DW_FORM_string, DW_FORM_strp or
255 DW_FORM_GNU_str_index.
256
257 3) GCC chooses the form to use late, depending on the size and
258 reference count.
259
260 Rather than forcing the all debug string handling functions and
261 callers to deal with these complications, simply use a separate,
262 special-cased string table for any attribute that should go in the
263 main object file. This limits the complexity to just the places
264 that need it. */
265
266 static GTY (()) hash_table<indirect_string_hasher> *skeleton_debug_str_hash;
267
268 static GTY(()) int dw2_string_counter;
269
270 /* True if the compilation unit places functions in more than one section. */
271 static GTY(()) bool have_multiple_function_sections = false;
272
273 /* Whether the default text and cold text sections have been used at all. */
274
275 static GTY(()) bool text_section_used = false;
276 static GTY(()) bool cold_text_section_used = false;
277
278 /* The default cold text section. */
279 static GTY(()) section *cold_text_section;
280
281 /* The DIE for C++14 'auto' in a function return type. */
282 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref auto_die;
283
284 /* The DIE for C++14 'decltype(auto)' in a function return type. */
285 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref decltype_auto_die;
286
287 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
288
289 static char *stripattributes (const char *);
290 static void output_call_frame_info (int);
291 static void dwarf2out_note_section_used (void);
292
293 /* Personality decl of current unit. Used only when assembler does not support
294 personality CFI. */
295 static GTY(()) rtx current_unit_personality;
296
297 /* Data and reference forms for relocatable data. */
298 #define DW_FORM_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_data8 : DW_FORM_data4)
299 #define DW_FORM_ref (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_ref8 : DW_FORM_ref4)
300
301 #ifndef DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION
302 #define DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION ".debug_frame"
303 #endif
304
305 #ifndef FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL
306 #define FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL "LFB"
307 #endif
308
309 #ifndef FUNC_END_LABEL
310 #define FUNC_END_LABEL "LFE"
311 #endif
312
313 #ifndef PROLOGUE_END_LABEL
314 #define PROLOGUE_END_LABEL "LPE"
315 #endif
316
317 #ifndef EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL
318 #define EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL "LEB"
319 #endif
320
321 #ifndef FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL
322 #define FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL "Lframe"
323 #endif
324 #define CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LSCIE"
325 #define CIE_END_LABEL "LECIE"
326 #define FDE_LABEL "LSFDE"
327 #define FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LASFDE"
328 #define FDE_END_LABEL "LEFDE"
329 #define LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL "LSLT"
330 #define LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL "LELT"
331 #define LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL "LASLTP"
332 #define LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL "LELTP"
333 #define DIE_LABEL_PREFIX "DW"
334 \f
335 /* Match the base name of a file to the base name of a compilation unit. */
336
337 static int
338 matches_main_base (const char *path)
339 {
340 /* Cache the last query. */
341 static const char *last_path = NULL;
342 static int last_match = 0;
343 if (path != last_path)
344 {
345 const char *base;
346 int length = base_of_path (path, &base);
347 last_path = path;
348 last_match = (length == main_input_baselength
349 && memcmp (base, main_input_basename, length) == 0);
350 }
351 return last_match;
352 }
353
354 #ifdef DEBUG_DEBUG_STRUCT
355
356 static int
357 dump_struct_debug (tree type, enum debug_info_usage usage,
358 enum debug_struct_file criterion, int generic,
359 int matches, int result)
360 {
361 /* Find the type name. */
362 tree type_decl = TYPE_STUB_DECL (type);
363 tree t = type_decl;
364 const char *name = 0;
365 if (TREE_CODE (t) == TYPE_DECL)
366 t = DECL_NAME (t);
367 if (t)
368 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t);
369
370 fprintf (stderr, " struct %d %s %s %s %s %d %p %s\n",
371 criterion,
372 DECL_IN_SYSTEM_HEADER (type_decl) ? "sys" : "usr",
373 matches ? "bas" : "hdr",
374 generic ? "gen" : "ord",
375 usage == DINFO_USAGE_DFN ? ";" :
376 usage == DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE ? "." : "*",
377 result,
378 (void*) type_decl, name);
379 return result;
380 }
381 #define DUMP_GSTRUCT(type, usage, criterion, generic, matches, result) \
382 dump_struct_debug (type, usage, criterion, generic, matches, result)
383
384 #else
385
386 #define DUMP_GSTRUCT(type, usage, criterion, generic, matches, result) \
387 (result)
388
389 #endif
390
391 /* Get the number of HOST_WIDE_INTs needed to represent the precision
392 of the number. */
393
394 static unsigned int
395 get_full_len (const wide_int &op)
396 {
397 return ((op.get_precision () + HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 1)
398 / HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT);
399 }
400
401 static bool
402 should_emit_struct_debug (tree type, enum debug_info_usage usage)
403 {
404 enum debug_struct_file criterion;
405 tree type_decl;
406 bool generic = lang_hooks.types.generic_p (type);
407
408 if (generic)
409 criterion = debug_struct_generic[usage];
410 else
411 criterion = debug_struct_ordinary[usage];
412
413 if (criterion == DINFO_STRUCT_FILE_NONE)
414 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, false);
415 if (criterion == DINFO_STRUCT_FILE_ANY)
416 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, true);
417
418 type_decl = TYPE_STUB_DECL (TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type));
419
420 if (type_decl != NULL)
421 {
422 if (criterion == DINFO_STRUCT_FILE_SYS && DECL_IN_SYSTEM_HEADER (type_decl))
423 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, true);
424
425 if (matches_main_base (DECL_SOURCE_FILE (type_decl)))
426 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, true, true);
427 }
428
429 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, false);
430 }
431 \f
432 /* Return a pointer to a copy of the section string name S with all
433 attributes stripped off, and an asterisk prepended (for assemble_name). */
434
435 static inline char *
436 stripattributes (const char *s)
437 {
438 char *stripped = XNEWVEC (char, strlen (s) + 2);
439 char *p = stripped;
440
441 *p++ = '*';
442
443 while (*s && *s != ',')
444 *p++ = *s++;
445
446 *p = '\0';
447 return stripped;
448 }
449
450 /* Switch [BACK] to eh_frame_section. If we don't have an eh_frame_section,
451 switch to the data section instead, and write out a synthetic start label
452 for collect2 the first time around. */
453
454 static void
455 switch_to_eh_frame_section (bool back)
456 {
457 tree label;
458
459 #ifdef EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
460 if (eh_frame_section == 0)
461 {
462 int flags;
463
464 if (EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY)
465 {
466 int fde_encoding;
467 int per_encoding;
468 int lsda_encoding;
469
470 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1,
471 /*global=*/0);
472 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2,
473 /*global=*/1);
474 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0,
475 /*global=*/0);
476 flags = ((! flag_pic
477 || ((fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
478 && (fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
479 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
480 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
481 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
482 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned))
483 ? 0 : SECTION_WRITE);
484 }
485 else
486 flags = SECTION_WRITE;
487 eh_frame_section = get_section (EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME, flags, NULL);
488 }
489 #endif /* EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME */
490
491 if (eh_frame_section)
492 switch_to_section (eh_frame_section);
493 else
494 {
495 /* We have no special eh_frame section. Put the information in
496 the data section and emit special labels to guide collect2. */
497 switch_to_section (data_section);
498
499 if (!back)
500 {
501 label = get_file_function_name ("F");
502 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
503 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file,
504 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
505 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
506 }
507 }
508 }
509
510 /* Switch [BACK] to the eh or debug frame table section, depending on
511 FOR_EH. */
512
513 static void
514 switch_to_frame_table_section (int for_eh, bool back)
515 {
516 if (for_eh)
517 switch_to_eh_frame_section (back);
518 else
519 {
520 if (!debug_frame_section)
521 debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
522 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
523 switch_to_section (debug_frame_section);
524 }
525 }
526
527 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd1 are used. */
528
529 enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
530 dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
531 {
532 switch (cfi)
533 {
534 case DW_CFA_nop:
535 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
536 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
537 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
538 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
539
540 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
541 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
542 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
543 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
544 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
545 return dw_cfi_oprnd_addr;
546
547 case DW_CFA_offset:
548 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
549 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
550 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
551 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
552 case DW_CFA_restore:
553 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
554 case DW_CFA_undefined:
555 case DW_CFA_same_value:
556 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
557 case DW_CFA_register:
558 case DW_CFA_expression:
559 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
560
561 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
562 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
563 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
564 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
565
566 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
567 return dw_cfi_oprnd_loc;
568
569 default:
570 gcc_unreachable ();
571 }
572 }
573
574 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd2 are used. */
575
576 enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
577 dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
578 {
579 switch (cfi)
580 {
581 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
582 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
583 case DW_CFA_offset:
584 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
585 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
586 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
587
588 case DW_CFA_register:
589 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
590
591 case DW_CFA_expression:
592 return dw_cfi_oprnd_loc;
593
594 default:
595 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
596 }
597 }
598
599 /* Output one FDE. */
600
601 static void
602 output_fde (dw_fde_ref fde, bool for_eh, bool second,
603 char *section_start_label, int fde_encoding, char *augmentation,
604 bool any_lsda_needed, int lsda_encoding)
605 {
606 const char *begin, *end;
607 static unsigned int j;
608 char l1[20], l2[20];
609
610 targetm.asm_out.emit_unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde->decl, for_eh,
611 /* empty */ 0);
612 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, FDE_LABEL,
613 for_eh + j);
614 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh + j);
615 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, FDE_END_LABEL, for_eh + j);
616 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
617 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff, "Initial length escape value"
618 " indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
619 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
620 "FDE Length");
621 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
622
623 if (for_eh)
624 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, l1, section_start_label, "FDE CIE offset");
625 else
626 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, section_start_label,
627 debug_frame_section, "FDE CIE offset");
628
629 begin = second ? fde->dw_fde_second_begin : fde->dw_fde_begin;
630 end = second ? fde->dw_fde_second_end : fde->dw_fde_end;
631
632 if (for_eh)
633 {
634 rtx sym_ref = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, begin);
635 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
636 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding, sym_ref, false,
637 "FDE initial location");
638 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
639 end, begin, "FDE address range");
640 }
641 else
642 {
643 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, begin, "FDE initial location");
644 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, end, begin, "FDE address range");
645 }
646
647 if (augmentation[0])
648 {
649 if (any_lsda_needed)
650 {
651 int size = size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding);
652
653 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
654 {
655 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
656 + 4 /* CIE offset */
657 + 2 * size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding)
658 + 1 /* Augmentation size */ );
659 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
660
661 size += pad;
662 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (size) == 1);
663 }
664
665 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "Augmentation size");
666
667 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
668 {
669 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, second ? "LLSDAC" : "LLSDA",
670 fde->funcdef_number);
671 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (lsda_encoding,
672 gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, l1),
673 false,
674 "Language Specific Data Area");
675 }
676 else
677 {
678 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
679 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
680 dw2_asm_output_data (size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding), 0,
681 "Language Specific Data Area (none)");
682 }
683 }
684 else
685 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "Augmentation size");
686 }
687
688 /* Loop through the Call Frame Instructions associated with this FDE. */
689 fde->dw_fde_current_label = begin;
690 {
691 size_t from, until, i;
692
693 from = 0;
694 until = vec_safe_length (fde->dw_fde_cfi);
695
696 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin == NULL)
697 ;
698 else if (!second)
699 until = fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index;
700 else
701 from = fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index;
702
703 for (i = from; i < until; i++)
704 output_cfi ((*fde->dw_fde_cfi)[i], fde, for_eh);
705 }
706
707 /* If we are to emit a ref/link from function bodies to their frame tables,
708 do it now. This is typically performed to make sure that tables
709 associated with functions are dragged with them and not discarded in
710 garbage collecting links. We need to do this on a per function basis to
711 cope with -ffunction-sections. */
712
713 #ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF
714 /* Switch to the function section, emit the ref to the tables, and
715 switch *back* into the table section. */
716 switch_to_section (function_section (fde->decl));
717 ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (section_start_label);
718 switch_to_frame_table_section (for_eh, true);
719 #endif
720
721 /* Pad the FDE out to an address sized boundary. */
722 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
723 floor_log2 ((for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)));
724 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
725
726 j += 2;
727 }
728
729 /* Return true if frame description entry FDE is needed for EH. */
730
731 static bool
732 fde_needed_for_eh_p (dw_fde_ref fde)
733 {
734 if (flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
735 return true;
736
737 if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO && DECL_WEAK (fde->decl))
738 return true;
739
740 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
741 return true;
742
743 /* If exceptions are enabled, we have collected nothrow info. */
744 if (flag_exceptions && (fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls || fde->nothrow))
745 return false;
746
747 return true;
748 }
749
750 /* Output the call frame information used to record information
751 that relates to calculating the frame pointer, and records the
752 location of saved registers. */
753
754 static void
755 output_call_frame_info (int for_eh)
756 {
757 unsigned int i;
758 dw_fde_ref fde;
759 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
760 char l1[20], l2[20], section_start_label[20];
761 bool any_lsda_needed = false;
762 char augmentation[6];
763 int augmentation_size;
764 int fde_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
765 int per_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
766 int lsda_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
767 int return_reg;
768 rtx personality = NULL;
769 int dw_cie_version;
770
771 /* Don't emit a CIE if there won't be any FDEs. */
772 if (!fde_vec)
773 return;
774
775 /* Nothing to do if the assembler's doing it all. */
776 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
777 return;
778
779 /* If we don't have any functions we'll want to unwind out of, don't emit
780 any EH unwind information. If we make FDEs linkonce, we may have to
781 emit an empty label for an FDE that wouldn't otherwise be emitted. We
782 want to avoid having an FDE kept around when the function it refers to
783 is discarded. Example where this matters: a primary function template
784 in C++ requires EH information, an explicit specialization doesn't. */
785 if (for_eh)
786 {
787 bool any_eh_needed = false;
788
789 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, i, fde)
790 {
791 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
792 any_eh_needed = any_lsda_needed = true;
793 else if (fde_needed_for_eh_p (fde))
794 any_eh_needed = true;
795 else if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO)
796 targetm.asm_out.emit_unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde->decl, 1, 1);
797 }
798
799 if (!any_eh_needed)
800 return;
801 }
802
803 /* We're going to be generating comments, so turn on app. */
804 if (flag_debug_asm)
805 app_enable ();
806
807 /* Switch to the proper frame section, first time. */
808 switch_to_frame_table_section (for_eh, false);
809
810 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (section_start_label, FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL, for_eh);
811 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, section_start_label);
812
813 /* Output the CIE. */
814 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh);
815 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, CIE_END_LABEL, for_eh);
816 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
817 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
818 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
819 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
820 "Length of Common Information Entry");
821 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
822
823 /* Now that the CIE pointer is PC-relative for EH,
824 use 0 to identify the CIE. */
825 dw2_asm_output_data ((for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE),
826 (for_eh ? 0 : DWARF_CIE_ID),
827 "CIE Identifier Tag");
828
829 /* Use the CIE version 3 for DWARF3; allow DWARF2 to continue to
830 use CIE version 1, unless that would produce incorrect results
831 due to overflowing the return register column. */
832 return_reg = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, for_eh);
833 dw_cie_version = 1;
834 if (return_reg >= 256 || dwarf_version > 2)
835 dw_cie_version = 3;
836 dw2_asm_output_data (1, dw_cie_version, "CIE Version");
837
838 augmentation[0] = 0;
839 augmentation_size = 0;
840
841 personality = current_unit_personality;
842 if (for_eh)
843 {
844 char *p;
845
846 /* Augmentation:
847 z Indicates that a uleb128 is present to size the
848 augmentation section.
849 L Indicates the encoding (and thus presence) of
850 an LSDA pointer in the FDE augmentation.
851 R Indicates a non-default pointer encoding for
852 FDE code pointers.
853 P Indicates the presence of an encoding + language
854 personality routine in the CIE augmentation. */
855
856 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0);
857 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
858 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
859
860 p = augmentation + 1;
861 if (personality)
862 {
863 *p++ = 'P';
864 augmentation_size += 1 + size_of_encoded_value (per_encoding);
865 assemble_external_libcall (personality);
866 }
867 if (any_lsda_needed)
868 {
869 *p++ = 'L';
870 augmentation_size += 1;
871 }
872 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
873 {
874 *p++ = 'R';
875 augmentation_size += 1;
876 }
877 if (p > augmentation + 1)
878 {
879 augmentation[0] = 'z';
880 *p = '\0';
881 }
882
883 /* Ug. Some platforms can't do unaligned dynamic relocations at all. */
884 if (personality && per_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
885 {
886 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
887 + 4 /* CIE Id */
888 + 1 /* CIE version */
889 + strlen (augmentation) + 1 /* Augmentation */
890 + size_of_uleb128 (1) /* Code alignment */
891 + size_of_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT)
892 + 1 /* RA column */
893 + 1 /* Augmentation size */
894 + 1 /* Personality encoding */ );
895 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
896
897 augmentation_size += pad;
898
899 /* Augmentations should be small, so there's scarce need to
900 iterate for a solution. Die if we exceed one uleb128 byte. */
901 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (augmentation_size) == 1);
902 }
903 }
904
905 dw2_asm_output_nstring (augmentation, -1, "CIE Augmentation");
906 if (dw_cie_version >= 4)
907 {
908 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "CIE Address Size");
909 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "CIE Segment Size");
910 }
911 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, "CIE Code Alignment Factor");
912 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT,
913 "CIE Data Alignment Factor");
914
915 if (dw_cie_version == 1)
916 dw2_asm_output_data (1, return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
917 else
918 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
919
920 if (augmentation[0])
921 {
922 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (augmentation_size, "Augmentation size");
923 if (personality)
924 {
925 dw2_asm_output_data (1, per_encoding, "Personality (%s)",
926 eh_data_format_name (per_encoding));
927 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (per_encoding,
928 personality,
929 true, NULL);
930 }
931
932 if (any_lsda_needed)
933 dw2_asm_output_data (1, lsda_encoding, "LSDA Encoding (%s)",
934 eh_data_format_name (lsda_encoding));
935
936 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
937 dw2_asm_output_data (1, fde_encoding, "FDE Encoding (%s)",
938 eh_data_format_name (fde_encoding));
939 }
940
941 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*cie_cfi_vec, i, cfi)
942 output_cfi (cfi, NULL, for_eh);
943
944 /* Pad the CIE out to an address sized boundary. */
945 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
946 floor_log2 (for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE));
947 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
948
949 /* Loop through all of the FDE's. */
950 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, i, fde)
951 {
952 unsigned int k;
953
954 /* Don't emit EH unwind info for leaf functions that don't need it. */
955 if (for_eh && !fde_needed_for_eh_p (fde))
956 continue;
957
958 for (k = 0; k < (fde->dw_fde_second_begin ? 2 : 1); k++)
959 output_fde (fde, for_eh, k, section_start_label, fde_encoding,
960 augmentation, any_lsda_needed, lsda_encoding);
961 }
962
963 if (for_eh && targetm.terminate_dw2_eh_frame_info)
964 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0, "End of Table");
965
966 /* Turn off app to make assembly quicker. */
967 if (flag_debug_asm)
968 app_disable ();
969 }
970
971 /* Emit .cfi_startproc and .cfi_personality/.cfi_lsda if needed. */
972
973 static void
974 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (bool second)
975 {
976 int enc;
977 rtx ref;
978 rtx personality = get_personality_function (current_function_decl);
979
980 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_startproc\n");
981
982 if (personality)
983 {
984 enc = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
985 ref = personality;
986
987 /* ??? The GAS support isn't entirely consistent. We have to
988 handle indirect support ourselves, but PC-relative is done
989 in the assembler. Further, the assembler can't handle any
990 of the weirder relocation types. */
991 if (enc & DW_EH_PE_indirect)
992 ref = dw2_force_const_mem (ref, true);
993
994 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_personality %#x,", enc);
995 output_addr_const (asm_out_file, ref);
996 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
997 }
998
999 if (crtl->uses_eh_lsda)
1000 {
1001 char lab[20];
1002
1003 enc = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
1004 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (lab, second ? "LLSDAC" : "LLSDA",
1005 current_function_funcdef_no);
1006 ref = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, lab);
1007 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (ref) = SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
1008
1009 if (enc & DW_EH_PE_indirect)
1010 ref = dw2_force_const_mem (ref, true);
1011
1012 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_lsda %#x,", enc);
1013 output_addr_const (asm_out_file, ref);
1014 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
1015 }
1016 }
1017
1018 /* Allocate CURRENT_FDE. Immediately initialize all we can, noting that
1019 this allocation may be done before pass_final. */
1020
1021 dw_fde_ref
1022 dwarf2out_alloc_current_fde (void)
1023 {
1024 dw_fde_ref fde;
1025
1026 fde = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_fde_node> ();
1027 fde->decl = current_function_decl;
1028 fde->funcdef_number = current_function_funcdef_no;
1029 fde->fde_index = vec_safe_length (fde_vec);
1030 fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls = crtl->all_throwers_are_sibcalls;
1031 fde->uses_eh_lsda = crtl->uses_eh_lsda;
1032 fde->nothrow = crtl->nothrow;
1033 fde->drap_reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
1034 fde->vdrap_reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
1035
1036 /* Record the FDE associated with this function. */
1037 cfun->fde = fde;
1038 vec_safe_push (fde_vec, fde);
1039
1040 return fde;
1041 }
1042
1043 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of a function, before
1044 the prologue. */
1045
1046 void
1047 dwarf2out_begin_prologue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1048 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1049 {
1050 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1051 char * dup_label;
1052 dw_fde_ref fde;
1053 section *fnsec;
1054 bool do_frame;
1055
1056 current_function_func_begin_label = NULL;
1057
1058 do_frame = dwarf2out_do_frame ();
1059
1060 /* ??? current_function_func_begin_label is also used by except.c for
1061 call-site information. We must emit this label if it might be used. */
1062 if (!do_frame
1063 && (!flag_exceptions
1064 || targetm_common.except_unwind_info (&global_options) == UI_SJLJ))
1065 return;
1066
1067 fnsec = function_section (current_function_decl);
1068 switch_to_section (fnsec);
1069 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
1070 current_function_funcdef_no);
1071 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
1072 current_function_funcdef_no);
1073 dup_label = xstrdup (label);
1074 current_function_func_begin_label = dup_label;
1075
1076 /* We can elide the fde allocation if we're not emitting debug info. */
1077 if (!do_frame)
1078 return;
1079
1080 /* Cater to the various TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK implementations that
1081 emit insns as rtx but bypass the bulk of rest_of_compilation, which
1082 would include pass_dwarf2_frame. If we've not created the FDE yet,
1083 do so now. */
1084 fde = cfun->fde;
1085 if (fde == NULL)
1086 fde = dwarf2out_alloc_current_fde ();
1087
1088 /* Initialize the bits of CURRENT_FDE that were not available earlier. */
1089 fde->dw_fde_begin = dup_label;
1090 fde->dw_fde_current_label = dup_label;
1091 fde->in_std_section = (fnsec == text_section
1092 || (cold_text_section && fnsec == cold_text_section));
1093
1094 /* We only want to output line number information for the genuine dwarf2
1095 prologue case, not the eh frame case. */
1096 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
1097 if (file)
1098 dwarf2out_source_line (line, file, 0, true);
1099 #endif
1100
1101 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
1102 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (false);
1103 else
1104 {
1105 rtx personality = get_personality_function (current_function_decl);
1106 if (!current_unit_personality)
1107 current_unit_personality = personality;
1108
1109 /* We cannot keep a current personality per function as without CFI
1110 asm, at the point where we emit the CFI data, there is no current
1111 function anymore. */
1112 if (personality && current_unit_personality != personality)
1113 sorry ("multiple EH personalities are supported only with assemblers "
1114 "supporting .cfi_personality directive");
1115 }
1116 }
1117
1118 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code
1119 for a function prologue. This gets called *after* the prologue code has
1120 been generated. */
1121
1122 void
1123 dwarf2out_vms_end_prologue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1124 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1125 {
1126 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1127
1128 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
1129 function. */
1130 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, PROLOGUE_END_LABEL,
1131 current_function_funcdef_no);
1132 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, PROLOGUE_END_LABEL,
1133 current_function_funcdef_no);
1134 cfun->fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue = xstrdup (label);
1135 }
1136
1137 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code
1138 for a function epilogue. This gets called *before* the prologue code has
1139 been generated. */
1140
1141 void
1142 dwarf2out_vms_begin_epilogue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1143 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1144 {
1145 dw_fde_ref fde = cfun->fde;
1146 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1147
1148 if (fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue)
1149 return;
1150
1151 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
1152 function. */
1153 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL,
1154 current_function_funcdef_no);
1155 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL,
1156 current_function_funcdef_no);
1157 fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue = xstrdup (label);
1158 }
1159
1160 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the absolute end of the generated code
1161 for a function definition. This gets called *after* the epilogue code has
1162 been generated. */
1163
1164 void
1165 dwarf2out_end_epilogue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1166 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1167 {
1168 dw_fde_ref fde;
1169 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1170
1171 last_var_location_insn = NULL;
1172 cached_next_real_insn = NULL;
1173
1174 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
1175 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_endproc\n");
1176
1177 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
1178 function. */
1179 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_END_LABEL,
1180 current_function_funcdef_no);
1181 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
1182 fde = cfun->fde;
1183 gcc_assert (fde != NULL);
1184 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin == NULL)
1185 fde->dw_fde_end = xstrdup (label);
1186 }
1187
1188 void
1189 dwarf2out_frame_finish (void)
1190 {
1191 /* Output call frame information. */
1192 if (targetm.debug_unwind_info () == UI_DWARF2)
1193 output_call_frame_info (0);
1194
1195 /* Output another copy for the unwinder. */
1196 if ((flag_unwind_tables || flag_exceptions)
1197 && targetm_common.except_unwind_info (&global_options) == UI_DWARF2)
1198 output_call_frame_info (1);
1199 }
1200
1201 /* Note that the current function section is being used for code. */
1202
1203 static void
1204 dwarf2out_note_section_used (void)
1205 {
1206 section *sec = current_function_section ();
1207 if (sec == text_section)
1208 text_section_used = true;
1209 else if (sec == cold_text_section)
1210 cold_text_section_used = true;
1211 }
1212
1213 static void var_location_switch_text_section (void);
1214 static void set_cur_line_info_table (section *);
1215
1216 void
1217 dwarf2out_switch_text_section (void)
1218 {
1219 section *sect;
1220 dw_fde_ref fde = cfun->fde;
1221
1222 gcc_assert (cfun && fde && fde->dw_fde_second_begin == NULL);
1223
1224 if (!in_cold_section_p)
1225 {
1226 fde->dw_fde_end = crtl->subsections.cold_section_end_label;
1227 fde->dw_fde_second_begin = crtl->subsections.hot_section_label;
1228 fde->dw_fde_second_end = crtl->subsections.hot_section_end_label;
1229 }
1230 else
1231 {
1232 fde->dw_fde_end = crtl->subsections.hot_section_end_label;
1233 fde->dw_fde_second_begin = crtl->subsections.cold_section_label;
1234 fde->dw_fde_second_end = crtl->subsections.cold_section_end_label;
1235 }
1236 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
1237
1238 /* There is no need to mark used sections when not debugging. */
1239 if (cold_text_section != NULL)
1240 dwarf2out_note_section_used ();
1241
1242 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
1243 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_endproc\n");
1244
1245 /* Now do the real section switch. */
1246 sect = current_function_section ();
1247 switch_to_section (sect);
1248
1249 fde->second_in_std_section
1250 = (sect == text_section
1251 || (cold_text_section && sect == cold_text_section));
1252
1253 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
1254 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (true);
1255
1256 var_location_switch_text_section ();
1257
1258 if (cold_text_section != NULL)
1259 set_cur_line_info_table (sect);
1260 }
1261 \f
1262 /* And now, the subset of the debugging information support code necessary
1263 for emitting location expressions. */
1264
1265 /* Data about a single source file. */
1266 struct GTY((for_user)) dwarf_file_data {
1267 const char * filename;
1268 int emitted_number;
1269 };
1270
1271 typedef struct GTY(()) deferred_locations_struct
1272 {
1273 tree variable;
1274 dw_die_ref die;
1275 } deferred_locations;
1276
1277
1278 static GTY(()) vec<deferred_locations, va_gc> *deferred_locations_list;
1279
1280
1281 /* Describe an entry into the .debug_addr section. */
1282
1283 enum ate_kind {
1284 ate_kind_rtx,
1285 ate_kind_rtx_dtprel,
1286 ate_kind_label
1287 };
1288
1289 typedef struct GTY((for_user)) addr_table_entry_struct {
1290 enum ate_kind kind;
1291 unsigned int refcount;
1292 unsigned int index;
1293 union addr_table_entry_struct_union
1294 {
1295 rtx GTY ((tag ("0"))) rtl;
1296 char * GTY ((tag ("1"))) label;
1297 }
1298 GTY ((desc ("%1.kind"))) addr;
1299 }
1300 addr_table_entry;
1301
1302 /* Location lists are ranges + location descriptions for that range,
1303 so you can track variables that are in different places over
1304 their entire life. */
1305 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_loc_list_struct {
1306 dw_loc_list_ref dw_loc_next;
1307 const char *begin; /* Label and addr_entry for start of range */
1308 addr_table_entry *begin_entry;
1309 const char *end; /* Label for end of range */
1310 char *ll_symbol; /* Label for beginning of location list.
1311 Only on head of list */
1312 const char *section; /* Section this loclist is relative to */
1313 dw_loc_descr_ref expr;
1314 hashval_t hash;
1315 /* True if all addresses in this and subsequent lists are known to be
1316 resolved. */
1317 bool resolved_addr;
1318 /* True if this list has been replaced by dw_loc_next. */
1319 bool replaced;
1320 bool emitted;
1321 /* True if the range should be emitted even if begin and end
1322 are the same. */
1323 bool force;
1324 } dw_loc_list_node;
1325
1326 static dw_loc_descr_ref int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT);
1327
1328 /* Convert a DWARF stack opcode into its string name. */
1329
1330 static const char *
1331 dwarf_stack_op_name (unsigned int op)
1332 {
1333 const char *name = get_DW_OP_name (op);
1334
1335 if (name != NULL)
1336 return name;
1337
1338 return "OP_<unknown>";
1339 }
1340
1341 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description. Location
1342 descriptions are simple expression terms that can be strung
1343 together to form more complicated location (address) descriptions. */
1344
1345 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
1346 new_loc_descr (enum dwarf_location_atom op, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd1,
1347 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd2)
1348 {
1349 dw_loc_descr_ref descr = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_loc_descr_node> ();
1350
1351 descr->dw_loc_opc = op;
1352 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
1353 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry = NULL;
1354 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = oprnd1;
1355 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
1356 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_entry = NULL;
1357 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned = oprnd2;
1358
1359 return descr;
1360 }
1361
1362 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description for
1363 REG and OFFSET. */
1364
1365 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
1366 new_reg_loc_descr (unsigned int reg, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1367 {
1368 if (reg <= 31)
1369 return new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + reg),
1370 offset, 0);
1371 else
1372 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, reg, offset);
1373 }
1374
1375 /* Add a location description term to a location description expression. */
1376
1377 static inline void
1378 add_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
1379 {
1380 dw_loc_descr_ref *d;
1381
1382 /* Find the end of the chain. */
1383 for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
1384 ;
1385
1386 *d = descr;
1387 }
1388
1389 /* Compare two location operands for exact equality. */
1390
1391 static bool
1392 dw_val_equal_p (dw_val_node *a, dw_val_node *b)
1393 {
1394 if (a->val_class != b->val_class)
1395 return false;
1396 switch (a->val_class)
1397 {
1398 case dw_val_class_none:
1399 return true;
1400 case dw_val_class_addr:
1401 return rtx_equal_p (a->v.val_addr, b->v.val_addr);
1402
1403 case dw_val_class_offset:
1404 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
1405 case dw_val_class_const:
1406 case dw_val_class_range_list:
1407 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
1408 case dw_val_class_macptr:
1409 /* These are all HOST_WIDE_INT, signed or unsigned. */
1410 return a->v.val_unsigned == b->v.val_unsigned;
1411
1412 case dw_val_class_loc:
1413 return a->v.val_loc == b->v.val_loc;
1414 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
1415 return a->v.val_loc_list == b->v.val_loc_list;
1416 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
1417 return a->v.val_die_ref.die == b->v.val_die_ref.die;
1418 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
1419 return a->v.val_fde_index == b->v.val_fde_index;
1420 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
1421 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
1422 return strcmp (a->v.val_lbl_id, b->v.val_lbl_id) == 0;
1423 case dw_val_class_str:
1424 return a->v.val_str == b->v.val_str;
1425 case dw_val_class_flag:
1426 return a->v.val_flag == b->v.val_flag;
1427 case dw_val_class_file:
1428 return a->v.val_file == b->v.val_file;
1429 case dw_val_class_decl_ref:
1430 return a->v.val_decl_ref == b->v.val_decl_ref;
1431
1432 case dw_val_class_const_double:
1433 return (a->v.val_double.high == b->v.val_double.high
1434 && a->v.val_double.low == b->v.val_double.low);
1435
1436 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
1437 return *a->v.val_wide == *b->v.val_wide;
1438
1439 case dw_val_class_vec:
1440 {
1441 size_t a_len = a->v.val_vec.elt_size * a->v.val_vec.length;
1442 size_t b_len = b->v.val_vec.elt_size * b->v.val_vec.length;
1443
1444 return (a_len == b_len
1445 && !memcmp (a->v.val_vec.array, b->v.val_vec.array, a_len));
1446 }
1447
1448 case dw_val_class_data8:
1449 return memcmp (a->v.val_data8, b->v.val_data8, 8) == 0;
1450
1451 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
1452 return (!strcmp (a->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1, b->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1)
1453 && !strcmp (a->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1, b->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1));
1454 }
1455 gcc_unreachable ();
1456 }
1457
1458 /* Compare two location atoms for exact equality. */
1459
1460 static bool
1461 loc_descr_equal_p_1 (dw_loc_descr_ref a, dw_loc_descr_ref b)
1462 {
1463 if (a->dw_loc_opc != b->dw_loc_opc)
1464 return false;
1465
1466 /* ??? This is only ever set for DW_OP_constNu, for N equal to the
1467 address size, but since we always allocate cleared storage it
1468 should be zero for other types of locations. */
1469 if (a->dtprel != b->dtprel)
1470 return false;
1471
1472 return (dw_val_equal_p (&a->dw_loc_oprnd1, &b->dw_loc_oprnd1)
1473 && dw_val_equal_p (&a->dw_loc_oprnd2, &b->dw_loc_oprnd2));
1474 }
1475
1476 /* Compare two complete location expressions for exact equality. */
1477
1478 bool
1479 loc_descr_equal_p (dw_loc_descr_ref a, dw_loc_descr_ref b)
1480 {
1481 while (1)
1482 {
1483 if (a == b)
1484 return true;
1485 if (a == NULL || b == NULL)
1486 return false;
1487 if (!loc_descr_equal_p_1 (a, b))
1488 return false;
1489
1490 a = a->dw_loc_next;
1491 b = b->dw_loc_next;
1492 }
1493 }
1494
1495
1496 /* Add a constant OFFSET to a location expression. */
1497
1498 static void
1499 loc_descr_plus_const (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1500 {
1501 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
1502 HOST_WIDE_INT *p;
1503
1504 gcc_assert (*list_head != NULL);
1505
1506 if (!offset)
1507 return;
1508
1509 /* Find the end of the chain. */
1510 for (loc = *list_head; loc->dw_loc_next != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
1511 ;
1512
1513 p = NULL;
1514 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_fbreg
1515 || (loc->dw_loc_opc >= DW_OP_breg0 && loc->dw_loc_opc <= DW_OP_breg31))
1516 p = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
1517 else if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bregx)
1518 p = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int;
1519
1520 /* If the last operation is fbreg, breg{0..31,x}, optimize by adjusting its
1521 offset. Don't optimize if an signed integer overflow would happen. */
1522 if (p != NULL
1523 && ((offset > 0 && *p <= INTTYPE_MAXIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT) - offset)
1524 || (offset < 0 && *p >= INTTYPE_MINIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT) - offset)))
1525 *p += offset;
1526
1527 else if (offset > 0)
1528 loc->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, offset, 0);
1529
1530 else
1531 {
1532 loc->dw_loc_next = int_loc_descriptor (-offset);
1533 add_loc_descr (&loc->dw_loc_next, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
1534 }
1535 }
1536
1537 /* Add a constant OFFSET to a location list. */
1538
1539 static void
1540 loc_list_plus_const (dw_loc_list_ref list_head, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1541 {
1542 dw_loc_list_ref d;
1543 for (d = list_head; d != NULL; d = d->dw_loc_next)
1544 loc_descr_plus_const (&d->expr, offset);
1545 }
1546
1547 #define DWARF_REF_SIZE \
1548 (dwarf_version == 2 ? DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
1549
1550 static unsigned long int get_base_type_offset (dw_die_ref);
1551
1552 /* Return the size of a location descriptor. */
1553
1554 static unsigned long
1555 size_of_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
1556 {
1557 unsigned long size = 1;
1558
1559 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
1560 {
1561 case DW_OP_addr:
1562 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
1563 break;
1564 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
1565 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
1566 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
1567 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index);
1568 break;
1569 case DW_OP_const1u:
1570 case DW_OP_const1s:
1571 size += 1;
1572 break;
1573 case DW_OP_const2u:
1574 case DW_OP_const2s:
1575 size += 2;
1576 break;
1577 case DW_OP_const4u:
1578 case DW_OP_const4s:
1579 size += 4;
1580 break;
1581 case DW_OP_const8u:
1582 case DW_OP_const8s:
1583 size += 8;
1584 break;
1585 case DW_OP_constu:
1586 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1587 break;
1588 case DW_OP_consts:
1589 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
1590 break;
1591 case DW_OP_pick:
1592 size += 1;
1593 break;
1594 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
1595 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1596 break;
1597 case DW_OP_skip:
1598 case DW_OP_bra:
1599 size += 2;
1600 break;
1601 case DW_OP_breg0:
1602 case DW_OP_breg1:
1603 case DW_OP_breg2:
1604 case DW_OP_breg3:
1605 case DW_OP_breg4:
1606 case DW_OP_breg5:
1607 case DW_OP_breg6:
1608 case DW_OP_breg7:
1609 case DW_OP_breg8:
1610 case DW_OP_breg9:
1611 case DW_OP_breg10:
1612 case DW_OP_breg11:
1613 case DW_OP_breg12:
1614 case DW_OP_breg13:
1615 case DW_OP_breg14:
1616 case DW_OP_breg15:
1617 case DW_OP_breg16:
1618 case DW_OP_breg17:
1619 case DW_OP_breg18:
1620 case DW_OP_breg19:
1621 case DW_OP_breg20:
1622 case DW_OP_breg21:
1623 case DW_OP_breg22:
1624 case DW_OP_breg23:
1625 case DW_OP_breg24:
1626 case DW_OP_breg25:
1627 case DW_OP_breg26:
1628 case DW_OP_breg27:
1629 case DW_OP_breg28:
1630 case DW_OP_breg29:
1631 case DW_OP_breg30:
1632 case DW_OP_breg31:
1633 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
1634 break;
1635 case DW_OP_regx:
1636 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1637 break;
1638 case DW_OP_fbreg:
1639 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
1640 break;
1641 case DW_OP_bregx:
1642 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1643 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
1644 break;
1645 case DW_OP_piece:
1646 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1647 break;
1648 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
1649 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1650 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned);
1651 break;
1652 case DW_OP_deref_size:
1653 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
1654 size += 1;
1655 break;
1656 case DW_OP_call2:
1657 size += 2;
1658 break;
1659 case DW_OP_call4:
1660 size += 4;
1661 break;
1662 case DW_OP_call_ref:
1663 size += DWARF_REF_SIZE;
1664 break;
1665 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
1666 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned)
1667 + loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
1668 break;
1669 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
1670 size += DWARF_REF_SIZE + size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
1671 break;
1672 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
1673 {
1674 unsigned long op_size = size_of_locs (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc);
1675 size += size_of_uleb128 (op_size) + op_size;
1676 break;
1677 }
1678 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
1679 {
1680 unsigned long o
1681 = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die);
1682 size += size_of_uleb128 (o) + 1;
1683 switch (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class)
1684 {
1685 case dw_val_class_vec:
1686 size += loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length
1687 * loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size;
1688 break;
1689 case dw_val_class_const:
1690 size += HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT;
1691 break;
1692 case dw_val_class_const_double:
1693 size += HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT;
1694 break;
1695 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
1696 size += (get_full_len (*loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide)
1697 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT);
1698 break;
1699 default:
1700 gcc_unreachable ();
1701 }
1702 break;
1703 }
1704 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
1705 {
1706 unsigned long o
1707 = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die);
1708 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned)
1709 + size_of_uleb128 (o);
1710 }
1711 break;
1712 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
1713 {
1714 unsigned long o
1715 = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die);
1716 size += 1 + size_of_uleb128 (o);
1717 }
1718 break;
1719 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
1720 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
1721 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
1722 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1723 else
1724 {
1725 unsigned long o
1726 = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die);
1727 size += size_of_uleb128 (o);
1728 }
1729 break;
1730 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
1731 size += 4;
1732 break;
1733 default:
1734 break;
1735 }
1736
1737 return size;
1738 }
1739
1740 /* Return the size of a series of location descriptors. */
1741
1742 unsigned long
1743 size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
1744 {
1745 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
1746 unsigned long size;
1747
1748 /* If there are no skip or bra opcodes, don't fill in the dw_loc_addr
1749 field, to avoid writing to a PCH file. */
1750 for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
1751 {
1752 if (l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_skip || l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bra)
1753 break;
1754 size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
1755 }
1756 if (! l)
1757 return size;
1758
1759 for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
1760 {
1761 l->dw_loc_addr = size;
1762 size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
1763 }
1764
1765 return size;
1766 }
1767
1768 static HOST_WIDE_INT extract_int (const unsigned char *, unsigned);
1769 static void get_ref_die_offset_label (char *, dw_die_ref);
1770 static unsigned long int get_ref_die_offset (dw_die_ref);
1771
1772 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any).
1773 The for_eh_or_skip parameter controls whether register numbers are
1774 converted using DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT, which is needed in the case that
1775 hard reg numbers have been processed via DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i.e. for unwind
1776 info). This should be suppressed for the cases that have not been converted
1777 (i.e. symbolic debug info), by setting the parameter < 0. See PR47324. */
1778
1779 static void
1780 output_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, int for_eh_or_skip)
1781 {
1782 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
1783 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
1784
1785 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
1786 {
1787 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
1788 case DW_OP_const2u:
1789 case DW_OP_const2s:
1790 dw2_asm_output_data (2, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1791 break;
1792 case DW_OP_const4u:
1793 if (loc->dtprel)
1794 {
1795 gcc_assert (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel);
1796 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file, 4,
1797 val1->v.val_addr);
1798 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
1799 break;
1800 }
1801 /* FALLTHRU */
1802 case DW_OP_const4s:
1803 dw2_asm_output_data (4, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1804 break;
1805 case DW_OP_const8u:
1806 if (loc->dtprel)
1807 {
1808 gcc_assert (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel);
1809 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file, 8,
1810 val1->v.val_addr);
1811 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
1812 break;
1813 }
1814 /* FALLTHRU */
1815 case DW_OP_const8s:
1816 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64);
1817 dw2_asm_output_data (8, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1818 break;
1819 case DW_OP_skip:
1820 case DW_OP_bra:
1821 {
1822 int offset;
1823
1824 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
1825 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
1826
1827 dw2_asm_output_data (2, offset, NULL);
1828 }
1829 break;
1830 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
1831 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
1832 switch (val2->val_class)
1833 {
1834 case dw_val_class_const:
1835 dw2_asm_output_data (val1->v.val_unsigned, val2->v.val_int, NULL);
1836 break;
1837 case dw_val_class_vec:
1838 {
1839 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
1840 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
1841 unsigned int i;
1842 unsigned char *p;
1843
1844 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
1845 {
1846 elt_size /= 2;
1847 len *= 2;
1848 }
1849 for (i = 0, p = val2->v.val_vec.array;
1850 i < len;
1851 i++, p += elt_size)
1852 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
1853 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
1854 }
1855 break;
1856 case dw_val_class_const_double:
1857 {
1858 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
1859
1860 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
1861 {
1862 first = val2->v.val_double.high;
1863 second = val2->v.val_double.low;
1864 }
1865 else
1866 {
1867 first = val2->v.val_double.low;
1868 second = val2->v.val_double.high;
1869 }
1870 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
1871 first, NULL);
1872 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
1873 second, NULL);
1874 }
1875 break;
1876 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
1877 {
1878 int i;
1879 int len = get_full_len (*val2->v.val_wide);
1880 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
1881 for (i = len - 1; i >= 0; --i)
1882 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
1883 val2->v.val_wide->elt (i), NULL);
1884 else
1885 for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
1886 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
1887 val2->v.val_wide->elt (i), NULL);
1888 }
1889 break;
1890 case dw_val_class_addr:
1891 gcc_assert (val1->v.val_unsigned == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
1892 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val2->v.val_addr, NULL);
1893 break;
1894 default:
1895 gcc_unreachable ();
1896 }
1897 break;
1898 #else
1899 case DW_OP_const2u:
1900 case DW_OP_const2s:
1901 case DW_OP_const4u:
1902 case DW_OP_const4s:
1903 case DW_OP_const8u:
1904 case DW_OP_const8s:
1905 case DW_OP_skip:
1906 case DW_OP_bra:
1907 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
1908 /* We currently don't make any attempt to make sure these are
1909 aligned properly like we do for the main unwind info, so
1910 don't support emitting things larger than a byte if we're
1911 only doing unwinding. */
1912 gcc_unreachable ();
1913 #endif
1914 case DW_OP_const1u:
1915 case DW_OP_const1s:
1916 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1917 break;
1918 case DW_OP_constu:
1919 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
1920 break;
1921 case DW_OP_consts:
1922 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1923 break;
1924 case DW_OP_pick:
1925 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1926 break;
1927 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
1928 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
1929 break;
1930 case DW_OP_breg0:
1931 case DW_OP_breg1:
1932 case DW_OP_breg2:
1933 case DW_OP_breg3:
1934 case DW_OP_breg4:
1935 case DW_OP_breg5:
1936 case DW_OP_breg6:
1937 case DW_OP_breg7:
1938 case DW_OP_breg8:
1939 case DW_OP_breg9:
1940 case DW_OP_breg10:
1941 case DW_OP_breg11:
1942 case DW_OP_breg12:
1943 case DW_OP_breg13:
1944 case DW_OP_breg14:
1945 case DW_OP_breg15:
1946 case DW_OP_breg16:
1947 case DW_OP_breg17:
1948 case DW_OP_breg18:
1949 case DW_OP_breg19:
1950 case DW_OP_breg20:
1951 case DW_OP_breg21:
1952 case DW_OP_breg22:
1953 case DW_OP_breg23:
1954 case DW_OP_breg24:
1955 case DW_OP_breg25:
1956 case DW_OP_breg26:
1957 case DW_OP_breg27:
1958 case DW_OP_breg28:
1959 case DW_OP_breg29:
1960 case DW_OP_breg30:
1961 case DW_OP_breg31:
1962 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1963 break;
1964 case DW_OP_regx:
1965 {
1966 unsigned r = val1->v.val_unsigned;
1967 if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0)
1968 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
1969 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
1970 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
1971 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
1972 }
1973 break;
1974 case DW_OP_fbreg:
1975 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1976 break;
1977 case DW_OP_bregx:
1978 {
1979 unsigned r = val1->v.val_unsigned;
1980 if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0)
1981 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
1982 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
1983 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
1984 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
1985 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
1986 }
1987 break;
1988 case DW_OP_piece:
1989 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
1990 break;
1991 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
1992 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
1993 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val2->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
1994 break;
1995 case DW_OP_deref_size:
1996 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
1997 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1998 break;
1999
2000 case DW_OP_addr:
2001 if (loc->dtprel)
2002 {
2003 if (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
2004 {
2005 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file,
2006 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2007 val1->v.val_addr);
2008 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
2009 }
2010 else
2011 gcc_unreachable ();
2012 }
2013 else
2014 {
2015 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
2016 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val1->v.val_addr, NULL);
2017 #else
2018 gcc_unreachable ();
2019 #endif
2020 }
2021 break;
2022
2023 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
2024 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
2025 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
2026 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index,
2027 "(index into .debug_addr)");
2028 break;
2029
2030 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
2031 {
2032 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES
2033 + HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / 2 + 2];
2034 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
2035 get_ref_die_offset_label (label, val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
2036 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_REF_SIZE, label, debug_info_section, NULL);
2037 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
2038 }
2039 break;
2040
2041 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
2042 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size_of_locs (val1->v.val_loc), NULL);
2043 output_loc_sequence (val1->v.val_loc, for_eh_or_skip);
2044 break;
2045
2046 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
2047 {
2048 unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val1->v.val_die_ref.die), l;
2049 gcc_assert (o);
2050 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
2051 switch (val2->val_class)
2052 {
2053 case dw_val_class_const:
2054 l = HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
2055 dw2_asm_output_data (1, l, NULL);
2056 dw2_asm_output_data (l, val2->v.val_int, NULL);
2057 break;
2058 case dw_val_class_vec:
2059 {
2060 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
2061 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
2062 unsigned int i;
2063 unsigned char *p;
2064
2065 l = len * elt_size;
2066 dw2_asm_output_data (1, l, NULL);
2067 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
2068 {
2069 elt_size /= 2;
2070 len *= 2;
2071 }
2072 for (i = 0, p = val2->v.val_vec.array;
2073 i < len;
2074 i++, p += elt_size)
2075 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
2076 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
2077 }
2078 break;
2079 case dw_val_class_const_double:
2080 {
2081 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
2082 l = HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
2083
2084 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 2 * l, NULL);
2085 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
2086 {
2087 first = val2->v.val_double.high;
2088 second = val2->v.val_double.low;
2089 }
2090 else
2091 {
2092 first = val2->v.val_double.low;
2093 second = val2->v.val_double.high;
2094 }
2095 dw2_asm_output_data (l, first, NULL);
2096 dw2_asm_output_data (l, second, NULL);
2097 }
2098 break;
2099 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
2100 {
2101 int i;
2102 int len = get_full_len (*val2->v.val_wide);
2103 l = HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
2104
2105 dw2_asm_output_data (1, len * l, NULL);
2106 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
2107 for (i = len - 1; i >= 0; --i)
2108 dw2_asm_output_data (l, val2->v.val_wide->elt (i), NULL);
2109 else
2110 for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
2111 dw2_asm_output_data (l, val2->v.val_wide->elt (i), NULL);
2112 }
2113 break;
2114 default:
2115 gcc_unreachable ();
2116 }
2117 }
2118 break;
2119 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
2120 {
2121 unsigned r = val1->v.val_unsigned;
2122 unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val2->v.val_die_ref.die);
2123 gcc_assert (o);
2124 if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0)
2125 {
2126 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
2127 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
2128 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
2129 }
2130 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2131 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
2132 }
2133 break;
2134 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
2135 {
2136 unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val2->v.val_die_ref.die);
2137 gcc_assert (o);
2138 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2139 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
2140 }
2141 break;
2142 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
2143 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
2144 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
2145 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2146 else
2147 {
2148 unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
2149 gcc_assert (o);
2150 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
2151 }
2152 break;
2153
2154 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
2155 {
2156 unsigned long o;
2157 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
2158 o = get_ref_die_offset (val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
2159 dw2_asm_output_data (4, o, NULL);
2160 }
2161 break;
2162
2163 default:
2164 /* Other codes have no operands. */
2165 break;
2166 }
2167 }
2168
2169 /* Output a sequence of location operations.
2170 The for_eh_or_skip parameter controls whether register numbers are
2171 converted using DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT, which is needed in the case that
2172 hard reg numbers have been processed via DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i.e. for unwind
2173 info). This should be suppressed for the cases that have not been converted
2174 (i.e. symbolic debug info), by setting the parameter < 0. See PR47324. */
2175
2176 void
2177 output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, int for_eh_or_skip)
2178 {
2179 for (; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
2180 {
2181 enum dwarf_location_atom opc = loc->dw_loc_opc;
2182 /* Output the opcode. */
2183 if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0
2184 && opc >= DW_OP_breg0 && opc <= DW_OP_breg31)
2185 {
2186 unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_breg0);
2187 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
2188 gcc_assert (r <= 31);
2189 opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + r);
2190 }
2191 else if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0
2192 && opc >= DW_OP_reg0 && opc <= DW_OP_reg31)
2193 {
2194 unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_reg0);
2195 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
2196 gcc_assert (r <= 31);
2197 opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_reg0 + r);
2198 }
2199
2200 dw2_asm_output_data (1, opc,
2201 "%s", dwarf_stack_op_name (opc));
2202
2203 /* Output the operand(s) (if any). */
2204 output_loc_operands (loc, for_eh_or_skip);
2205 }
2206 }
2207
2208 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any).
2209 The output is single bytes on a line, suitable for .cfi_escape. */
2210
2211 static void
2212 output_loc_operands_raw (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
2213 {
2214 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
2215 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
2216
2217 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
2218 {
2219 case DW_OP_addr:
2220 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
2221 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
2222 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
2223 /* We cannot output addresses in .cfi_escape, only bytes. */
2224 gcc_unreachable ();
2225
2226 case DW_OP_const1u:
2227 case DW_OP_const1s:
2228 case DW_OP_pick:
2229 case DW_OP_deref_size:
2230 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
2231 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2232 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (1, val1->v.val_int);
2233 break;
2234
2235 case DW_OP_const2u:
2236 case DW_OP_const2s:
2237 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2238 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (2, val1->v.val_int);
2239 break;
2240
2241 case DW_OP_const4u:
2242 case DW_OP_const4s:
2243 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2244 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (4, val1->v.val_int);
2245 break;
2246
2247 case DW_OP_const8u:
2248 case DW_OP_const8s:
2249 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64);
2250 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2251 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (8, val1->v.val_int);
2252 break;
2253
2254 case DW_OP_skip:
2255 case DW_OP_bra:
2256 {
2257 int offset;
2258
2259 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
2260 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
2261
2262 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2263 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (2, offset);
2264 }
2265 break;
2266
2267 case DW_OP_regx:
2268 {
2269 unsigned r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (val1->v.val_unsigned, 1);
2270 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
2271 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
2272 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2273 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (r);
2274 }
2275 break;
2276
2277 case DW_OP_constu:
2278 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
2279 case DW_OP_piece:
2280 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2281 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val1->v.val_unsigned);
2282 break;
2283
2284 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
2285 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2286 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val1->v.val_unsigned);
2287 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val2->v.val_unsigned);
2288 break;
2289
2290 case DW_OP_consts:
2291 case DW_OP_breg0:
2292 case DW_OP_breg1:
2293 case DW_OP_breg2:
2294 case DW_OP_breg3:
2295 case DW_OP_breg4:
2296 case DW_OP_breg5:
2297 case DW_OP_breg6:
2298 case DW_OP_breg7:
2299 case DW_OP_breg8:
2300 case DW_OP_breg9:
2301 case DW_OP_breg10:
2302 case DW_OP_breg11:
2303 case DW_OP_breg12:
2304 case DW_OP_breg13:
2305 case DW_OP_breg14:
2306 case DW_OP_breg15:
2307 case DW_OP_breg16:
2308 case DW_OP_breg17:
2309 case DW_OP_breg18:
2310 case DW_OP_breg19:
2311 case DW_OP_breg20:
2312 case DW_OP_breg21:
2313 case DW_OP_breg22:
2314 case DW_OP_breg23:
2315 case DW_OP_breg24:
2316 case DW_OP_breg25:
2317 case DW_OP_breg26:
2318 case DW_OP_breg27:
2319 case DW_OP_breg28:
2320 case DW_OP_breg29:
2321 case DW_OP_breg30:
2322 case DW_OP_breg31:
2323 case DW_OP_fbreg:
2324 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2325 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128_raw (val1->v.val_int);
2326 break;
2327
2328 case DW_OP_bregx:
2329 {
2330 unsigned r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (val1->v.val_unsigned, 1);
2331 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
2332 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
2333 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2334 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (r);
2335 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2336 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128_raw (val2->v.val_int);
2337 }
2338 break;
2339
2340 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
2341 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
2342 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
2343 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
2344 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
2345 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
2346 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
2347 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
2348 gcc_unreachable ();
2349 break;
2350
2351 default:
2352 /* Other codes have no operands. */
2353 break;
2354 }
2355 }
2356
2357 void
2358 output_loc_sequence_raw (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
2359 {
2360 while (1)
2361 {
2362 enum dwarf_location_atom opc = loc->dw_loc_opc;
2363 /* Output the opcode. */
2364 if (opc >= DW_OP_breg0 && opc <= DW_OP_breg31)
2365 {
2366 unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_breg0);
2367 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, 1);
2368 gcc_assert (r <= 31);
2369 opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + r);
2370 }
2371 else if (opc >= DW_OP_reg0 && opc <= DW_OP_reg31)
2372 {
2373 unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_reg0);
2374 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, 1);
2375 gcc_assert (r <= 31);
2376 opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_reg0 + r);
2377 }
2378 /* Output the opcode. */
2379 fprintf (asm_out_file, "%#x", opc);
2380 output_loc_operands_raw (loc);
2381
2382 if (!loc->dw_loc_next)
2383 break;
2384 loc = loc->dw_loc_next;
2385
2386 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2387 }
2388 }
2389
2390 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence from a
2391 dw_cfa_location, adding the given OFFSET to the result of the
2392 expression. */
2393
2394 struct dw_loc_descr_node *
2395 build_cfa_loc (dw_cfa_location *cfa, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
2396 {
2397 struct dw_loc_descr_node *head, *tmp;
2398
2399 offset += cfa->offset;
2400
2401 if (cfa->indirect)
2402 {
2403 head = new_reg_loc_descr (cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset);
2404 head->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
2405 head->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry = NULL;
2406 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
2407 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
2408 if (offset != 0)
2409 {
2410 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, offset, 0);
2411 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
2412 }
2413 }
2414 else
2415 head = new_reg_loc_descr (cfa->reg, offset);
2416
2417 return head;
2418 }
2419
2420 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence for
2421 the address at OFFSET from the CFA when stack is aligned to
2422 ALIGNMENT byte. */
2423
2424 struct dw_loc_descr_node *
2425 build_cfa_aligned_loc (dw_cfa_location *cfa,
2426 HOST_WIDE_INT offset, HOST_WIDE_INT alignment)
2427 {
2428 struct dw_loc_descr_node *head;
2429 unsigned int dwarf_fp
2430 = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
2431
2432 /* When CFA is defined as FP+OFFSET, emulate stack alignment. */
2433 if (cfa->reg == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM && cfa->indirect == 0)
2434 {
2435 head = new_reg_loc_descr (dwarf_fp, 0);
2436 add_loc_descr (&head, int_loc_descriptor (alignment));
2437 add_loc_descr (&head, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
2438 loc_descr_plus_const (&head, offset);
2439 }
2440 else
2441 head = new_reg_loc_descr (dwarf_fp, offset);
2442 return head;
2443 }
2444 \f
2445 /* And now, the support for symbolic debugging information. */
2446
2447 /* .debug_str support. */
2448
2449 static void dwarf2out_init (const char *);
2450 static void dwarf2out_finish (const char *);
2451 static void dwarf2out_assembly_start (void);
2452 static void dwarf2out_define (unsigned int, const char *);
2453 static void dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int, const char *);
2454 static void dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned, const char *);
2455 static void dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned);
2456 static void dwarf2out_function_decl (tree);
2457 static void dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned, unsigned);
2458 static void dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned, unsigned);
2459 static bool dwarf2out_ignore_block (const_tree);
2460 static void dwarf2out_global_decl (tree);
2461 static void dwarf2out_type_decl (tree, int);
2462 static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree, tree, tree, bool);
2463 static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (tree, tree, tree,
2464 dw_die_ref);
2465 static void dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree);
2466 static void dwarf2out_var_location (rtx_insn *);
2467 static void dwarf2out_begin_function (tree);
2468 static void dwarf2out_end_function (unsigned int);
2469 static void dwarf2out_set_name (tree, tree);
2470
2471 /* The debug hooks structure. */
2472
2473 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks =
2474 {
2475 dwarf2out_init,
2476 dwarf2out_finish,
2477 dwarf2out_assembly_start,
2478 dwarf2out_define,
2479 dwarf2out_undef,
2480 dwarf2out_start_source_file,
2481 dwarf2out_end_source_file,
2482 dwarf2out_begin_block,
2483 dwarf2out_end_block,
2484 dwarf2out_ignore_block,
2485 dwarf2out_source_line,
2486 dwarf2out_begin_prologue,
2487 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
2488 dwarf2out_vms_end_prologue,
2489 dwarf2out_vms_begin_epilogue,
2490 #else
2491 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2492 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2493 #endif
2494 dwarf2out_end_epilogue,
2495 dwarf2out_begin_function,
2496 dwarf2out_end_function, /* end_function */
2497 dwarf2out_function_decl, /* function_decl */
2498 dwarf2out_global_decl,
2499 dwarf2out_type_decl, /* type_decl */
2500 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl,
2501 debug_nothing_tree, /* deferred_inline_function */
2502 /* The DWARF 2 backend tries to reduce debugging bloat by not
2503 emitting the abstract description of inline functions until
2504 something tries to reference them. */
2505 dwarf2out_abstract_function, /* outlining_inline_function */
2506 debug_nothing_rtx_code_label, /* label */
2507 debug_nothing_int, /* handle_pch */
2508 dwarf2out_var_location,
2509 dwarf2out_switch_text_section,
2510 dwarf2out_set_name,
2511 1, /* start_end_main_source_file */
2512 TYPE_SYMTAB_IS_DIE /* tree_type_symtab_field */
2513 };
2514 \f
2515 /* NOTE: In the comments in this file, many references are made to
2516 "Debugging Information Entries". This term is abbreviated as `DIE'
2517 throughout the remainder of this file. */
2518
2519 /* An internal representation of the DWARF output is built, and then
2520 walked to generate the DWARF debugging info. The walk of the internal
2521 representation is done after the entire program has been compiled.
2522 The types below are used to describe the internal representation. */
2523
2524 /* Whether to put type DIEs into their own section .debug_types instead
2525 of making them part of the .debug_info section. Only supported for
2526 Dwarf V4 or higher and the user didn't disable them through
2527 -fno-debug-types-section. It is more efficient to put them in a
2528 separate comdat sections since the linker will then be able to
2529 remove duplicates. But not all tools support .debug_types sections
2530 yet. */
2531
2532 #define use_debug_types (dwarf_version >= 4 && flag_debug_types_section)
2533
2534 /* Various DIE's use offsets relative to the beginning of the
2535 .debug_info section to refer to each other. */
2536
2537 typedef long int dw_offset;
2538
2539 /* Define typedefs here to avoid circular dependencies. */
2540
2541 typedef struct dw_attr_struct *dw_attr_ref;
2542 typedef struct dw_line_info_struct *dw_line_info_ref;
2543 typedef struct pubname_struct *pubname_ref;
2544 typedef struct dw_ranges_struct *dw_ranges_ref;
2545 typedef struct dw_ranges_by_label_struct *dw_ranges_by_label_ref;
2546 typedef struct comdat_type_struct *comdat_type_node_ref;
2547
2548 /* The entries in the line_info table more-or-less mirror the opcodes
2549 that are used in the real dwarf line table. Arrays of these entries
2550 are collected per section when DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO is not
2551 supported. */
2552
2553 enum dw_line_info_opcode {
2554 /* Emit DW_LNE_set_address; the operand is the label index. */
2555 LI_set_address,
2556
2557 /* Emit a row to the matrix with the given line. This may be done
2558 via any combination of DW_LNS_copy, DW_LNS_advance_line, and
2559 special opcodes. */
2560 LI_set_line,
2561
2562 /* Emit a DW_LNS_set_file. */
2563 LI_set_file,
2564
2565 /* Emit a DW_LNS_set_column. */
2566 LI_set_column,
2567
2568 /* Emit a DW_LNS_negate_stmt; the operand is ignored. */
2569 LI_negate_stmt,
2570
2571 /* Emit a DW_LNS_set_prologue_end/epilogue_begin; the operand is ignored. */
2572 LI_set_prologue_end,
2573 LI_set_epilogue_begin,
2574
2575 /* Emit a DW_LNE_set_discriminator. */
2576 LI_set_discriminator
2577 };
2578
2579 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_line_info_struct {
2580 enum dw_line_info_opcode opcode;
2581 unsigned int val;
2582 } dw_line_info_entry;
2583
2584
2585 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_line_info_table_struct {
2586 /* The label that marks the end of this section. */
2587 const char *end_label;
2588
2589 /* The values for the last row of the matrix, as collected in the table.
2590 These are used to minimize the changes to the next row. */
2591 unsigned int file_num;
2592 unsigned int line_num;
2593 unsigned int column_num;
2594 int discrim_num;
2595 bool is_stmt;
2596 bool in_use;
2597
2598 vec<dw_line_info_entry, va_gc> *entries;
2599 } dw_line_info_table;
2600
2601 typedef dw_line_info_table *dw_line_info_table_p;
2602
2603
2604 /* Each DIE attribute has a field specifying the attribute kind,
2605 a link to the next attribute in the chain, and an attribute value.
2606 Attributes are typically linked below the DIE they modify. */
2607
2608 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_attr_struct {
2609 enum dwarf_attribute dw_attr;
2610 dw_val_node dw_attr_val;
2611 }
2612 dw_attr_node;
2613
2614
2615 /* The Debugging Information Entry (DIE) structure. DIEs form a tree.
2616 The children of each node form a circular list linked by
2617 die_sib. die_child points to the node *before* the "first" child node. */
2618
2619 typedef struct GTY((chain_circular ("%h.die_sib"), for_user)) die_struct {
2620 union die_symbol_or_type_node
2621 {
2622 const char * GTY ((tag ("0"))) die_symbol;
2623 comdat_type_node_ref GTY ((tag ("1"))) die_type_node;
2624 }
2625 GTY ((desc ("%0.comdat_type_p"))) die_id;
2626 vec<dw_attr_node, va_gc> *die_attr;
2627 dw_die_ref die_parent;
2628 dw_die_ref die_child;
2629 dw_die_ref die_sib;
2630 dw_die_ref die_definition; /* ref from a specification to its definition */
2631 dw_offset die_offset;
2632 unsigned long die_abbrev;
2633 int die_mark;
2634 unsigned int decl_id;
2635 enum dwarf_tag die_tag;
2636 /* Die is used and must not be pruned as unused. */
2637 BOOL_BITFIELD die_perennial_p : 1;
2638 BOOL_BITFIELD comdat_type_p : 1; /* DIE has a type signature */
2639 /* Lots of spare bits. */
2640 }
2641 die_node;
2642
2643 /* Evaluate 'expr' while 'c' is set to each child of DIE in order. */
2644 #define FOR_EACH_CHILD(die, c, expr) do { \
2645 c = die->die_child; \
2646 if (c) do { \
2647 c = c->die_sib; \
2648 expr; \
2649 } while (c != die->die_child); \
2650 } while (0)
2651
2652 /* The pubname structure */
2653
2654 typedef struct GTY(()) pubname_struct {
2655 dw_die_ref die;
2656 const char *name;
2657 }
2658 pubname_entry;
2659
2660
2661 struct GTY(()) dw_ranges_struct {
2662 /* If this is positive, it's a block number, otherwise it's a
2663 bitwise-negated index into dw_ranges_by_label. */
2664 int num;
2665 };
2666
2667 /* A structure to hold a macinfo entry. */
2668
2669 typedef struct GTY(()) macinfo_struct {
2670 unsigned char code;
2671 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT lineno;
2672 const char *info;
2673 }
2674 macinfo_entry;
2675
2676
2677 struct GTY(()) dw_ranges_by_label_struct {
2678 const char *begin;
2679 const char *end;
2680 };
2681
2682 /* The comdat type node structure. */
2683 typedef struct GTY(()) comdat_type_struct
2684 {
2685 dw_die_ref root_die;
2686 dw_die_ref type_die;
2687 dw_die_ref skeleton_die;
2688 char signature[DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE];
2689 struct comdat_type_struct *next;
2690 }
2691 comdat_type_node;
2692
2693 /* The limbo die list structure. */
2694 typedef struct GTY(()) limbo_die_struct {
2695 dw_die_ref die;
2696 tree created_for;
2697 struct limbo_die_struct *next;
2698 }
2699 limbo_die_node;
2700
2701 typedef struct skeleton_chain_struct
2702 {
2703 dw_die_ref old_die;
2704 dw_die_ref new_die;
2705 struct skeleton_chain_struct *parent;
2706 }
2707 skeleton_chain_node;
2708
2709 /* Define a macro which returns nonzero for a TYPE_DECL which was
2710 implicitly generated for a type.
2711
2712 Note that, unlike the C front-end (which generates a NULL named
2713 TYPE_DECL node for each complete tagged type, each array type,
2714 and each function type node created) the C++ front-end generates
2715 a _named_ TYPE_DECL node for each tagged type node created.
2716 These TYPE_DECLs have DECL_ARTIFICIAL set, so we know not to
2717 generate a DW_TAG_typedef DIE for them. Likewise with the Ada
2718 front-end, but for each type, tagged or not. */
2719
2720 #define TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB(decl) \
2721 (DECL_NAME (decl) == NULL_TREE \
2722 || (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) \
2723 && ((decl == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl))) \
2724 /* This is necessary for stub decls that \
2725 appear in nested inline functions. */ \
2726 || (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) != NULL_TREE \
2727 && (decl_ultimate_origin (decl) \
2728 == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl)))))))
2729
2730 /* Information concerning the compilation unit's programming
2731 language, and compiler version. */
2732
2733 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF compilation unit header. */
2734 #define DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
2735 (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 3)
2736
2737 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF comdat type unit header. */
2738 #define DWARF_COMDAT_TYPE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
2739 (DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE \
2740 + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
2741
2742 /* Fixed size portion of public names info. */
2743 #define DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 2)
2744
2745 /* Fixed size portion of the address range info. */
2746 #define DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE \
2747 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
2748 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
2749 - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE)
2750
2751 /* Size of padding portion in the address range info. It must be
2752 aligned to twice the pointer size. */
2753 #define DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE \
2754 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
2755 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
2756 - (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4))
2757
2758 /* Use assembler line directives if available. */
2759 #ifndef DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
2760 #ifdef HAVE_AS_DWARF2_DEBUG_LINE
2761 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 1
2762 #else
2763 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 0
2764 #endif
2765 #endif
2766
2767 /* Minimum line offset in a special line info. opcode.
2768 This value was chosen to give a reasonable range of values. */
2769 #define DWARF_LINE_BASE -10
2770
2771 /* First special line opcode - leave room for the standard opcodes. */
2772 #define DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE ((int)DW_LNS_set_isa + 1)
2773
2774 /* Range of line offsets in a special line info. opcode. */
2775 #define DWARF_LINE_RANGE (254-DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE+1)
2776
2777 /* Flag that indicates the initial value of the is_stmt_start flag.
2778 In the present implementation, we do not mark any lines as
2779 the beginning of a source statement, because that information
2780 is not made available by the GCC front-end. */
2781 #define DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START 1
2782
2783 /* Maximum number of operations per instruction bundle. */
2784 #ifndef DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_MAX_OPS_PER_INSN
2785 #define DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_MAX_OPS_PER_INSN 1
2786 #endif
2787
2788 /* This location is used by calc_die_sizes() to keep track
2789 the offset of each DIE within the .debug_info section. */
2790 static unsigned long next_die_offset;
2791
2792 /* Record the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit. */
2793 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref single_comp_unit_die;
2794
2795 /* A list of type DIEs that have been separated into comdat sections. */
2796 static GTY(()) comdat_type_node *comdat_type_list;
2797
2798 /* A list of DIEs with a NULL parent waiting to be relocated. */
2799 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *limbo_die_list;
2800
2801 /* A list of DIEs for which we may have to generate
2802 DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name once their DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAMEs are set. */
2803 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *deferred_asm_name;
2804
2805 struct dwarf_file_hasher : ggc_hasher<dwarf_file_data *>
2806 {
2807 typedef const char *compare_type;
2808
2809 static hashval_t hash (dwarf_file_data *);
2810 static bool equal (dwarf_file_data *, const char *);
2811 };
2812
2813 /* Filenames referenced by this compilation unit. */
2814 static GTY(()) hash_table<dwarf_file_hasher> *file_table;
2815
2816 struct decl_die_hasher : ggc_hasher<die_node *>
2817 {
2818 typedef tree compare_type;
2819
2820 static hashval_t hash (die_node *);
2821 static bool equal (die_node *, tree);
2822 };
2823 /* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe declarations.
2824 The key is a DECL_UID() which is a unique number identifying each decl. */
2825 static GTY (()) hash_table<decl_die_hasher> *decl_die_table;
2826
2827 struct block_die_hasher : ggc_hasher<die_struct *>
2828 {
2829 static hashval_t hash (die_struct *);
2830 static bool equal (die_struct *, die_struct *);
2831 };
2832
2833 /* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe COMMON blocks.
2834 The key is DECL_UID() ^ die_parent. */
2835 static GTY (()) hash_table<block_die_hasher> *common_block_die_table;
2836
2837 typedef struct GTY(()) die_arg_entry_struct {
2838 dw_die_ref die;
2839 tree arg;
2840 } die_arg_entry;
2841
2842
2843 /* Node of the variable location list. */
2844 struct GTY ((chain_next ("%h.next"))) var_loc_node {
2845 /* Either NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION, or, for SRA optimized variables,
2846 EXPR_LIST chain. For small bitsizes, bitsize is encoded
2847 in mode of the EXPR_LIST node and first EXPR_LIST operand
2848 is either NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION for a piece with a known
2849 location or NULL for padding. For larger bitsizes,
2850 mode is 0 and first operand is a CONCAT with bitsize
2851 as first CONCAT operand and NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION resp.
2852 NULL as second operand. */
2853 rtx GTY (()) loc;
2854 const char * GTY (()) label;
2855 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) next;
2856 };
2857
2858 /* Variable location list. */
2859 struct GTY ((for_user)) var_loc_list_def {
2860 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) first;
2861
2862 /* Pointer to the last but one or last element of the
2863 chained list. If the list is empty, both first and
2864 last are NULL, if the list contains just one node
2865 or the last node certainly is not redundant, it points
2866 to the last node, otherwise points to the last but one.
2867 Do not mark it for GC because it is marked through the chain. */
2868 struct var_loc_node * GTY ((skip ("%h"))) last;
2869
2870 /* Pointer to the last element before section switch,
2871 if NULL, either sections weren't switched or first
2872 is after section switch. */
2873 struct var_loc_node * GTY ((skip ("%h"))) last_before_switch;
2874
2875 /* DECL_UID of the variable decl. */
2876 unsigned int decl_id;
2877 };
2878 typedef struct var_loc_list_def var_loc_list;
2879
2880 /* Call argument location list. */
2881 struct GTY ((chain_next ("%h.next"))) call_arg_loc_node {
2882 rtx GTY (()) call_arg_loc_note;
2883 const char * GTY (()) label;
2884 tree GTY (()) block;
2885 bool tail_call_p;
2886 rtx GTY (()) symbol_ref;
2887 struct call_arg_loc_node * GTY (()) next;
2888 };
2889
2890
2891 struct decl_loc_hasher : ggc_hasher<var_loc_list *>
2892 {
2893 typedef const_tree compare_type;
2894
2895 static hashval_t hash (var_loc_list *);
2896 static bool equal (var_loc_list *, const_tree);
2897 };
2898
2899 /* Table of decl location linked lists. */
2900 static GTY (()) hash_table<decl_loc_hasher> *decl_loc_table;
2901
2902 /* Head and tail of call_arg_loc chain. */
2903 static GTY (()) struct call_arg_loc_node *call_arg_locations;
2904 static struct call_arg_loc_node *call_arg_loc_last;
2905
2906 /* Number of call sites in the current function. */
2907 static int call_site_count = -1;
2908 /* Number of tail call sites in the current function. */
2909 static int tail_call_site_count = -1;
2910
2911 /* Vector mapping block numbers to DW_TAG_{lexical_block,inlined_subroutine}
2912 DIEs. */
2913 static vec<dw_die_ref> block_map;
2914
2915 /* A cached location list. */
2916 struct GTY ((for_user)) cached_dw_loc_list_def {
2917 /* The DECL_UID of the decl that this entry describes. */
2918 unsigned int decl_id;
2919
2920 /* The cached location list. */
2921 dw_loc_list_ref loc_list;
2922 };
2923 typedef struct cached_dw_loc_list_def cached_dw_loc_list;
2924
2925 struct dw_loc_list_hasher : ggc_hasher<cached_dw_loc_list *>
2926 {
2927
2928 typedef const_tree compare_type;
2929
2930 static hashval_t hash (cached_dw_loc_list *);
2931 static bool equal (cached_dw_loc_list *, const_tree);
2932 };
2933
2934 /* Table of cached location lists. */
2935 static GTY (()) hash_table<dw_loc_list_hasher> *cached_dw_loc_list_table;
2936
2937 /* A pointer to the base of a list of references to DIE's that
2938 are uniquely identified by their tag, presence/absence of
2939 children DIE's, and list of attribute/value pairs. */
2940 static GTY((length ("abbrev_die_table_allocated")))
2941 dw_die_ref *abbrev_die_table;
2942
2943 /* Number of elements currently allocated for abbrev_die_table. */
2944 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_allocated;
2945
2946 /* Number of elements in type_die_table currently in use. */
2947 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_in_use;
2948
2949 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
2950 abbrev_die_table. */
2951 #define ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
2952
2953 /* A global counter for generating labels for line number data. */
2954 static unsigned int line_info_label_num;
2955
2956 /* The current table to which we should emit line number information
2957 for the current function. This will be set up at the beginning of
2958 assembly for the function. */
2959 static dw_line_info_table *cur_line_info_table;
2960
2961 /* The two default tables of line number info. */
2962 static GTY(()) dw_line_info_table *text_section_line_info;
2963 static GTY(()) dw_line_info_table *cold_text_section_line_info;
2964
2965 /* The set of all non-default tables of line number info. */
2966 static GTY(()) vec<dw_line_info_table_p, va_gc> *separate_line_info;
2967
2968 /* A flag to tell pubnames/types export if there is an info section to
2969 refer to. */
2970 static bool info_section_emitted;
2971
2972 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
2973 accessible names. */
2974 static GTY (()) vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *pubname_table;
2975
2976 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
2977 accessible types. */
2978 static GTY (()) vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *pubtype_table;
2979
2980 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of macro
2981 defines/undefines (and file start/end markers). */
2982 static GTY (()) vec<macinfo_entry, va_gc> *macinfo_table;
2983
2984 /* True if .debug_macinfo or .debug_macros section is going to be
2985 emitted. */
2986 #define have_macinfo \
2987 (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE \
2988 && !macinfo_table->is_empty ())
2989
2990 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_ranges info. */
2991 static GTY ((length ("ranges_table_allocated"))) dw_ranges_ref ranges_table;
2992
2993 /* Number of elements currently allocated for ranges_table. */
2994 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_allocated;
2995
2996 /* Number of elements in ranges_table currently in use. */
2997 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_in_use;
2998
2999 /* Array of pairs of labels referenced in ranges_table. */
3000 static GTY ((length ("ranges_by_label_allocated")))
3001 dw_ranges_by_label_ref ranges_by_label;
3002
3003 /* Number of elements currently allocated for ranges_by_label. */
3004 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_by_label_allocated;
3005
3006 /* Number of elements in ranges_by_label currently in use. */
3007 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_by_label_in_use;
3008
3009 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3010 ranges_table. */
3011 #define RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
3012
3013 /* Whether we have location lists that need outputting */
3014 static GTY(()) bool have_location_lists;
3015
3016 /* Unique label counter. */
3017 static GTY(()) unsigned int loclabel_num;
3018
3019 /* Unique label counter for point-of-call tables. */
3020 static GTY(()) unsigned int poc_label_num;
3021
3022 /* The last file entry emitted by maybe_emit_file(). */
3023 static GTY(()) struct dwarf_file_data * last_emitted_file;
3024
3025 /* Number of internal labels generated by gen_internal_sym(). */
3026 static GTY(()) int label_num;
3027
3028 /* Cached result of previous call to lookup_filename. */
3029 static GTY(()) struct dwarf_file_data * file_table_last_lookup;
3030
3031 static GTY(()) vec<die_arg_entry, va_gc> *tmpl_value_parm_die_table;
3032
3033 /* Instances of generic types for which we need to generate debug
3034 info that describe their generic parameters and arguments. That
3035 generation needs to happen once all types are properly laid out so
3036 we do it at the end of compilation. */
3037 static GTY(()) vec<tree, va_gc> *generic_type_instances;
3038
3039 /* Offset from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the frame base,
3040 within the current function. */
3041 static HOST_WIDE_INT frame_pointer_fb_offset;
3042 static bool frame_pointer_fb_offset_valid;
3043
3044 static vec<dw_die_ref> base_types;
3045
3046 /* Flags to represent a set of attribute classes for attributes that represent
3047 a scalar value (bounds, pointers, ...). */
3048 enum dw_scalar_form
3049 {
3050 dw_scalar_form_constant = 0x01,
3051 dw_scalar_form_exprloc = 0x02,
3052 dw_scalar_form_reference = 0x04
3053 };
3054
3055 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
3056
3057 static int is_pseudo_reg (const_rtx);
3058 static tree type_main_variant (tree);
3059 static int is_tagged_type (const_tree);
3060 static const char *dwarf_tag_name (unsigned);
3061 static const char *dwarf_attr_name (unsigned);
3062 static const char *dwarf_form_name (unsigned);
3063 static tree decl_ultimate_origin (const_tree);
3064 static tree decl_class_context (tree);
3065 static void add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref, dw_attr_ref);
3066 static inline enum dw_val_class AT_class (dw_attr_ref);
3067 static inline unsigned int AT_index (dw_attr_ref);
3068 static void add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
3069 static inline unsigned AT_flag (dw_attr_ref);
3070 static void add_AT_int (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, HOST_WIDE_INT);
3071 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT AT_int (dw_attr_ref);
3072 static void add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
3073 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT AT_unsigned (dw_attr_ref);
3074 static void add_AT_double (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3075 HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
3076 static inline void add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned int,
3077 unsigned int, unsigned char *);
3078 static void add_AT_data8 (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned char *);
3079 static void add_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3080 static inline const char *AT_string (dw_attr_ref);
3081 static enum dwarf_form AT_string_form (dw_attr_ref);
3082 static void add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_die_ref);
3083 static void add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3084 static inline dw_die_ref AT_ref (dw_attr_ref);
3085 static inline int AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref);
3086 static inline void set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref, int);
3087 static void add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
3088 static void add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_loc_descr_ref);
3089 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref AT_loc (dw_attr_ref);
3090 static void add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3091 dw_loc_list_ref);
3092 static inline dw_loc_list_ref AT_loc_list (dw_attr_ref);
3093 static addr_table_entry *add_addr_table_entry (void *, enum ate_kind);
3094 static void remove_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry *);
3095 static void add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, rtx, bool);
3096 static inline rtx AT_addr (dw_attr_ref);
3097 static void add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3098 static void add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3099 static void add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3100 static void add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3101 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
3102 static void add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3103 unsigned long, bool);
3104 static inline const char *AT_lbl (dw_attr_ref);
3105 static dw_attr_ref get_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3106 static const char *get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref);
3107 static const char *get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref);
3108 static const char *get_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3109 static int get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3110 static unsigned get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3111 static inline dw_die_ref get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3112 static bool is_cxx (void);
3113 static bool is_fortran (void);
3114 static bool is_ada (void);
3115 static void remove_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3116 static void remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_tag);
3117 static void add_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3118 static dw_die_ref new_die (enum dwarf_tag, dw_die_ref, tree);
3119 static dw_die_ref lookup_type_die (tree);
3120 static dw_die_ref strip_naming_typedef (tree, dw_die_ref);
3121 static dw_die_ref lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (tree);
3122 static void equate_type_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3123 static dw_die_ref lookup_decl_die (tree);
3124 static var_loc_list *lookup_decl_loc (const_tree);
3125 static void equate_decl_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3126 static struct var_loc_node *add_var_loc_to_decl (tree, rtx, const char *);
3127 static void print_spaces (FILE *);
3128 static void print_die (dw_die_ref, FILE *);
3129 static dw_die_ref push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3130 static dw_die_ref pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref);
3131 static void loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
3132 static void attr_checksum (dw_attr_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
3133 static void die_checksum (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
3134 static void checksum_sleb128 (HOST_WIDE_INT, struct md5_ctx *);
3135 static void checksum_uleb128 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, struct md5_ctx *);
3136 static void loc_checksum_ordered (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
3137 static void attr_checksum_ordered (enum dwarf_tag, dw_attr_ref,
3138 struct md5_ctx *, int *);
3139 struct checksum_attributes;
3140 static void collect_checksum_attributes (struct checksum_attributes *, dw_die_ref);
3141 static void die_checksum_ordered (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
3142 static void checksum_die_context (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
3143 static void generate_type_signature (dw_die_ref, comdat_type_node *);
3144 static int same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref, dw_loc_descr_ref, int *);
3145 static int same_dw_val_p (const dw_val_node *, const dw_val_node *, int *);
3146 static int same_attr_p (dw_attr_ref, dw_attr_ref, int *);
3147 static int same_die_p (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref, int *);
3148 static int same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3149 static void compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref);
3150 static int is_type_die (dw_die_ref);
3151 static int is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref);
3152 static int is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref);
3153 static inline bool is_template_instantiation (dw_die_ref);
3154 static void assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref);
3155 static void break_out_includes (dw_die_ref);
3156 static int is_declaration_die (dw_die_ref);
3157 static int should_move_die_to_comdat (dw_die_ref);
3158 static dw_die_ref clone_as_declaration (dw_die_ref);
3159 static dw_die_ref clone_die (dw_die_ref);
3160 static dw_die_ref clone_tree (dw_die_ref);
3161 static dw_die_ref copy_declaration_context (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3162 static void generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (skeleton_chain_node *);
3163 static void generate_skeleton_bottom_up (skeleton_chain_node *);
3164 static dw_die_ref generate_skeleton (dw_die_ref);
3165 static dw_die_ref remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (dw_die_ref,
3166 dw_die_ref,
3167 dw_die_ref);
3168 static void break_out_comdat_types (dw_die_ref);
3169 static void copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (dw_die_ref);
3170
3171 static void add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref);
3172 static void output_location_lists (dw_die_ref);
3173 static int constant_size (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
3174 static unsigned long size_of_die (dw_die_ref);
3175 static void calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref);
3176 static void calc_base_type_die_sizes (void);
3177 static void mark_dies (dw_die_ref);
3178 static void unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
3179 static void unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref);
3180 static unsigned long size_of_pubnames (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *);
3181 static unsigned long size_of_aranges (void);
3182 static enum dwarf_form value_format (dw_attr_ref);
3183 static void output_value_format (dw_attr_ref);
3184 static void output_abbrev_section (void);
3185 static void output_die_abbrevs (unsigned long, dw_die_ref);
3186 static void output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref);
3187 static void output_die (dw_die_ref);
3188 static void output_compilation_unit_header (void);
3189 static void output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref, int);
3190 static void output_comdat_type_unit (comdat_type_node *);
3191 static const char *dwarf2_name (tree, int);
3192 static void add_pubname (tree, dw_die_ref);
3193 static void add_enumerator_pubname (const char *, dw_die_ref);
3194 static void add_pubname_string (const char *, dw_die_ref);
3195 static void add_pubtype (tree, dw_die_ref);
3196 static void output_pubnames (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *);
3197 static void output_aranges (unsigned long);
3198 static unsigned int add_ranges_num (int);
3199 static unsigned int add_ranges (const_tree);
3200 static void add_ranges_by_labels (dw_die_ref, const char *, const char *,
3201 bool *, bool);
3202 static void output_ranges (void);
3203 static dw_line_info_table *new_line_info_table (void);
3204 static void output_line_info (bool);
3205 static void output_file_names (void);
3206 static dw_die_ref base_type_die (tree);
3207 static int is_base_type (tree);
3208 static dw_die_ref subrange_type_die (tree, tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3209 static int decl_quals (const_tree);
3210 static dw_die_ref modified_type_die (tree, int, dw_die_ref);
3211 static dw_die_ref generic_parameter_die (tree, tree, bool, dw_die_ref);
3212 static dw_die_ref template_parameter_pack_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3213 static int type_is_enum (const_tree);
3214 static unsigned int dbx_reg_number (const_rtx);
3215 static void add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *, int);
3216 static dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, enum var_init_status);
3217 static dw_loc_descr_ref one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int,
3218 enum var_init_status);
3219 static dw_loc_descr_ref multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx,
3220 enum var_init_status);
3221 static dw_loc_descr_ref based_loc_descr (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT,
3222 enum var_init_status);
3223 static int is_based_loc (const_rtx);
3224 static bool resolve_one_addr (rtx *);
3225 static dw_loc_descr_ref concat_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx,
3226 enum var_init_status);
3227 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor (rtx, machine_mode mode,
3228 enum var_init_status);
3229 struct loc_descr_context;
3230 static dw_loc_list_ref loc_list_from_tree (tree, int,
3231 const struct loc_descr_context *);
3232 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree, int,
3233 const struct loc_descr_context *);
3234 static HOST_WIDE_INT ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int);
3235 static tree field_type (const_tree);
3236 static unsigned int simple_type_align_in_bits (const_tree);
3237 static unsigned int simple_decl_align_in_bits (const_tree);
3238 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT simple_type_size_in_bits (const_tree);
3239 static HOST_WIDE_INT field_byte_offset (const_tree);
3240 static void add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3241 dw_loc_list_ref);
3242 static void add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3243 static bool add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, rtx);
3244 static void insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned, unsigned char *);
3245 static void insert_wide_int (const wide_int &, unsigned char *, int);
3246 static void insert_float (const_rtx, unsigned char *);
3247 static rtx rtl_for_decl_location (tree);
3248 static bool add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, bool,
3249 enum dwarf_attribute);
3250 static bool tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3251 static bool tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (dw_die_ref, tree);
3252 static void add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref, const char *);
3253 static void add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, dw_die_ref);
3254 static void add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref);
3255 static void add_scalar_info (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, tree, int,
3256 const struct loc_descr_context *);
3257 static void add_bound_info (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, tree,
3258 const struct loc_descr_context *);
3259 static void add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref, tree, bool);
3260 static void add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3261 static void add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3262 static void add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3263 static void add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3264 static dw_die_ref add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3265 static void add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3266 static void add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
3267 static void add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
3268 static void push_decl_scope (tree);
3269 static void pop_decl_scope (void);
3270 static dw_die_ref scope_die_for (tree, dw_die_ref);
3271 static inline int local_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
3272 static inline int class_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
3273 static inline int class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
3274 static void add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, int, dw_die_ref);
3275 static void add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3276 static const char *type_tag (const_tree);
3277 static tree member_declared_type (const_tree);
3278 #if 0
3279 static const char *decl_start_label (tree);
3280 #endif
3281 static void gen_array_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3282 static void gen_descr_array_type_die (tree, struct array_descr_info *, dw_die_ref);
3283 #if 0
3284 static void gen_entry_point_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3285 #endif
3286 static dw_die_ref gen_enumeration_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3287 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_die (tree, tree, bool, dw_die_ref);
3288 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref, tree*);
3289 static void gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3290 static void gen_formal_types_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3291 static void gen_subprogram_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3292 static void gen_variable_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3293 static void gen_const_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3294 static void gen_label_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3295 static void gen_lexical_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3296 static void gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3297 static void gen_field_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3298 static void gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3299 static dw_die_ref gen_compile_unit_die (const char *);
3300 static void gen_inheritance_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3301 static void gen_member_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3302 static void gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref,
3303 enum debug_info_usage);
3304 static void gen_subroutine_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3305 static void gen_typedef_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3306 static void gen_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3307 static void gen_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3308 static void decls_for_scope (tree, dw_die_ref);
3309 static inline int is_redundant_typedef (const_tree);
3310 static bool is_naming_typedef_decl (const_tree);
3311 static inline dw_die_ref get_context_die (tree);
3312 static void gen_namespace_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3313 static dw_die_ref gen_namelist_decl (tree, dw_die_ref, tree);
3314 static dw_die_ref gen_decl_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3315 static dw_die_ref force_decl_die (tree);
3316 static dw_die_ref force_type_die (tree);
3317 static dw_die_ref setup_namespace_context (tree, dw_die_ref);
3318 static dw_die_ref declare_in_namespace (tree, dw_die_ref);
3319 static struct dwarf_file_data * lookup_filename (const char *);
3320 static void retry_incomplete_types (void);
3321 static void gen_type_die_for_member (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3322 static void gen_generic_params_dies (tree);
3323 static void gen_tagged_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref, enum debug_info_usage);
3324 static void gen_type_die_with_usage (tree, dw_die_ref, enum debug_info_usage);
3325 static void splice_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3326 static int file_info_cmp (const void *, const void *);
3327 static dw_loc_list_ref new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref, const char *,
3328 const char *, const char *);
3329 static void output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref);
3330 static char *gen_internal_sym (const char *);
3331 static bool want_pubnames (void);
3332
3333 static void prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
3334 static void prune_unused_types_mark_generic_parms_dies (dw_die_ref);
3335 static void prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref, int);
3336 static void prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref);
3337 static void prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref);
3338 static void prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref);
3339 static void prune_unused_types (void);
3340 static int maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data *fd);
3341 static inline const char *AT_vms_delta1 (dw_attr_ref);
3342 static inline const char *AT_vms_delta2 (dw_attr_ref);
3343 static inline void add_AT_vms_delta (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3344 const char *, const char *);
3345 static void append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (dw_die_ref, tree);
3346 static void gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute (void);
3347 static bool generic_type_p (tree);
3348 static void schedule_generic_params_dies_gen (tree t);
3349 static void gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies (void);
3350
3351 static const char *comp_dir_string (void);
3352
3353 static void hash_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref, inchash::hash &);
3354
3355 /* enum for tracking thread-local variables whose address is really an offset
3356 relative to the TLS pointer, which will need link-time relocation, but will
3357 not need relocation by the DWARF consumer. */
3358
3359 enum dtprel_bool
3360 {
3361 dtprel_false = 0,
3362 dtprel_true = 1
3363 };
3364
3365 /* Return the operator to use for an address of a variable. For dtprel_true, we
3366 use DW_OP_const*. For regular variables, which need both link-time
3367 relocation and consumer-level relocation (e.g., to account for shared objects
3368 loaded at a random address), we use DW_OP_addr*. */
3369
3370 static inline enum dwarf_location_atom
3371 dw_addr_op (enum dtprel_bool dtprel)
3372 {
3373 if (dtprel == dtprel_true)
3374 return (dwarf_split_debug_info ? DW_OP_GNU_const_index
3375 : (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 4 ? DW_OP_const4u : DW_OP_const8u));
3376 else
3377 return dwarf_split_debug_info ? DW_OP_GNU_addr_index : DW_OP_addr;
3378 }
3379
3380 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated address location description. If
3381 dwarf_split_debug_info is true, then record the address with the appropriate
3382 relocation. */
3383 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
3384 new_addr_loc_descr (rtx addr, enum dtprel_bool dtprel)
3385 {
3386 dw_loc_descr_ref ref = new_loc_descr (dw_addr_op (dtprel), 0, 0);
3387
3388 ref->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
3389 ref->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = addr;
3390 ref->dtprel = dtprel;
3391 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
3392 ref->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry
3393 = add_addr_table_entry (addr,
3394 dtprel ? ate_kind_rtx_dtprel : ate_kind_rtx);
3395 else
3396 ref->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry = NULL;
3397
3398 return ref;
3399 }
3400
3401 /* Section names used to hold DWARF debugging information. */
3402
3403 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION
3404 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION ".debug_info"
3405 #endif
3406 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_INFO_SECTION
3407 #define DEBUG_DWO_INFO_SECTION ".debug_info.dwo"
3408 #endif
3409 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION
3410 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION ".debug_abbrev"
3411 #endif
3412 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION
3413 #define DEBUG_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION ".debug_abbrev.dwo"
3414 #endif
3415 #ifndef DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION
3416 #define DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION ".debug_aranges"
3417 #endif
3418 #ifndef DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION
3419 #define DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION ".debug_addr"
3420 #endif
3421 #ifndef DEBUG_NORM_MACINFO_SECTION
3422 #define DEBUG_NORM_MACINFO_SECTION ".debug_macinfo"
3423 #endif
3424 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION
3425 #define DEBUG_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION ".debug_macinfo.dwo"
3426 #endif
3427 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION
3428 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION \
3429 (!dwarf_split_debug_info \
3430 ? (DEBUG_NORM_MACINFO_SECTION) : (DEBUG_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION))
3431 #endif
3432 #ifndef DEBUG_NORM_MACRO_SECTION
3433 #define DEBUG_NORM_MACRO_SECTION ".debug_macro"
3434 #endif
3435 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_MACRO_SECTION
3436 #define DEBUG_DWO_MACRO_SECTION ".debug_macro.dwo"
3437 #endif
3438 #ifndef DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION
3439 #define DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION \
3440 (!dwarf_split_debug_info \
3441 ? (DEBUG_NORM_MACRO_SECTION) : (DEBUG_DWO_MACRO_SECTION))
3442 #endif
3443 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION
3444 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION ".debug_line"
3445 #endif
3446 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_LINE_SECTION
3447 #define DEBUG_DWO_LINE_SECTION ".debug_line.dwo"
3448 #endif
3449 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION
3450 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION ".debug_loc"
3451 #endif
3452 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_LOC_SECTION
3453 #define DEBUG_DWO_LOC_SECTION ".debug_loc.dwo"
3454 #endif
3455 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION
3456 #define DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION \
3457 ((debug_generate_pub_sections == 2) \
3458 ? ".debug_gnu_pubnames" : ".debug_pubnames")
3459 #endif
3460 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION
3461 #define DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION \
3462 ((debug_generate_pub_sections == 2) \
3463 ? ".debug_gnu_pubtypes" : ".debug_pubtypes")
3464 #endif
3465 #define DEBUG_NORM_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION ".debug_str_offsets"
3466 #define DEBUG_DWO_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION ".debug_str_offsets.dwo"
3467 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION
3468 #define DEBUG_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION \
3469 (!dwarf_split_debug_info \
3470 ? (DEBUG_NORM_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION) : (DEBUG_DWO_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION))
3471 #endif
3472 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION
3473 #define DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION ".debug_str.dwo"
3474 #endif
3475 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_SECTION
3476 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION ".debug_str"
3477 #endif
3478 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION
3479 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION ".debug_ranges"
3480 #endif
3481
3482 /* Standard ELF section names for compiled code and data. */
3483 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_NAME
3484 #define TEXT_SECTION_NAME ".text"
3485 #endif
3486
3487 /* Section flags for .debug_macinfo/.debug_macro section. */
3488 #define DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_FLAGS \
3489 (dwarf_split_debug_info ? SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE : SECTION_DEBUG)
3490
3491 /* Section flags for .debug_str section. */
3492 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS \
3493 (HAVE_GAS_SHF_MERGE && flag_merge_debug_strings \
3494 ? SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_MERGE | SECTION_STRINGS | 1 \
3495 : SECTION_DEBUG)
3496
3497 /* Section flags for .debug_str.dwo section. */
3498 #define DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION_FLAGS (SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE)
3499
3500 /* Labels we insert at beginning sections we can reference instead of
3501 the section names themselves. */
3502
3503 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
3504 #define TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext"
3505 #endif
3506 #ifndef COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
3507 #define COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext_cold"
3508 #endif
3509 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL
3510 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_line"
3511 #endif
3512 #ifndef DEBUG_SKELETON_LINE_SECTION_LABEL
3513 #define DEBUG_SKELETON_LINE_SECTION_LABEL "Lskeleton_debug_line"
3514 #endif
3515 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL
3516 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_info"
3517 #endif
3518 #ifndef DEBUG_SKELETON_INFO_SECTION_LABEL
3519 #define DEBUG_SKELETON_INFO_SECTION_LABEL "Lskeleton_debug_info"
3520 #endif
3521 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL
3522 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_abbrev"
3523 #endif
3524 #ifndef DEBUG_SKELETON_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL
3525 #define DEBUG_SKELETON_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL "Lskeleton_debug_abbrev"
3526 #endif
3527 #ifndef DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION_LABEL
3528 #define DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_addr"
3529 #endif
3530 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL
3531 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_loc"
3532 #endif
3533 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL
3534 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_ranges"
3535 #endif
3536 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
3537 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_macinfo"
3538 #endif
3539 #ifndef DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL
3540 #define DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_macro"
3541 #endif
3542 #define SKELETON_COMP_DIE_ABBREV 1
3543 #define SKELETON_TYPE_DIE_ABBREV 2
3544
3545 /* Definitions of defaults for formats and names of various special
3546 (artificial) labels which may be generated within this file (when the -g
3547 options is used and DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO is in effect.
3548 If necessary, these may be overridden from within the tm.h file, but
3549 typically, overriding these defaults is unnecessary. */
3550
3551 static char text_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3552 static char text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3553 static char cold_text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3554 static char cold_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3555 static char abbrev_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3556 static char debug_info_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3557 static char debug_skeleton_info_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3558 static char debug_skeleton_abbrev_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3559 static char debug_line_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3560 static char debug_addr_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3561 static char debug_skeleton_line_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3562 static char macinfo_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3563 static char loc_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3564 static char ranges_section_label[2 * MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3565
3566 #ifndef TEXT_END_LABEL
3567 #define TEXT_END_LABEL "Letext"
3568 #endif
3569 #ifndef COLD_END_LABEL
3570 #define COLD_END_LABEL "Letext_cold"
3571 #endif
3572 #ifndef BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL
3573 #define BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL "LBB"
3574 #endif
3575 #ifndef BLOCK_END_LABEL
3576 #define BLOCK_END_LABEL "LBE"
3577 #endif
3578 #ifndef LINE_CODE_LABEL
3579 #define LINE_CODE_LABEL "LM"
3580 #endif
3581
3582 \f
3583 /* Return the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit. */
3584 static dw_die_ref
3585 comp_unit_die (void)
3586 {
3587 if (!single_comp_unit_die)
3588 single_comp_unit_die = gen_compile_unit_die (NULL);
3589 return single_comp_unit_die;
3590 }
3591
3592 /* We allow a language front-end to designate a function that is to be
3593 called to "demangle" any name before it is put into a DIE. */
3594
3595 static const char *(*demangle_name_func) (const char *);
3596
3597 void
3598 dwarf2out_set_demangle_name_func (const char *(*func) (const char *))
3599 {
3600 demangle_name_func = func;
3601 }
3602
3603 /* Test if rtl node points to a pseudo register. */
3604
3605 static inline int
3606 is_pseudo_reg (const_rtx rtl)
3607 {
3608 return ((REG_P (rtl) && REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
3609 || (GET_CODE (rtl) == SUBREG
3610 && REGNO (SUBREG_REG (rtl)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER));
3611 }
3612
3613 /* Return a reference to a type, with its const and volatile qualifiers
3614 removed. */
3615
3616 static inline tree
3617 type_main_variant (tree type)
3618 {
3619 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
3620
3621 /* ??? There really should be only one main variant among any group of
3622 variants of a given type (and all of the MAIN_VARIANT values for all
3623 members of the group should point to that one type) but sometimes the C
3624 front-end messes this up for array types, so we work around that bug
3625 here. */
3626 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
3627 while (type != TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type))
3628 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
3629
3630 return type;
3631 }
3632
3633 /* Return nonzero if the given type node represents a tagged type. */
3634
3635 static inline int
3636 is_tagged_type (const_tree type)
3637 {
3638 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
3639
3640 return (code == RECORD_TYPE || code == UNION_TYPE
3641 || code == QUAL_UNION_TYPE || code == ENUMERAL_TYPE);
3642 }
3643
3644 /* Set label to debug_info_section_label + die_offset of a DIE reference. */
3645
3646 static void
3647 get_ref_die_offset_label (char *label, dw_die_ref ref)
3648 {
3649 sprintf (label, "%s+%ld", debug_info_section_label, ref->die_offset);
3650 }
3651
3652 /* Return die_offset of a DIE reference to a base type. */
3653
3654 static unsigned long int
3655 get_base_type_offset (dw_die_ref ref)
3656 {
3657 if (ref->die_offset)
3658 return ref->die_offset;
3659 if (comp_unit_die ()->die_abbrev)
3660 {
3661 calc_base_type_die_sizes ();
3662 gcc_assert (ref->die_offset);
3663 }
3664 return ref->die_offset;
3665 }
3666
3667 /* Return die_offset of a DIE reference other than base type. */
3668
3669 static unsigned long int
3670 get_ref_die_offset (dw_die_ref ref)
3671 {
3672 gcc_assert (ref->die_offset);
3673 return ref->die_offset;
3674 }
3675
3676 /* Convert a DIE tag into its string name. */
3677
3678 static const char *
3679 dwarf_tag_name (unsigned int tag)
3680 {
3681 const char *name = get_DW_TAG_name (tag);
3682
3683 if (name != NULL)
3684 return name;
3685
3686 return "DW_TAG_<unknown>";
3687 }
3688
3689 /* Convert a DWARF attribute code into its string name. */
3690
3691 static const char *
3692 dwarf_attr_name (unsigned int attr)
3693 {
3694 const char *name;
3695
3696 switch (attr)
3697 {
3698 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
3699 case DW_AT_HP_prologue:
3700 return "DW_AT_HP_prologue";
3701 #else
3702 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor:
3703 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor";
3704 #endif
3705
3706 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
3707 case DW_AT_HP_epilogue:
3708 return "DW_AT_HP_epilogue";
3709 #else
3710 case DW_AT_MIPS_stride:
3711 return "DW_AT_MIPS_stride";
3712 #endif
3713 }
3714
3715 name = get_DW_AT_name (attr);
3716
3717 if (name != NULL)
3718 return name;
3719
3720 return "DW_AT_<unknown>";
3721 }
3722
3723 /* Convert a DWARF value form code into its string name. */
3724
3725 static const char *
3726 dwarf_form_name (unsigned int form)
3727 {
3728 const char *name = get_DW_FORM_name (form);
3729
3730 if (name != NULL)
3731 return name;
3732
3733 return "DW_FORM_<unknown>";
3734 }
3735 \f
3736 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a decl. The decl may be an inlined
3737 instance of an inlined instance of a decl which is local to an inline
3738 function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
3739 to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
3740 given block. */
3741
3742 static tree
3743 decl_ultimate_origin (const_tree decl)
3744 {
3745 if (!CODE_CONTAINS_STRUCT (TREE_CODE (decl), TS_DECL_COMMON))
3746 return NULL_TREE;
3747
3748 /* DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN can point to itself; ignore that if
3749 we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function. */
3750 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == decl)
3751 return NULL_TREE;
3752
3753 /* Since the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for a DECL is supposed to be the
3754 most distant ancestor, this should never happen. */
3755 gcc_assert (!DECL_FROM_INLINE (DECL_ORIGIN (decl)));
3756
3757 return DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl);
3758 }
3759
3760 /* Get the class to which DECL belongs, if any. In g++, the DECL_CONTEXT
3761 of a virtual function may refer to a base class, so we check the 'this'
3762 parameter. */
3763
3764 static tree
3765 decl_class_context (tree decl)
3766 {
3767 tree context = NULL_TREE;
3768
3769 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || ! DECL_VINDEX (decl))
3770 context = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
3771 else
3772 context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT
3773 (TREE_TYPE (TREE_VALUE (TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl)))));
3774
3775 if (context && !TYPE_P (context))
3776 context = NULL_TREE;
3777
3778 return context;
3779 }
3780 \f
3781 /* Add an attribute/value pair to a DIE. */
3782
3783 static inline void
3784 add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref die, dw_attr_ref attr)
3785 {
3786 /* Maybe this should be an assert? */
3787 if (die == NULL)
3788 return;
3789
3790 vec_safe_reserve (die->die_attr, 1);
3791 vec_safe_push (die->die_attr, *attr);
3792 }
3793
3794 static inline enum dw_val_class
3795 AT_class (dw_attr_ref a)
3796 {
3797 return a->dw_attr_val.val_class;
3798 }
3799
3800 /* Return the index for any attribute that will be referenced with a
3801 DW_FORM_GNU_addr_index or DW_FORM_GNU_str_index. String indices
3802 are stored in dw_attr_val.v.val_str for reference counting
3803 pruning. */
3804
3805 static inline unsigned int
3806 AT_index (dw_attr_ref a)
3807 {
3808 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
3809 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->index;
3810 else if (a->dw_attr_val.val_entry != NULL)
3811 return a->dw_attr_val.val_entry->index;
3812 return NOT_INDEXED;
3813 }
3814
3815 /* Add a flag value attribute to a DIE. */
3816
3817 static inline void
3818 add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int flag)
3819 {
3820 dw_attr_node attr;
3821
3822 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
3823 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_flag;
3824 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
3825 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_flag = flag;
3826 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
3827 }
3828
3829 static inline unsigned
3830 AT_flag (dw_attr_ref a)
3831 {
3832 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_flag);
3833 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag;
3834 }
3835
3836 /* Add a signed integer attribute value to a DIE. */
3837
3838 static inline void
3839 add_AT_int (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, HOST_WIDE_INT int_val)
3840 {
3841 dw_attr_node attr;
3842
3843 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
3844 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
3845 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
3846 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_int = int_val;
3847 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
3848 }
3849
3850 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
3851 AT_int (dw_attr_ref a)
3852 {
3853 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_const);
3854 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_int;
3855 }
3856
3857 /* Add an unsigned integer attribute value to a DIE. */
3858
3859 static inline void
3860 add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
3861 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned_val)
3862 {
3863 dw_attr_node attr;
3864
3865 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
3866 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
3867 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
3868 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned = unsigned_val;
3869 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
3870 }
3871
3872 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
3873 AT_unsigned (dw_attr_ref a)
3874 {
3875 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_unsigned_const);
3876 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned;
3877 }
3878
3879 /* Add an unsigned wide integer attribute value to a DIE. */
3880
3881 static inline void
3882 add_AT_wide (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
3883 const wide_int& w)
3884 {
3885 dw_attr_node attr;
3886
3887 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
3888 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_wide_int;
3889 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
3890 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_wide = ggc_alloc<wide_int> ();
3891 *attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_wide = w;
3892 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
3893 }
3894
3895 /* Add an unsigned double integer attribute value to a DIE. */
3896
3897 static inline void
3898 add_AT_double (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
3899 HOST_WIDE_INT high, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT low)
3900 {
3901 dw_attr_node attr;
3902
3903 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
3904 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const_double;
3905 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
3906 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high = high;
3907 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low = low;
3908 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
3909 }
3910
3911 /* Add a floating point attribute value to a DIE and return it. */
3912
3913 static inline void
3914 add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
3915 unsigned int length, unsigned int elt_size, unsigned char *array)
3916 {
3917 dw_attr_node attr;
3918
3919 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
3920 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
3921 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
3922 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length = length;
3923 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size = elt_size;
3924 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array = array;
3925 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
3926 }
3927
3928 /* Add an 8-byte data attribute value to a DIE. */
3929
3930 static inline void
3931 add_AT_data8 (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
3932 unsigned char data8[8])
3933 {
3934 dw_attr_node attr;
3935
3936 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
3937 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_data8;
3938 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
3939 memcpy (attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_data8, data8, 8);
3940 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
3941 }
3942
3943 /* Add DW_AT_low_pc and DW_AT_high_pc to a DIE. When using
3944 dwarf_split_debug_info, address attributes in dies destined for the
3945 final executable have force_direct set to avoid using indexed
3946 references. */
3947
3948 static inline void
3949 add_AT_low_high_pc (dw_die_ref die, const char *lbl_low, const char *lbl_high,
3950 bool force_direct)
3951 {
3952 dw_attr_node attr;
3953 char * lbl_id;
3954
3955 lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_low);
3956 attr.dw_attr = DW_AT_low_pc;
3957 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
3958 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = lbl_id;
3959 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && !force_direct)
3960 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry
3961 = add_addr_table_entry (lbl_id, ate_kind_label);
3962 else
3963 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
3964 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
3965
3966 attr.dw_attr = DW_AT_high_pc;
3967 if (dwarf_version < 4)
3968 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
3969 else
3970 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_high_pc;
3971 lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_high);
3972 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = lbl_id;
3973 if (attr.dw_attr_val.val_class == dw_val_class_lbl_id
3974 && dwarf_split_debug_info && !force_direct)
3975 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry
3976 = add_addr_table_entry (lbl_id, ate_kind_label);
3977 else
3978 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
3979 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
3980 }
3981
3982 /* Hash and equality functions for debug_str_hash. */
3983
3984 hashval_t
3985 indirect_string_hasher::hash (indirect_string_node *x)
3986 {
3987 return htab_hash_string (x->str);
3988 }
3989
3990 bool
3991 indirect_string_hasher::equal (indirect_string_node *x1, const char *x2)
3992 {
3993 return strcmp (x1->str, x2) == 0;
3994 }
3995
3996 /* Add STR to the given string hash table. */
3997
3998 static struct indirect_string_node *
3999 find_AT_string_in_table (const char *str,
4000 hash_table<indirect_string_hasher> *table)
4001 {
4002 struct indirect_string_node *node;
4003
4004 indirect_string_node **slot
4005 = table->find_slot_with_hash (str, htab_hash_string (str), INSERT);
4006 if (*slot == NULL)
4007 {
4008 node = ggc_cleared_alloc<indirect_string_node> ();
4009 node->str = ggc_strdup (str);
4010 *slot = node;
4011 }
4012 else
4013 node = *slot;
4014
4015 node->refcount++;
4016 return node;
4017 }
4018
4019 /* Add STR to the indirect string hash table. */
4020
4021 static struct indirect_string_node *
4022 find_AT_string (const char *str)
4023 {
4024 if (! debug_str_hash)
4025 debug_str_hash = hash_table<indirect_string_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
4026
4027 return find_AT_string_in_table (str, debug_str_hash);
4028 }
4029
4030 /* Add a string attribute value to a DIE. */
4031
4032 static inline void
4033 add_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *str)
4034 {
4035 dw_attr_node attr;
4036 struct indirect_string_node *node;
4037
4038 node = find_AT_string (str);
4039
4040 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4041 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_str;
4042 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4043 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
4044 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4045 }
4046
4047 static inline const char *
4048 AT_string (dw_attr_ref a)
4049 {
4050 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
4051 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str;
4052 }
4053
4054 /* Call this function directly to bypass AT_string_form's logic to put
4055 the string inline in the die. */
4056
4057 static void
4058 set_indirect_string (struct indirect_string_node *node)
4059 {
4060 char label[32];
4061 /* Already indirect is a no op. */
4062 if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp || node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index)
4063 {
4064 gcc_assert (node->label);
4065 return;
4066 }
4067 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LASF", dw2_string_counter);
4068 ++dw2_string_counter;
4069 node->label = xstrdup (label);
4070
4071 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
4072 {
4073 node->form = DW_FORM_strp;
4074 node->index = NOT_INDEXED;
4075 }
4076 else
4077 {
4078 node->form = DW_FORM_GNU_str_index;
4079 node->index = NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED;
4080 }
4081 }
4082
4083 /* Find out whether a string should be output inline in DIE
4084 or out-of-line in .debug_str section. */
4085
4086 static enum dwarf_form
4087 find_string_form (struct indirect_string_node *node)
4088 {
4089 unsigned int len;
4090
4091 if (node->form)
4092 return node->form;
4093
4094 len = strlen (node->str) + 1;
4095
4096 /* If the string is shorter or equal to the size of the reference, it is
4097 always better to put it inline. */
4098 if (len <= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE || node->refcount == 0)
4099 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
4100
4101 /* If we cannot expect the linker to merge strings in .debug_str
4102 section, only put it into .debug_str if it is worth even in this
4103 single module. */
4104 if (DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET
4105 || ((debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) == 0
4106 && (len - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE) * node->refcount <= len))
4107 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
4108
4109 set_indirect_string (node);
4110
4111 return node->form;
4112 }
4113
4114 /* Find out whether the string referenced from the attribute should be
4115 output inline in DIE or out-of-line in .debug_str section. */
4116
4117 static enum dwarf_form
4118 AT_string_form (dw_attr_ref a)
4119 {
4120 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
4121 return find_string_form (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str);
4122 }
4123
4124 /* Add a DIE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
4125
4126 static inline void
4127 add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_die_ref targ_die)
4128 {
4129 dw_attr_node attr;
4130
4131 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
4132 gcc_assert (targ_die != NULL);
4133 #else
4134 /* With LTO we can end up trying to reference something we didn't create
4135 a DIE for. Avoid crashing later on a NULL referenced DIE. */
4136 if (targ_die == NULL)
4137 return;
4138 #endif
4139
4140 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4141 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
4142 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4143 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = targ_die;
4144 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
4145 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4146 }
4147
4148 /* Change DIE reference REF to point to NEW_DIE instead. */
4149
4150 static inline void
4151 change_AT_die_ref (dw_attr_ref ref, dw_die_ref new_die)
4152 {
4153 gcc_assert (ref->dw_attr_val.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
4154 ref->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = new_die;
4155 ref->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
4156 }
4157
4158 /* Add an AT_specification attribute to a DIE, and also make the back
4159 pointer from the specification to the definition. */
4160
4161 static inline void
4162 add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref targ_die)
4163 {
4164 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_specification, targ_die);
4165 gcc_assert (!targ_die->die_definition);
4166 targ_die->die_definition = die;
4167 }
4168
4169 static inline dw_die_ref
4170 AT_ref (dw_attr_ref a)
4171 {
4172 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
4173 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die;
4174 }
4175
4176 static inline int
4177 AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref a)
4178 {
4179 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
4180 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external;
4181
4182 return 0;
4183 }
4184
4185 static inline void
4186 set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref a, int i)
4187 {
4188 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
4189 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = i;
4190 }
4191
4192 /* Add an FDE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
4193
4194 static inline void
4195 add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int targ_fde)
4196 {
4197 dw_attr_node attr;
4198
4199 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4200 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_fde_ref;
4201 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4202 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index = targ_fde;
4203 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4204 }
4205
4206 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE. */
4207
4208 static inline void
4209 add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
4210 {
4211 dw_attr_node attr;
4212
4213 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4214 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
4215 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4216 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc = loc;
4217 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4218 }
4219
4220 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
4221 AT_loc (dw_attr_ref a)
4222 {
4223 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc);
4224 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc;
4225 }
4226
4227 static inline void
4228 add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_list_ref loc_list)
4229 {
4230 dw_attr_node attr;
4231
4232 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4233 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc_list;
4234 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4235 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = loc_list;
4236 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4237 have_location_lists = true;
4238 }
4239
4240 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
4241 AT_loc_list (dw_attr_ref a)
4242 {
4243 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list);
4244 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
4245 }
4246
4247 static inline dw_loc_list_ref *
4248 AT_loc_list_ptr (dw_attr_ref a)
4249 {
4250 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list);
4251 return &a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
4252 }
4253
4254 struct addr_hasher : ggc_hasher<addr_table_entry *>
4255 {
4256 static hashval_t hash (addr_table_entry *);
4257 static bool equal (addr_table_entry *, addr_table_entry *);
4258 };
4259
4260 /* Table of entries into the .debug_addr section. */
4261
4262 static GTY (()) hash_table<addr_hasher> *addr_index_table;
4263
4264 /* Hash an address_table_entry. */
4265
4266 hashval_t
4267 addr_hasher::hash (addr_table_entry *a)
4268 {
4269 inchash::hash hstate;
4270 switch (a->kind)
4271 {
4272 case ate_kind_rtx:
4273 hstate.add_int (0);
4274 break;
4275 case ate_kind_rtx_dtprel:
4276 hstate.add_int (1);
4277 break;
4278 case ate_kind_label:
4279 return htab_hash_string (a->addr.label);
4280 default:
4281 gcc_unreachable ();
4282 }
4283 inchash::add_rtx (a->addr.rtl, hstate);
4284 return hstate.end ();
4285 }
4286
4287 /* Determine equality for two address_table_entries. */
4288
4289 bool
4290 addr_hasher::equal (addr_table_entry *a1, addr_table_entry *a2)
4291 {
4292 if (a1->kind != a2->kind)
4293 return 0;
4294 switch (a1->kind)
4295 {
4296 case ate_kind_rtx:
4297 case ate_kind_rtx_dtprel:
4298 return rtx_equal_p (a1->addr.rtl, a2->addr.rtl);
4299 case ate_kind_label:
4300 return strcmp (a1->addr.label, a2->addr.label) == 0;
4301 default:
4302 gcc_unreachable ();
4303 }
4304 }
4305
4306 /* Initialize an addr_table_entry. */
4307
4308 void
4309 init_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry *e, enum ate_kind kind, void *addr)
4310 {
4311 e->kind = kind;
4312 switch (kind)
4313 {
4314 case ate_kind_rtx:
4315 case ate_kind_rtx_dtprel:
4316 e->addr.rtl = (rtx) addr;
4317 break;
4318 case ate_kind_label:
4319 e->addr.label = (char *) addr;
4320 break;
4321 }
4322 e->refcount = 0;
4323 e->index = NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED;
4324 }
4325
4326 /* Add attr to the address table entry to the table. Defer setting an
4327 index until output time. */
4328
4329 static addr_table_entry *
4330 add_addr_table_entry (void *addr, enum ate_kind kind)
4331 {
4332 addr_table_entry *node;
4333 addr_table_entry finder;
4334
4335 gcc_assert (dwarf_split_debug_info);
4336 if (! addr_index_table)
4337 addr_index_table = hash_table<addr_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
4338 init_addr_table_entry (&finder, kind, addr);
4339 addr_table_entry **slot = addr_index_table->find_slot (&finder, INSERT);
4340
4341 if (*slot == HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
4342 {
4343 node = ggc_cleared_alloc<addr_table_entry> ();
4344 init_addr_table_entry (node, kind, addr);
4345 *slot = node;
4346 }
4347 else
4348 node = *slot;
4349
4350 node->refcount++;
4351 return node;
4352 }
4353
4354 /* Remove an entry from the addr table by decrementing its refcount.
4355 Strictly, decrementing the refcount would be enough, but the
4356 assertion that the entry is actually in the table has found
4357 bugs. */
4358
4359 static void
4360 remove_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry *entry)
4361 {
4362 gcc_assert (dwarf_split_debug_info && addr_index_table);
4363 /* After an index is assigned, the table is frozen. */
4364 gcc_assert (entry->refcount > 0 && entry->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
4365 entry->refcount--;
4366 }
4367
4368 /* Given a location list, remove all addresses it refers to from the
4369 address_table. */
4370
4371 static void
4372 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
4373 {
4374 for (; descr; descr = descr->dw_loc_next)
4375 if (descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry != NULL)
4376 {
4377 gcc_assert (descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
4378 remove_addr_table_entry (descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry);
4379 }
4380 }
4381
4382 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
4383 htab_traverse. Assign an addr_table_entry its index. All entries
4384 must be collected into the table when this function is called,
4385 because the indexing code relies on htab_traverse to traverse nodes
4386 in the same order for each run. */
4387
4388 int
4389 index_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry **h, unsigned int *index)
4390 {
4391 addr_table_entry *node = *h;
4392
4393 /* Don't index unreferenced nodes. */
4394 if (node->refcount == 0)
4395 return 1;
4396
4397 gcc_assert (node->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
4398 node->index = *index;
4399 *index += 1;
4400
4401 return 1;
4402 }
4403
4404 /* Add an address constant attribute value to a DIE. When using
4405 dwarf_split_debug_info, address attributes in dies destined for the
4406 final executable should be direct references--setting the parameter
4407 force_direct ensures this behavior. */
4408
4409 static inline void
4410 add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, rtx addr,
4411 bool force_direct)
4412 {
4413 dw_attr_node attr;
4414
4415 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4416 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
4417 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_addr = addr;
4418 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && !force_direct)
4419 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = add_addr_table_entry (addr, ate_kind_rtx);
4420 else
4421 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4422 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4423 }
4424
4425 /* Get the RTX from to an address DIE attribute. */
4426
4427 static inline rtx
4428 AT_addr (dw_attr_ref a)
4429 {
4430 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_addr);
4431 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr;
4432 }
4433
4434 /* Add a file attribute value to a DIE. */
4435
4436 static inline void
4437 add_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4438 struct dwarf_file_data *fd)
4439 {
4440 dw_attr_node attr;
4441
4442 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4443 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_file;
4444 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4445 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_file = fd;
4446 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4447 }
4448
4449 /* Get the dwarf_file_data from a file DIE attribute. */
4450
4451 static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
4452 AT_file (dw_attr_ref a)
4453 {
4454 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_file);
4455 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file;
4456 }
4457
4458 /* Add a vms delta attribute value to a DIE. */
4459
4460 static inline void
4461 add_AT_vms_delta (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4462 const char *lbl1, const char *lbl2)
4463 {
4464 dw_attr_node attr;
4465
4466 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4467 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_vms_delta;
4468 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4469 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl1 = xstrdup (lbl1);
4470 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl2 = xstrdup (lbl2);
4471 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4472 }
4473
4474 /* Add a label identifier attribute value to a DIE. */
4475
4476 static inline void
4477 add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4478 const char *lbl_id)
4479 {
4480 dw_attr_node attr;
4481
4482 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4483 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
4484 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4485 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_id);
4486 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
4487 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry
4488 = add_addr_table_entry (attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id,
4489 ate_kind_label);
4490 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4491 }
4492
4493 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
4494 debug_line section. */
4495
4496 static inline void
4497 add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4498 const char *label)
4499 {
4500 dw_attr_node attr;
4501
4502 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4503 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lineptr;
4504 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4505 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
4506 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4507 }
4508
4509 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
4510 debug_macinfo section. */
4511
4512 static inline void
4513 add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4514 const char *label)
4515 {
4516 dw_attr_node attr;
4517
4518 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4519 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_macptr;
4520 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4521 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
4522 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4523 }
4524
4525 /* Add an offset attribute value to a DIE. */
4526
4527 static inline void
4528 add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4529 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
4530 {
4531 dw_attr_node attr;
4532
4533 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4534 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_offset;
4535 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4536 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
4537 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4538 }
4539
4540 /* Add a range_list attribute value to a DIE. When using
4541 dwarf_split_debug_info, address attributes in dies destined for the
4542 final executable should be direct references--setting the parameter
4543 force_direct ensures this behavior. */
4544
4545 #define UNRELOCATED_OFFSET ((addr_table_entry *) 1)
4546 #define RELOCATED_OFFSET (NULL)
4547
4548 static void
4549 add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4550 long unsigned int offset, bool force_direct)
4551 {
4552 dw_attr_node attr;
4553
4554 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4555 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_range_list;
4556 /* For the range_list attribute, use val_entry to store whether the
4557 offset should follow split-debug-info or normal semantics. This
4558 value is read in output_range_list_offset. */
4559 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && !force_direct)
4560 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = UNRELOCATED_OFFSET;
4561 else
4562 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = RELOCATED_OFFSET;
4563 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
4564 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4565 }
4566
4567 /* Return the start label of a delta attribute. */
4568
4569 static inline const char *
4570 AT_vms_delta1 (dw_attr_ref a)
4571 {
4572 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_vms_delta));
4573 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl1;
4574 }
4575
4576 /* Return the end label of a delta attribute. */
4577
4578 static inline const char *
4579 AT_vms_delta2 (dw_attr_ref a)
4580 {
4581 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_vms_delta));
4582 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl2;
4583 }
4584
4585 static inline const char *
4586 AT_lbl (dw_attr_ref a)
4587 {
4588 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lbl_id
4589 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lineptr
4590 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_macptr
4591 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_high_pc));
4592 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id;
4593 }
4594
4595 /* Get the attribute of type attr_kind. */
4596
4597 static dw_attr_ref
4598 get_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
4599 {
4600 dw_attr_ref a;
4601 unsigned ix;
4602 dw_die_ref spec = NULL;
4603
4604 if (! die)
4605 return NULL;
4606
4607 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
4608 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
4609 return a;
4610 else if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification
4611 || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_abstract_origin)
4612 spec = AT_ref (a);
4613
4614 if (spec)
4615 return get_AT (spec, attr_kind);
4616
4617 return NULL;
4618 }
4619
4620 /* Returns the parent of the declaration of DIE. */
4621
4622 static dw_die_ref
4623 get_die_parent (dw_die_ref die)
4624 {
4625 dw_die_ref t;
4626
4627 if (!die)
4628 return NULL;
4629
4630 if ((t = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin))
4631 || (t = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification)))
4632 die = t;
4633
4634 return die->die_parent;
4635 }
4636
4637 /* Return the "low pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
4638 DIE. Return null if the "low pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
4639 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
4640
4641 static inline const char *
4642 get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref die)
4643 {
4644 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_low_pc);
4645
4646 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
4647 }
4648
4649 /* Return the "high pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
4650 DIE. Return null if the "high pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
4651 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
4652
4653 static inline const char *
4654 get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref die)
4655 {
4656 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_high_pc);
4657
4658 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
4659 }
4660
4661 /* Return the value of the string attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or
4662 NULL if it is not present. */
4663
4664 static inline const char *
4665 get_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
4666 {
4667 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
4668
4669 return a ? AT_string (a) : NULL;
4670 }
4671
4672 /* Return the value of the flag attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or -1
4673 if it is not present. */
4674
4675 static inline int
4676 get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
4677 {
4678 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
4679
4680 return a ? AT_flag (a) : 0;
4681 }
4682
4683 /* Return the value of the unsigned attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or 0
4684 if it is not present. */
4685
4686 static inline unsigned
4687 get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
4688 {
4689 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
4690
4691 return a ? AT_unsigned (a) : 0;
4692 }
4693
4694 static inline dw_die_ref
4695 get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
4696 {
4697 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
4698
4699 return a ? AT_ref (a) : NULL;
4700 }
4701
4702 static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
4703 get_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
4704 {
4705 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
4706
4707 return a ? AT_file (a) : NULL;
4708 }
4709
4710 /* Return TRUE if the language is C++. */
4711
4712 static inline bool
4713 is_cxx (void)
4714 {
4715 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language);
4716
4717 return (lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus
4718 || lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_11 || lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_14);
4719 }
4720
4721 /* Return TRUE if the language is Java. */
4722
4723 static inline bool
4724 is_java (void)
4725 {
4726 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language);
4727
4728 return lang == DW_LANG_Java;
4729 }
4730
4731 /* Return TRUE if the language is Fortran. */
4732
4733 static inline bool
4734 is_fortran (void)
4735 {
4736 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language);
4737
4738 return (lang == DW_LANG_Fortran77
4739 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran90
4740 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran95
4741 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran03
4742 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran08);
4743 }
4744
4745 /* Return TRUE if the language is Ada. */
4746
4747 static inline bool
4748 is_ada (void)
4749 {
4750 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language);
4751
4752 return lang == DW_LANG_Ada95 || lang == DW_LANG_Ada83;
4753 }
4754
4755 /* Remove the specified attribute if present. */
4756
4757 static void
4758 remove_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
4759 {
4760 dw_attr_ref a;
4761 unsigned ix;
4762
4763 if (! die)
4764 return;
4765
4766 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
4767 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
4768 {
4769 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
4770 if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount)
4771 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
4772
4773 /* vec::ordered_remove should help reduce the number of abbrevs
4774 that are needed. */
4775 die->die_attr->ordered_remove (ix);
4776 return;
4777 }
4778 }
4779
4780 /* Remove CHILD from its parent. PREV must have the property that
4781 PREV->DIE_SIB == CHILD. Does not alter CHILD. */
4782
4783 static void
4784 remove_child_with_prev (dw_die_ref child, dw_die_ref prev)
4785 {
4786 gcc_assert (child->die_parent == prev->die_parent);
4787 gcc_assert (prev->die_sib == child);
4788 if (prev == child)
4789 {
4790 gcc_assert (child->die_parent->die_child == child);
4791 prev = NULL;
4792 }
4793 else
4794 prev->die_sib = child->die_sib;
4795 if (child->die_parent->die_child == child)
4796 child->die_parent->die_child = prev;
4797 }
4798
4799 /* Replace OLD_CHILD with NEW_CHILD. PREV must have the property that
4800 PREV->DIE_SIB == OLD_CHILD. Does not alter OLD_CHILD. */
4801
4802 static void
4803 replace_child (dw_die_ref old_child, dw_die_ref new_child, dw_die_ref prev)
4804 {
4805 dw_die_ref parent = old_child->die_parent;
4806
4807 gcc_assert (parent == prev->die_parent);
4808 gcc_assert (prev->die_sib == old_child);
4809
4810 new_child->die_parent = parent;
4811 if (prev == old_child)
4812 {
4813 gcc_assert (parent->die_child == old_child);
4814 new_child->die_sib = new_child;
4815 }
4816 else
4817 {
4818 prev->die_sib = new_child;
4819 new_child->die_sib = old_child->die_sib;
4820 }
4821 if (old_child->die_parent->die_child == old_child)
4822 old_child->die_parent->die_child = new_child;
4823 }
4824
4825 /* Move all children from OLD_PARENT to NEW_PARENT. */
4826
4827 static void
4828 move_all_children (dw_die_ref old_parent, dw_die_ref new_parent)
4829 {
4830 dw_die_ref c;
4831 new_parent->die_child = old_parent->die_child;
4832 old_parent->die_child = NULL;
4833 FOR_EACH_CHILD (new_parent, c, c->die_parent = new_parent);
4834 }
4835
4836 /* Remove child DIE whose die_tag is TAG. Do nothing if no child
4837 matches TAG. */
4838
4839 static void
4840 remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_tag tag)
4841 {
4842 dw_die_ref c;
4843
4844 c = die->die_child;
4845 if (c) do {
4846 dw_die_ref prev = c;
4847 c = c->die_sib;
4848 while (c->die_tag == tag)
4849 {
4850 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
4851 /* Might have removed every child. */
4852 if (c == c->die_sib)
4853 return;
4854 c = c->die_sib;
4855 }
4856 } while (c != die->die_child);
4857 }
4858
4859 /* Add a CHILD_DIE as the last child of DIE. */
4860
4861 static void
4862 add_child_die (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref child_die)
4863 {
4864 /* FIXME this should probably be an assert. */
4865 if (! die || ! child_die)
4866 return;
4867 gcc_assert (die != child_die);
4868
4869 child_die->die_parent = die;
4870 if (die->die_child)
4871 {
4872 child_die->die_sib = die->die_child->die_sib;
4873 die->die_child->die_sib = child_die;
4874 }
4875 else
4876 child_die->die_sib = child_die;
4877 die->die_child = child_die;
4878 }
4879
4880 /* Move CHILD, which must be a child of PARENT or the DIE for which PARENT
4881 is the specification, to the end of PARENT's list of children.
4882 This is done by removing and re-adding it. */
4883
4884 static void
4885 splice_child_die (dw_die_ref parent, dw_die_ref child)
4886 {
4887 dw_die_ref p;
4888
4889 /* We want the declaration DIE from inside the class, not the
4890 specification DIE at toplevel. */
4891 if (child->die_parent != parent)
4892 {
4893 dw_die_ref tmp = get_AT_ref (child, DW_AT_specification);
4894
4895 if (tmp)
4896 child = tmp;
4897 }
4898
4899 gcc_assert (child->die_parent == parent
4900 || (child->die_parent
4901 == get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification)));
4902
4903 for (p = child->die_parent->die_child; ; p = p->die_sib)
4904 if (p->die_sib == child)
4905 {
4906 remove_child_with_prev (child, p);
4907 break;
4908 }
4909
4910 add_child_die (parent, child);
4911 }
4912
4913 /* Return a pointer to a newly created DIE node. */
4914
4915 static inline dw_die_ref
4916 new_die (enum dwarf_tag tag_value, dw_die_ref parent_die, tree t)
4917 {
4918 dw_die_ref die = ggc_cleared_alloc<die_node> ();
4919
4920 die->die_tag = tag_value;
4921
4922 if (parent_die != NULL)
4923 add_child_die (parent_die, die);
4924 else
4925 {
4926 limbo_die_node *limbo_node;
4927
4928 limbo_node = ggc_cleared_alloc<limbo_die_node> ();
4929 limbo_node->die = die;
4930 limbo_node->created_for = t;
4931 limbo_node->next = limbo_die_list;
4932 limbo_die_list = limbo_node;
4933 }
4934
4935 return die;
4936 }
4937
4938 /* Return the DIE associated with the given type specifier. */
4939
4940 static inline dw_die_ref
4941 lookup_type_die (tree type)
4942 {
4943 return TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type);
4944 }
4945
4946 /* Given a TYPE_DIE representing the type TYPE, if TYPE is an
4947 anonymous type named by the typedef TYPE_DIE, return the DIE of the
4948 anonymous type instead the one of the naming typedef. */
4949
4950 static inline dw_die_ref
4951 strip_naming_typedef (tree type, dw_die_ref type_die)
4952 {
4953 if (type
4954 && TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
4955 && type_die
4956 && type_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_typedef
4957 && is_naming_typedef_decl (TYPE_NAME (type)))
4958 type_die = get_AT_ref (type_die, DW_AT_type);
4959 return type_die;
4960 }
4961
4962 /* Like lookup_type_die, but if type is an anonymous type named by a
4963 typedef[1], return the DIE of the anonymous type instead the one of
4964 the naming typedef. This is because in gen_typedef_die, we did
4965 equate the anonymous struct named by the typedef with the DIE of
4966 the naming typedef. So by default, lookup_type_die on an anonymous
4967 struct yields the DIE of the naming typedef.
4968
4969 [1]: Read the comment of is_naming_typedef_decl to learn about what
4970 a naming typedef is. */
4971
4972 static inline dw_die_ref
4973 lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (tree type)
4974 {
4975 dw_die_ref die = lookup_type_die (type);
4976 return strip_naming_typedef (type, die);
4977 }
4978
4979 /* Equate a DIE to a given type specifier. */
4980
4981 static inline void
4982 equate_type_number_to_die (tree type, dw_die_ref type_die)
4983 {
4984 TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type) = type_die;
4985 }
4986
4987 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct). */
4988
4989 inline hashval_t
4990 decl_die_hasher::hash (die_node *x)
4991 {
4992 return (hashval_t) x->decl_id;
4993 }
4994
4995 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of die_struct X is the same as UID of decl *Y. */
4996
4997 inline bool
4998 decl_die_hasher::equal (die_node *x, tree y)
4999 {
5000 return (x->decl_id == DECL_UID (y));
5001 }
5002
5003 /* Return the DIE associated with a given declaration. */
5004
5005 static inline dw_die_ref
5006 lookup_decl_die (tree decl)
5007 {
5008 return decl_die_table->find_with_hash (decl, DECL_UID (decl));
5009 }
5010
5011 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a var_loc_list). */
5012
5013 inline hashval_t
5014 decl_loc_hasher::hash (var_loc_list *x)
5015 {
5016 return (hashval_t) x->decl_id;
5017 }
5018
5019 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of var_loc_list X is the same as
5020 UID of decl *Y. */
5021
5022 inline bool
5023 decl_loc_hasher::equal (var_loc_list *x, const_tree y)
5024 {
5025 return (x->decl_id == DECL_UID (y));
5026 }
5027
5028 /* Return the var_loc list associated with a given declaration. */
5029
5030 static inline var_loc_list *
5031 lookup_decl_loc (const_tree decl)
5032 {
5033 if (!decl_loc_table)
5034 return NULL;
5035 return decl_loc_table->find_with_hash (decl, DECL_UID (decl));
5036 }
5037
5038 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a cached_dw_loc_list_list). */
5039
5040 inline hashval_t
5041 dw_loc_list_hasher::hash (cached_dw_loc_list *x)
5042 {
5043 return (hashval_t) x->decl_id;
5044 }
5045
5046 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of cached_dw_loc_list X is the same as
5047 UID of decl *Y. */
5048
5049 inline bool
5050 dw_loc_list_hasher::equal (cached_dw_loc_list *x, const_tree y)
5051 {
5052 return (x->decl_id == DECL_UID (y));
5053 }
5054
5055 /* Equate a DIE to a particular declaration. */
5056
5057 static void
5058 equate_decl_number_to_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref decl_die)
5059 {
5060 unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
5061
5062 *decl_die_table->find_slot_with_hash (decl, decl_id, INSERT) = decl_die;
5063 decl_die->decl_id = decl_id;
5064 }
5065
5066 /* Return how many bits covers PIECE EXPR_LIST. */
5067
5068 static HOST_WIDE_INT
5069 decl_piece_bitsize (rtx piece)
5070 {
5071 int ret = (int) GET_MODE (piece);
5072 if (ret)
5073 return ret;
5074 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (piece, 0)) == CONCAT
5075 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (piece, 0), 0)));
5076 return INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (piece, 0), 0));
5077 }
5078
5079 /* Return pointer to the location of location note in PIECE EXPR_LIST. */
5080
5081 static rtx *
5082 decl_piece_varloc_ptr (rtx piece)
5083 {
5084 if ((int) GET_MODE (piece))
5085 return &XEXP (piece, 0);
5086 else
5087 return &XEXP (XEXP (piece, 0), 1);
5088 }
5089
5090 /* Create an EXPR_LIST for location note LOC_NOTE covering BITSIZE bits.
5091 Next is the chain of following piece nodes. */
5092
5093 static rtx_expr_list *
5094 decl_piece_node (rtx loc_note, HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, rtx next)
5095 {
5096 if (bitsize > 0 && bitsize <= (int) MAX_MACHINE_MODE)
5097 return alloc_EXPR_LIST (bitsize, loc_note, next);
5098 else
5099 return alloc_EXPR_LIST (0, gen_rtx_CONCAT (VOIDmode,
5100 GEN_INT (bitsize),
5101 loc_note), next);
5102 }
5103
5104 /* Return rtx that should be stored into loc field for
5105 LOC_NOTE and BITPOS/BITSIZE. */
5106
5107 static rtx
5108 construct_piece_list (rtx loc_note, HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos,
5109 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize)
5110 {
5111 if (bitsize != -1)
5112 {
5113 loc_note = decl_piece_node (loc_note, bitsize, NULL_RTX);
5114 if (bitpos != 0)
5115 loc_note = decl_piece_node (NULL_RTX, bitpos, loc_note);
5116 }
5117 return loc_note;
5118 }
5119
5120 /* This function either modifies location piece list *DEST in
5121 place (if SRC and INNER is NULL), or copies location piece list
5122 *SRC to *DEST while modifying it. Location BITPOS is modified
5123 to contain LOC_NOTE, any pieces overlapping it are removed resp.
5124 not copied and if needed some padding around it is added.
5125 When modifying in place, DEST should point to EXPR_LIST where
5126 earlier pieces cover PIECE_BITPOS bits, when copying SRC points
5127 to the start of the whole list and INNER points to the EXPR_LIST
5128 where earlier pieces cover PIECE_BITPOS bits. */
5129
5130 static void
5131 adjust_piece_list (rtx *dest, rtx *src, rtx *inner,
5132 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos, HOST_WIDE_INT piece_bitpos,
5133 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, rtx loc_note)
5134 {
5135 HOST_WIDE_INT diff;
5136 bool copy = inner != NULL;
5137
5138 if (copy)
5139 {
5140 /* First copy all nodes preceding the current bitpos. */
5141 while (src != inner)
5142 {
5143 *dest = decl_piece_node (*decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*src),
5144 decl_piece_bitsize (*src), NULL_RTX);
5145 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
5146 src = &XEXP (*src, 1);
5147 }
5148 }
5149 /* Add padding if needed. */
5150 if (bitpos != piece_bitpos)
5151 {
5152 *dest = decl_piece_node (NULL_RTX, bitpos - piece_bitpos,
5153 copy ? NULL_RTX : *dest);
5154 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
5155 }
5156 else if (*dest && decl_piece_bitsize (*dest) == bitsize)
5157 {
5158 gcc_assert (!copy);
5159 /* A piece with correct bitpos and bitsize already exist,
5160 just update the location for it and return. */
5161 *decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*dest) = loc_note;
5162 return;
5163 }
5164 /* Add the piece that changed. */
5165 *dest = decl_piece_node (loc_note, bitsize, copy ? NULL_RTX : *dest);
5166 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
5167 /* Skip over pieces that overlap it. */
5168 diff = bitpos - piece_bitpos + bitsize;
5169 if (!copy)
5170 src = dest;
5171 while (diff > 0 && *src)
5172 {
5173 rtx piece = *src;
5174 diff -= decl_piece_bitsize (piece);
5175 if (copy)
5176 src = &XEXP (piece, 1);
5177 else
5178 {
5179 *src = XEXP (piece, 1);
5180 free_EXPR_LIST_node (piece);
5181 }
5182 }
5183 /* Add padding if needed. */
5184 if (diff < 0 && *src)
5185 {
5186 if (!copy)
5187 dest = src;
5188 *dest = decl_piece_node (NULL_RTX, -diff, copy ? NULL_RTX : *dest);
5189 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
5190 }
5191 if (!copy)
5192 return;
5193 /* Finally copy all nodes following it. */
5194 while (*src)
5195 {
5196 *dest = decl_piece_node (*decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*src),
5197 decl_piece_bitsize (*src), NULL_RTX);
5198 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
5199 src = &XEXP (*src, 1);
5200 }
5201 }
5202
5203 /* Add a variable location node to the linked list for DECL. */
5204
5205 static struct var_loc_node *
5206 add_var_loc_to_decl (tree decl, rtx loc_note, const char *label)
5207 {
5208 unsigned int decl_id;
5209 var_loc_list *temp;
5210 struct var_loc_node *loc = NULL;
5211 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize = -1, bitpos = -1;
5212
5213 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
5214 && DECL_HAS_DEBUG_EXPR_P (decl))
5215 {
5216 tree realdecl = DECL_DEBUG_EXPR (decl);
5217 if (handled_component_p (realdecl)
5218 || (TREE_CODE (realdecl) == MEM_REF
5219 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (realdecl, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR))
5220 {
5221 HOST_WIDE_INT maxsize;
5222 tree innerdecl;
5223 innerdecl
5224 = get_ref_base_and_extent (realdecl, &bitpos, &bitsize, &maxsize);
5225 if (!DECL_P (innerdecl)
5226 || DECL_IGNORED_P (innerdecl)
5227 || TREE_STATIC (innerdecl)
5228 || bitsize <= 0
5229 || bitpos + bitsize > 256
5230 || bitsize != maxsize)
5231 return NULL;
5232 decl = innerdecl;
5233 }
5234 }
5235
5236 decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
5237 var_loc_list **slot
5238 = decl_loc_table->find_slot_with_hash (decl, decl_id, INSERT);
5239 if (*slot == NULL)
5240 {
5241 temp = ggc_cleared_alloc<var_loc_list> ();
5242 temp->decl_id = decl_id;
5243 *slot = temp;
5244 }
5245 else
5246 temp = *slot;
5247
5248 /* For PARM_DECLs try to keep around the original incoming value,
5249 even if that means we'll emit a zero-range .debug_loc entry. */
5250 if (temp->last
5251 && temp->first == temp->last
5252 && TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
5253 && NOTE_P (temp->first->loc)
5254 && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (temp->first->loc) == decl
5255 && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl)
5256 && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->first->loc)
5257 && GET_CODE (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->first->loc))
5258 == GET_CODE (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
5259 && prev_real_insn (temp->first->loc) == NULL_RTX
5260 && (bitsize != -1
5261 || !rtx_equal_p (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->first->loc),
5262 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note))
5263 || (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (temp->first->loc)
5264 != NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note))))
5265 {
5266 loc = ggc_cleared_alloc<var_loc_node> ();
5267 temp->first->next = loc;
5268 temp->last = loc;
5269 loc->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
5270 }
5271 else if (temp->last)
5272 {
5273 struct var_loc_node *last = temp->last, *unused = NULL;
5274 rtx *piece_loc = NULL, last_loc_note;
5275 HOST_WIDE_INT piece_bitpos = 0;
5276 if (last->next)
5277 {
5278 last = last->next;
5279 gcc_assert (last->next == NULL);
5280 }
5281 if (bitsize != -1 && GET_CODE (last->loc) == EXPR_LIST)
5282 {
5283 piece_loc = &last->loc;
5284 do
5285 {
5286 HOST_WIDE_INT cur_bitsize = decl_piece_bitsize (*piece_loc);
5287 if (piece_bitpos + cur_bitsize > bitpos)
5288 break;
5289 piece_bitpos += cur_bitsize;
5290 piece_loc = &XEXP (*piece_loc, 1);
5291 }
5292 while (*piece_loc);
5293 }
5294 /* TEMP->LAST here is either pointer to the last but one or
5295 last element in the chained list, LAST is pointer to the
5296 last element. */
5297 if (label && strcmp (last->label, label) == 0)
5298 {
5299 /* For SRA optimized variables if there weren't any real
5300 insns since last note, just modify the last node. */
5301 if (piece_loc != NULL)
5302 {
5303 adjust_piece_list (piece_loc, NULL, NULL,
5304 bitpos, piece_bitpos, bitsize, loc_note);
5305 return NULL;
5306 }
5307 /* If the last note doesn't cover any instructions, remove it. */
5308 if (temp->last != last)
5309 {
5310 temp->last->next = NULL;
5311 unused = last;
5312 last = temp->last;
5313 gcc_assert (strcmp (last->label, label) != 0);
5314 }
5315 else
5316 {
5317 gcc_assert (temp->first == temp->last
5318 || (temp->first->next == temp->last
5319 && TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL));
5320 memset (temp->last, '\0', sizeof (*temp->last));
5321 temp->last->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
5322 return temp->last;
5323 }
5324 }
5325 if (bitsize == -1 && NOTE_P (last->loc))
5326 last_loc_note = last->loc;
5327 else if (piece_loc != NULL
5328 && *piece_loc != NULL_RTX
5329 && piece_bitpos == bitpos
5330 && decl_piece_bitsize (*piece_loc) == bitsize)
5331 last_loc_note = *decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*piece_loc);
5332 else
5333 last_loc_note = NULL_RTX;
5334 /* If the current location is the same as the end of the list,
5335 and either both or neither of the locations is uninitialized,
5336 we have nothing to do. */
5337 if (last_loc_note == NULL_RTX
5338 || (!rtx_equal_p (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (last_loc_note),
5339 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note)))
5340 || ((NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (last_loc_note)
5341 != NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note))
5342 && ((NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (last_loc_note)
5343 == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
5344 || (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note)
5345 == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED))))
5346 {
5347 /* Add LOC to the end of list and update LAST. If the last
5348 element of the list has been removed above, reuse its
5349 memory for the new node, otherwise allocate a new one. */
5350 if (unused)
5351 {
5352 loc = unused;
5353 memset (loc, '\0', sizeof (*loc));
5354 }
5355 else
5356 loc = ggc_cleared_alloc<var_loc_node> ();
5357 if (bitsize == -1 || piece_loc == NULL)
5358 loc->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
5359 else
5360 adjust_piece_list (&loc->loc, &last->loc, piece_loc,
5361 bitpos, piece_bitpos, bitsize, loc_note);
5362 last->next = loc;
5363 /* Ensure TEMP->LAST will point either to the new last but one
5364 element of the chain, or to the last element in it. */
5365 if (last != temp->last)
5366 temp->last = last;
5367 }
5368 else if (unused)
5369 ggc_free (unused);
5370 }
5371 else
5372 {
5373 loc = ggc_cleared_alloc<var_loc_node> ();
5374 temp->first = loc;
5375 temp->last = loc;
5376 loc->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
5377 }
5378 return loc;
5379 }
5380 \f
5381 /* Keep track of the number of spaces used to indent the
5382 output of the debugging routines that print the structure of
5383 the DIE internal representation. */
5384 static int print_indent;
5385
5386 /* Indent the line the number of spaces given by print_indent. */
5387
5388 static inline void
5389 print_spaces (FILE *outfile)
5390 {
5391 fprintf (outfile, "%*s", print_indent, "");
5392 }
5393
5394 /* Print a type signature in hex. */
5395
5396 static inline void
5397 print_signature (FILE *outfile, char *sig)
5398 {
5399 int i;
5400
5401 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
5402 fprintf (outfile, "%02x", sig[i] & 0xff);
5403 }
5404
5405 static void print_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref, FILE *);
5406
5407 /* Print the value associated to the VAL DWARF value node to OUTFILE. If
5408 RECURSE, output location descriptor operations. */
5409
5410 static void
5411 print_dw_val (dw_val_node *val, bool recurse, FILE *outfile)
5412 {
5413 switch (val->val_class)
5414 {
5415 case dw_val_class_addr:
5416 fprintf (outfile, "address");
5417 break;
5418 case dw_val_class_offset:
5419 fprintf (outfile, "offset");
5420 break;
5421 case dw_val_class_loc:
5422 fprintf (outfile, "location descriptor");
5423 if (val->v.val_loc == NULL)
5424 fprintf (outfile, " -> <null>\n");
5425 else if (recurse)
5426 {
5427 fprintf (outfile, ":\n");
5428 print_indent += 4;
5429 print_loc_descr (val->v.val_loc, outfile);
5430 print_indent -= 4;
5431 }
5432 else
5433 fprintf (outfile, " (%p)\n", (void *) val->v.val_loc);
5434 break;
5435 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
5436 fprintf (outfile, "location list -> label:%s",
5437 val->v.val_loc_list->ll_symbol);
5438 break;
5439 case dw_val_class_range_list:
5440 fprintf (outfile, "range list");
5441 break;
5442 case dw_val_class_const:
5443 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, val->v.val_int);
5444 break;
5445 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5446 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, val->v.val_unsigned);
5447 break;
5448 case dw_val_class_const_double:
5449 fprintf (outfile, "constant ("HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC","\
5450 HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED")",
5451 val->v.val_double.high,
5452 val->v.val_double.low);
5453 break;
5454 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
5455 {
5456 int i = val->v.val_wide->get_len ();
5457 fprintf (outfile, "constant (");
5458 gcc_assert (i > 0);
5459 if (val->v.val_wide->elt (i - 1) == 0)
5460 fprintf (outfile, "0x");
5461 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
5462 val->v.val_wide->elt (--i));
5463 while (--i >= 0)
5464 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_PADDED_HEX,
5465 val->v.val_wide->elt (i));
5466 fprintf (outfile, ")");
5467 break;
5468 }
5469 case dw_val_class_vec:
5470 fprintf (outfile, "floating-point or vector constant");
5471 break;
5472 case dw_val_class_flag:
5473 fprintf (outfile, "%u", val->v.val_flag);
5474 break;
5475 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
5476 if (val->v.val_die_ref.die != NULL)
5477 {
5478 dw_die_ref die = val->v.val_die_ref.die;
5479
5480 if (die->comdat_type_p)
5481 {
5482 fprintf (outfile, "die -> signature: ");
5483 print_signature (outfile,
5484 die->die_id.die_type_node->signature);
5485 }
5486 else if (die->die_id.die_symbol)
5487 fprintf (outfile, "die -> label: %s", die->die_id.die_symbol);
5488 else
5489 fprintf (outfile, "die -> %ld", die->die_offset);
5490 fprintf (outfile, " (%p)", (void *) die);
5491 }
5492 else
5493 fprintf (outfile, "die -> <null>");
5494 break;
5495 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
5496 fprintf (outfile, "delta: @slotcount(%s-%s)",
5497 val->v.val_vms_delta.lbl2, val->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1);
5498 break;
5499 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
5500 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
5501 case dw_val_class_macptr:
5502 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
5503 fprintf (outfile, "label: %s", val->v.val_lbl_id);
5504 break;
5505 case dw_val_class_str:
5506 if (val->v.val_str->str != NULL)
5507 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\"", val->v.val_str->str);
5508 else
5509 fprintf (outfile, "<null>");
5510 break;
5511 case dw_val_class_file:
5512 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\" (%d)", val->v.val_file->filename,
5513 val->v.val_file->emitted_number);
5514 break;
5515 case dw_val_class_data8:
5516 {
5517 int i;
5518
5519 for (i = 0; i < 8; i++)
5520 fprintf (outfile, "%02x", val->v.val_data8[i]);
5521 break;
5522 }
5523 default:
5524 break;
5525 }
5526 }
5527
5528 /* Likewise, for a DIE attribute. */
5529
5530 static void
5531 print_attribute (dw_attr_ref a, bool recurse, FILE *outfile)
5532 {
5533 print_dw_val (&a->dw_attr_val, recurse, outfile);
5534 }
5535
5536
5537 /* Print the list of operands in the LOC location description to OUTFILE. This
5538 routine is a debugging aid only. */
5539
5540 static void
5541 print_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, FILE *outfile)
5542 {
5543 dw_loc_descr_ref l = loc;
5544
5545 if (loc == NULL)
5546 {
5547 print_spaces (outfile);
5548 fprintf (outfile, "<null>\n");
5549 return;
5550 }
5551
5552 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
5553 {
5554 print_spaces (outfile);
5555 fprintf (outfile, "(%p) %s",
5556 (void *) l,
5557 dwarf_stack_op_name (l->dw_loc_opc));
5558 if (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class != dw_val_class_none)
5559 {
5560 fprintf (outfile, " ");
5561 print_dw_val (&l->dw_loc_oprnd1, false, outfile);
5562 }
5563 if (l->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class != dw_val_class_none)
5564 {
5565 fprintf (outfile, ", ");
5566 print_dw_val (&l->dw_loc_oprnd2, false, outfile);
5567 }
5568 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5569 }
5570 }
5571
5572 /* Print the information associated with a given DIE, and its children.
5573 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
5574
5575 static void
5576 print_die (dw_die_ref die, FILE *outfile)
5577 {
5578 dw_attr_ref a;
5579 dw_die_ref c;
5580 unsigned ix;
5581
5582 print_spaces (outfile);
5583 fprintf (outfile, "DIE %4ld: %s (%p)\n",
5584 die->die_offset, dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag),
5585 (void*) die);
5586 print_spaces (outfile);
5587 fprintf (outfile, " abbrev id: %lu", die->die_abbrev);
5588 fprintf (outfile, " offset: %ld", die->die_offset);
5589 fprintf (outfile, " mark: %d\n", die->die_mark);
5590
5591 if (die->comdat_type_p)
5592 {
5593 print_spaces (outfile);
5594 fprintf (outfile, " signature: ");
5595 print_signature (outfile, die->die_id.die_type_node->signature);
5596 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5597 }
5598
5599 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
5600 {
5601 print_spaces (outfile);
5602 fprintf (outfile, " %s: ", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
5603
5604 print_attribute (a, true, outfile);
5605 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5606 }
5607
5608 if (die->die_child != NULL)
5609 {
5610 print_indent += 4;
5611 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, print_die (c, outfile));
5612 print_indent -= 4;
5613 }
5614 if (print_indent == 0)
5615 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5616 }
5617
5618 /* Print the list of operations in the LOC location description. */
5619
5620 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
5621 debug_dwarf_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
5622 {
5623 print_loc_descr (loc, stderr);
5624 }
5625
5626 /* Print the information collected for a given DIE. */
5627
5628 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
5629 debug_dwarf_die (dw_die_ref die)
5630 {
5631 print_die (die, stderr);
5632 }
5633
5634 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
5635 debug (die_struct &ref)
5636 {
5637 print_die (&ref, stderr);
5638 }
5639
5640 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
5641 debug (die_struct *ptr)
5642 {
5643 if (ptr)
5644 debug (*ptr);
5645 else
5646 fprintf (stderr, "<nil>\n");
5647 }
5648
5649
5650 /* Print all DWARF information collected for the compilation unit.
5651 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
5652
5653 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
5654 debug_dwarf (void)
5655 {
5656 print_indent = 0;
5657 print_die (comp_unit_die (), stderr);
5658 }
5659 \f
5660 /* Start a new compilation unit DIE for an include file. OLD_UNIT is the CU
5661 for the enclosing include file, if any. BINCL_DIE is the DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL
5662 DIE that marks the start of the DIEs for this include file. */
5663
5664 static dw_die_ref
5665 push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit, dw_die_ref bincl_die)
5666 {
5667 const char *filename = get_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name);
5668 dw_die_ref new_unit = gen_compile_unit_die (filename);
5669
5670 new_unit->die_sib = old_unit;
5671 return new_unit;
5672 }
5673
5674 /* Close an include-file CU and reopen the enclosing one. */
5675
5676 static dw_die_ref
5677 pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit)
5678 {
5679 dw_die_ref new_unit = old_unit->die_sib;
5680
5681 old_unit->die_sib = NULL;
5682 return new_unit;
5683 }
5684
5685 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
5686 #define CHECKSUM_BLOCK(FOO, SIZE) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), (SIZE), ctx)
5687 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO), ctx)
5688
5689 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression. */
5690
5691 static inline void
5692 loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
5693 {
5694 int tem;
5695 inchash::hash hstate;
5696 hashval_t hash;
5697
5698 tem = (loc->dtprel << 8) | ((unsigned int) loc->dw_loc_opc);
5699 CHECKSUM (tem);
5700 hash_loc_operands (loc, hstate);
5701 hash = hstate.end();
5702 CHECKSUM (hash);
5703 }
5704
5705 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute. */
5706
5707 static void
5708 attr_checksum (dw_attr_ref at, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
5709 {
5710 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
5711 rtx r;
5712
5713 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr);
5714
5715 /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
5716 snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters. */
5717 if (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
5718 return;
5719
5720 switch (AT_class (at))
5721 {
5722 case dw_val_class_const:
5723 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
5724 break;
5725 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5726 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
5727 break;
5728 case dw_val_class_const_double:
5729 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double);
5730 break;
5731 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
5732 CHECKSUM_BLOCK (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide->get_val (),
5733 get_full_len (*at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
5734 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
5735 break;
5736 case dw_val_class_vec:
5737 CHECKSUM_BLOCK (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array,
5738 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
5739 * at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size));
5740 break;
5741 case dw_val_class_flag:
5742 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag);
5743 break;
5744 case dw_val_class_str:
5745 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
5746 break;
5747
5748 case dw_val_class_addr:
5749 r = AT_addr (at);
5750 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r) == SYMBOL_REF);
5751 CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
5752 break;
5753
5754 case dw_val_class_offset:
5755 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
5756 break;
5757
5758 case dw_val_class_loc:
5759 for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
5760 loc_checksum (loc, ctx);
5761 break;
5762
5763 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
5764 die_checksum (AT_ref (at), ctx, mark);
5765 break;
5766
5767 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
5768 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
5769 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
5770 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
5771 case dw_val_class_macptr:
5772 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
5773 break;
5774
5775 case dw_val_class_file:
5776 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_file (at)->filename);
5777 break;
5778
5779 case dw_val_class_data8:
5780 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8);
5781 break;
5782
5783 default:
5784 break;
5785 }
5786 }
5787
5788 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE. */
5789
5790 static void
5791 die_checksum (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
5792 {
5793 dw_die_ref c;
5794 dw_attr_ref a;
5795 unsigned ix;
5796
5797 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
5798 if (die->die_mark)
5799 {
5800 CHECKSUM (die->die_mark);
5801 return;
5802 }
5803 die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
5804
5805 CHECKSUM (die->die_tag);
5806
5807 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
5808 attr_checksum (a, ctx, mark);
5809
5810 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, die_checksum (c, ctx, mark));
5811 }
5812
5813 #undef CHECKSUM
5814 #undef CHECKSUM_BLOCK
5815 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
5816
5817 /* For DWARF-4 types, include the trailing NULL when checksumming strings. */
5818 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
5819 #define CHECKSUM_BLOCK(FOO, SIZE) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), (SIZE), ctx)
5820 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO) + 1, ctx)
5821 #define CHECKSUM_SLEB128(FOO) checksum_sleb128 ((FOO), ctx)
5822 #define CHECKSUM_ULEB128(FOO) checksum_uleb128 ((FOO), ctx)
5823 #define CHECKSUM_ATTR(FOO) \
5824 if (FOO) attr_checksum_ordered (die->die_tag, (FOO), ctx, mark)
5825
5826 /* Calculate the checksum of a number in signed LEB128 format. */
5827
5828 static void
5829 checksum_sleb128 (HOST_WIDE_INT value, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
5830 {
5831 unsigned char byte;
5832 bool more;
5833
5834 while (1)
5835 {
5836 byte = (value & 0x7f);
5837 value >>= 7;
5838 more = !((value == 0 && (byte & 0x40) == 0)
5839 || (value == -1 && (byte & 0x40) != 0));
5840 if (more)
5841 byte |= 0x80;
5842 CHECKSUM (byte);
5843 if (!more)
5844 break;
5845 }
5846 }
5847
5848 /* Calculate the checksum of a number in unsigned LEB128 format. */
5849
5850 static void
5851 checksum_uleb128 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT value, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
5852 {
5853 while (1)
5854 {
5855 unsigned char byte = (value & 0x7f);
5856 value >>= 7;
5857 if (value != 0)
5858 /* More bytes to follow. */
5859 byte |= 0x80;
5860 CHECKSUM (byte);
5861 if (value == 0)
5862 break;
5863 }
5864 }
5865
5866 /* Checksum the context of the DIE. This adds the names of any
5867 surrounding namespaces or structures to the checksum. */
5868
5869 static void
5870 checksum_die_context (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
5871 {
5872 const char *name;
5873 dw_die_ref spec;
5874 int tag = die->die_tag;
5875
5876 if (tag != DW_TAG_namespace
5877 && tag != DW_TAG_structure_type
5878 && tag != DW_TAG_class_type)
5879 return;
5880
5881 name = get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name);
5882
5883 spec = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
5884 if (spec != NULL)
5885 die = spec;
5886
5887 if (die->die_parent != NULL)
5888 checksum_die_context (die->die_parent, ctx);
5889
5890 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('C');
5891 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (tag);
5892 if (name != NULL)
5893 CHECKSUM_STRING (name);
5894 }
5895
5896 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression. */
5897
5898 static inline void
5899 loc_checksum_ordered (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
5900 {
5901 /* Special case for lone DW_OP_plus_uconst: checksum as if the location
5902 were emitted as a DW_FORM_sdata instead of a location expression. */
5903 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_plus_uconst && loc->dw_loc_next == NULL)
5904 {
5905 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
5906 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 ((HOST_WIDE_INT) loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
5907 return;
5908 }
5909
5910 /* Otherwise, just checksum the raw location expression. */
5911 while (loc != NULL)
5912 {
5913 inchash::hash hstate;
5914 hashval_t hash;
5915
5916 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (loc->dtprel);
5917 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (loc->dw_loc_opc);
5918 hash_loc_operands (loc, hstate);
5919 hash = hstate.end ();
5920 CHECKSUM (hash);
5921 loc = loc->dw_loc_next;
5922 }
5923 }
5924
5925 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute. */
5926
5927 static void
5928 attr_checksum_ordered (enum dwarf_tag tag, dw_attr_ref at,
5929 struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
5930 {
5931 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
5932 rtx r;
5933
5934 if (AT_class (at) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
5935 {
5936 dw_die_ref target_die = AT_ref (at);
5937
5938 /* For pointer and reference types, we checksum only the (qualified)
5939 name of the target type (if there is a name). For friend entries,
5940 we checksum only the (qualified) name of the target type or function.
5941 This allows the checksum to remain the same whether the target type
5942 is complete or not. */
5943 if ((at->dw_attr == DW_AT_type
5944 && (tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
5945 || tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
5946 || tag == DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type
5947 || tag == DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type))
5948 || (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_friend
5949 && tag == DW_TAG_friend))
5950 {
5951 dw_attr_ref name_attr = get_AT (target_die, DW_AT_name);
5952
5953 if (name_attr != NULL)
5954 {
5955 dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (target_die, DW_AT_specification);
5956
5957 if (decl == NULL)
5958 decl = target_die;
5959 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('N');
5960 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
5961 if (decl->die_parent != NULL)
5962 checksum_die_context (decl->die_parent, ctx);
5963 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('E');
5964 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (name_attr));
5965 return;
5966 }
5967 }
5968
5969 /* For all other references to another DIE, we check to see if the
5970 target DIE has already been visited. If it has, we emit a
5971 backward reference; if not, we descend recursively. */
5972 if (target_die->die_mark > 0)
5973 {
5974 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('R');
5975 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
5976 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (target_die->die_mark);
5977 }
5978 else
5979 {
5980 dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (target_die, DW_AT_specification);
5981
5982 if (decl == NULL)
5983 decl = target_die;
5984 target_die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
5985 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('T');
5986 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
5987 if (decl->die_parent != NULL)
5988 checksum_die_context (decl->die_parent, ctx);
5989 die_checksum_ordered (target_die, ctx, mark);
5990 }
5991 return;
5992 }
5993
5994 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('A');
5995 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
5996
5997 switch (AT_class (at))
5998 {
5999 case dw_val_class_const:
6000 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
6001 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
6002 break;
6003
6004 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6005 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
6006 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 ((int) at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
6007 break;
6008
6009 case dw_val_class_const_double:
6010 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_block);
6011 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (sizeof (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double));
6012 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double);
6013 break;
6014
6015 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
6016 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_block);
6017 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (get_full_len (*at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
6018 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT);
6019 CHECKSUM_BLOCK (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide->get_val (),
6020 get_full_len (*at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
6021 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
6022 break;
6023
6024 case dw_val_class_vec:
6025 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_block);
6026 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
6027 * at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size);
6028 CHECKSUM_BLOCK (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array,
6029 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
6030 * at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size));
6031 break;
6032
6033 case dw_val_class_flag:
6034 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_flag);
6035 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag ? 1 : 0);
6036 break;
6037
6038 case dw_val_class_str:
6039 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
6040 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
6041 break;
6042
6043 case dw_val_class_addr:
6044 r = AT_addr (at);
6045 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r) == SYMBOL_REF);
6046 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
6047 CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
6048 break;
6049
6050 case dw_val_class_offset:
6051 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
6052 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
6053 break;
6054
6055 case dw_val_class_loc:
6056 for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
6057 loc_checksum_ordered (loc, ctx);
6058 break;
6059
6060 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6061 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6062 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6063 case dw_val_class_macptr:
6064 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
6065 break;
6066
6067 case dw_val_class_file:
6068 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
6069 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_file (at)->filename);
6070 break;
6071
6072 case dw_val_class_data8:
6073 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8);
6074 break;
6075
6076 default:
6077 break;
6078 }
6079 }
6080
6081 struct checksum_attributes
6082 {
6083 dw_attr_ref at_name;
6084 dw_attr_ref at_type;
6085 dw_attr_ref at_friend;
6086 dw_attr_ref at_accessibility;
6087 dw_attr_ref at_address_class;
6088 dw_attr_ref at_allocated;
6089 dw_attr_ref at_artificial;
6090 dw_attr_ref at_associated;
6091 dw_attr_ref at_binary_scale;
6092 dw_attr_ref at_bit_offset;
6093 dw_attr_ref at_bit_size;
6094 dw_attr_ref at_bit_stride;
6095 dw_attr_ref at_byte_size;
6096 dw_attr_ref at_byte_stride;
6097 dw_attr_ref at_const_value;
6098 dw_attr_ref at_containing_type;
6099 dw_attr_ref at_count;
6100 dw_attr_ref at_data_location;
6101 dw_attr_ref at_data_member_location;
6102 dw_attr_ref at_decimal_scale;
6103 dw_attr_ref at_decimal_sign;
6104 dw_attr_ref at_default_value;
6105 dw_attr_ref at_digit_count;
6106 dw_attr_ref at_discr;
6107 dw_attr_ref at_discr_list;
6108 dw_attr_ref at_discr_value;
6109 dw_attr_ref at_encoding;
6110 dw_attr_ref at_endianity;
6111 dw_attr_ref at_explicit;
6112 dw_attr_ref at_is_optional;
6113 dw_attr_ref at_location;
6114 dw_attr_ref at_lower_bound;
6115 dw_attr_ref at_mutable;
6116 dw_attr_ref at_ordering;
6117 dw_attr_ref at_picture_string;
6118 dw_attr_ref at_prototyped;
6119 dw_attr_ref at_small;
6120 dw_attr_ref at_segment;
6121 dw_attr_ref at_string_length;
6122 dw_attr_ref at_threads_scaled;
6123 dw_attr_ref at_upper_bound;
6124 dw_attr_ref at_use_location;
6125 dw_attr_ref at_use_UTF8;
6126 dw_attr_ref at_variable_parameter;
6127 dw_attr_ref at_virtuality;
6128 dw_attr_ref at_visibility;
6129 dw_attr_ref at_vtable_elem_location;
6130 };
6131
6132 /* Collect the attributes that we will want to use for the checksum. */
6133
6134 static void
6135 collect_checksum_attributes (struct checksum_attributes *attrs, dw_die_ref die)
6136 {
6137 dw_attr_ref a;
6138 unsigned ix;
6139
6140 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
6141 {
6142 switch (a->dw_attr)
6143 {
6144 case DW_AT_name:
6145 attrs->at_name = a;
6146 break;
6147 case DW_AT_type:
6148 attrs->at_type = a;
6149 break;
6150 case DW_AT_friend:
6151 attrs->at_friend = a;
6152 break;
6153 case DW_AT_accessibility:
6154 attrs->at_accessibility = a;
6155 break;
6156 case DW_AT_address_class:
6157 attrs->at_address_class = a;
6158 break;
6159 case DW_AT_allocated:
6160 attrs->at_allocated = a;
6161 break;
6162 case DW_AT_artificial:
6163 attrs->at_artificial = a;
6164 break;
6165 case DW_AT_associated:
6166 attrs->at_associated = a;
6167 break;
6168 case DW_AT_binary_scale:
6169 attrs->at_binary_scale = a;
6170 break;
6171 case DW_AT_bit_offset:
6172 attrs->at_bit_offset = a;
6173 break;
6174 case DW_AT_bit_size:
6175 attrs->at_bit_size = a;
6176 break;
6177 case DW_AT_bit_stride:
6178 attrs->at_bit_stride = a;
6179 break;
6180 case DW_AT_byte_size:
6181 attrs->at_byte_size = a;
6182 break;
6183 case DW_AT_byte_stride:
6184 attrs->at_byte_stride = a;
6185 break;
6186 case DW_AT_const_value:
6187 attrs->at_const_value = a;
6188 break;
6189 case DW_AT_containing_type:
6190 attrs->at_containing_type = a;
6191 break;
6192 case DW_AT_count:
6193 attrs->at_count = a;
6194 break;
6195 case DW_AT_data_location:
6196 attrs->at_data_location = a;
6197 break;
6198 case DW_AT_data_member_location:
6199 attrs->at_data_member_location = a;
6200 break;
6201 case DW_AT_decimal_scale:
6202 attrs->at_decimal_scale = a;
6203 break;
6204 case DW_AT_decimal_sign:
6205 attrs->at_decimal_sign = a;
6206 break;
6207 case DW_AT_default_value:
6208 attrs->at_default_value = a;
6209 break;
6210 case DW_AT_digit_count:
6211 attrs->at_digit_count = a;
6212 break;
6213 case DW_AT_discr:
6214 attrs->at_discr = a;
6215 break;
6216 case DW_AT_discr_list:
6217 attrs->at_discr_list = a;
6218 break;
6219 case DW_AT_discr_value:
6220 attrs->at_discr_value = a;
6221 break;
6222 case DW_AT_encoding:
6223 attrs->at_encoding = a;
6224 break;
6225 case DW_AT_endianity:
6226 attrs->at_endianity = a;
6227 break;
6228 case DW_AT_explicit:
6229 attrs->at_explicit = a;
6230 break;
6231 case DW_AT_is_optional:
6232 attrs->at_is_optional = a;
6233 break;
6234 case DW_AT_location:
6235 attrs->at_location = a;
6236 break;
6237 case DW_AT_lower_bound:
6238 attrs->at_lower_bound = a;
6239 break;
6240 case DW_AT_mutable:
6241 attrs->at_mutable = a;
6242 break;
6243 case DW_AT_ordering:
6244 attrs->at_ordering = a;
6245 break;
6246 case DW_AT_picture_string:
6247 attrs->at_picture_string = a;
6248 break;
6249 case DW_AT_prototyped:
6250 attrs->at_prototyped = a;
6251 break;
6252 case DW_AT_small:
6253 attrs->at_small = a;
6254 break;
6255 case DW_AT_segment:
6256 attrs->at_segment = a;
6257 break;
6258 case DW_AT_string_length:
6259 attrs->at_string_length = a;
6260 break;
6261 case DW_AT_threads_scaled:
6262 attrs->at_threads_scaled = a;
6263 break;
6264 case DW_AT_upper_bound:
6265 attrs->at_upper_bound = a;
6266 break;
6267 case DW_AT_use_location:
6268 attrs->at_use_location = a;
6269 break;
6270 case DW_AT_use_UTF8:
6271 attrs->at_use_UTF8 = a;
6272 break;
6273 case DW_AT_variable_parameter:
6274 attrs->at_variable_parameter = a;
6275 break;
6276 case DW_AT_virtuality:
6277 attrs->at_virtuality = a;
6278 break;
6279 case DW_AT_visibility:
6280 attrs->at_visibility = a;
6281 break;
6282 case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location:
6283 attrs->at_vtable_elem_location = a;
6284 break;
6285 default:
6286 break;
6287 }
6288 }
6289 }
6290
6291 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE, using an ordered subset of attributes. */
6292
6293 static void
6294 die_checksum_ordered (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
6295 {
6296 dw_die_ref c;
6297 dw_die_ref decl;
6298 struct checksum_attributes attrs;
6299
6300 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('D');
6301 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (die->die_tag);
6302
6303 memset (&attrs, 0, sizeof (attrs));
6304
6305 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
6306 if (decl != NULL)
6307 collect_checksum_attributes (&attrs, decl);
6308 collect_checksum_attributes (&attrs, die);
6309
6310 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_name);
6311 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_accessibility);
6312 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_address_class);
6313 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_allocated);
6314 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_artificial);
6315 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_associated);
6316 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_binary_scale);
6317 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_offset);
6318 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_size);
6319 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_stride);
6320 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_byte_size);
6321 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_byte_stride);
6322 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_const_value);
6323 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_containing_type);
6324 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_count);
6325 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_data_location);
6326 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_data_member_location);
6327 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_decimal_scale);
6328 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_decimal_sign);
6329 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_default_value);
6330 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_digit_count);
6331 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr);
6332 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr_list);
6333 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr_value);
6334 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_encoding);
6335 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_endianity);
6336 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_explicit);
6337 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_is_optional);
6338 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_location);
6339 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_lower_bound);
6340 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_mutable);
6341 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_ordering);
6342 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_picture_string);
6343 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_prototyped);
6344 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_small);
6345 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_segment);
6346 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_string_length);
6347 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_threads_scaled);
6348 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_upper_bound);
6349 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_use_location);
6350 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_use_UTF8);
6351 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_variable_parameter);
6352 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_virtuality);
6353 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_visibility);
6354 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_vtable_elem_location);
6355 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_type);
6356 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_friend);
6357
6358 /* Checksum the child DIEs. */
6359 c = die->die_child;
6360 if (c) do {
6361 dw_attr_ref name_attr;
6362
6363 c = c->die_sib;
6364 name_attr = get_AT (c, DW_AT_name);
6365 if (is_template_instantiation (c))
6366 {
6367 /* Ignore instantiations of member type and function templates. */
6368 }
6369 else if (name_attr != NULL
6370 && (is_type_die (c) || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram))
6371 {
6372 /* Use a shallow checksum for named nested types and member
6373 functions. */
6374 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('S');
6375 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (c->die_tag);
6376 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (name_attr));
6377 }
6378 else
6379 {
6380 /* Use a deep checksum for other children. */
6381 /* Mark this DIE so it gets processed when unmarking. */
6382 if (c->die_mark == 0)
6383 c->die_mark = -1;
6384 die_checksum_ordered (c, ctx, mark);
6385 }
6386 } while (c != die->die_child);
6387
6388 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (0);
6389 }
6390
6391 /* Add a type name and tag to a hash. */
6392 static void
6393 die_odr_checksum (int tag, const char *name, md5_ctx *ctx)
6394 {
6395 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (tag);
6396 CHECKSUM_STRING (name);
6397 }
6398
6399 #undef CHECKSUM
6400 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
6401 #undef CHECKSUM_ATTR
6402 #undef CHECKSUM_LEB128
6403 #undef CHECKSUM_ULEB128
6404
6405 /* Generate the type signature for DIE. This is computed by generating an
6406 MD5 checksum over the DIE's tag, its relevant attributes, and its
6407 children. Attributes that are references to other DIEs are processed
6408 by recursion, using the MARK field to prevent infinite recursion.
6409 If the DIE is nested inside a namespace or another type, we also
6410 need to include that context in the signature. The lower 64 bits
6411 of the resulting MD5 checksum comprise the signature. */
6412
6413 static void
6414 generate_type_signature (dw_die_ref die, comdat_type_node *type_node)
6415 {
6416 int mark;
6417 const char *name;
6418 unsigned char checksum[16];
6419 struct md5_ctx ctx;
6420 dw_die_ref decl;
6421 dw_die_ref parent;
6422
6423 name = get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name);
6424 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
6425 parent = get_die_parent (die);
6426
6427 /* First, compute a signature for just the type name (and its surrounding
6428 context, if any. This is stored in the type unit DIE for link-time
6429 ODR (one-definition rule) checking. */
6430
6431 if (is_cxx () && name != NULL)
6432 {
6433 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
6434
6435 /* Checksum the names of surrounding namespaces and structures. */
6436 if (parent != NULL)
6437 checksum_die_context (parent, &ctx);
6438
6439 /* Checksum the current DIE. */
6440 die_odr_checksum (die->die_tag, name, &ctx);
6441 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
6442
6443 add_AT_data8 (type_node->root_die, DW_AT_GNU_odr_signature, &checksum[8]);
6444 }
6445
6446 /* Next, compute the complete type signature. */
6447
6448 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
6449 mark = 1;
6450 die->die_mark = mark;
6451
6452 /* Checksum the names of surrounding namespaces and structures. */
6453 if (parent != NULL)
6454 checksum_die_context (parent, &ctx);
6455
6456 /* Checksum the DIE and its children. */
6457 die_checksum_ordered (die, &ctx, &mark);
6458 unmark_all_dies (die);
6459 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
6460
6461 /* Store the signature in the type node and link the type DIE and the
6462 type node together. */
6463 memcpy (type_node->signature, &checksum[16 - DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE],
6464 DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE);
6465 die->comdat_type_p = true;
6466 die->die_id.die_type_node = type_node;
6467 type_node->type_die = die;
6468
6469 /* If the DIE is a specification, link its declaration to the type node
6470 as well. */
6471 if (decl != NULL)
6472 {
6473 decl->comdat_type_p = true;
6474 decl->die_id.die_type_node = type_node;
6475 }
6476 }
6477
6478 /* Do the location expressions look same? */
6479 static inline int
6480 same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, dw_loc_descr_ref loc2, int *mark)
6481 {
6482 return loc1->dw_loc_opc == loc2->dw_loc_opc
6483 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd1, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd1, mark)
6484 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd2, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd2, mark);
6485 }
6486
6487 /* Do the values look the same? */
6488 static int
6489 same_dw_val_p (const dw_val_node *v1, const dw_val_node *v2, int *mark)
6490 {
6491 dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, loc2;
6492 rtx r1, r2;
6493
6494 if (v1->val_class != v2->val_class)
6495 return 0;
6496
6497 switch (v1->val_class)
6498 {
6499 case dw_val_class_const:
6500 return v1->v.val_int == v2->v.val_int;
6501 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6502 return v1->v.val_unsigned == v2->v.val_unsigned;
6503 case dw_val_class_const_double:
6504 return v1->v.val_double.high == v2->v.val_double.high
6505 && v1->v.val_double.low == v2->v.val_double.low;
6506 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
6507 return *v1->v.val_wide == *v2->v.val_wide;
6508 case dw_val_class_vec:
6509 if (v1->v.val_vec.length != v2->v.val_vec.length
6510 || v1->v.val_vec.elt_size != v2->v.val_vec.elt_size)
6511 return 0;
6512 if (memcmp (v1->v.val_vec.array, v2->v.val_vec.array,
6513 v1->v.val_vec.length * v1->v.val_vec.elt_size))
6514 return 0;
6515 return 1;
6516 case dw_val_class_flag:
6517 return v1->v.val_flag == v2->v.val_flag;
6518 case dw_val_class_str:
6519 return !strcmp (v1->v.val_str->str, v2->v.val_str->str);
6520
6521 case dw_val_class_addr:
6522 r1 = v1->v.val_addr;
6523 r2 = v2->v.val_addr;
6524 if (GET_CODE (r1) != GET_CODE (r2))
6525 return 0;
6526 return !rtx_equal_p (r1, r2);
6527
6528 case dw_val_class_offset:
6529 return v1->v.val_offset == v2->v.val_offset;
6530
6531 case dw_val_class_loc:
6532 for (loc1 = v1->v.val_loc, loc2 = v2->v.val_loc;
6533 loc1 && loc2;
6534 loc1 = loc1->dw_loc_next, loc2 = loc2->dw_loc_next)
6535 if (!same_loc_p (loc1, loc2, mark))
6536 return 0;
6537 return !loc1 && !loc2;
6538
6539 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6540 return same_die_p (v1->v.val_die_ref.die, v2->v.val_die_ref.die, mark);
6541
6542 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6543 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
6544 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6545 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6546 case dw_val_class_macptr:
6547 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
6548 return 1;
6549
6550 case dw_val_class_file:
6551 return v1->v.val_file == v2->v.val_file;
6552
6553 case dw_val_class_data8:
6554 return !memcmp (v1->v.val_data8, v2->v.val_data8, 8);
6555
6556 default:
6557 return 1;
6558 }
6559 }
6560
6561 /* Do the attributes look the same? */
6562
6563 static int
6564 same_attr_p (dw_attr_ref at1, dw_attr_ref at2, int *mark)
6565 {
6566 if (at1->dw_attr != at2->dw_attr)
6567 return 0;
6568
6569 /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
6570 snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters. */
6571 if (at1->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
6572 return 1;
6573
6574 return same_dw_val_p (&at1->dw_attr_val, &at2->dw_attr_val, mark);
6575 }
6576
6577 /* Do the dies look the same? */
6578
6579 static int
6580 same_die_p (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2, int *mark)
6581 {
6582 dw_die_ref c1, c2;
6583 dw_attr_ref a1;
6584 unsigned ix;
6585
6586 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
6587 if (die1->die_mark)
6588 return die1->die_mark == die2->die_mark;
6589 die1->die_mark = die2->die_mark = ++(*mark);
6590
6591 if (die1->die_tag != die2->die_tag)
6592 return 0;
6593
6594 if (vec_safe_length (die1->die_attr) != vec_safe_length (die2->die_attr))
6595 return 0;
6596
6597 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die1->die_attr, ix, a1)
6598 if (!same_attr_p (a1, &(*die2->die_attr)[ix], mark))
6599 return 0;
6600
6601 c1 = die1->die_child;
6602 c2 = die2->die_child;
6603 if (! c1)
6604 {
6605 if (c2)
6606 return 0;
6607 }
6608 else
6609 for (;;)
6610 {
6611 if (!same_die_p (c1, c2, mark))
6612 return 0;
6613 c1 = c1->die_sib;
6614 c2 = c2->die_sib;
6615 if (c1 == die1->die_child)
6616 {
6617 if (c2 == die2->die_child)
6618 break;
6619 else
6620 return 0;
6621 }
6622 }
6623
6624 return 1;
6625 }
6626
6627 /* Do the dies look the same? Wrapper around same_die_p. */
6628
6629 static int
6630 same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2)
6631 {
6632 int mark = 0;
6633 int ret = same_die_p (die1, die2, &mark);
6634
6635 unmark_all_dies (die1);
6636 unmark_all_dies (die2);
6637
6638 return ret;
6639 }
6640
6641 /* The prefix to attach to symbols on DIEs in the current comdat debug
6642 info section. */
6643 static const char *comdat_symbol_id;
6644
6645 /* The index of the current symbol within the current comdat CU. */
6646 static unsigned int comdat_symbol_number;
6647
6648 /* Calculate the MD5 checksum of the compilation unit DIE UNIT_DIE and its
6649 children, and set comdat_symbol_id accordingly. */
6650
6651 static void
6652 compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref unit_die)
6653 {
6654 const char *die_name = get_AT_string (unit_die, DW_AT_name);
6655 const char *base = die_name ? lbasename (die_name) : "anonymous";
6656 char *name = XALLOCAVEC (char, strlen (base) + 64);
6657 char *p;
6658 int i, mark;
6659 unsigned char checksum[16];
6660 struct md5_ctx ctx;
6661
6662 /* Compute the checksum of the DIE, then append part of it as hex digits to
6663 the name filename of the unit. */
6664
6665 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
6666 mark = 0;
6667 die_checksum (unit_die, &ctx, &mark);
6668 unmark_all_dies (unit_die);
6669 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
6670
6671 sprintf (name, "%s.", base);
6672 clean_symbol_name (name);
6673
6674 p = name + strlen (name);
6675 for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
6676 {
6677 sprintf (p, "%.2x", checksum[i]);
6678 p += 2;
6679 }
6680
6681 comdat_symbol_id = unit_die->die_id.die_symbol = xstrdup (name);
6682 comdat_symbol_number = 0;
6683 }
6684
6685 /* Returns nonzero if DIE represents a type, in the sense of TYPE_P. */
6686
6687 static int
6688 is_type_die (dw_die_ref die)
6689 {
6690 switch (die->die_tag)
6691 {
6692 case DW_TAG_array_type:
6693 case DW_TAG_class_type:
6694 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
6695 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
6696 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
6697 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
6698 case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
6699 case DW_TAG_string_type:
6700 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
6701 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
6702 case DW_TAG_union_type:
6703 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
6704 case DW_TAG_set_type:
6705 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
6706 case DW_TAG_base_type:
6707 case DW_TAG_const_type:
6708 case DW_TAG_file_type:
6709 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
6710 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
6711 case DW_TAG_typedef:
6712 return 1;
6713 default:
6714 return 0;
6715 }
6716 }
6717
6718 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that should go into a COMDAT CU.
6719 Basically, we want to choose the bits that are likely to be shared between
6720 compilations (types) and leave out the bits that are specific to individual
6721 compilations (functions). */
6722
6723 static int
6724 is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref c)
6725 {
6726 /* I think we want to leave base types and __vtbl_ptr_type in the main CU, as
6727 we do for stabs. The advantage is a greater likelihood of sharing between
6728 objects that don't include headers in the same order (and therefore would
6729 put the base types in a different comdat). jason 8/28/00 */
6730
6731 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
6732 return 0;
6733
6734 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
6735 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
6736 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type
6737 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_const_type
6738 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_volatile_type)
6739 {
6740 dw_die_ref t = get_AT_ref (c, DW_AT_type);
6741
6742 return t ? is_comdat_die (t) : 0;
6743 }
6744
6745 return is_type_die (c);
6746 }
6747
6748 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that might be referred to from another
6749 compilation unit. */
6750
6751 static int
6752 is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref c)
6753 {
6754 return (is_type_die (c)
6755 || is_declaration_die (c)
6756 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace
6757 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_module);
6758 }
6759
6760 /* Returns true iff C is a compile-unit DIE. */
6761
6762 static inline bool
6763 is_cu_die (dw_die_ref c)
6764 {
6765 return c && c->die_tag == DW_TAG_compile_unit;
6766 }
6767
6768 /* Returns true iff C is a unit DIE of some sort. */
6769
6770 static inline bool
6771 is_unit_die (dw_die_ref c)
6772 {
6773 return c && (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_compile_unit
6774 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_partial_unit
6775 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_type_unit);
6776 }
6777
6778 /* Returns true iff C is a namespace DIE. */
6779
6780 static inline bool
6781 is_namespace_die (dw_die_ref c)
6782 {
6783 return c && c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace;
6784 }
6785
6786 /* Returns true iff C is a class or structure DIE. */
6787
6788 static inline bool
6789 is_class_die (dw_die_ref c)
6790 {
6791 return c && (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type
6792 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type);
6793 }
6794
6795 /* Return non-zero if this DIE is a template parameter. */
6796
6797 static inline bool
6798 is_template_parameter (dw_die_ref die)
6799 {
6800 switch (die->die_tag)
6801 {
6802 case DW_TAG_template_type_param:
6803 case DW_TAG_template_value_param:
6804 case DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param:
6805 case DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack:
6806 return true;
6807 default:
6808 return false;
6809 }
6810 }
6811
6812 /* Return non-zero if this DIE represents a template instantiation. */
6813
6814 static inline bool
6815 is_template_instantiation (dw_die_ref die)
6816 {
6817 dw_die_ref c;
6818
6819 if (!is_type_die (die) && die->die_tag != DW_TAG_subprogram)
6820 return false;
6821 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, if (is_template_parameter (c)) return true);
6822 return false;
6823 }
6824
6825 static char *
6826 gen_internal_sym (const char *prefix)
6827 {
6828 char buf[256];
6829
6830 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (buf, prefix, label_num++);
6831 return xstrdup (buf);
6832 }
6833
6834 /* Assign symbols to all worthy DIEs under DIE. */
6835
6836 static void
6837 assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref die)
6838 {
6839 dw_die_ref c;
6840
6841 if (is_symbol_die (die) && !die->comdat_type_p)
6842 {
6843 if (comdat_symbol_id)
6844 {
6845 char *p = XALLOCAVEC (char, strlen (comdat_symbol_id) + 64);
6846
6847 sprintf (p, "%s.%s.%x", DIE_LABEL_PREFIX,
6848 comdat_symbol_id, comdat_symbol_number++);
6849 die->die_id.die_symbol = xstrdup (p);
6850 }
6851 else
6852 die->die_id.die_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LDIE");
6853 }
6854
6855 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, assign_symbol_names (c));
6856 }
6857
6858 struct cu_hash_table_entry
6859 {
6860 dw_die_ref cu;
6861 unsigned min_comdat_num, max_comdat_num;
6862 struct cu_hash_table_entry *next;
6863 };
6864
6865 /* Helpers to manipulate hash table of CUs. */
6866
6867 struct cu_hash_table_entry_hasher
6868 {
6869 typedef cu_hash_table_entry *value_type;
6870 typedef die_struct *compare_type;
6871 static inline hashval_t hash (const cu_hash_table_entry *);
6872 static inline bool equal (const cu_hash_table_entry *, const die_struct *);
6873 static inline void remove (cu_hash_table_entry *);
6874 };
6875
6876 inline hashval_t
6877 cu_hash_table_entry_hasher::hash (const cu_hash_table_entry *entry)
6878 {
6879 return htab_hash_string (entry->cu->die_id.die_symbol);
6880 }
6881
6882 inline bool
6883 cu_hash_table_entry_hasher::equal (const cu_hash_table_entry *entry1,
6884 const die_struct *entry2)
6885 {
6886 return !strcmp (entry1->cu->die_id.die_symbol, entry2->die_id.die_symbol);
6887 }
6888
6889 inline void
6890 cu_hash_table_entry_hasher::remove (cu_hash_table_entry *entry)
6891 {
6892 struct cu_hash_table_entry *next;
6893
6894 while (entry)
6895 {
6896 next = entry->next;
6897 free (entry);
6898 entry = next;
6899 }
6900 }
6901
6902 typedef hash_table<cu_hash_table_entry_hasher> cu_hash_type;
6903
6904 /* Check whether we have already seen this CU and set up SYM_NUM
6905 accordingly. */
6906 static int
6907 check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref cu, cu_hash_type *htable, unsigned int *sym_num)
6908 {
6909 struct cu_hash_table_entry dummy;
6910 struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry, *last = &dummy;
6911
6912 dummy.max_comdat_num = 0;
6913
6914 slot = htable->find_slot_with_hash (cu,
6915 htab_hash_string (cu->die_id.die_symbol),
6916 INSERT);
6917 entry = *slot;
6918
6919 for (; entry; last = entry, entry = entry->next)
6920 {
6921 if (same_die_p_wrap (cu, entry->cu))
6922 break;
6923 }
6924
6925 if (entry)
6926 {
6927 *sym_num = entry->min_comdat_num;
6928 return 1;
6929 }
6930
6931 entry = XCNEW (struct cu_hash_table_entry);
6932 entry->cu = cu;
6933 entry->min_comdat_num = *sym_num = last->max_comdat_num;
6934 entry->next = *slot;
6935 *slot = entry;
6936
6937 return 0;
6938 }
6939
6940 /* Record SYM_NUM to record of CU in HTABLE. */
6941 static void
6942 record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref cu, cu_hash_type *htable,
6943 unsigned int sym_num)
6944 {
6945 struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry;
6946
6947 slot = htable->find_slot_with_hash (cu,
6948 htab_hash_string (cu->die_id.die_symbol),
6949 NO_INSERT);
6950 entry = *slot;
6951
6952 entry->max_comdat_num = sym_num;
6953 }
6954
6955 /* Traverse the DIE (which is always comp_unit_die), and set up
6956 additional compilation units for each of the include files we see
6957 bracketed by BINCL/EINCL. */
6958
6959 static void
6960 break_out_includes (dw_die_ref die)
6961 {
6962 dw_die_ref c;
6963 dw_die_ref unit = NULL;
6964 limbo_die_node *node, **pnode;
6965
6966 c = die->die_child;
6967 if (c) do {
6968 dw_die_ref prev = c;
6969 c = c->die_sib;
6970 while (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL
6971 || (unit && is_comdat_die (c)))
6972 {
6973 dw_die_ref next = c->die_sib;
6974
6975 /* This DIE is for a secondary CU; remove it from the main one. */
6976 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
6977
6978 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL)
6979 unit = push_new_compile_unit (unit, c);
6980 else if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL)
6981 unit = pop_compile_unit (unit);
6982 else
6983 add_child_die (unit, c);
6984 c = next;
6985 if (c == die->die_child)
6986 break;
6987 }
6988 } while (c != die->die_child);
6989
6990 #if 0
6991 /* We can only use this in debugging, since the frontend doesn't check
6992 to make sure that we leave every include file we enter. */
6993 gcc_assert (!unit);
6994 #endif
6995
6996 assign_symbol_names (die);
6997 cu_hash_type cu_hash_table (10);
6998 for (node = limbo_die_list, pnode = &limbo_die_list;
6999 node;
7000 node = node->next)
7001 {
7002 int is_dupl;
7003
7004 compute_section_prefix (node->die);
7005 is_dupl = check_duplicate_cu (node->die, &cu_hash_table,
7006 &comdat_symbol_number);
7007 assign_symbol_names (node->die);
7008 if (is_dupl)
7009 *pnode = node->next;
7010 else
7011 {
7012 pnode = &node->next;
7013 record_comdat_symbol_number (node->die, &cu_hash_table,
7014 comdat_symbol_number);
7015 }
7016 }
7017 }
7018
7019 /* Return non-zero if this DIE is a declaration. */
7020
7021 static int
7022 is_declaration_die (dw_die_ref die)
7023 {
7024 dw_attr_ref a;
7025 unsigned ix;
7026
7027 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
7028 if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_declaration)
7029 return 1;
7030
7031 return 0;
7032 }
7033
7034 /* Return non-zero if this DIE is nested inside a subprogram. */
7035
7036 static int
7037 is_nested_in_subprogram (dw_die_ref die)
7038 {
7039 dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
7040
7041 if (decl == NULL)
7042 decl = die;
7043 return local_scope_p (decl);
7044 }
7045
7046 /* Return non-zero if this DIE contains a defining declaration of a
7047 subprogram. */
7048
7049 static int
7050 contains_subprogram_definition (dw_die_ref die)
7051 {
7052 dw_die_ref c;
7053
7054 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram && ! is_declaration_die (die))
7055 return 1;
7056 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, if (contains_subprogram_definition (c)) return 1);
7057 return 0;
7058 }
7059
7060 /* Return non-zero if this is a type DIE that should be moved to a
7061 COMDAT .debug_types section. */
7062
7063 static int
7064 should_move_die_to_comdat (dw_die_ref die)
7065 {
7066 switch (die->die_tag)
7067 {
7068 case DW_TAG_class_type:
7069 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
7070 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
7071 case DW_TAG_union_type:
7072 /* Don't move declarations, inlined instances, types nested in a
7073 subprogram, or types that contain subprogram definitions. */
7074 if (is_declaration_die (die)
7075 || get_AT (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin)
7076 || is_nested_in_subprogram (die)
7077 || contains_subprogram_definition (die))
7078 return 0;
7079 return 1;
7080 case DW_TAG_array_type:
7081 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
7082 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
7083 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
7084 case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
7085 case DW_TAG_string_type:
7086 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
7087 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
7088 case DW_TAG_set_type:
7089 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
7090 case DW_TAG_base_type:
7091 case DW_TAG_const_type:
7092 case DW_TAG_file_type:
7093 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
7094 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
7095 case DW_TAG_typedef:
7096 default:
7097 return 0;
7098 }
7099 }
7100
7101 /* Make a clone of DIE. */
7102
7103 static dw_die_ref
7104 clone_die (dw_die_ref die)
7105 {
7106 dw_die_ref clone;
7107 dw_attr_ref a;
7108 unsigned ix;
7109
7110 clone = ggc_cleared_alloc<die_node> ();
7111 clone->die_tag = die->die_tag;
7112
7113 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
7114 add_dwarf_attr (clone, a);
7115
7116 return clone;
7117 }
7118
7119 /* Make a clone of the tree rooted at DIE. */
7120
7121 static dw_die_ref
7122 clone_tree (dw_die_ref die)
7123 {
7124 dw_die_ref c;
7125 dw_die_ref clone = clone_die (die);
7126
7127 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_child_die (clone, clone_tree (c)));
7128
7129 return clone;
7130 }
7131
7132 /* Make a clone of DIE as a declaration. */
7133
7134 static dw_die_ref
7135 clone_as_declaration (dw_die_ref die)
7136 {
7137 dw_die_ref clone;
7138 dw_die_ref decl;
7139 dw_attr_ref a;
7140 unsigned ix;
7141
7142 /* If the DIE is already a declaration, just clone it. */
7143 if (is_declaration_die (die))
7144 return clone_die (die);
7145
7146 /* If the DIE is a specification, just clone its declaration DIE. */
7147 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
7148 if (decl != NULL)
7149 {
7150 clone = clone_die (decl);
7151 if (die->comdat_type_p)
7152 add_AT_die_ref (clone, DW_AT_signature, die);
7153 return clone;
7154 }
7155
7156 clone = ggc_cleared_alloc<die_node> ();
7157 clone->die_tag = die->die_tag;
7158
7159 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
7160 {
7161 /* We don't want to copy over all attributes.
7162 For example we don't want DW_AT_byte_size because otherwise we will no
7163 longer have a declaration and GDB will treat it as a definition. */
7164
7165 switch (a->dw_attr)
7166 {
7167 case DW_AT_abstract_origin:
7168 case DW_AT_artificial:
7169 case DW_AT_containing_type:
7170 case DW_AT_external:
7171 case DW_AT_name:
7172 case DW_AT_type:
7173 case DW_AT_virtuality:
7174 case DW_AT_linkage_name:
7175 case DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name:
7176 add_dwarf_attr (clone, a);
7177 break;
7178 case DW_AT_byte_size:
7179 default:
7180 break;
7181 }
7182 }
7183
7184 if (die->comdat_type_p)
7185 add_AT_die_ref (clone, DW_AT_signature, die);
7186
7187 add_AT_flag (clone, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
7188 return clone;
7189 }
7190
7191
7192 /* Structure to map a DIE in one CU to its copy in a comdat type unit. */
7193
7194 struct decl_table_entry
7195 {
7196 dw_die_ref orig;
7197 dw_die_ref copy;
7198 };
7199
7200 /* Helpers to manipulate hash table of copied declarations. */
7201
7202 /* Hashtable helpers. */
7203
7204 struct decl_table_entry_hasher : typed_free_remove <decl_table_entry>
7205 {
7206 typedef decl_table_entry *value_type;
7207 typedef die_struct *compare_type;
7208 static inline hashval_t hash (const decl_table_entry *);
7209 static inline bool equal (const decl_table_entry *, const die_struct *);
7210 };
7211
7212 inline hashval_t
7213 decl_table_entry_hasher::hash (const decl_table_entry *entry)
7214 {
7215 return htab_hash_pointer (entry->orig);
7216 }
7217
7218 inline bool
7219 decl_table_entry_hasher::equal (const decl_table_entry *entry1,
7220 const die_struct *entry2)
7221 {
7222 return entry1->orig == entry2;
7223 }
7224
7225 typedef hash_table<decl_table_entry_hasher> decl_hash_type;
7226
7227 /* Copy DIE and its ancestors, up to, but not including, the compile unit
7228 or type unit entry, to a new tree. Adds the new tree to UNIT and returns
7229 a pointer to the copy of DIE. If DECL_TABLE is provided, it is used
7230 to check if the ancestor has already been copied into UNIT. */
7231
7232 static dw_die_ref
7233 copy_ancestor_tree (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die,
7234 decl_hash_type *decl_table)
7235 {
7236 dw_die_ref parent = die->die_parent;
7237 dw_die_ref new_parent = unit;
7238 dw_die_ref copy;
7239 decl_table_entry **slot = NULL;
7240 struct decl_table_entry *entry = NULL;
7241
7242 if (decl_table)
7243 {
7244 /* Check if the entry has already been copied to UNIT. */
7245 slot = decl_table->find_slot_with_hash (die, htab_hash_pointer (die),
7246 INSERT);
7247 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
7248 {
7249 entry = *slot;
7250 return entry->copy;
7251 }
7252
7253 /* Record in DECL_TABLE that DIE has been copied to UNIT. */
7254 entry = XCNEW (struct decl_table_entry);
7255 entry->orig = die;
7256 entry->copy = NULL;
7257 *slot = entry;
7258 }
7259
7260 if (parent != NULL)
7261 {
7262 dw_die_ref spec = get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification);
7263 if (spec != NULL)
7264 parent = spec;
7265 if (!is_unit_die (parent))
7266 new_parent = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, parent, decl_table);
7267 }
7268
7269 copy = clone_as_declaration (die);
7270 add_child_die (new_parent, copy);
7271
7272 if (decl_table)
7273 {
7274 /* Record the pointer to the copy. */
7275 entry->copy = copy;
7276 }
7277
7278 return copy;
7279 }
7280 /* Copy the declaration context to the new type unit DIE. This includes
7281 any surrounding namespace or type declarations. If the DIE has an
7282 AT_specification attribute, it also includes attributes and children
7283 attached to the specification, and returns a pointer to the original
7284 parent of the declaration DIE. Returns NULL otherwise. */
7285
7286 static dw_die_ref
7287 copy_declaration_context (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die)
7288 {
7289 dw_die_ref decl;
7290 dw_die_ref new_decl;
7291 dw_die_ref orig_parent = NULL;
7292
7293 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
7294 if (decl == NULL)
7295 decl = die;
7296 else
7297 {
7298 unsigned ix;
7299 dw_die_ref c;
7300 dw_attr_ref a;
7301
7302 /* The original DIE will be changed to a declaration, and must
7303 be moved to be a child of the original declaration DIE. */
7304 orig_parent = decl->die_parent;
7305
7306 /* Copy the type node pointer from the new DIE to the original
7307 declaration DIE so we can forward references later. */
7308 decl->comdat_type_p = true;
7309 decl->die_id.die_type_node = die->die_id.die_type_node;
7310
7311 remove_AT (die, DW_AT_specification);
7312
7313 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (decl->die_attr, ix, a)
7314 {
7315 if (a->dw_attr != DW_AT_name
7316 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_declaration
7317 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_external)
7318 add_dwarf_attr (die, a);
7319 }
7320
7321 FOR_EACH_CHILD (decl, c, add_child_die (die, clone_tree (c)));
7322 }
7323
7324 if (decl->die_parent != NULL
7325 && !is_unit_die (decl->die_parent))
7326 {
7327 new_decl = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, decl, NULL);
7328 if (new_decl != NULL)
7329 {
7330 remove_AT (new_decl, DW_AT_signature);
7331 add_AT_specification (die, new_decl);
7332 }
7333 }
7334
7335 return orig_parent;
7336 }
7337
7338 /* Generate the skeleton ancestor tree for the given NODE, then clone
7339 the DIE and add the clone into the tree. */
7340
7341 static void
7342 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (skeleton_chain_node *node)
7343 {
7344 if (node->new_die != NULL)
7345 return;
7346
7347 node->new_die = clone_as_declaration (node->old_die);
7348
7349 if (node->parent != NULL)
7350 {
7351 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (node->parent);
7352 add_child_die (node->parent->new_die, node->new_die);
7353 }
7354 }
7355
7356 /* Generate a skeleton tree of DIEs containing any declarations that are
7357 found in the original tree. We traverse the tree looking for declaration
7358 DIEs, and construct the skeleton from the bottom up whenever we find one. */
7359
7360 static void
7361 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (skeleton_chain_node *parent)
7362 {
7363 skeleton_chain_node node;
7364 dw_die_ref c;
7365 dw_die_ref first;
7366 dw_die_ref prev = NULL;
7367 dw_die_ref next = NULL;
7368
7369 node.parent = parent;
7370
7371 first = c = parent->old_die->die_child;
7372 if (c)
7373 next = c->die_sib;
7374 if (c) do {
7375 if (prev == NULL || prev->die_sib == c)
7376 prev = c;
7377 c = next;
7378 next = (c == first ? NULL : c->die_sib);
7379 node.old_die = c;
7380 node.new_die = NULL;
7381 if (is_declaration_die (c))
7382 {
7383 if (is_template_instantiation (c))
7384 {
7385 /* Instantiated templates do not need to be cloned into the
7386 type unit. Just move the DIE and its children back to
7387 the skeleton tree (in the main CU). */
7388 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
7389 add_child_die (parent->new_die, c);
7390 c = prev;
7391 }
7392 else
7393 {
7394 /* Clone the existing DIE, move the original to the skeleton
7395 tree (which is in the main CU), and put the clone, with
7396 all the original's children, where the original came from
7397 (which is about to be moved to the type unit). */
7398 dw_die_ref clone = clone_die (c);
7399 move_all_children (c, clone);
7400
7401 /* If the original has a DW_AT_object_pointer attribute,
7402 it would now point to a child DIE just moved to the
7403 cloned tree, so we need to remove that attribute from
7404 the original. */
7405 remove_AT (c, DW_AT_object_pointer);
7406
7407 replace_child (c, clone, prev);
7408 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (parent);
7409 add_child_die (parent->new_die, c);
7410 node.new_die = c;
7411 c = clone;
7412 }
7413 }
7414 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (&node);
7415 } while (next != NULL);
7416 }
7417
7418 /* Wrapper function for generate_skeleton_bottom_up. */
7419
7420 static dw_die_ref
7421 generate_skeleton (dw_die_ref die)
7422 {
7423 skeleton_chain_node node;
7424
7425 node.old_die = die;
7426 node.new_die = NULL;
7427 node.parent = NULL;
7428
7429 /* If this type definition is nested inside another type,
7430 and is not an instantiation of a template, always leave
7431 at least a declaration in its place. */
7432 if (die->die_parent != NULL
7433 && is_type_die (die->die_parent)
7434 && !is_template_instantiation (die))
7435 node.new_die = clone_as_declaration (die);
7436
7437 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (&node);
7438 return node.new_die;
7439 }
7440
7441 /* Remove the CHILD DIE from its parent, possibly replacing it with a cloned
7442 declaration. The original DIE is moved to a new compile unit so that
7443 existing references to it follow it to the new location. If any of the
7444 original DIE's descendants is a declaration, we need to replace the
7445 original DIE with a skeleton tree and move the declarations back into the
7446 skeleton tree. */
7447
7448 static dw_die_ref
7449 remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref child,
7450 dw_die_ref prev)
7451 {
7452 dw_die_ref skeleton, orig_parent;
7453
7454 /* Copy the declaration context to the type unit DIE. If the returned
7455 ORIG_PARENT is not NULL, the skeleton needs to be added as a child of
7456 that DIE. */
7457 orig_parent = copy_declaration_context (unit, child);
7458
7459 skeleton = generate_skeleton (child);
7460 if (skeleton == NULL)
7461 remove_child_with_prev (child, prev);
7462 else
7463 {
7464 skeleton->comdat_type_p = true;
7465 skeleton->die_id.die_type_node = child->die_id.die_type_node;
7466
7467 /* If the original DIE was a specification, we need to put
7468 the skeleton under the parent DIE of the declaration.
7469 This leaves the original declaration in the tree, but
7470 it will be pruned later since there are no longer any
7471 references to it. */
7472 if (orig_parent != NULL)
7473 {
7474 remove_child_with_prev (child, prev);
7475 add_child_die (orig_parent, skeleton);
7476 }
7477 else
7478 replace_child (child, skeleton, prev);
7479 }
7480
7481 return skeleton;
7482 }
7483
7484 /* Traverse the DIE and set up additional .debug_types sections for each
7485 type worthy of being placed in a COMDAT section. */
7486
7487 static void
7488 break_out_comdat_types (dw_die_ref die)
7489 {
7490 dw_die_ref c;
7491 dw_die_ref first;
7492 dw_die_ref prev = NULL;
7493 dw_die_ref next = NULL;
7494 dw_die_ref unit = NULL;
7495
7496 first = c = die->die_child;
7497 if (c)
7498 next = c->die_sib;
7499 if (c) do {
7500 if (prev == NULL || prev->die_sib == c)
7501 prev = c;
7502 c = next;
7503 next = (c == first ? NULL : c->die_sib);
7504 if (should_move_die_to_comdat (c))
7505 {
7506 dw_die_ref replacement;
7507 comdat_type_node_ref type_node;
7508
7509 /* Break out nested types into their own type units. */
7510 break_out_comdat_types (c);
7511
7512 /* Create a new type unit DIE as the root for the new tree, and
7513 add it to the list of comdat types. */
7514 unit = new_die (DW_TAG_type_unit, NULL, NULL);
7515 add_AT_unsigned (unit, DW_AT_language,
7516 get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language));
7517 type_node = ggc_cleared_alloc<comdat_type_node> ();
7518 type_node->root_die = unit;
7519 type_node->next = comdat_type_list;
7520 comdat_type_list = type_node;
7521
7522 /* Generate the type signature. */
7523 generate_type_signature (c, type_node);
7524
7525 /* Copy the declaration context, attributes, and children of the
7526 declaration into the new type unit DIE, then remove this DIE
7527 from the main CU (or replace it with a skeleton if necessary). */
7528 replacement = remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (unit, c, prev);
7529 type_node->skeleton_die = replacement;
7530
7531 /* Add the DIE to the new compunit. */
7532 add_child_die (unit, c);
7533
7534 if (replacement != NULL)
7535 c = replacement;
7536 }
7537 else if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace
7538 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type
7539 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
7540 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type)
7541 {
7542 /* Look for nested types that can be broken out. */
7543 break_out_comdat_types (c);
7544 }
7545 } while (next != NULL);
7546 }
7547
7548 /* Like clone_tree, but copy DW_TAG_subprogram DIEs as declarations.
7549 Enter all the cloned children into the hash table decl_table. */
7550
7551 static dw_die_ref
7552 clone_tree_partial (dw_die_ref die, decl_hash_type *decl_table)
7553 {
7554 dw_die_ref c;
7555 dw_die_ref clone;
7556 struct decl_table_entry *entry;
7557 decl_table_entry **slot;
7558
7559 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
7560 clone = clone_as_declaration (die);
7561 else
7562 clone = clone_die (die);
7563
7564 slot = decl_table->find_slot_with_hash (die,
7565 htab_hash_pointer (die), INSERT);
7566
7567 /* Assert that DIE isn't in the hash table yet. If it would be there
7568 before, the ancestors would be necessarily there as well, therefore
7569 clone_tree_partial wouldn't be called. */
7570 gcc_assert (*slot == HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY);
7571
7572 entry = XCNEW (struct decl_table_entry);
7573 entry->orig = die;
7574 entry->copy = clone;
7575 *slot = entry;
7576
7577 if (die->die_tag != DW_TAG_subprogram)
7578 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c,
7579 add_child_die (clone, clone_tree_partial (c, decl_table)));
7580
7581 return clone;
7582 }
7583
7584 /* Walk the DIE and its children, looking for references to incomplete
7585 or trivial types that are unmarked (i.e., that are not in the current
7586 type_unit). */
7587
7588 static void
7589 copy_decls_walk (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die, decl_hash_type *decl_table)
7590 {
7591 dw_die_ref c;
7592 dw_attr_ref a;
7593 unsigned ix;
7594
7595 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
7596 {
7597 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
7598 {
7599 dw_die_ref targ = AT_ref (a);
7600 decl_table_entry **slot;
7601 struct decl_table_entry *entry;
7602
7603 if (targ->die_mark != 0 || targ->comdat_type_p)
7604 continue;
7605
7606 slot = decl_table->find_slot_with_hash (targ,
7607 htab_hash_pointer (targ),
7608 INSERT);
7609
7610 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
7611 {
7612 /* TARG has already been copied, so we just need to
7613 modify the reference to point to the copy. */
7614 entry = *slot;
7615 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = entry->copy;
7616 }
7617 else
7618 {
7619 dw_die_ref parent = unit;
7620 dw_die_ref copy = clone_die (targ);
7621
7622 /* Record in DECL_TABLE that TARG has been copied.
7623 Need to do this now, before the recursive call,
7624 because DECL_TABLE may be expanded and SLOT
7625 would no longer be a valid pointer. */
7626 entry = XCNEW (struct decl_table_entry);
7627 entry->orig = targ;
7628 entry->copy = copy;
7629 *slot = entry;
7630
7631 /* If TARG is not a declaration DIE, we need to copy its
7632 children. */
7633 if (!is_declaration_die (targ))
7634 {
7635 FOR_EACH_CHILD (
7636 targ, c,
7637 add_child_die (copy,
7638 clone_tree_partial (c, decl_table)));
7639 }
7640
7641 /* Make sure the cloned tree is marked as part of the
7642 type unit. */
7643 mark_dies (copy);
7644
7645 /* If TARG has surrounding context, copy its ancestor tree
7646 into the new type unit. */
7647 if (targ->die_parent != NULL
7648 && !is_unit_die (targ->die_parent))
7649 parent = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, targ->die_parent,
7650 decl_table);
7651
7652 add_child_die (parent, copy);
7653 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = copy;
7654
7655 /* Make sure the newly-copied DIE is walked. If it was
7656 installed in a previously-added context, it won't
7657 get visited otherwise. */
7658 if (parent != unit)
7659 {
7660 /* Find the highest point of the newly-added tree,
7661 mark each node along the way, and walk from there. */
7662 parent->die_mark = 1;
7663 while (parent->die_parent
7664 && parent->die_parent->die_mark == 0)
7665 {
7666 parent = parent->die_parent;
7667 parent->die_mark = 1;
7668 }
7669 copy_decls_walk (unit, parent, decl_table);
7670 }
7671 }
7672 }
7673 }
7674
7675 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, copy_decls_walk (unit, c, decl_table));
7676 }
7677
7678 /* Copy declarations for "unworthy" types into the new comdat section.
7679 Incomplete types, modified types, and certain other types aren't broken
7680 out into comdat sections of their own, so they don't have a signature,
7681 and we need to copy the declaration into the same section so that we
7682 don't have an external reference. */
7683
7684 static void
7685 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (dw_die_ref unit)
7686 {
7687 mark_dies (unit);
7688 decl_hash_type decl_table (10);
7689 copy_decls_walk (unit, unit, &decl_table);
7690 unmark_dies (unit);
7691 }
7692
7693 /* Traverse the DIE and add a sibling attribute if it may have the
7694 effect of speeding up access to siblings. To save some space,
7695 avoid generating sibling attributes for DIE's without children. */
7696
7697 static void
7698 add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref die)
7699 {
7700 dw_die_ref c;
7701
7702 if (! die->die_child)
7703 return;
7704
7705 if (die->die_parent && die != die->die_parent->die_child)
7706 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_sibling, die->die_sib);
7707
7708 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_sibling_attributes (c));
7709 }
7710
7711 /* Output all location lists for the DIE and its children. */
7712
7713 static void
7714 output_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
7715 {
7716 dw_die_ref c;
7717 dw_attr_ref a;
7718 unsigned ix;
7719
7720 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
7721 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
7722 output_loc_list (AT_loc_list (a));
7723
7724 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_location_lists (c));
7725 }
7726
7727 /* We want to limit the number of external references, because they are
7728 larger than local references: a relocation takes multiple words, and
7729 even a sig8 reference is always eight bytes, whereas a local reference
7730 can be as small as one byte (though DW_FORM_ref is usually 4 in GCC).
7731 So if we encounter multiple external references to the same type DIE, we
7732 make a local typedef stub for it and redirect all references there.
7733
7734 This is the element of the hash table for keeping track of these
7735 references. */
7736
7737 struct external_ref
7738 {
7739 dw_die_ref type;
7740 dw_die_ref stub;
7741 unsigned n_refs;
7742 };
7743
7744 /* Hashtable helpers. */
7745
7746 struct external_ref_hasher : typed_free_remove <external_ref>
7747 {
7748 typedef external_ref *value_type;
7749 typedef external_ref *compare_type;
7750 static inline hashval_t hash (const external_ref *);
7751 static inline bool equal (const external_ref *, const external_ref *);
7752 };
7753
7754 inline hashval_t
7755 external_ref_hasher::hash (const external_ref *r)
7756 {
7757 dw_die_ref die = r->type;
7758 hashval_t h = 0;
7759
7760 /* We can't use the address of the DIE for hashing, because
7761 that will make the order of the stub DIEs non-deterministic. */
7762 if (! die->comdat_type_p)
7763 /* We have a symbol; use it to compute a hash. */
7764 h = htab_hash_string (die->die_id.die_symbol);
7765 else
7766 {
7767 /* We have a type signature; use a subset of the bits as the hash.
7768 The 8-byte signature is at least as large as hashval_t. */
7769 comdat_type_node_ref type_node = die->die_id.die_type_node;
7770 memcpy (&h, type_node->signature, sizeof (h));
7771 }
7772 return h;
7773 }
7774
7775 inline bool
7776 external_ref_hasher::equal (const external_ref *r1, const external_ref *r2)
7777 {
7778 return r1->type == r2->type;
7779 }
7780
7781 typedef hash_table<external_ref_hasher> external_ref_hash_type;
7782
7783 /* Return a pointer to the external_ref for references to DIE. */
7784
7785 static struct external_ref *
7786 lookup_external_ref (external_ref_hash_type *map, dw_die_ref die)
7787 {
7788 struct external_ref ref, *ref_p;
7789 external_ref **slot;
7790
7791 ref.type = die;
7792 slot = map->find_slot (&ref, INSERT);
7793 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
7794 return *slot;
7795
7796 ref_p = XCNEW (struct external_ref);
7797 ref_p->type = die;
7798 *slot = ref_p;
7799 return ref_p;
7800 }
7801
7802 /* Subroutine of optimize_external_refs, below.
7803
7804 If we see a type skeleton, record it as our stub. If we see external
7805 references, remember how many we've seen. */
7806
7807 static void
7808 optimize_external_refs_1 (dw_die_ref die, external_ref_hash_type *map)
7809 {
7810 dw_die_ref c;
7811 dw_attr_ref a;
7812 unsigned ix;
7813 struct external_ref *ref_p;
7814
7815 if (is_type_die (die)
7816 && (c = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_signature)))
7817 {
7818 /* This is a local skeleton; use it for local references. */
7819 ref_p = lookup_external_ref (map, c);
7820 ref_p->stub = die;
7821 }
7822
7823 /* Scan the DIE references, and remember any that refer to DIEs from
7824 other CUs (i.e. those which are not marked). */
7825 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
7826 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref
7827 && (c = AT_ref (a))->die_mark == 0
7828 && is_type_die (c))
7829 {
7830 ref_p = lookup_external_ref (map, c);
7831 ref_p->n_refs++;
7832 }
7833
7834 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, optimize_external_refs_1 (c, map));
7835 }
7836
7837 /* htab_traverse callback function for optimize_external_refs, below. SLOT
7838 points to an external_ref, DATA is the CU we're processing. If we don't
7839 already have a local stub, and we have multiple refs, build a stub. */
7840
7841 int
7842 dwarf2_build_local_stub (external_ref **slot, dw_die_ref data)
7843 {
7844 struct external_ref *ref_p = *slot;
7845
7846 if (ref_p->stub == NULL && ref_p->n_refs > 1 && !dwarf_strict)
7847 {
7848 /* We have multiple references to this type, so build a small stub.
7849 Both of these forms are a bit dodgy from the perspective of the
7850 DWARF standard, since technically they should have names. */
7851 dw_die_ref cu = data;
7852 dw_die_ref type = ref_p->type;
7853 dw_die_ref stub = NULL;
7854
7855 if (type->comdat_type_p)
7856 {
7857 /* If we refer to this type via sig8, use AT_signature. */
7858 stub = new_die (type->die_tag, cu, NULL_TREE);
7859 add_AT_die_ref (stub, DW_AT_signature, type);
7860 }
7861 else
7862 {
7863 /* Otherwise, use a typedef with no name. */
7864 stub = new_die (DW_TAG_typedef, cu, NULL_TREE);
7865 add_AT_die_ref (stub, DW_AT_type, type);
7866 }
7867
7868 stub->die_mark++;
7869 ref_p->stub = stub;
7870 }
7871 return 1;
7872 }
7873
7874 /* DIE is a unit; look through all the DIE references to see if there are
7875 any external references to types, and if so, create local stubs for
7876 them which will be applied in build_abbrev_table. This is useful because
7877 references to local DIEs are smaller. */
7878
7879 static external_ref_hash_type *
7880 optimize_external_refs (dw_die_ref die)
7881 {
7882 external_ref_hash_type *map = new external_ref_hash_type (10);
7883 optimize_external_refs_1 (die, map);
7884 map->traverse <dw_die_ref, dwarf2_build_local_stub> (die);
7885 return map;
7886 }
7887
7888 /* The format of each DIE (and its attribute value pairs) is encoded in an
7889 abbreviation table. This routine builds the abbreviation table and assigns
7890 a unique abbreviation id for each abbreviation entry. The children of each
7891 die are visited recursively. */
7892
7893 static void
7894 build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref die, external_ref_hash_type *extern_map)
7895 {
7896 unsigned long abbrev_id;
7897 unsigned int n_alloc;
7898 dw_die_ref c;
7899 dw_attr_ref a;
7900 unsigned ix;
7901
7902 /* Scan the DIE references, and replace any that refer to
7903 DIEs from other CUs (i.e. those which are not marked) with
7904 the local stubs we built in optimize_external_refs. */
7905 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
7906 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref
7907 && (c = AT_ref (a))->die_mark == 0)
7908 {
7909 struct external_ref *ref_p;
7910 gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->comdat_type_p || AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol);
7911
7912 ref_p = lookup_external_ref (extern_map, c);
7913 if (ref_p->stub && ref_p->stub != die)
7914 change_AT_die_ref (a, ref_p->stub);
7915 else
7916 /* We aren't changing this reference, so mark it external. */
7917 set_AT_ref_external (a, 1);
7918 }
7919
7920 for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
7921 {
7922 dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
7923 dw_attr_ref die_a, abbrev_a;
7924 unsigned ix;
7925 bool ok = true;
7926
7927 if (abbrev->die_tag != die->die_tag)
7928 continue;
7929 if ((abbrev->die_child != NULL) != (die->die_child != NULL))
7930 continue;
7931
7932 if (vec_safe_length (abbrev->die_attr) != vec_safe_length (die->die_attr))
7933 continue;
7934
7935 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, die_a)
7936 {
7937 abbrev_a = &(*abbrev->die_attr)[ix];
7938 if ((abbrev_a->dw_attr != die_a->dw_attr)
7939 || (value_format (abbrev_a) != value_format (die_a)))
7940 {
7941 ok = false;
7942 break;
7943 }
7944 }
7945 if (ok)
7946 break;
7947 }
7948
7949 if (abbrev_id >= abbrev_die_table_in_use)
7950 {
7951 if (abbrev_die_table_in_use >= abbrev_die_table_allocated)
7952 {
7953 n_alloc = abbrev_die_table_allocated + ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
7954 abbrev_die_table = GGC_RESIZEVEC (dw_die_ref, abbrev_die_table,
7955 n_alloc);
7956
7957 memset (&abbrev_die_table[abbrev_die_table_allocated], 0,
7958 (n_alloc - abbrev_die_table_allocated) * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
7959 abbrev_die_table_allocated = n_alloc;
7960 }
7961
7962 ++abbrev_die_table_in_use;
7963 abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id] = die;
7964 }
7965
7966 die->die_abbrev = abbrev_id;
7967 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, build_abbrev_table (c, extern_map));
7968 }
7969 \f
7970 /* Return the power-of-two number of bytes necessary to represent VALUE. */
7971
7972 static int
7973 constant_size (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT value)
7974 {
7975 int log;
7976
7977 if (value == 0)
7978 log = 0;
7979 else
7980 log = floor_log2 (value);
7981
7982 log = log / 8;
7983 log = 1 << (floor_log2 (log) + 1);
7984
7985 return log;
7986 }
7987
7988 /* Return the size of a DIE as it is represented in the
7989 .debug_info section. */
7990
7991 static unsigned long
7992 size_of_die (dw_die_ref die)
7993 {
7994 unsigned long size = 0;
7995 dw_attr_ref a;
7996 unsigned ix;
7997 enum dwarf_form form;
7998
7999 size += size_of_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev);
8000 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8001 {
8002 switch (AT_class (a))
8003 {
8004 case dw_val_class_addr:
8005 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
8006 {
8007 gcc_assert (AT_index (a) != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
8008 size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_index (a));
8009 }
8010 else
8011 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
8012 break;
8013 case dw_val_class_offset:
8014 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
8015 break;
8016 case dw_val_class_loc:
8017 {
8018 unsigned long lsize = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
8019
8020 /* Block length. */
8021 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
8022 size += size_of_uleb128 (lsize);
8023 else
8024 size += constant_size (lsize);
8025 size += lsize;
8026 }
8027 break;
8028 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
8029 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
8030 {
8031 gcc_assert (AT_index (a) != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
8032 size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_index (a));
8033 }
8034 else
8035 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
8036 break;
8037 case dw_val_class_range_list:
8038 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
8039 break;
8040 case dw_val_class_const:
8041 size += size_of_sleb128 (AT_int (a));
8042 break;
8043 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
8044 {
8045 int csize = constant_size (AT_unsigned (a));
8046 if (dwarf_version == 3
8047 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_data_member_location
8048 && csize >= 4)
8049 size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_unsigned (a));
8050 else
8051 size += csize;
8052 }
8053 break;
8054 case dw_val_class_const_double:
8055 size += HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
8056 if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64)
8057 size++; /* block */
8058 break;
8059 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
8060 size += (get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
8061 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
8062 if (get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide) * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
8063 > 64)
8064 size++; /* block */
8065 break;
8066 case dw_val_class_vec:
8067 size += constant_size (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
8068 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size)
8069 + a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
8070 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size; /* block */
8071 break;
8072 case dw_val_class_flag:
8073 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
8074 /* Currently all add_AT_flag calls pass in 1 as last argument,
8075 so DW_FORM_flag_present can be used. If that ever changes,
8076 we'll need to use DW_FORM_flag and have some optimization
8077 in build_abbrev_table that will change those to
8078 DW_FORM_flag_present if it is set to 1 in all DIEs using
8079 the same abbrev entry. */
8080 gcc_assert (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag == 1);
8081 else
8082 size += 1;
8083 break;
8084 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
8085 if (AT_ref_external (a))
8086 {
8087 /* In DWARF4, we use DW_FORM_ref_sig8; for earlier versions
8088 we use DW_FORM_ref_addr. In DWARF2, DW_FORM_ref_addr
8089 is sized by target address length, whereas in DWARF3
8090 it's always sized as an offset. */
8091 if (use_debug_types)
8092 size += DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE;
8093 else if (dwarf_version == 2)
8094 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
8095 else
8096 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
8097 }
8098 else
8099 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
8100 break;
8101 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
8102 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
8103 break;
8104 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
8105 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
8106 {
8107 gcc_assert (AT_index (a) != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
8108 size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_index (a));
8109 }
8110 else
8111 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
8112 break;
8113 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
8114 case dw_val_class_macptr:
8115 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
8116 break;
8117 case dw_val_class_str:
8118 form = AT_string_form (a);
8119 if (form == DW_FORM_strp)
8120 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
8121 else if (form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index)
8122 size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_index (a));
8123 else
8124 size += strlen (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str) + 1;
8125 break;
8126 case dw_val_class_file:
8127 size += constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file));
8128 break;
8129 case dw_val_class_data8:
8130 size += 8;
8131 break;
8132 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
8133 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
8134 break;
8135 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
8136 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
8137 break;
8138 default:
8139 gcc_unreachable ();
8140 }
8141 }
8142
8143 return size;
8144 }
8145
8146 /* Size the debugging information associated with a given DIE. Visits the
8147 DIE's children recursively. Updates the global variable next_die_offset, on
8148 each time through. Uses the current value of next_die_offset to update the
8149 die_offset field in each DIE. */
8150
8151 static void
8152 calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref die)
8153 {
8154 dw_die_ref c;
8155
8156 gcc_assert (die->die_offset == 0
8157 || (unsigned long int) die->die_offset == next_die_offset);
8158 die->die_offset = next_die_offset;
8159 next_die_offset += size_of_die (die);
8160
8161 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, calc_die_sizes (c));
8162
8163 if (die->die_child != NULL)
8164 /* Count the null byte used to terminate sibling lists. */
8165 next_die_offset += 1;
8166 }
8167
8168 /* Size just the base type children at the start of the CU.
8169 This is needed because build_abbrev needs to size locs
8170 and sizing of type based stack ops needs to know die_offset
8171 values for the base types. */
8172
8173 static void
8174 calc_base_type_die_sizes (void)
8175 {
8176 unsigned long die_offset = DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
8177 unsigned int i;
8178 dw_die_ref base_type;
8179 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
8180 dw_die_ref prev = comp_unit_die ()->die_child;
8181 #endif
8182
8183 die_offset += size_of_die (comp_unit_die ());
8184 for (i = 0; base_types.iterate (i, &base_type); i++)
8185 {
8186 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
8187 gcc_assert (base_type->die_offset == 0
8188 && prev->die_sib == base_type
8189 && base_type->die_child == NULL
8190 && base_type->die_abbrev);
8191 prev = base_type;
8192 #endif
8193 base_type->die_offset = die_offset;
8194 die_offset += size_of_die (base_type);
8195 }
8196 }
8197
8198 /* Set the marks for a die and its children. We do this so
8199 that we know whether or not a reference needs to use FORM_ref_addr; only
8200 DIEs in the same CU will be marked. We used to clear out the offset
8201 and use that as the flag, but ran into ordering problems. */
8202
8203 static void
8204 mark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
8205 {
8206 dw_die_ref c;
8207
8208 gcc_assert (!die->die_mark);
8209
8210 die->die_mark = 1;
8211 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, mark_dies (c));
8212 }
8213
8214 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children. */
8215
8216 static void
8217 unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
8218 {
8219 dw_die_ref c;
8220
8221 if (! use_debug_types)
8222 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
8223
8224 die->die_mark = 0;
8225 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_dies (c));
8226 }
8227
8228 /* Clear the marks for a die, its children and referred dies. */
8229
8230 static void
8231 unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref die)
8232 {
8233 dw_die_ref c;
8234 dw_attr_ref a;
8235 unsigned ix;
8236
8237 if (!die->die_mark)
8238 return;
8239 die->die_mark = 0;
8240
8241 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_all_dies (c));
8242
8243 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8244 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
8245 unmark_all_dies (AT_ref (a));
8246 }
8247
8248 /* Calculate if the entry should appear in the final output file. It may be
8249 from a pruned a type. */
8250
8251 static bool
8252 include_pubname_in_output (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *table, pubname_entry *p)
8253 {
8254 /* By limiting gnu pubnames to definitions only, gold can generate a
8255 gdb index without entries for declarations, which don't include
8256 enough information to be useful. */
8257 if (debug_generate_pub_sections == 2 && is_declaration_die (p->die))
8258 return false;
8259
8260 if (table == pubname_table)
8261 {
8262 /* Enumerator names are part of the pubname table, but the
8263 parent DW_TAG_enumeration_type die may have been pruned.
8264 Don't output them if that is the case. */
8265 if (p->die->die_tag == DW_TAG_enumerator &&
8266 (p->die->die_parent == NULL
8267 || !p->die->die_parent->die_perennial_p))
8268 return false;
8269
8270 /* Everything else in the pubname table is included. */
8271 return true;
8272 }
8273
8274 /* The pubtypes table shouldn't include types that have been
8275 pruned. */
8276 return (p->die->die_offset != 0
8277 || !flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types);
8278 }
8279
8280 /* Return the size of the .debug_pubnames or .debug_pubtypes table
8281 generated for the compilation unit. */
8282
8283 static unsigned long
8284 size_of_pubnames (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *names)
8285 {
8286 unsigned long size;
8287 unsigned i;
8288 pubname_ref p;
8289 int space_for_flags = (debug_generate_pub_sections == 2) ? 1 : 0;
8290
8291 size = DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE;
8292 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*names, i, p)
8293 if (include_pubname_in_output (names, p))
8294 size += strlen (p->name) + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 1 + space_for_flags;
8295
8296 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
8297 return size;
8298 }
8299
8300 /* Return the size of the information in the .debug_aranges section. */
8301
8302 static unsigned long
8303 size_of_aranges (void)
8304 {
8305 unsigned long size;
8306
8307 size = DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE;
8308
8309 /* Count the address/length pair for this compilation unit. */
8310 if (text_section_used)
8311 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
8312 if (cold_text_section_used)
8313 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
8314 if (have_multiple_function_sections)
8315 {
8316 unsigned fde_idx;
8317 dw_fde_ref fde;
8318
8319 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, fde_idx, fde)
8320 {
8321 if (DECL_IGNORED_P (fde->decl))
8322 continue;
8323 if (!fde->in_std_section)
8324 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
8325 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && !fde->second_in_std_section)
8326 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
8327 }
8328 }
8329
8330 /* Count the two zero words used to terminated the address range table. */
8331 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
8332 return size;
8333 }
8334 \f
8335 /* Select the encoding of an attribute value. */
8336
8337 static enum dwarf_form
8338 value_format (dw_attr_ref a)
8339 {
8340 switch (AT_class (a))
8341 {
8342 case dw_val_class_addr:
8343 /* Only very few attributes allow DW_FORM_addr. */
8344 switch (a->dw_attr)
8345 {
8346 case DW_AT_low_pc:
8347 case DW_AT_high_pc:
8348 case DW_AT_entry_pc:
8349 case DW_AT_trampoline:
8350 return (AT_index (a) == NOT_INDEXED
8351 ? DW_FORM_addr : DW_FORM_GNU_addr_index);
8352 default:
8353 break;
8354 }
8355 switch (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
8356 {
8357 case 1:
8358 return DW_FORM_data1;
8359 case 2:
8360 return DW_FORM_data2;
8361 case 4:
8362 return DW_FORM_data4;
8363 case 8:
8364 return DW_FORM_data8;
8365 default:
8366 gcc_unreachable ();
8367 }
8368 case dw_val_class_range_list:
8369 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
8370 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
8371 return DW_FORM_sec_offset;
8372 /* FALLTHRU */
8373 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
8374 case dw_val_class_offset:
8375 switch (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
8376 {
8377 case 4:
8378 return DW_FORM_data4;
8379 case 8:
8380 return DW_FORM_data8;
8381 default:
8382 gcc_unreachable ();
8383 }
8384 case dw_val_class_loc:
8385 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
8386 return DW_FORM_exprloc;
8387 switch (constant_size (size_of_locs (AT_loc (a))))
8388 {
8389 case 1:
8390 return DW_FORM_block1;
8391 case 2:
8392 return DW_FORM_block2;
8393 case 4:
8394 return DW_FORM_block4;
8395 default:
8396 gcc_unreachable ();
8397 }
8398 case dw_val_class_const:
8399 return DW_FORM_sdata;
8400 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
8401 switch (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)))
8402 {
8403 case 1:
8404 return DW_FORM_data1;
8405 case 2:
8406 return DW_FORM_data2;
8407 case 4:
8408 /* In DWARF3 DW_AT_data_member_location with
8409 DW_FORM_data4 or DW_FORM_data8 is a loclistptr, not
8410 constant, so we need to use DW_FORM_udata if we need
8411 a large constant. */
8412 if (dwarf_version == 3 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_data_member_location)
8413 return DW_FORM_udata;
8414 return DW_FORM_data4;
8415 case 8:
8416 if (dwarf_version == 3 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_data_member_location)
8417 return DW_FORM_udata;
8418 return DW_FORM_data8;
8419 default:
8420 gcc_unreachable ();
8421 }
8422 case dw_val_class_const_double:
8423 switch (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
8424 {
8425 case 8:
8426 return DW_FORM_data2;
8427 case 16:
8428 return DW_FORM_data4;
8429 case 32:
8430 return DW_FORM_data8;
8431 case 64:
8432 default:
8433 return DW_FORM_block1;
8434 }
8435 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
8436 switch (get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide) * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
8437 {
8438 case 8:
8439 return DW_FORM_data1;
8440 case 16:
8441 return DW_FORM_data2;
8442 case 32:
8443 return DW_FORM_data4;
8444 case 64:
8445 return DW_FORM_data8;
8446 default:
8447 return DW_FORM_block1;
8448 }
8449 case dw_val_class_vec:
8450 switch (constant_size (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
8451 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size))
8452 {
8453 case 1:
8454 return DW_FORM_block1;
8455 case 2:
8456 return DW_FORM_block2;
8457 case 4:
8458 return DW_FORM_block4;
8459 default:
8460 gcc_unreachable ();
8461 }
8462 case dw_val_class_flag:
8463 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
8464 {
8465 /* Currently all add_AT_flag calls pass in 1 as last argument,
8466 so DW_FORM_flag_present can be used. If that ever changes,
8467 we'll need to use DW_FORM_flag and have some optimization
8468 in build_abbrev_table that will change those to
8469 DW_FORM_flag_present if it is set to 1 in all DIEs using
8470 the same abbrev entry. */
8471 gcc_assert (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag == 1);
8472 return DW_FORM_flag_present;
8473 }
8474 return DW_FORM_flag;
8475 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
8476 if (AT_ref_external (a))
8477 return use_debug_types ? DW_FORM_ref_sig8 : DW_FORM_ref_addr;
8478 else
8479 return DW_FORM_ref;
8480 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
8481 return DW_FORM_data;
8482 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
8483 return (AT_index (a) == NOT_INDEXED
8484 ? DW_FORM_addr : DW_FORM_GNU_addr_index);
8485 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
8486 case dw_val_class_macptr:
8487 return dwarf_version >= 4 ? DW_FORM_sec_offset : DW_FORM_data;
8488 case dw_val_class_str:
8489 return AT_string_form (a);
8490 case dw_val_class_file:
8491 switch (constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file)))
8492 {
8493 case 1:
8494 return DW_FORM_data1;
8495 case 2:
8496 return DW_FORM_data2;
8497 case 4:
8498 return DW_FORM_data4;
8499 default:
8500 gcc_unreachable ();
8501 }
8502
8503 case dw_val_class_data8:
8504 return DW_FORM_data8;
8505
8506 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
8507 switch (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
8508 {
8509 case 1:
8510 return DW_FORM_data1;
8511 case 2:
8512 return DW_FORM_data2;
8513 case 4:
8514 return DW_FORM_data4;
8515 case 8:
8516 return DW_FORM_data8;
8517 default:
8518 gcc_unreachable ();
8519 }
8520
8521 default:
8522 gcc_unreachable ();
8523 }
8524 }
8525
8526 /* Output the encoding of an attribute value. */
8527
8528 static void
8529 output_value_format (dw_attr_ref a)
8530 {
8531 enum dwarf_form form = value_format (a);
8532
8533 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (form, "(%s)", dwarf_form_name (form));
8534 }
8535
8536 /* Given a die and id, produce the appropriate abbreviations. */
8537
8538 static void
8539 output_die_abbrevs (unsigned long abbrev_id, dw_die_ref abbrev)
8540 {
8541 unsigned ix;
8542 dw_attr_ref a_attr;
8543
8544 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev_id, "(abbrev code)");
8545 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev->die_tag, "(TAG: %s)",
8546 dwarf_tag_name (abbrev->die_tag));
8547
8548 if (abbrev->die_child != NULL)
8549 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_yes, "DW_children_yes");
8550 else
8551 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_no, "DW_children_no");
8552
8553 for (ix = 0; vec_safe_iterate (abbrev->die_attr, ix, &a_attr); ix++)
8554 {
8555 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (a_attr->dw_attr, "(%s)",
8556 dwarf_attr_name (a_attr->dw_attr));
8557 output_value_format (a_attr);
8558 }
8559
8560 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
8561 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
8562 }
8563
8564
8565 /* Output the .debug_abbrev section which defines the DIE abbreviation
8566 table. */
8567
8568 static void
8569 output_abbrev_section (void)
8570 {
8571 unsigned long abbrev_id;
8572
8573 for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
8574 output_die_abbrevs (abbrev_id, abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id]);
8575
8576 /* Terminate the table. */
8577 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
8578 }
8579
8580 /* Output a symbol we can use to refer to this DIE from another CU. */
8581
8582 static inline void
8583 output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref die)
8584 {
8585 const char *sym = die->die_id.die_symbol;
8586
8587 gcc_assert (!die->comdat_type_p);
8588
8589 if (sym == 0)
8590 return;
8591
8592 if (strncmp (sym, DIE_LABEL_PREFIX, sizeof (DIE_LABEL_PREFIX) - 1) == 0)
8593 /* We make these global, not weak; if the target doesn't support
8594 .linkonce, it doesn't support combining the sections, so debugging
8595 will break. */
8596 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file, sym);
8597
8598 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, sym);
8599 }
8600
8601 /* Return a new location list, given the begin and end range, and the
8602 expression. */
8603
8604 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
8605 new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref expr, const char *begin, const char *end,
8606 const char *section)
8607 {
8608 dw_loc_list_ref retlist = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_loc_list_node> ();
8609
8610 retlist->begin = begin;
8611 retlist->begin_entry = NULL;
8612 retlist->end = end;
8613 retlist->expr = expr;
8614 retlist->section = section;
8615
8616 return retlist;
8617 }
8618
8619 /* Generate a new internal symbol for this location list node, if it
8620 hasn't got one yet. */
8621
8622 static inline void
8623 gen_llsym (dw_loc_list_ref list)
8624 {
8625 gcc_assert (!list->ll_symbol);
8626 list->ll_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LLST");
8627 }
8628
8629 /* Output the location list given to us. */
8630
8631 static void
8632 output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref list_head)
8633 {
8634 dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head;
8635
8636 if (list_head->emitted)
8637 return;
8638 list_head->emitted = true;
8639
8640 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, list_head->ll_symbol);
8641
8642 /* Walk the location list, and output each range + expression. */
8643 for (curr = list_head; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
8644 {
8645 unsigned long size;
8646 /* Don't output an entry that starts and ends at the same address. */
8647 if (strcmp (curr->begin, curr->end) == 0 && !curr->force)
8648 continue;
8649 size = size_of_locs (curr->expr);
8650 /* If the expression is too large, drop it on the floor. We could
8651 perhaps put it into DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure and refer to that
8652 in the expression, but >= 64KB expressions for a single value
8653 in a single range are unlikely very useful. */
8654 if (size > 0xffff)
8655 continue;
8656 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
8657 {
8658 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_GNU_start_length_entry,
8659 "Location list start/length entry (%s)",
8660 list_head->ll_symbol);
8661 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (curr->begin_entry->index,
8662 "Location list range start index (%s)",
8663 curr->begin);
8664 /* The length field is 4 bytes. If we ever need to support
8665 an 8-byte length, we can add a new DW_LLE code or fall back
8666 to DW_LLE_GNU_start_end_entry. */
8667 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, curr->end, curr->begin,
8668 "Location list range length (%s)",
8669 list_head->ll_symbol);
8670 }
8671 else if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
8672 {
8673 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin, curr->section,
8674 "Location list begin address (%s)",
8675 list_head->ll_symbol);
8676 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end, curr->section,
8677 "Location list end address (%s)",
8678 list_head->ll_symbol);
8679 }
8680 else
8681 {
8682 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin,
8683 "Location list begin address (%s)",
8684 list_head->ll_symbol);
8685 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end,
8686 "Location list end address (%s)",
8687 list_head->ll_symbol);
8688 }
8689
8690 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
8691 gcc_assert (size <= 0xffff);
8692 dw2_asm_output_data (2, size, "%s", "Location expression size");
8693
8694 output_loc_sequence (curr->expr, -1);
8695 }
8696
8697 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
8698 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_GNU_end_of_list_entry,
8699 "Location list terminator (%s)",
8700 list_head->ll_symbol);
8701 else
8702 {
8703 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
8704 "Location list terminator begin (%s)",
8705 list_head->ll_symbol);
8706 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
8707 "Location list terminator end (%s)",
8708 list_head->ll_symbol);
8709 }
8710 }
8711
8712 /* Output a range_list offset into the debug_range section. Emit a
8713 relocated reference if val_entry is NULL, otherwise, emit an
8714 indirect reference. */
8715
8716 static void
8717 output_range_list_offset (dw_attr_ref a)
8718 {
8719 const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
8720
8721 if (a->dw_attr_val.val_entry == RELOCATED_OFFSET)
8722 {
8723 char *p = strchr (ranges_section_label, '\0');
8724 sprintf (p, "+" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
8725 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, ranges_section_label,
8726 debug_ranges_section, "%s", name);
8727 *p = '\0';
8728 }
8729 else
8730 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset,
8731 "%s (offset from %s)", name, ranges_section_label);
8732 }
8733
8734 /* Output the offset into the debug_loc section. */
8735
8736 static void
8737 output_loc_list_offset (dw_attr_ref a)
8738 {
8739 char *sym = AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol;
8740
8741 gcc_assert (sym);
8742 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
8743 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym, loc_section_label,
8744 "%s", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
8745 else
8746 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym, debug_loc_section,
8747 "%s", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
8748 }
8749
8750 /* Output an attribute's index or value appropriately. */
8751
8752 static void
8753 output_attr_index_or_value (dw_attr_ref a)
8754 {
8755 const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
8756
8757 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
8758 {
8759 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (AT_index (a), "%s", name);
8760 return;
8761 }
8762 switch (AT_class (a))
8763 {
8764 case dw_val_class_addr:
8765 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_addr (a), "%s", name);
8766 break;
8767 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
8768 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
8769 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_lbl (a), "%s", name);
8770 break;
8771 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
8772 output_loc_list_offset (a);
8773 break;
8774 default:
8775 gcc_unreachable ();
8776 }
8777 }
8778
8779 /* Output a type signature. */
8780
8781 static inline void
8782 output_signature (const char *sig, const char *name)
8783 {
8784 int i;
8785
8786 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
8787 dw2_asm_output_data (1, sig[i], i == 0 ? "%s" : NULL, name);
8788 }
8789
8790 /* Output the DIE and its attributes. Called recursively to generate
8791 the definitions of each child DIE. */
8792
8793 static void
8794 output_die (dw_die_ref die)
8795 {
8796 dw_attr_ref a;
8797 dw_die_ref c;
8798 unsigned long size;
8799 unsigned ix;
8800
8801 /* If someone in another CU might refer to us, set up a symbol for
8802 them to point to. */
8803 if (! die->comdat_type_p && die->die_id.die_symbol)
8804 output_die_symbol (die);
8805
8806 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev, "(DIE (%#lx) %s)",
8807 (unsigned long)die->die_offset,
8808 dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
8809
8810 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8811 {
8812 const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
8813
8814 switch (AT_class (a))
8815 {
8816 case dw_val_class_addr:
8817 output_attr_index_or_value (a);
8818 break;
8819
8820 case dw_val_class_offset:
8821 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset,
8822 "%s", name);
8823 break;
8824
8825 case dw_val_class_range_list:
8826 output_range_list_offset (a);
8827 break;
8828
8829 case dw_val_class_loc:
8830 size = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
8831
8832 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
8833 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
8834 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "%s", name);
8835 else
8836 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (size), size, "%s", name);
8837
8838 output_loc_sequence (AT_loc (a), -1);
8839 break;
8840
8841 case dw_val_class_const:
8842 /* ??? It would be slightly more efficient to use a scheme like is
8843 used for unsigned constants below, but gdb 4.x does not sign
8844 extend. Gdb 5.x does sign extend. */
8845 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (AT_int (a), "%s", name);
8846 break;
8847
8848 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
8849 {
8850 int csize = constant_size (AT_unsigned (a));
8851 if (dwarf_version == 3
8852 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_data_member_location
8853 && csize >= 4)
8854 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (AT_unsigned (a), "%s", name);
8855 else
8856 dw2_asm_output_data (csize, AT_unsigned (a), "%s", name);
8857 }
8858 break;
8859
8860 case dw_val_class_const_double:
8861 {
8862 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
8863
8864 if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64)
8865 dw2_asm_output_data (1,
8866 HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT
8867 / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
8868 NULL);
8869
8870 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
8871 {
8872 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high;
8873 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low;
8874 }
8875 else
8876 {
8877 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low;
8878 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high;
8879 }
8880
8881 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
8882 first, "%s", name);
8883 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
8884 second, NULL);
8885 }
8886 break;
8887
8888 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
8889 {
8890 int i;
8891 int len = get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide);
8892 int l = HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
8893 if (len * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT > 64)
8894 dw2_asm_output_data (1, get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide) * l,
8895 NULL);
8896
8897 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
8898 for (i = len - 1; i >= 0; --i)
8899 {
8900 dw2_asm_output_data (l, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide->elt (i),
8901 "%s", name);
8902 name = NULL;
8903 }
8904 else
8905 for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
8906 {
8907 dw2_asm_output_data (l, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide->elt (i),
8908 "%s", name);
8909 name = NULL;
8910 }
8911 }
8912 break;
8913
8914 case dw_val_class_vec:
8915 {
8916 unsigned int elt_size = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size;
8917 unsigned int len = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length;
8918 unsigned int i;
8919 unsigned char *p;
8920
8921 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (len * elt_size),
8922 len * elt_size, "%s", name);
8923 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
8924 {
8925 elt_size /= 2;
8926 len *= 2;
8927 }
8928 for (i = 0, p = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array;
8929 i < len;
8930 i++, p += elt_size)
8931 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
8932 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
8933 break;
8934 }
8935
8936 case dw_val_class_flag:
8937 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
8938 {
8939 /* Currently all add_AT_flag calls pass in 1 as last argument,
8940 so DW_FORM_flag_present can be used. If that ever changes,
8941 we'll need to use DW_FORM_flag and have some optimization
8942 in build_abbrev_table that will change those to
8943 DW_FORM_flag_present if it is set to 1 in all DIEs using
8944 the same abbrev entry. */
8945 gcc_assert (AT_flag (a) == 1);
8946 if (flag_debug_asm)
8947 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t\t\t%s %s\n",
8948 ASM_COMMENT_START, name);
8949 break;
8950 }
8951 dw2_asm_output_data (1, AT_flag (a), "%s", name);
8952 break;
8953
8954 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
8955 output_attr_index_or_value (a);
8956 break;
8957
8958 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
8959 if (AT_ref_external (a))
8960 {
8961 if (AT_ref (a)->comdat_type_p)
8962 {
8963 comdat_type_node_ref type_node =
8964 AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_type_node;
8965
8966 gcc_assert (type_node);
8967 output_signature (type_node->signature, name);
8968 }
8969 else
8970 {
8971 const char *sym = AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol;
8972 int size;
8973
8974 gcc_assert (sym);
8975 /* In DWARF2, DW_FORM_ref_addr is sized by target address
8976 length, whereas in DWARF3 it's always sized as an
8977 offset. */
8978 if (dwarf_version == 2)
8979 size = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
8980 else
8981 size = DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
8982 dw2_asm_output_offset (size, sym, debug_info_section, "%s",
8983 name);
8984 }
8985 }
8986 else
8987 {
8988 gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
8989 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_ref (a)->die_offset,
8990 "%s", name);
8991 }
8992 break;
8993
8994 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
8995 {
8996 char l1[20];
8997
8998 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_LABEL,
8999 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index * 2);
9000 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l1, debug_frame_section,
9001 "%s", name);
9002 }
9003 break;
9004
9005 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
9006 #ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA
9007 dw2_asm_output_vms_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
9008 AT_vms_delta2 (a), AT_vms_delta1 (a),
9009 "%s", name);
9010 #else
9011 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
9012 AT_vms_delta2 (a), AT_vms_delta1 (a),
9013 "%s", name);
9014 #endif
9015 break;
9016
9017 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
9018 output_attr_index_or_value (a);
9019 break;
9020
9021 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
9022 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
9023 debug_line_section, "%s", name);
9024 break;
9025
9026 case dw_val_class_macptr:
9027 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
9028 debug_macinfo_section, "%s", name);
9029 break;
9030
9031 case dw_val_class_str:
9032 if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->form == DW_FORM_strp)
9033 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
9034 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->label,
9035 debug_str_section,
9036 "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
9037 else if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index)
9038 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (AT_index (a),
9039 "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
9040 else
9041 dw2_asm_output_nstring (AT_string (a), -1, "%s", name);
9042 break;
9043
9044 case dw_val_class_file:
9045 {
9046 int f = maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file);
9047
9048 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (f), f, "%s (%s)", name,
9049 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file->filename);
9050 break;
9051 }
9052
9053 case dw_val_class_data8:
9054 {
9055 int i;
9056
9057 for (i = 0; i < 8; i++)
9058 dw2_asm_output_data (1, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8[i],
9059 i == 0 ? "%s" : NULL, name);
9060 break;
9061 }
9062
9063 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
9064 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
9065 get_AT_low_pc (die), "DW_AT_high_pc");
9066 break;
9067
9068 default:
9069 gcc_unreachable ();
9070 }
9071 }
9072
9073 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_die (c));
9074
9075 /* Add null byte to terminate sibling list. */
9076 if (die->die_child != NULL)
9077 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end of children of DIE %#lx",
9078 (unsigned long) die->die_offset);
9079 }
9080
9081 /* Output the compilation unit that appears at the beginning of the
9082 .debug_info section, and precedes the DIE descriptions. */
9083
9084 static void
9085 output_compilation_unit_header (void)
9086 {
9087 /* We don't support actual DWARFv5 units yet, we just use some
9088 DWARFv5 draft DIE tags in DWARFv4 format. */
9089 int ver = dwarf_version < 5 ? dwarf_version : 4;
9090
9091 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
9092 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
9093 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
9094 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
9095 next_die_offset - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE,
9096 "Length of Compilation Unit Info");
9097 dw2_asm_output_data (2, ver, "DWARF version number");
9098 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, abbrev_section_label,
9099 debug_abbrev_section,
9100 "Offset Into Abbrev. Section");
9101 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
9102 }
9103
9104 /* Output the compilation unit DIE and its children. */
9105
9106 static void
9107 output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref die, int output_if_empty)
9108 {
9109 const char *secname, *oldsym;
9110 char *tmp;
9111
9112 /* Unless we are outputting main CU, we may throw away empty ones. */
9113 if (!output_if_empty && die->die_child == NULL)
9114 return;
9115
9116 /* Even if there are no children of this DIE, we must output the information
9117 about the compilation unit. Otherwise, on an empty translation unit, we
9118 will generate a present, but empty, .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm'
9119 will then complain when examining the file. First mark all the DIEs in
9120 this CU so we know which get local refs. */
9121 mark_dies (die);
9122
9123 external_ref_hash_type *extern_map = optimize_external_refs (die);
9124
9125 build_abbrev_table (die, extern_map);
9126
9127 delete extern_map;
9128
9129 /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets. */
9130 next_die_offset = DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
9131 calc_die_sizes (die);
9132
9133 oldsym = die->die_id.die_symbol;
9134 if (oldsym)
9135 {
9136 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, strlen (oldsym) + 24);
9137
9138 sprintf (tmp, ".gnu.linkonce.wi.%s", oldsym);
9139 secname = tmp;
9140 die->die_id.die_symbol = NULL;
9141 switch_to_section (get_section (secname, SECTION_DEBUG, NULL));
9142 }
9143 else
9144 {
9145 switch_to_section (debug_info_section);
9146 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_info_section_label);
9147 info_section_emitted = true;
9148 }
9149
9150 /* Output debugging information. */
9151 output_compilation_unit_header ();
9152 output_die (die);
9153
9154 /* Leave the marks on the main CU, so we can check them in
9155 output_pubnames. */
9156 if (oldsym)
9157 {
9158 unmark_dies (die);
9159 die->die_id.die_symbol = oldsym;
9160 }
9161 }
9162
9163 /* Whether to generate the DWARF accelerator tables in .debug_pubnames
9164 and .debug_pubtypes. This is configured per-target, but can be
9165 overridden by the -gpubnames or -gno-pubnames options. */
9166
9167 static inline bool
9168 want_pubnames (void)
9169 {
9170 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
9171 return false;
9172 if (debug_generate_pub_sections != -1)
9173 return debug_generate_pub_sections;
9174 return targetm.want_debug_pub_sections;
9175 }
9176
9177 /* Add the DW_AT_GNU_pubnames and DW_AT_GNU_pubtypes attributes. */
9178
9179 static void
9180 add_AT_pubnames (dw_die_ref die)
9181 {
9182 if (want_pubnames ())
9183 add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_GNU_pubnames, 1);
9184 }
9185
9186 /* Add a string attribute value to a skeleton DIE. */
9187
9188 static inline void
9189 add_skeleton_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
9190 const char *str)
9191 {
9192 dw_attr_node attr;
9193 struct indirect_string_node *node;
9194
9195 if (! skeleton_debug_str_hash)
9196 skeleton_debug_str_hash
9197 = hash_table<indirect_string_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
9198
9199 node = find_AT_string_in_table (str, skeleton_debug_str_hash);
9200 find_string_form (node);
9201 if (node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index)
9202 node->form = DW_FORM_strp;
9203
9204 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
9205 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_str;
9206 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
9207 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
9208 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
9209 }
9210
9211 /* Helper function to generate top-level dies for skeleton debug_info and
9212 debug_types. */
9213
9214 static void
9215 add_top_level_skeleton_die_attrs (dw_die_ref die)
9216 {
9217 const char *dwo_file_name = concat (aux_base_name, ".dwo", NULL);
9218 const char *comp_dir = comp_dir_string ();
9219
9220 add_skeleton_AT_string (die, DW_AT_GNU_dwo_name, dwo_file_name);
9221 if (comp_dir != NULL)
9222 add_skeleton_AT_string (die, DW_AT_comp_dir, comp_dir);
9223 add_AT_pubnames (die);
9224 add_AT_lineptr (die, DW_AT_GNU_addr_base, debug_addr_section_label);
9225 }
9226
9227 /* Output skeleton debug sections that point to the dwo file. */
9228
9229 static void
9230 output_skeleton_debug_sections (dw_die_ref comp_unit)
9231 {
9232 /* We don't support actual DWARFv5 units yet, we just use some
9233 DWARFv5 draft DIE tags in DWARFv4 format. */
9234 int ver = dwarf_version < 5 ? dwarf_version : 4;
9235
9236 /* These attributes will be found in the full debug_info section. */
9237 remove_AT (comp_unit, DW_AT_producer);
9238 remove_AT (comp_unit, DW_AT_language);
9239
9240 switch_to_section (debug_skeleton_info_section);
9241 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_skeleton_info_section_label);
9242
9243 /* Produce the skeleton compilation-unit header. This one differs enough from
9244 a normal CU header that it's better not to call output_compilation_unit
9245 header. */
9246 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
9247 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
9248 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
9249
9250 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
9251 DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE
9252 - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
9253 + size_of_die (comp_unit),
9254 "Length of Compilation Unit Info");
9255 dw2_asm_output_data (2, ver, "DWARF version number");
9256 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_skeleton_abbrev_section_label,
9257 debug_abbrev_section,
9258 "Offset Into Abbrev. Section");
9259 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
9260
9261 comp_unit->die_abbrev = SKELETON_COMP_DIE_ABBREV;
9262 output_die (comp_unit);
9263
9264 /* Build the skeleton debug_abbrev section. */
9265 switch_to_section (debug_skeleton_abbrev_section);
9266 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_skeleton_abbrev_section_label);
9267
9268 output_die_abbrevs (SKELETON_COMP_DIE_ABBREV, comp_unit);
9269
9270 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end of skeleton .debug_abbrev");
9271 }
9272
9273 /* Output a comdat type unit DIE and its children. */
9274
9275 static void
9276 output_comdat_type_unit (comdat_type_node *node)
9277 {
9278 const char *secname;
9279 char *tmp;
9280 int i;
9281 #if defined (OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF)
9282 tree comdat_key;
9283 #endif
9284
9285 /* First mark all the DIEs in this CU so we know which get local refs. */
9286 mark_dies (node->root_die);
9287
9288 external_ref_hash_type *extern_map = optimize_external_refs (node->root_die);
9289
9290 build_abbrev_table (node->root_die, extern_map);
9291
9292 delete extern_map;
9293 extern_map = NULL;
9294
9295 /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets. */
9296 next_die_offset = DWARF_COMDAT_TYPE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
9297 calc_die_sizes (node->root_die);
9298
9299 #if defined (OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF)
9300 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
9301 secname = ".debug_types";
9302 else
9303 secname = ".debug_types.dwo";
9304
9305 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, 4 + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE * 2);
9306 sprintf (tmp, "wt.");
9307 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
9308 sprintf (tmp + 3 + i * 2, "%02x", node->signature[i] & 0xff);
9309 comdat_key = get_identifier (tmp);
9310 targetm.asm_out.named_section (secname,
9311 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_LINKONCE,
9312 comdat_key);
9313 #else
9314 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, 18 + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE * 2);
9315 sprintf (tmp, ".gnu.linkonce.wt.");
9316 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
9317 sprintf (tmp + 17 + i * 2, "%02x", node->signature[i] & 0xff);
9318 secname = tmp;
9319 switch_to_section (get_section (secname, SECTION_DEBUG, NULL));
9320 #endif
9321
9322 /* Output debugging information. */
9323 output_compilation_unit_header ();
9324 output_signature (node->signature, "Type Signature");
9325 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, node->type_die->die_offset,
9326 "Offset to Type DIE");
9327 output_die (node->root_die);
9328
9329 unmark_dies (node->root_die);
9330 }
9331
9332 /* Return the DWARF2/3 pubname associated with a decl. */
9333
9334 static const char *
9335 dwarf2_name (tree decl, int scope)
9336 {
9337 if (DECL_NAMELESS (decl))
9338 return NULL;
9339 return lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, scope ? 1 : 0);
9340 }
9341
9342 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubnames if appropriate. */
9343
9344 static void
9345 add_pubname_string (const char *str, dw_die_ref die)
9346 {
9347 pubname_entry e;
9348
9349 e.die = die;
9350 e.name = xstrdup (str);
9351 vec_safe_push (pubname_table, e);
9352 }
9353
9354 static void
9355 add_pubname (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
9356 {
9357 if (!want_pubnames ())
9358 return;
9359
9360 /* Don't add items to the table when we expect that the consumer will have
9361 just read the enclosing die. For example, if the consumer is looking at a
9362 class_member, it will either be inside the class already, or will have just
9363 looked up the class to find the member. Either way, searching the class is
9364 faster than searching the index. */
9365 if ((TREE_PUBLIC (decl) && !class_scope_p (die->die_parent))
9366 || is_cu_die (die->die_parent) || is_namespace_die (die->die_parent))
9367 {
9368 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 1);
9369
9370 if (name)
9371 add_pubname_string (name, die);
9372 }
9373 }
9374
9375 /* Add an enumerator to the pubnames section. */
9376
9377 static void
9378 add_enumerator_pubname (const char *scope_name, dw_die_ref die)
9379 {
9380 pubname_entry e;
9381
9382 gcc_assert (scope_name);
9383 e.name = concat (scope_name, get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name), NULL);
9384 e.die = die;
9385 vec_safe_push (pubname_table, e);
9386 }
9387
9388 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubtypes if appropriate. */
9389
9390 static void
9391 add_pubtype (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
9392 {
9393 pubname_entry e;
9394
9395 if (!want_pubnames ())
9396 return;
9397
9398 if ((TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
9399 || is_cu_die (die->die_parent) || is_namespace_die (die->die_parent))
9400 && (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_typedef || COMPLETE_TYPE_P (decl)))
9401 {
9402 tree scope = NULL;
9403 const char *scope_name = "";
9404 const char *sep = is_cxx () ? "::" : ".";
9405 const char *name;
9406
9407 scope = TYPE_P (decl) ? TYPE_CONTEXT (decl) : NULL;
9408 if (scope && TREE_CODE (scope) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
9409 {
9410 scope_name = lang_hooks.dwarf_name (scope, 1);
9411 if (scope_name != NULL && scope_name[0] != '\0')
9412 scope_name = concat (scope_name, sep, NULL);
9413 else
9414 scope_name = "";
9415 }
9416
9417 if (TYPE_P (decl))
9418 name = type_tag (decl);
9419 else
9420 name = lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, 1);
9421
9422 /* If we don't have a name for the type, there's no point in adding
9423 it to the table. */
9424 if (name != NULL && name[0] != '\0')
9425 {
9426 e.die = die;
9427 e.name = concat (scope_name, name, NULL);
9428 vec_safe_push (pubtype_table, e);
9429 }
9430
9431 /* Although it might be more consistent to add the pubinfo for the
9432 enumerators as their dies are created, they should only be added if the
9433 enum type meets the criteria above. So rather than re-check the parent
9434 enum type whenever an enumerator die is created, just output them all
9435 here. This isn't protected by the name conditional because anonymous
9436 enums don't have names. */
9437 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_enumeration_type)
9438 {
9439 dw_die_ref c;
9440
9441 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_enumerator_pubname (scope_name, c));
9442 }
9443 }
9444 }
9445
9446 /* Output a single entry in the pubnames table. */
9447
9448 static void
9449 output_pubname (dw_offset die_offset, pubname_entry *entry)
9450 {
9451 dw_die_ref die = entry->die;
9452 int is_static = get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_external) ? 0 : 1;
9453
9454 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, die_offset, "DIE offset");
9455
9456 if (debug_generate_pub_sections == 2)
9457 {
9458 /* This logic follows gdb's method for determining the value of the flag
9459 byte. */
9460 uint32_t flags = GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_NONE;
9461 switch (die->die_tag)
9462 {
9463 case DW_TAG_typedef:
9464 case DW_TAG_base_type:
9465 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
9466 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags, GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_TYPE);
9467 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, 1);
9468 break;
9469 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
9470 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags,
9471 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_VARIABLE);
9472 if (!is_cxx () && !is_java ())
9473 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, 1);
9474 break;
9475 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
9476 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags,
9477 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_FUNCTION);
9478 if (!is_ada ())
9479 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, is_static);
9480 break;
9481 case DW_TAG_constant:
9482 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags,
9483 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_VARIABLE);
9484 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, is_static);
9485 break;
9486 case DW_TAG_variable:
9487 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags,
9488 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_VARIABLE);
9489 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, is_static);
9490 break;
9491 case DW_TAG_namespace:
9492 case DW_TAG_imported_declaration:
9493 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags, GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_TYPE);
9494 break;
9495 case DW_TAG_class_type:
9496 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
9497 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
9498 case DW_TAG_union_type:
9499 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
9500 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags, GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_TYPE);
9501 if (!is_cxx () && !is_java ())
9502 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, 1);
9503 break;
9504 default:
9505 /* An unusual tag. Leave the flag-byte empty. */
9506 break;
9507 }
9508 dw2_asm_output_data (1, flags >> GDB_INDEX_CU_BITSIZE,
9509 "GDB-index flags");
9510 }
9511
9512 dw2_asm_output_nstring (entry->name, -1, "external name");
9513 }
9514
9515
9516 /* Output the public names table used to speed up access to externally
9517 visible names; or the public types table used to find type definitions. */
9518
9519 static void
9520 output_pubnames (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *names)
9521 {
9522 unsigned i;
9523 unsigned long pubnames_length = size_of_pubnames (names);
9524 pubname_ref pub;
9525
9526 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
9527 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
9528 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
9529 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length, "Pub Info Length");
9530
9531 /* Version number for pubnames/pubtypes is independent of dwarf version. */
9532 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 2, "DWARF Version");
9533
9534 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
9535 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_skeleton_info_section_label,
9536 debug_skeleton_info_section,
9537 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
9538 else
9539 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
9540 debug_info_section,
9541 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
9542 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, next_die_offset,
9543 "Compilation Unit Length");
9544
9545 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*names, i, pub)
9546 {
9547 if (include_pubname_in_output (names, pub))
9548 {
9549 dw_offset die_offset = pub->die->die_offset;
9550
9551 /* We shouldn't see pubnames for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
9552 if (names == pubname_table && pub->die->die_tag != DW_TAG_enumerator)
9553 gcc_assert (pub->die->die_mark);
9554
9555 /* If we're putting types in their own .debug_types sections,
9556 the .debug_pubtypes table will still point to the compile
9557 unit (not the type unit), so we want to use the offset of
9558 the skeleton DIE (if there is one). */
9559 if (pub->die->comdat_type_p && names == pubtype_table)
9560 {
9561 comdat_type_node_ref type_node = pub->die->die_id.die_type_node;
9562
9563 if (type_node != NULL)
9564 die_offset = (type_node->skeleton_die != NULL
9565 ? type_node->skeleton_die->die_offset
9566 : comp_unit_die ()->die_offset);
9567 }
9568
9569 output_pubname (die_offset, pub);
9570 }
9571 }
9572
9573 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0, NULL);
9574 }
9575
9576 /* Output public names and types tables if necessary. */
9577
9578 static void
9579 output_pubtables (void)
9580 {
9581 if (!want_pubnames () || !info_section_emitted)
9582 return;
9583
9584 switch_to_section (debug_pubnames_section);
9585 output_pubnames (pubname_table);
9586 /* ??? Only defined by DWARF3, but emitted by Darwin for DWARF2.
9587 It shouldn't hurt to emit it always, since pure DWARF2 consumers
9588 simply won't look for the section. */
9589 switch_to_section (debug_pubtypes_section);
9590 output_pubnames (pubtype_table);
9591 }
9592
9593
9594 /* Output the information that goes into the .debug_aranges table.
9595 Namely, define the beginning and ending address range of the
9596 text section generated for this compilation unit. */
9597
9598 static void
9599 output_aranges (unsigned long aranges_length)
9600 {
9601 unsigned i;
9602
9603 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
9604 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
9605 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
9606 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, aranges_length,
9607 "Length of Address Ranges Info");
9608 /* Version number for aranges is still 2, even up to DWARF5. */
9609 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 2, "DWARF Version");
9610 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
9611 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_skeleton_info_section_label,
9612 debug_skeleton_info_section,
9613 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
9614 else
9615 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
9616 debug_info_section,
9617 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
9618 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Size of Address");
9619 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Size of Segment Descriptor");
9620
9621 /* We need to align to twice the pointer size here. */
9622 if (DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE)
9623 {
9624 /* Pad using a 2 byte words so that padding is correct for any
9625 pointer size. */
9626 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, "Pad to %d byte boundary",
9627 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
9628 for (i = 2; i < (unsigned) DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE; i += 2)
9629 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, NULL);
9630 }
9631
9632 /* It is necessary not to output these entries if the sections were
9633 not used; if the sections were not used, the length will be 0 and
9634 the address may end up as 0 if the section is discarded by ld
9635 --gc-sections, leaving an invalid (0, 0) entry that can be
9636 confused with the terminator. */
9637 if (text_section_used)
9638 {
9639 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_section_label, "Address");
9640 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label,
9641 text_section_label, "Length");
9642 }
9643 if (cold_text_section_used)
9644 {
9645 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_text_section_label,
9646 "Address");
9647 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_end_label,
9648 cold_text_section_label, "Length");
9649 }
9650
9651 if (have_multiple_function_sections)
9652 {
9653 unsigned fde_idx;
9654 dw_fde_ref fde;
9655
9656 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, fde_idx, fde)
9657 {
9658 if (DECL_IGNORED_P (fde->decl))
9659 continue;
9660 if (!fde->in_std_section)
9661 {
9662 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_begin,
9663 "Address");
9664 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_end,
9665 fde->dw_fde_begin, "Length");
9666 }
9667 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && !fde->second_in_std_section)
9668 {
9669 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
9670 "Address");
9671 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_second_end,
9672 fde->dw_fde_second_begin, "Length");
9673 }
9674 }
9675 }
9676
9677 /* Output the terminator words. */
9678 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
9679 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
9680 }
9681
9682 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges. Return the offset at which it
9683 was placed. */
9684
9685 static unsigned int
9686 add_ranges_num (int num)
9687 {
9688 unsigned int in_use = ranges_table_in_use;
9689
9690 if (in_use == ranges_table_allocated)
9691 {
9692 ranges_table_allocated += RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT;
9693 ranges_table = GGC_RESIZEVEC (struct dw_ranges_struct, ranges_table,
9694 ranges_table_allocated);
9695 memset (ranges_table + ranges_table_in_use, 0,
9696 RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_struct));
9697 }
9698
9699 ranges_table[in_use].num = num;
9700 ranges_table_in_use = in_use + 1;
9701
9702 return in_use * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9703 }
9704
9705 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges corresponding to a block, or a
9706 range terminator if BLOCK is NULL. */
9707
9708 static unsigned int
9709 add_ranges (const_tree block)
9710 {
9711 return add_ranges_num (block ? BLOCK_NUMBER (block) : 0);
9712 }
9713
9714 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges corresponding to a pair of labels.
9715 When using dwarf_split_debug_info, address attributes in dies destined
9716 for the final executable should be direct references--setting the
9717 parameter force_direct ensures this behavior. */
9718
9719 static void
9720 add_ranges_by_labels (dw_die_ref die, const char *begin, const char *end,
9721 bool *added, bool force_direct)
9722 {
9723 unsigned int in_use = ranges_by_label_in_use;
9724 unsigned int offset;
9725
9726 if (in_use == ranges_by_label_allocated)
9727 {
9728 ranges_by_label_allocated += RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT;
9729 ranges_by_label = GGC_RESIZEVEC (struct dw_ranges_by_label_struct,
9730 ranges_by_label,
9731 ranges_by_label_allocated);
9732 memset (ranges_by_label + ranges_by_label_in_use, 0,
9733 RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT
9734 * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_by_label_struct));
9735 }
9736
9737 ranges_by_label[in_use].begin = begin;
9738 ranges_by_label[in_use].end = end;
9739 ranges_by_label_in_use = in_use + 1;
9740
9741 offset = add_ranges_num (-(int)in_use - 1);
9742 if (!*added)
9743 {
9744 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, offset, force_direct);
9745 *added = true;
9746 }
9747 }
9748
9749 static void
9750 output_ranges (void)
9751 {
9752 unsigned i;
9753 static const char *const start_fmt = "Offset %#x";
9754 const char *fmt = start_fmt;
9755
9756 for (i = 0; i < ranges_table_in_use; i++)
9757 {
9758 int block_num = ranges_table[i].num;
9759
9760 if (block_num > 0)
9761 {
9762 char blabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
9763 char elabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
9764
9765 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (blabel, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, block_num);
9766 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (elabel, BLOCK_END_LABEL, block_num);
9767
9768 /* If all code is in the text section, then the compilation
9769 unit base address defaults to DW_AT_low_pc, which is the
9770 base of the text section. */
9771 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
9772 {
9773 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
9774 text_section_label,
9775 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
9776 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel,
9777 text_section_label, NULL);
9778 }
9779
9780 /* Otherwise, the compilation unit base address is zero,
9781 which allows us to use absolute addresses, and not worry
9782 about whether the target supports cross-section
9783 arithmetic. */
9784 else
9785 {
9786 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
9787 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
9788 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel, NULL);
9789 }
9790
9791 fmt = NULL;
9792 }
9793
9794 /* Negative block_num stands for an index into ranges_by_label. */
9795 else if (block_num < 0)
9796 {
9797 int lab_idx = - block_num - 1;
9798
9799 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
9800 {
9801 gcc_unreachable ();
9802 #if 0
9803 /* If we ever use add_ranges_by_labels () for a single
9804 function section, all we have to do is to take out
9805 the #if 0 above. */
9806 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
9807 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].begin,
9808 text_section_label,
9809 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
9810 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
9811 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].end,
9812 text_section_label, NULL);
9813 #endif
9814 }
9815 else
9816 {
9817 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
9818 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].begin,
9819 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
9820 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
9821 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].end,
9822 NULL);
9823 }
9824 }
9825 else
9826 {
9827 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
9828 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
9829 fmt = start_fmt;
9830 }
9831 }
9832 }
9833
9834 /* Data structure containing information about input files. */
9835 struct file_info
9836 {
9837 const char *path; /* Complete file name. */
9838 const char *fname; /* File name part. */
9839 int length; /* Length of entire string. */
9840 struct dwarf_file_data * file_idx; /* Index in input file table. */
9841 int dir_idx; /* Index in directory table. */
9842 };
9843
9844 /* Data structure containing information about directories with source
9845 files. */
9846 struct dir_info
9847 {
9848 const char *path; /* Path including directory name. */
9849 int length; /* Path length. */
9850 int prefix; /* Index of directory entry which is a prefix. */
9851 int count; /* Number of files in this directory. */
9852 int dir_idx; /* Index of directory used as base. */
9853 };
9854
9855 /* Callback function for file_info comparison. We sort by looking at
9856 the directories in the path. */
9857
9858 static int
9859 file_info_cmp (const void *p1, const void *p2)
9860 {
9861 const struct file_info *const s1 = (const struct file_info *) p1;
9862 const struct file_info *const s2 = (const struct file_info *) p2;
9863 const unsigned char *cp1;
9864 const unsigned char *cp2;
9865
9866 /* Take care of file names without directories. We need to make sure that
9867 we return consistent values to qsort since some will get confused if
9868 we return the same value when identical operands are passed in opposite
9869 orders. So if neither has a directory, return 0 and otherwise return
9870 1 or -1 depending on which one has the directory. */
9871 if ((s1->path == s1->fname || s2->path == s2->fname))
9872 return (s2->path == s2->fname) - (s1->path == s1->fname);
9873
9874 cp1 = (const unsigned char *) s1->path;
9875 cp2 = (const unsigned char *) s2->path;
9876
9877 while (1)
9878 {
9879 ++cp1;
9880 ++cp2;
9881 /* Reached the end of the first path? If so, handle like above. */
9882 if ((cp1 == (const unsigned char *) s1->fname)
9883 || (cp2 == (const unsigned char *) s2->fname))
9884 return ((cp2 == (const unsigned char *) s2->fname)
9885 - (cp1 == (const unsigned char *) s1->fname));
9886
9887 /* Character of current path component the same? */
9888 else if (*cp1 != *cp2)
9889 return *cp1 - *cp2;
9890 }
9891 }
9892
9893 struct file_name_acquire_data
9894 {
9895 struct file_info *files;
9896 int used_files;
9897 int max_files;
9898 };
9899
9900 /* Traversal function for the hash table. */
9901
9902 int
9903 file_name_acquire (dwarf_file_data **slot, file_name_acquire_data *fnad)
9904 {
9905 struct dwarf_file_data *d = *slot;
9906 struct file_info *fi;
9907 const char *f;
9908
9909 gcc_assert (fnad->max_files >= d->emitted_number);
9910
9911 if (! d->emitted_number)
9912 return 1;
9913
9914 gcc_assert (fnad->max_files != fnad->used_files);
9915
9916 fi = fnad->files + fnad->used_files++;
9917
9918 /* Skip all leading "./". */
9919 f = d->filename;
9920 while (f[0] == '.' && IS_DIR_SEPARATOR (f[1]))
9921 f += 2;
9922
9923 /* Create a new array entry. */
9924 fi->path = f;
9925 fi->length = strlen (f);
9926 fi->file_idx = d;
9927
9928 /* Search for the file name part. */
9929 f = strrchr (f, DIR_SEPARATOR);
9930 #if defined (DIR_SEPARATOR_2)
9931 {
9932 char *g = strrchr (fi->path, DIR_SEPARATOR_2);
9933
9934 if (g != NULL)
9935 {
9936 if (f == NULL || f < g)
9937 f = g;
9938 }
9939 }
9940 #endif
9941
9942 fi->fname = f == NULL ? fi->path : f + 1;
9943 return 1;
9944 }
9945
9946 /* Output the directory table and the file name table. We try to minimize
9947 the total amount of memory needed. A heuristic is used to avoid large
9948 slowdowns with many input files. */
9949
9950 static void
9951 output_file_names (void)
9952 {
9953 struct file_name_acquire_data fnad;
9954 int numfiles;
9955 struct file_info *files;
9956 struct dir_info *dirs;
9957 int *saved;
9958 int *savehere;
9959 int *backmap;
9960 int ndirs;
9961 int idx_offset;
9962 int i;
9963
9964 if (!last_emitted_file)
9965 {
9966 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
9967 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
9968 return;
9969 }
9970
9971 numfiles = last_emitted_file->emitted_number;
9972
9973 /* Allocate the various arrays we need. */
9974 files = XALLOCAVEC (struct file_info, numfiles);
9975 dirs = XALLOCAVEC (struct dir_info, numfiles);
9976
9977 fnad.files = files;
9978 fnad.used_files = 0;
9979 fnad.max_files = numfiles;
9980 file_table->traverse<file_name_acquire_data *, file_name_acquire> (&fnad);
9981 gcc_assert (fnad.used_files == fnad.max_files);
9982
9983 qsort (files, numfiles, sizeof (files[0]), file_info_cmp);
9984
9985 /* Find all the different directories used. */
9986 dirs[0].path = files[0].path;
9987 dirs[0].length = files[0].fname - files[0].path;
9988 dirs[0].prefix = -1;
9989 dirs[0].count = 1;
9990 dirs[0].dir_idx = 0;
9991 files[0].dir_idx = 0;
9992 ndirs = 1;
9993
9994 for (i = 1; i < numfiles; i++)
9995 if (files[i].fname - files[i].path == dirs[ndirs - 1].length
9996 && memcmp (dirs[ndirs - 1].path, files[i].path,
9997 dirs[ndirs - 1].length) == 0)
9998 {
9999 /* Same directory as last entry. */
10000 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs - 1;
10001 ++dirs[ndirs - 1].count;
10002 }
10003 else
10004 {
10005 int j;
10006
10007 /* This is a new directory. */
10008 dirs[ndirs].path = files[i].path;
10009 dirs[ndirs].length = files[i].fname - files[i].path;
10010 dirs[ndirs].count = 1;
10011 dirs[ndirs].dir_idx = ndirs;
10012 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs;
10013
10014 /* Search for a prefix. */
10015 dirs[ndirs].prefix = -1;
10016 for (j = 0; j < ndirs; j++)
10017 if (dirs[j].length < dirs[ndirs].length
10018 && dirs[j].length > 1
10019 && (dirs[ndirs].prefix == -1
10020 || dirs[j].length > dirs[dirs[ndirs].prefix].length)
10021 && memcmp (dirs[j].path, dirs[ndirs].path, dirs[j].length) == 0)
10022 dirs[ndirs].prefix = j;
10023
10024 ++ndirs;
10025 }
10026
10027 /* Now to the actual work. We have to find a subset of the directories which
10028 allow expressing the file name using references to the directory table
10029 with the least amount of characters. We do not do an exhaustive search
10030 where we would have to check out every combination of every single
10031 possible prefix. Instead we use a heuristic which provides nearly optimal
10032 results in most cases and never is much off. */
10033 saved = XALLOCAVEC (int, ndirs);
10034 savehere = XALLOCAVEC (int, ndirs);
10035
10036 memset (saved, '\0', ndirs * sizeof (saved[0]));
10037 for (i = 0; i < ndirs; i++)
10038 {
10039 int j;
10040 int total;
10041
10042 /* We can always save some space for the current directory. But this
10043 does not mean it will be enough to justify adding the directory. */
10044 savehere[i] = dirs[i].length;
10045 total = (savehere[i] - saved[i]) * dirs[i].count;
10046
10047 for (j = i + 1; j < ndirs; j++)
10048 {
10049 savehere[j] = 0;
10050 if (saved[j] < dirs[i].length)
10051 {
10052 /* Determine whether the dirs[i] path is a prefix of the
10053 dirs[j] path. */
10054 int k;
10055
10056 k = dirs[j].prefix;
10057 while (k != -1 && k != (int) i)
10058 k = dirs[k].prefix;
10059
10060 if (k == (int) i)
10061 {
10062 /* Yes it is. We can possibly save some memory by
10063 writing the filenames in dirs[j] relative to
10064 dirs[i]. */
10065 savehere[j] = dirs[i].length;
10066 total += (savehere[j] - saved[j]) * dirs[j].count;
10067 }
10068 }
10069 }
10070
10071 /* Check whether we can save enough to justify adding the dirs[i]
10072 directory. */
10073 if (total > dirs[i].length + 1)
10074 {
10075 /* It's worthwhile adding. */
10076 for (j = i; j < ndirs; j++)
10077 if (savehere[j] > 0)
10078 {
10079 /* Remember how much we saved for this directory so far. */
10080 saved[j] = savehere[j];
10081
10082 /* Remember the prefix directory. */
10083 dirs[j].dir_idx = i;
10084 }
10085 }
10086 }
10087
10088 /* Emit the directory name table. */
10089 idx_offset = dirs[0].length > 0 ? 1 : 0;
10090 for (i = 1 - idx_offset; i < ndirs; i++)
10091 dw2_asm_output_nstring (dirs[i].path,
10092 dirs[i].length
10093 - !DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR,
10094 "Directory Entry: %#x", i + idx_offset);
10095
10096 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
10097
10098 /* We have to emit them in the order of emitted_number since that's
10099 used in the debug info generation. To do this efficiently we
10100 generate a back-mapping of the indices first. */
10101 backmap = XALLOCAVEC (int, numfiles);
10102 for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
10103 backmap[files[i].file_idx->emitted_number - 1] = i;
10104
10105 /* Now write all the file names. */
10106 for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
10107 {
10108 int file_idx = backmap[i];
10109 int dir_idx = dirs[files[file_idx].dir_idx].dir_idx;
10110
10111 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10112 #define MAX_VMS_VERSION_LEN 6 /* ";32768" */
10113
10114 /* Setting these fields can lead to debugger miscomparisons,
10115 but VMS Debug requires them to be set correctly. */
10116
10117 int ver;
10118 long long cdt;
10119 long siz;
10120 int maxfilelen = strlen (files[file_idx].path)
10121 + dirs[dir_idx].length
10122 + MAX_VMS_VERSION_LEN + 1;
10123 char *filebuf = XALLOCAVEC (char, maxfilelen);
10124
10125 vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path, 0, 0, 0, &ver);
10126 snprintf (filebuf, maxfilelen, "%s;%d",
10127 files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length, ver);
10128
10129 dw2_asm_output_nstring
10130 (filebuf, -1, "File Entry: %#x", (unsigned) i + 1);
10131
10132 /* Include directory index. */
10133 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
10134
10135 /* Modification time. */
10136 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128
10137 ((vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path, &cdt, 0, 0, 0) == 0)
10138 ? cdt : 0,
10139 NULL);
10140
10141 /* File length in bytes. */
10142 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128
10143 ((vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path, 0, &siz, 0, 0) == 0)
10144 ? siz : 0,
10145 NULL);
10146 #else
10147 dw2_asm_output_nstring (files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length, -1,
10148 "File Entry: %#x", (unsigned) i + 1);
10149
10150 /* Include directory index. */
10151 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
10152
10153 /* Modification time. */
10154 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
10155
10156 /* File length in bytes. */
10157 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
10158 #endif /* VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO */
10159 }
10160
10161 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
10162 }
10163
10164
10165 /* Output one line number table into the .debug_line section. */
10166
10167 static void
10168 output_one_line_info_table (dw_line_info_table *table)
10169 {
10170 char line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10171 unsigned int current_line = 1;
10172 bool current_is_stmt = DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START;
10173 dw_line_info_entry *ent;
10174 size_t i;
10175
10176 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (table->entries, i, ent)
10177 {
10178 switch (ent->opcode)
10179 {
10180 case LI_set_address:
10181 /* ??? Unfortunately, we have little choice here currently, and
10182 must always use the most general form. GCC does not know the
10183 address delta itself, so we can't use DW_LNS_advance_pc. Many
10184 ports do have length attributes which will give an upper bound
10185 on the address range. We could perhaps use length attributes
10186 to determine when it is safe to use DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc. */
10187 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, LINE_CODE_LABEL, ent->val);
10188
10189 /* This can handle any delta. This takes
10190 4+DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE bytes. */
10191 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "set address %s", line_label);
10192 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
10193 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
10194 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
10195 break;
10196
10197 case LI_set_line:
10198 if (ent->val == current_line)
10199 {
10200 /* We still need to start a new row, so output a copy insn. */
10201 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy,
10202 "copy line %u", current_line);
10203 }
10204 else
10205 {
10206 int line_offset = ent->val - current_line;
10207 int line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
10208
10209 current_line = ent->val;
10210 if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
10211 {
10212 /* This can handle deltas from -10 to 234, using the current
10213 definitions of DWARF_LINE_BASE and DWARF_LINE_RANGE.
10214 This takes 1 byte. */
10215 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
10216 "line %u", current_line);
10217 }
10218 else
10219 {
10220 /* This can handle any delta. This takes at least 4 bytes,
10221 depending on the value being encoded. */
10222 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
10223 "advance to line %u", current_line);
10224 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
10225 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, NULL);
10226 }
10227 }
10228 break;
10229
10230 case LI_set_file:
10231 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "set file %u", ent->val);
10232 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ent->val, "%u", ent->val);
10233 break;
10234
10235 case LI_set_column:
10236 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_column, "column %u", ent->val);
10237 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ent->val, "%u", ent->val);
10238 break;
10239
10240 case LI_negate_stmt:
10241 current_is_stmt = !current_is_stmt;
10242 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_negate_stmt,
10243 "is_stmt %d", current_is_stmt);
10244 break;
10245
10246 case LI_set_prologue_end:
10247 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_prologue_end,
10248 "set prologue end");
10249 break;
10250
10251 case LI_set_epilogue_begin:
10252 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_epilogue_begin,
10253 "set epilogue begin");
10254 break;
10255
10256 case LI_set_discriminator:
10257 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "discriminator %u", ent->val);
10258 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + size_of_uleb128 (ent->val), NULL);
10259 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_discriminator, NULL);
10260 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ent->val, NULL);
10261 break;
10262 }
10263 }
10264
10265 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the table. */
10266 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "set address %s", table->end_label);
10267 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
10268 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
10269 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, table->end_label, NULL);
10270
10271 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end sequence");
10272 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
10273 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
10274 }
10275
10276 /* Output the source line number correspondence information. This
10277 information goes into the .debug_line section. */
10278
10279 static void
10280 output_line_info (bool prologue_only)
10281 {
10282 char l1[20], l2[20], p1[20], p2[20];
10283 /* We don't support DWARFv5 line tables yet. */
10284 int ver = dwarf_version < 5 ? dwarf_version : 4;
10285 bool saw_one = false;
10286 int opc;
10287
10288 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL, 0);
10289 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL, 0);
10290 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p1, LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL, 0);
10291 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p2, LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL, 0);
10292
10293 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
10294 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
10295 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
10296 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
10297 "Length of Source Line Info");
10298 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
10299
10300 dw2_asm_output_data (2, ver, "DWARF Version");
10301 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, p2, p1, "Prolog Length");
10302 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p1);
10303
10304 /* Define the architecture-dependent minimum instruction length (in bytes).
10305 In this implementation of DWARF, this field is used for information
10306 purposes only. Since GCC generates assembly language, we have no
10307 a priori knowledge of how many instruction bytes are generated for each
10308 source line, and therefore can use only the DW_LNE_set_address and
10309 DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc line information commands. Accordingly, we fix
10310 this as '1', which is "correct enough" for all architectures,
10311 and don't let the target override. */
10312 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1, "Minimum Instruction Length");
10313
10314 if (ver >= 4)
10315 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_MAX_OPS_PER_INSN,
10316 "Maximum Operations Per Instruction");
10317 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START,
10318 "Default is_stmt_start flag");
10319 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_BASE,
10320 "Line Base Value (Special Opcodes)");
10321 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_RANGE,
10322 "Line Range Value (Special Opcodes)");
10323 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE,
10324 "Special Opcode Base");
10325
10326 for (opc = 1; opc < DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE; opc++)
10327 {
10328 int n_op_args;
10329 switch (opc)
10330 {
10331 case DW_LNS_advance_pc:
10332 case DW_LNS_advance_line:
10333 case DW_LNS_set_file:
10334 case DW_LNS_set_column:
10335 case DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc:
10336 case DW_LNS_set_isa:
10337 n_op_args = 1;
10338 break;
10339 default:
10340 n_op_args = 0;
10341 break;
10342 }
10343
10344 dw2_asm_output_data (1, n_op_args, "opcode: %#x has %d args",
10345 opc, n_op_args);
10346 }
10347
10348 /* Write out the information about the files we use. */
10349 output_file_names ();
10350 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p2);
10351 if (prologue_only)
10352 {
10353 /* Output the marker for the end of the line number info. */
10354 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
10355 return;
10356 }
10357
10358 if (separate_line_info)
10359 {
10360 dw_line_info_table *table;
10361 size_t i;
10362
10363 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*separate_line_info, i, table)
10364 if (table->in_use)
10365 {
10366 output_one_line_info_table (table);
10367 saw_one = true;
10368 }
10369 }
10370 if (cold_text_section_line_info && cold_text_section_line_info->in_use)
10371 {
10372 output_one_line_info_table (cold_text_section_line_info);
10373 saw_one = true;
10374 }
10375
10376 /* ??? Some Darwin linkers crash on a .debug_line section with no
10377 sequences. Further, merely a DW_LNE_end_sequence entry is not
10378 sufficient -- the address column must also be initialized.
10379 Make sure to output at least one set_address/end_sequence pair,
10380 choosing .text since that section is always present. */
10381 if (text_section_line_info->in_use || !saw_one)
10382 output_one_line_info_table (text_section_line_info);
10383
10384 /* Output the marker for the end of the line number info. */
10385 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
10386 }
10387 \f
10388 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for some base type, return a pointer to
10389 a DIE that describes the given type.
10390
10391 This routine must only be called for GCC type nodes that correspond to
10392 Dwarf base (fundamental) types. */
10393
10394 static dw_die_ref
10395 base_type_die (tree type)
10396 {
10397 dw_die_ref base_type_result;
10398 enum dwarf_type encoding;
10399
10400 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK || TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE)
10401 return 0;
10402
10403 /* If this is a subtype that should not be emitted as a subrange type,
10404 use the base type. See subrange_type_for_debug_p. */
10405 if (TREE_CODE (type) == INTEGER_TYPE && TREE_TYPE (type) != NULL_TREE)
10406 type = TREE_TYPE (type);
10407
10408 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
10409 {
10410 case INTEGER_TYPE:
10411 if ((dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
10412 && TYPE_NAME (type)
10413 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
10414 && DECL_IS_BUILTIN (TYPE_NAME (type))
10415 && DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type)))
10416 {
10417 const char *name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type)));
10418 if (strcmp (name, "char16_t") == 0
10419 || strcmp (name, "char32_t") == 0)
10420 {
10421 encoding = DW_ATE_UTF;
10422 break;
10423 }
10424 }
10425 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type))
10426 {
10427 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
10428 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_char;
10429 else
10430 encoding = DW_ATE_signed_char;
10431 }
10432 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
10433 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned;
10434 else
10435 encoding = DW_ATE_signed;
10436 break;
10437
10438 case REAL_TYPE:
10439 if (DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type)))
10440 {
10441 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
10442 encoding = DW_ATE_decimal_float;
10443 else
10444 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
10445 }
10446 else
10447 encoding = DW_ATE_float;
10448 break;
10449
10450 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
10451 if (!(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
10452 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
10453 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
10454 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_fixed;
10455 else
10456 encoding = DW_ATE_signed_fixed;
10457 break;
10458
10459 /* Dwarf2 doesn't know anything about complex ints, so use
10460 a user defined type for it. */
10461 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
10462 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == REAL_TYPE)
10463 encoding = DW_ATE_complex_float;
10464 else
10465 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
10466 break;
10467
10468 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
10469 /* GNU FORTRAN/Ada/C++ BOOLEAN type. */
10470 encoding = DW_ATE_boolean;
10471 break;
10472
10473 default:
10474 /* No other TREE_CODEs are Dwarf fundamental types. */
10475 gcc_unreachable ();
10476 }
10477
10478 base_type_result = new_die (DW_TAG_base_type, comp_unit_die (), type);
10479
10480 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_byte_size,
10481 int_size_in_bytes (type));
10482 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_encoding, encoding);
10483 add_pubtype (type, base_type_result);
10484
10485 return base_type_result;
10486 }
10487
10488 /* A C++ function with deduced return type can have a TEMPLATE_TYPE_PARM
10489 named 'auto' in its type: return true for it, false otherwise. */
10490
10491 static inline bool
10492 is_cxx_auto (tree type)
10493 {
10494 if (is_cxx ())
10495 {
10496 tree name = TYPE_IDENTIFIER (type);
10497 if (name == get_identifier ("auto")
10498 || name == get_identifier ("decltype(auto)"))
10499 return true;
10500 }
10501 return false;
10502 }
10503
10504 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return nonzero if the
10505 given input type is a Dwarf "fundamental" type. Otherwise return null. */
10506
10507 static inline int
10508 is_base_type (tree type)
10509 {
10510 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
10511 {
10512 case ERROR_MARK:
10513 case VOID_TYPE:
10514 case INTEGER_TYPE:
10515 case REAL_TYPE:
10516 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
10517 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
10518 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
10519 case POINTER_BOUNDS_TYPE:
10520 return 1;
10521
10522 case ARRAY_TYPE:
10523 case RECORD_TYPE:
10524 case UNION_TYPE:
10525 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
10526 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
10527 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
10528 case METHOD_TYPE:
10529 case POINTER_TYPE:
10530 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
10531 case NULLPTR_TYPE:
10532 case OFFSET_TYPE:
10533 case LANG_TYPE:
10534 case VECTOR_TYPE:
10535 return 0;
10536
10537 default:
10538 if (is_cxx_auto (type))
10539 return 0;
10540 gcc_unreachable ();
10541 }
10542
10543 return 0;
10544 }
10545
10546 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, assumed to be some kind of a ..._TYPE
10547 node, return the size in bits for the type if it is a constant, or else
10548 return the alignment for the type if the type's size is not constant, or
10549 else return BITS_PER_WORD if the type actually turns out to be an
10550 ERROR_MARK node. */
10551
10552 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
10553 simple_type_size_in_bits (const_tree type)
10554 {
10555 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
10556 return BITS_PER_WORD;
10557 else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
10558 return 0;
10559 else if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (TYPE_SIZE (type)))
10560 return tree_to_uhwi (TYPE_SIZE (type));
10561 else
10562 return TYPE_ALIGN (type);
10563 }
10564
10565 /* Similarly, but return an offset_int instead of UHWI. */
10566
10567 static inline offset_int
10568 offset_int_type_size_in_bits (const_tree type)
10569 {
10570 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
10571 return BITS_PER_WORD;
10572 else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
10573 return 0;
10574 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (type)) == INTEGER_CST)
10575 return wi::to_offset (TYPE_SIZE (type));
10576 else
10577 return TYPE_ALIGN (type);
10578 }
10579
10580 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for a subrange type, return a pointer
10581 to a DIE that describes the given type. */
10582
10583 static dw_die_ref
10584 subrange_type_die (tree type, tree low, tree high, dw_die_ref context_die)
10585 {
10586 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
10587 const HOST_WIDE_INT size_in_bytes = int_size_in_bytes (type);
10588
10589 if (context_die == NULL)
10590 context_die = comp_unit_die ();
10591
10592 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, context_die, type);
10593
10594 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (type)) != size_in_bytes)
10595 {
10596 /* The size of the subrange type and its base type do not match,
10597 so we need to generate a size attribute for the subrange type. */
10598 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size_in_bytes);
10599 }
10600
10601 if (low)
10602 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, low, NULL);
10603 if (high)
10604 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, high, NULL);
10605
10606 return subrange_die;
10607 }
10608
10609 /* Returns the (const and/or volatile) cv_qualifiers associated with
10610 the decl node. This will normally be augmented with the
10611 cv_qualifiers of the underlying type in add_type_attribute. */
10612
10613 static int
10614 decl_quals (const_tree decl)
10615 {
10616 return ((TREE_READONLY (decl)
10617 ? TYPE_QUAL_CONST : TYPE_UNQUALIFIED)
10618 | (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl)
10619 ? TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE : TYPE_UNQUALIFIED));
10620 }
10621
10622 /* Determine the TYPE whose qualifiers match the largest strict subset
10623 of the given TYPE_QUALS, and return its qualifiers. Ignore all
10624 qualifiers outside QUAL_MASK. */
10625
10626 static int
10627 get_nearest_type_subqualifiers (tree type, int type_quals, int qual_mask)
10628 {
10629 tree t;
10630 int best_rank = 0, best_qual = 0, max_rank;
10631
10632 type_quals &= qual_mask;
10633 max_rank = popcount_hwi (type_quals) - 1;
10634
10635 for (t = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type); t && best_rank < max_rank;
10636 t = TYPE_NEXT_VARIANT (t))
10637 {
10638 int q = TYPE_QUALS (t) & qual_mask;
10639
10640 if ((q & type_quals) == q && q != type_quals
10641 && check_base_type (t, type))
10642 {
10643 int rank = popcount_hwi (q);
10644
10645 if (rank > best_rank)
10646 {
10647 best_rank = rank;
10648 best_qual = q;
10649 }
10650 }
10651 }
10652
10653 return best_qual;
10654 }
10655
10656 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a debugging
10657 entry that chains various modifiers in front of the given type. */
10658
10659 static dw_die_ref
10660 modified_type_die (tree type, int cv_quals, dw_die_ref context_die)
10661 {
10662 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
10663 dw_die_ref mod_type_die;
10664 dw_die_ref sub_die = NULL;
10665 tree item_type = NULL;
10666 tree qualified_type;
10667 tree name, low, high;
10668 dw_die_ref mod_scope;
10669 /* Only these cv-qualifiers are currently handled. */
10670 const int cv_qual_mask = (TYPE_QUAL_CONST | TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE
10671 | TYPE_QUAL_RESTRICT | TYPE_QUAL_ATOMIC);
10672
10673 if (code == ERROR_MARK)
10674 return NULL;
10675
10676 cv_quals &= cv_qual_mask;
10677
10678 /* Don't emit DW_TAG_restrict_type for DWARFv2, since it is a type
10679 tag modifier (and not an attribute) old consumers won't be able
10680 to handle it. */
10681 if (dwarf_version < 3)
10682 cv_quals &= ~TYPE_QUAL_RESTRICT;
10683
10684 /* Likewise for DW_TAG_atomic_type for DWARFv5. */
10685 if (dwarf_version < 5)
10686 cv_quals &= ~TYPE_QUAL_ATOMIC;
10687
10688 /* See if we already have the appropriately qualified variant of
10689 this type. */
10690 qualified_type = get_qualified_type (type, cv_quals);
10691
10692 if (qualified_type == sizetype
10693 && TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)
10694 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)) == TYPE_DECL)
10695 {
10696 tree t = TREE_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type));
10697
10698 gcc_checking_assert (TREE_CODE (t) == INTEGER_TYPE
10699 && TYPE_PRECISION (t)
10700 == TYPE_PRECISION (qualified_type)
10701 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (t)
10702 == TYPE_UNSIGNED (qualified_type));
10703 qualified_type = t;
10704 }
10705
10706 /* If we do, then we can just use its DIE, if it exists. */
10707 if (qualified_type)
10708 {
10709 mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
10710 if (mod_type_die)
10711 return mod_type_die;
10712 }
10713
10714 name = qualified_type ? TYPE_NAME (qualified_type) : NULL;
10715
10716 /* Handle C typedef types. */
10717 if (name && TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name)
10718 && !DECL_ARTIFICIAL (name))
10719 {
10720 tree dtype = TREE_TYPE (name);
10721
10722 if (qualified_type == dtype)
10723 {
10724 /* For a named type, use the typedef. */
10725 gen_type_die (qualified_type, context_die);
10726 return lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
10727 }
10728 else
10729 {
10730 int dquals = TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (dtype);
10731 dquals &= cv_qual_mask;
10732 if ((dquals & ~cv_quals) != TYPE_UNQUALIFIED
10733 || (cv_quals == dquals && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name) != type))
10734 /* cv-unqualified version of named type. Just use
10735 the unnamed type to which it refers. */
10736 return modified_type_die (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name),
10737 cv_quals, context_die);
10738 /* Else cv-qualified version of named type; fall through. */
10739 }
10740 }
10741
10742 mod_scope = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
10743
10744 if (cv_quals)
10745 {
10746 struct qual_info { int q; enum dwarf_tag t; };
10747 static const struct qual_info qual_info[] =
10748 {
10749 { TYPE_QUAL_ATOMIC, DW_TAG_atomic_type },
10750 { TYPE_QUAL_RESTRICT, DW_TAG_restrict_type },
10751 { TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE, DW_TAG_volatile_type },
10752 { TYPE_QUAL_CONST, DW_TAG_const_type },
10753 };
10754 int sub_quals;
10755 unsigned i;
10756
10757 /* Determine a lesser qualified type that most closely matches
10758 this one. Then generate DW_TAG_* entries for the remaining
10759 qualifiers. */
10760 sub_quals = get_nearest_type_subqualifiers (type, cv_quals,
10761 cv_qual_mask);
10762 mod_type_die = modified_type_die (type, sub_quals, context_die);
10763
10764 for (i = 0; i < sizeof (qual_info) / sizeof (qual_info[0]); i++)
10765 if (qual_info[i].q & cv_quals & ~sub_quals)
10766 {
10767 dw_die_ref d = new_die (qual_info[i].t, mod_scope, type);
10768 if (mod_type_die)
10769 add_AT_die_ref (d, DW_AT_type, mod_type_die);
10770 mod_type_die = d;
10771 }
10772 }
10773 else if (code == POINTER_TYPE)
10774 {
10775 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, mod_scope, type);
10776 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
10777 simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
10778 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
10779 if (!ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (item_type)))
10780 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_address_class,
10781 TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (item_type));
10782 }
10783 else if (code == REFERENCE_TYPE)
10784 {
10785 if (TYPE_REF_IS_RVALUE (type) && dwarf_version >= 4)
10786 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type, mod_scope,
10787 type);
10788 else
10789 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, mod_scope, type);
10790 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
10791 simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
10792 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
10793 if (!ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (item_type)))
10794 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_address_class,
10795 TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (item_type));
10796 }
10797 else if (code == INTEGER_TYPE
10798 && TREE_TYPE (type) != NULL_TREE
10799 && subrange_type_for_debug_p (type, &low, &high))
10800 {
10801 mod_type_die = subrange_type_die (type, low, high, context_die);
10802 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
10803 }
10804 else if (is_base_type (type))
10805 mod_type_die = base_type_die (type);
10806 else
10807 {
10808 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
10809
10810 /* We have to get the type_main_variant here (and pass that to the
10811 `lookup_type_die' routine) because the ..._TYPE node we have
10812 might simply be a *copy* of some original type node (where the
10813 copy was created to help us keep track of typedef names) and
10814 that copy might have a different TYPE_UID from the original
10815 ..._TYPE node. */
10816 if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
10817 return lookup_type_die (type_main_variant (type));
10818 else
10819 /* Vectors have the debugging information in the type,
10820 not the main variant. */
10821 return lookup_type_die (type);
10822 }
10823
10824 /* Builtin types don't have a DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE. For those,
10825 don't output a DW_TAG_typedef, since there isn't one in the
10826 user's program; just attach a DW_AT_name to the type.
10827 Don't attach a DW_AT_name to DW_TAG_const_type or DW_TAG_volatile_type
10828 if the base type already has the same name. */
10829 if (name
10830 && ((TREE_CODE (name) != TYPE_DECL
10831 && (qualified_type == TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type)
10832 || (cv_quals == TYPE_UNQUALIFIED)))
10833 || (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL
10834 && TREE_TYPE (name) == qualified_type
10835 && DECL_NAME (name))))
10836 {
10837 if (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL)
10838 /* Could just call add_name_and_src_coords_attributes here,
10839 but since this is a builtin type it doesn't have any
10840 useful source coordinates anyway. */
10841 name = DECL_NAME (name);
10842 add_name_attribute (mod_type_die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
10843 }
10844 /* This probably indicates a bug. */
10845 else if (mod_type_die && mod_type_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
10846 {
10847 name = TYPE_IDENTIFIER (type);
10848 add_name_attribute (mod_type_die,
10849 name ? IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name) : "__unknown__");
10850 }
10851
10852 if (qualified_type)
10853 equate_type_number_to_die (qualified_type, mod_type_die);
10854
10855 if (item_type)
10856 /* We must do this after the equate_type_number_to_die call, in case
10857 this is a recursive type. This ensures that the modified_type_die
10858 recursion will terminate even if the type is recursive. Recursive
10859 types are possible in Ada. */
10860 sub_die = modified_type_die (item_type,
10861 TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (item_type),
10862 context_die);
10863
10864 if (sub_die != NULL)
10865 add_AT_die_ref (mod_type_die, DW_AT_type, sub_die);
10866
10867 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (mod_type_die, type, context_die);
10868 if (TYPE_ARTIFICIAL (type))
10869 add_AT_flag (mod_type_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
10870
10871 return mod_type_die;
10872 }
10873
10874 /* Generate DIEs for the generic parameters of T.
10875 T must be either a generic type or a generic function.
10876 See http://gcc.gnu.org/wiki/TemplateParmsDwarf for more. */
10877
10878 static void
10879 gen_generic_params_dies (tree t)
10880 {
10881 tree parms, args;
10882 int parms_num, i;
10883 dw_die_ref die = NULL;
10884 int non_default;
10885
10886 if (!t || (TYPE_P (t) && !COMPLETE_TYPE_P (t)))
10887 return;
10888
10889 if (TYPE_P (t))
10890 die = lookup_type_die (t);
10891 else if (DECL_P (t))
10892 die = lookup_decl_die (t);
10893
10894 gcc_assert (die);
10895
10896 parms = lang_hooks.get_innermost_generic_parms (t);
10897 if (!parms)
10898 /* T has no generic parameter. It means T is neither a generic type
10899 or function. End of story. */
10900 return;
10901
10902 parms_num = TREE_VEC_LENGTH (parms);
10903 args = lang_hooks.get_innermost_generic_args (t);
10904 if (TREE_CHAIN (args) && TREE_CODE (TREE_CHAIN (args)) == INTEGER_CST)
10905 non_default = int_cst_value (TREE_CHAIN (args));
10906 else
10907 non_default = TREE_VEC_LENGTH (args);
10908 for (i = 0; i < parms_num; i++)
10909 {
10910 tree parm, arg, arg_pack_elems;
10911 dw_die_ref parm_die;
10912
10913 parm = TREE_VEC_ELT (parms, i);
10914 arg = TREE_VEC_ELT (args, i);
10915 arg_pack_elems = lang_hooks.types.get_argument_pack_elems (arg);
10916 gcc_assert (parm && TREE_VALUE (parm) && arg);
10917
10918 if (parm && TREE_VALUE (parm) && arg)
10919 {
10920 /* If PARM represents a template parameter pack,
10921 emit a DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack DIE, followed
10922 by DW_TAG_template_*_parameter DIEs for the argument
10923 pack elements of ARG. Note that ARG would then be
10924 an argument pack. */
10925 if (arg_pack_elems)
10926 parm_die = template_parameter_pack_die (TREE_VALUE (parm),
10927 arg_pack_elems,
10928 die);
10929 else
10930 parm_die = generic_parameter_die (TREE_VALUE (parm), arg,
10931 true /* emit name */, die);
10932 if (i >= non_default)
10933 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_default_value, 1);
10934 }
10935 }
10936 }
10937
10938 /* Create and return a DIE for PARM which should be
10939 the representation of a generic type parameter.
10940 For instance, in the C++ front end, PARM would be a template parameter.
10941 ARG is the argument to PARM.
10942 EMIT_NAME_P if tree, the DIE will have DW_AT_name attribute set to the
10943 name of the PARM.
10944 PARENT_DIE is the parent DIE which the new created DIE should be added to,
10945 as a child node. */
10946
10947 static dw_die_ref
10948 generic_parameter_die (tree parm, tree arg,
10949 bool emit_name_p,
10950 dw_die_ref parent_die)
10951 {
10952 dw_die_ref tmpl_die = NULL;
10953 const char *name = NULL;
10954
10955 if (!parm || !DECL_NAME (parm) || !arg)
10956 return NULL;
10957
10958 /* We support non-type generic parameters and arguments,
10959 type generic parameters and arguments, as well as
10960 generic generic parameters (a.k.a. template template parameters in C++)
10961 and arguments. */
10962 if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
10963 /* PARM is a nontype generic parameter */
10964 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_template_value_param, parent_die, parm);
10965 else if (TREE_CODE (parm) == TYPE_DECL)
10966 /* PARM is a type generic parameter. */
10967 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_template_type_param, parent_die, parm);
10968 else if (lang_hooks.decls.generic_generic_parameter_decl_p (parm))
10969 /* PARM is a generic generic parameter.
10970 Its DIE is a GNU extension. It shall have a
10971 DW_AT_name attribute to represent the name of the template template
10972 parameter, and a DW_AT_GNU_template_name attribute to represent the
10973 name of the template template argument. */
10974 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param,
10975 parent_die, parm);
10976 else
10977 gcc_unreachable ();
10978
10979 if (tmpl_die)
10980 {
10981 tree tmpl_type;
10982
10983 /* If PARM is a generic parameter pack, it means we are
10984 emitting debug info for a template argument pack element.
10985 In other terms, ARG is a template argument pack element.
10986 In that case, we don't emit any DW_AT_name attribute for
10987 the die. */
10988 if (emit_name_p)
10989 {
10990 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (parm));
10991 gcc_assert (name);
10992 add_AT_string (tmpl_die, DW_AT_name, name);
10993 }
10994
10995 if (!lang_hooks.decls.generic_generic_parameter_decl_p (parm))
10996 {
10997 /* DWARF3, 5.6.8 says if PARM is a non-type generic parameter
10998 TMPL_DIE should have a child DW_AT_type attribute that is set
10999 to the type of the argument to PARM, which is ARG.
11000 If PARM is a type generic parameter, TMPL_DIE should have a
11001 child DW_AT_type that is set to ARG. */
11002 tmpl_type = TYPE_P (arg) ? arg : TREE_TYPE (arg);
11003 add_type_attribute (tmpl_die, tmpl_type,
11004 (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (tmpl_type)
11005 ? TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE : TYPE_UNQUALIFIED),
11006 parent_die);
11007 }
11008 else
11009 {
11010 /* So TMPL_DIE is a DIE representing a
11011 a generic generic template parameter, a.k.a template template
11012 parameter in C++ and arg is a template. */
11013
11014 /* The DW_AT_GNU_template_name attribute of the DIE must be set
11015 to the name of the argument. */
11016 name = dwarf2_name (TYPE_P (arg) ? TYPE_NAME (arg) : arg, 1);
11017 if (name)
11018 add_AT_string (tmpl_die, DW_AT_GNU_template_name, name);
11019 }
11020
11021 if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
11022 /* So PARM is a non-type generic parameter.
11023 DWARF3 5.6.8 says we must set a DW_AT_const_value child
11024 attribute of TMPL_DIE which value represents the value
11025 of ARG.
11026 We must be careful here:
11027 The value of ARG might reference some function decls.
11028 We might currently be emitting debug info for a generic
11029 type and types are emitted before function decls, we don't
11030 know if the function decls referenced by ARG will actually be
11031 emitted after cgraph computations.
11032 So must defer the generation of the DW_AT_const_value to
11033 after cgraph is ready. */
11034 append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (tmpl_die, arg);
11035 }
11036
11037 return tmpl_die;
11038 }
11039
11040 /* Generate and return a DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack DIE representing.
11041 PARM_PACK must be a template parameter pack. The returned DIE
11042 will be child DIE of PARENT_DIE. */
11043
11044 static dw_die_ref
11045 template_parameter_pack_die (tree parm_pack,
11046 tree parm_pack_args,
11047 dw_die_ref parent_die)
11048 {
11049 dw_die_ref die;
11050 int j;
11051
11052 gcc_assert (parent_die && parm_pack);
11053
11054 die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack, parent_die, parm_pack);
11055 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (die, parm_pack);
11056 for (j = 0; j < TREE_VEC_LENGTH (parm_pack_args); j++)
11057 generic_parameter_die (parm_pack,
11058 TREE_VEC_ELT (parm_pack_args, j),
11059 false /* Don't emit DW_AT_name */,
11060 die);
11061 return die;
11062 }
11063
11064 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return true if it is
11065 an enumerated type. */
11066
11067 static inline int
11068 type_is_enum (const_tree type)
11069 {
11070 return TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE;
11071 }
11072
11073 /* Return the DBX register number described by a given RTL node. */
11074
11075 static unsigned int
11076 dbx_reg_number (const_rtx rtl)
11077 {
11078 unsigned regno = REGNO (rtl);
11079
11080 gcc_assert (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
11081
11082 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
11083 if (crtl->uses_only_leaf_regs)
11084 {
11085 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (regno);
11086 if (leaf_reg != -1)
11087 regno = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
11088 }
11089 #endif
11090
11091 regno = DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (regno);
11092 gcc_assert (regno != INVALID_REGNUM);
11093 return regno;
11094 }
11095
11096 /* Optionally add a DW_OP_piece term to a location description expression.
11097 DW_OP_piece is only added if the location description expression already
11098 doesn't end with DW_OP_piece. */
11099
11100 static void
11101 add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, int size)
11102 {
11103 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
11104
11105 if (*list_head != NULL)
11106 {
11107 /* Find the end of the chain. */
11108 for (loc = *list_head; loc->dw_loc_next != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
11109 ;
11110
11111 if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_piece)
11112 loc->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, size, 0);
11113 }
11114 }
11115
11116 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register or
11117 zero if there is none. */
11118
11119 static dw_loc_descr_ref
11120 reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum var_init_status initialized)
11121 {
11122 rtx regs;
11123
11124 if (REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
11125 return 0;
11126
11127 /* We only use "frame base" when we're sure we're talking about the
11128 post-prologue local stack frame. We do this by *not* running
11129 register elimination until this point, and recognizing the special
11130 argument pointer and soft frame pointer rtx's.
11131 Use DW_OP_fbreg offset DW_OP_stack_value in this case. */
11132 if ((rtl == arg_pointer_rtx || rtl == frame_pointer_rtx)
11133 && eliminate_regs (rtl, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX) != rtl)
11134 {
11135 dw_loc_descr_ref result = NULL;
11136
11137 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
11138 {
11139 result = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, GET_MODE (rtl), VOIDmode,
11140 initialized);
11141 if (result)
11142 add_loc_descr (&result,
11143 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
11144 }
11145 return result;
11146 }
11147
11148 regs = targetm.dwarf_register_span (rtl);
11149
11150 if (hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (rtl)][GET_MODE (rtl)] > 1 || regs)
11151 return multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, regs, initialized);
11152 else
11153 {
11154 unsigned int dbx_regnum = dbx_reg_number (rtl);
11155 if (dbx_regnum == IGNORED_DWARF_REGNUM)
11156 return 0;
11157 return one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_regnum, initialized);
11158 }
11159 }
11160
11161 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register for
11162 a given hard register number. */
11163
11164 static dw_loc_descr_ref
11165 one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int regno, enum var_init_status initialized)
11166 {
11167 dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descr;
11168
11169 if (regno <= 31)
11170 reg_loc_descr
11171 = new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_reg0 + regno), 0, 0);
11172 else
11173 reg_loc_descr = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, regno, 0);
11174
11175 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
11176 add_loc_descr (&reg_loc_descr, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
11177
11178 return reg_loc_descr;
11179 }
11180
11181 /* Given an RTL of a register, return a location descriptor that
11182 designates a value that spans more than one register. */
11183
11184 static dw_loc_descr_ref
11185 multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, rtx regs,
11186 enum var_init_status initialized)
11187 {
11188 int size, i;
11189 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
11190
11191 /* Simple, contiguous registers. */
11192 if (regs == NULL_RTX)
11193 {
11194 unsigned reg = REGNO (rtl);
11195 int nregs;
11196
11197 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
11198 if (crtl->uses_only_leaf_regs)
11199 {
11200 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (reg);
11201 if (leaf_reg != -1)
11202 reg = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
11203 }
11204 #endif
11205
11206 gcc_assert ((unsigned) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg) == dbx_reg_number (rtl));
11207 nregs = hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (rtl)][GET_MODE (rtl)];
11208
11209 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / nregs;
11210
11211 loc_result = NULL;
11212 while (nregs--)
11213 {
11214 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
11215
11216 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg),
11217 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11218 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
11219 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
11220 ++reg;
11221 }
11222 return loc_result;
11223 }
11224
11225 /* Now onto stupid register sets in non contiguous locations. */
11226
11227 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (regs) == PARALLEL);
11228
11229 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
11230 loc_result = NULL;
11231
11232 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (regs, 0); ++i)
11233 {
11234 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
11235
11236 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_reg_number (XVECEXP (regs, 0, i)),
11237 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11238 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
11239 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
11240 }
11241
11242 if (loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
11243 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
11244 return loc_result;
11245 }
11246
11247 static unsigned long size_of_int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT);
11248
11249 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a constant i,
11250 as a compound operation from constant (i >> shift), constant shift
11251 and DW_OP_shl. */
11252
11253 static dw_loc_descr_ref
11254 int_shift_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i, int shift)
11255 {
11256 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = int_loc_descriptor (i >> shift);
11257 add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
11258 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
11259 return ret;
11260 }
11261
11262 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a constant. */
11263
11264 static dw_loc_descr_ref
11265 int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i)
11266 {
11267 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
11268
11269 /* Pick the smallest representation of a constant, rather than just
11270 defaulting to the LEB encoding. */
11271 if (i >= 0)
11272 {
11273 int clz = clz_hwi (i);
11274 int ctz = ctz_hwi (i);
11275 if (i <= 31)
11276 op = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_lit0 + i);
11277 else if (i <= 0xff)
11278 op = DW_OP_const1u;
11279 else if (i <= 0xffff)
11280 op = DW_OP_const2u;
11281 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 5
11282 && clz + 5 + 255 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
11283 /* DW_OP_litX DW_OP_litY DW_OP_shl takes just 3 bytes and
11284 DW_OP_litX DW_OP_const1u Y DW_OP_shl takes just 4 bytes,
11285 while DW_OP_const4u is 5 bytes. */
11286 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 5);
11287 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 8
11288 && clz + 8 + 31 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
11289 /* DW_OP_const1u X DW_OP_litY DW_OP_shl takes just 4 bytes,
11290 while DW_OP_const4u is 5 bytes. */
11291 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 8);
11292 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i <= 0xffffffff)
11293 op = DW_OP_const4u;
11294 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 8
11295 && clz + 8 + 255 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
11296 /* DW_OP_const1u X DW_OP_const1u Y DW_OP_shl takes just 5 bytes,
11297 while DW_OP_constu of constant >= 0x100000000 takes at least
11298 6 bytes. */
11299 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 8);
11300 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 16
11301 && clz + 16 + (size_of_uleb128 (i) > 5 ? 255 : 31)
11302 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
11303 /* DW_OP_const2u X DW_OP_litY DW_OP_shl takes just 5 bytes,
11304 DW_OP_const2u X DW_OP_const1u Y DW_OP_shl takes 6 bytes,
11305 while DW_OP_constu takes in this case at least 6 bytes. */
11306 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 16);
11307 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 32
11308 && clz + 32 + 31 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
11309 && size_of_uleb128 (i) > 6)
11310 /* DW_OP_const4u X DW_OP_litY DW_OP_shl takes just 7 bytes. */
11311 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 32);
11312 else
11313 op = DW_OP_constu;
11314 }
11315 else
11316 {
11317 if (i >= -0x80)
11318 op = DW_OP_const1s;
11319 else if (i >= -0x8000)
11320 op = DW_OP_const2s;
11321 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i >= -0x80000000)
11322 {
11323 if (size_of_int_loc_descriptor (i) < 5)
11324 {
11325 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = int_loc_descriptor (-i);
11326 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_neg, 0, 0));
11327 return ret;
11328 }
11329 op = DW_OP_const4s;
11330 }
11331 else
11332 {
11333 if (size_of_int_loc_descriptor (i)
11334 < (unsigned long) 1 + size_of_sleb128 (i))
11335 {
11336 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = int_loc_descriptor (-i);
11337 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_neg, 0, 0));
11338 return ret;
11339 }
11340 op = DW_OP_consts;
11341 }
11342 }
11343
11344 return new_loc_descr (op, i, 0);
11345 }
11346
11347 /* Return size_of_locs (int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, shift))
11348 without actually allocating it. */
11349
11350 static unsigned long
11351 size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i, int shift)
11352 {
11353 return size_of_int_loc_descriptor (i >> shift)
11354 + size_of_int_loc_descriptor (shift)
11355 + 1;
11356 }
11357
11358 /* Return size_of_locs (int_loc_descriptor (i)) without
11359 actually allocating it. */
11360
11361 static unsigned long
11362 size_of_int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i)
11363 {
11364 unsigned long s;
11365
11366 if (i >= 0)
11367 {
11368 int clz, ctz;
11369 if (i <= 31)
11370 return 1;
11371 else if (i <= 0xff)
11372 return 2;
11373 else if (i <= 0xffff)
11374 return 3;
11375 clz = clz_hwi (i);
11376 ctz = ctz_hwi (i);
11377 if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 5
11378 && clz + 5 + 255 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
11379 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
11380 - clz - 5);
11381 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 8
11382 && clz + 8 + 31 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
11383 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
11384 - clz - 8);
11385 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i <= 0xffffffff)
11386 return 5;
11387 s = size_of_uleb128 ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i);
11388 if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 8
11389 && clz + 8 + 255 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
11390 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
11391 - clz - 8);
11392 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 16
11393 && clz + 16 + (s > 5 ? 255 : 31) >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
11394 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
11395 - clz - 16);
11396 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 32
11397 && clz + 32 + 31 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
11398 && s > 6)
11399 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
11400 - clz - 32);
11401 else
11402 return 1 + s;
11403 }
11404 else
11405 {
11406 if (i >= -0x80)
11407 return 2;
11408 else if (i >= -0x8000)
11409 return 3;
11410 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i >= -0x80000000)
11411 {
11412 if (-(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i != (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i)
11413 {
11414 s = size_of_int_loc_descriptor (-i) + 1;
11415 if (s < 5)
11416 return s;
11417 }
11418 return 5;
11419 }
11420 else
11421 {
11422 unsigned long r = 1 + size_of_sleb128 (i);
11423 if (-(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i != (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i)
11424 {
11425 s = size_of_int_loc_descriptor (-i) + 1;
11426 if (s < r)
11427 return s;
11428 }
11429 return r;
11430 }
11431 }
11432 }
11433
11434 /* Return loc description representing "address" of integer value.
11435 This can appear only as toplevel expression. */
11436
11437 static dw_loc_descr_ref
11438 address_of_int_loc_descriptor (int size, HOST_WIDE_INT i)
11439 {
11440 int litsize;
11441 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
11442
11443 if (!(dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
11444 return NULL;
11445
11446 litsize = size_of_int_loc_descriptor (i);
11447 /* Determine if DW_OP_stack_value or DW_OP_implicit_value
11448 is more compact. For DW_OP_stack_value we need:
11449 litsize + 1 (DW_OP_stack_value)
11450 and for DW_OP_implicit_value:
11451 1 (DW_OP_implicit_value) + 1 (length) + size. */
11452 if ((int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE >= size && litsize + 1 <= 1 + 1 + size)
11453 {
11454 loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (i);
11455 add_loc_descr (&loc_result,
11456 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
11457 return loc_result;
11458 }
11459
11460 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
11461 size, 0);
11462 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
11463 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int = i;
11464 return loc_result;
11465 }
11466
11467 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a base+offset location. */
11468
11469 static dw_loc_descr_ref
11470 based_loc_descr (rtx reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset,
11471 enum var_init_status initialized)
11472 {
11473 unsigned int regno;
11474 dw_loc_descr_ref result;
11475 dw_fde_ref fde = cfun->fde;
11476
11477 /* We only use "frame base" when we're sure we're talking about the
11478 post-prologue local stack frame. We do this by *not* running
11479 register elimination until this point, and recognizing the special
11480 argument pointer and soft frame pointer rtx's. */
11481 if (reg == arg_pointer_rtx || reg == frame_pointer_rtx)
11482 {
11483 rtx elim = (ira_use_lra_p
11484 ? lra_eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX)
11485 : eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX));
11486
11487 if (elim != reg)
11488 {
11489 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
11490 {
11491 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
11492 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
11493 }
11494 gcc_assert ((SUPPORTS_STACK_ALIGNMENT
11495 && (elim == hard_frame_pointer_rtx
11496 || elim == stack_pointer_rtx))
11497 || elim == (frame_pointer_needed
11498 ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
11499 : stack_pointer_rtx));
11500
11501 /* If drap register is used to align stack, use frame
11502 pointer + offset to access stack variables. If stack
11503 is aligned without drap, use stack pointer + offset to
11504 access stack variables. */
11505 if (crtl->stack_realign_tried
11506 && reg == frame_pointer_rtx)
11507 {
11508 int base_reg
11509 = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM ((fde && fde->drap_reg != INVALID_REGNUM)
11510 ? HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
11511 : REGNO (elim));
11512 return new_reg_loc_descr (base_reg, offset);
11513 }
11514
11515 gcc_assert (frame_pointer_fb_offset_valid);
11516 offset += frame_pointer_fb_offset;
11517 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, offset, 0);
11518 }
11519 }
11520
11521 regno = REGNO (reg);
11522 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
11523 if (crtl->uses_only_leaf_regs)
11524 {
11525 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (regno);
11526 if (leaf_reg != -1)
11527 regno = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
11528 }
11529 #endif
11530 regno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (regno);
11531
11532 if (!optimize && fde
11533 && (fde->drap_reg == regno || fde->vdrap_reg == regno))
11534 {
11535 /* Use cfa+offset to represent the location of arguments passed
11536 on the stack when drap is used to align stack.
11537 Only do this when not optimizing, for optimized code var-tracking
11538 is supposed to track where the arguments live and the register
11539 used as vdrap or drap in some spot might be used for something
11540 else in other part of the routine. */
11541 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, offset, 0);
11542 }
11543
11544 if (regno <= 31)
11545 result = new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + regno),
11546 offset, 0);
11547 else
11548 result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, regno, offset);
11549
11550 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
11551 add_loc_descr (&result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
11552
11553 return result;
11554 }
11555
11556 /* Return true if this RTL expression describes a base+offset calculation. */
11557
11558 static inline int
11559 is_based_loc (const_rtx rtl)
11560 {
11561 return (GET_CODE (rtl) == PLUS
11562 && ((REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
11563 && REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
11564 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))));
11565 }
11566
11567 /* Try to handle TLS MEMs, for which mem_loc_descriptor on XEXP (mem, 0)
11568 failed. */
11569
11570 static dw_loc_descr_ref
11571 tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtx mem)
11572 {
11573 tree base;
11574 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result;
11575
11576 if (MEM_EXPR (mem) == NULL_TREE || !MEM_OFFSET_KNOWN_P (mem))
11577 return NULL;
11578
11579 base = get_base_address (MEM_EXPR (mem));
11580 if (base == NULL
11581 || TREE_CODE (base) != VAR_DECL
11582 || !DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (base))
11583 return NULL;
11584
11585 loc_result = loc_descriptor_from_tree (MEM_EXPR (mem), 1, NULL);
11586 if (loc_result == NULL)
11587 return NULL;
11588
11589 if (MEM_OFFSET (mem))
11590 loc_descr_plus_const (&loc_result, MEM_OFFSET (mem));
11591
11592 return loc_result;
11593 }
11594
11595 /* Output debug info about reason why we failed to expand expression as dwarf
11596 expression. */
11597
11598 static void
11599 expansion_failed (tree expr, rtx rtl, char const *reason)
11600 {
11601 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
11602 {
11603 fprintf (dump_file, "Failed to expand as dwarf: ");
11604 if (expr)
11605 print_generic_expr (dump_file, expr, dump_flags);
11606 if (rtl)
11607 {
11608 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
11609 print_rtl (dump_file, rtl);
11610 }
11611 fprintf (dump_file, "\nReason: %s\n", reason);
11612 }
11613 }
11614
11615 /* Helper function for const_ok_for_output. */
11616
11617 static bool
11618 const_ok_for_output_1 (rtx rtl)
11619 {
11620 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == UNSPEC)
11621 {
11622 /* If delegitimize_address couldn't do anything with the UNSPEC, assume
11623 we can't express it in the debug info. */
11624 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
11625 /* Don't complain about TLS UNSPECs, those are just too hard to
11626 delegitimize. Note this could be a non-decl SYMBOL_REF such as
11627 one in a constant pool entry, so testing SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL
11628 rather than DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P is not just an optimization. */
11629 if (XVECLEN (rtl, 0) == 0
11630 || GET_CODE (XVECEXP (rtl, 0, 0)) != SYMBOL_REF
11631 || SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (XVECEXP (rtl, 0, 0)) == TLS_MODEL_NONE)
11632 inform (current_function_decl
11633 ? DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (current_function_decl)
11634 : UNKNOWN_LOCATION,
11635 #if NUM_UNSPEC_VALUES > 0
11636 "non-delegitimized UNSPEC %s (%d) found in variable location",
11637 ((XINT (rtl, 1) >= 0 && XINT (rtl, 1) < NUM_UNSPEC_VALUES)
11638 ? unspec_strings[XINT (rtl, 1)] : "unknown"),
11639 XINT (rtl, 1));
11640 #else
11641 "non-delegitimized UNSPEC %d found in variable location",
11642 XINT (rtl, 1));
11643 #endif
11644 #endif
11645 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
11646 "UNSPEC hasn't been delegitimized.\n");
11647 return false;
11648 }
11649
11650 if (targetm.const_not_ok_for_debug_p (rtl))
11651 {
11652 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
11653 "Expression rejected for debug by the backend.\n");
11654 return false;
11655 }
11656
11657 /* FIXME: Refer to PR60655. It is possible for simplification
11658 of rtl expressions in var tracking to produce such expressions.
11659 We should really identify / validate expressions
11660 enclosed in CONST that can be handled by assemblers on various
11661 targets and only handle legitimate cases here. */
11662 if (GET_CODE (rtl) != SYMBOL_REF)
11663 {
11664 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == NOT)
11665 return false;
11666 return true;
11667 }
11668
11669 if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
11670 {
11671 bool marked;
11672 get_pool_constant_mark (rtl, &marked);
11673 /* If all references to this pool constant were optimized away,
11674 it was not output and thus we can't represent it. */
11675 if (!marked)
11676 {
11677 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
11678 "Constant was removed from constant pool.\n");
11679 return false;
11680 }
11681 }
11682
11683 if (SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (rtl) != TLS_MODEL_NONE)
11684 return false;
11685
11686 /* Avoid references to external symbols in debug info, on several targets
11687 the linker might even refuse to link when linking a shared library,
11688 and in many other cases the relocations for .debug_info/.debug_loc are
11689 dropped, so the address becomes zero anyway. Hidden symbols, guaranteed
11690 to be defined within the same shared library or executable are fine. */
11691 if (SYMBOL_REF_EXTERNAL_P (rtl))
11692 {
11693 tree decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl);
11694
11695 if (decl == NULL || !targetm.binds_local_p (decl))
11696 {
11697 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
11698 "Symbol not defined in current TU.\n");
11699 return false;
11700 }
11701 }
11702
11703 return true;
11704 }
11705
11706 /* Return true if constant RTL can be emitted in DW_OP_addr or
11707 DW_AT_const_value. TLS SYMBOL_REFs, external SYMBOL_REFs or
11708 non-marked constant pool SYMBOL_REFs can't be referenced in it. */
11709
11710 static bool
11711 const_ok_for_output (rtx rtl)
11712 {
11713 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF)
11714 return const_ok_for_output_1 (rtl);
11715
11716 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST)
11717 {
11718 subrtx_var_iterator::array_type array;
11719 FOR_EACH_SUBRTX_VAR (iter, array, XEXP (rtl, 0), ALL)
11720 if (!const_ok_for_output_1 (*iter))
11721 return false;
11722 return true;
11723 }
11724
11725 return true;
11726 }
11727
11728 /* Return a reference to DW_TAG_base_type corresponding to MODE and UNSIGNEDP
11729 if possible, NULL otherwise. */
11730
11731 static dw_die_ref
11732 base_type_for_mode (machine_mode mode, bool unsignedp)
11733 {
11734 dw_die_ref type_die;
11735 tree type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (mode, unsignedp);
11736
11737 if (type == NULL)
11738 return NULL;
11739 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
11740 {
11741 case INTEGER_TYPE:
11742 case REAL_TYPE:
11743 break;
11744 default:
11745 return NULL;
11746 }
11747 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
11748 if (!type_die)
11749 type_die = modified_type_die (type, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, comp_unit_die ());
11750 if (type_die == NULL || type_die->die_tag != DW_TAG_base_type)
11751 return NULL;
11752 return type_die;
11753 }
11754
11755 /* For OP descriptor assumed to be in unsigned MODE, convert it to a unsigned
11756 type matching MODE, or, if MODE is narrower than or as wide as
11757 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, untyped. Return NULL if the conversion is not
11758 possible. */
11759
11760 static dw_loc_descr_ref
11761 convert_descriptor_to_mode (machine_mode mode, dw_loc_descr_ref op)
11762 {
11763 machine_mode outer_mode = mode;
11764 dw_die_ref type_die;
11765 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
11766
11767 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
11768 {
11769 add_loc_descr (&op, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0));
11770 return op;
11771 }
11772 type_die = base_type_for_mode (outer_mode, 1);
11773 if (type_die == NULL)
11774 return NULL;
11775 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
11776 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
11777 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
11778 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
11779 add_loc_descr (&op, cvt);
11780 return op;
11781 }
11782
11783 /* Return location descriptor for comparison OP with operands OP0 and OP1. */
11784
11785 static dw_loc_descr_ref
11786 compare_loc_descriptor (enum dwarf_location_atom op, dw_loc_descr_ref op0,
11787 dw_loc_descr_ref op1)
11788 {
11789 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = op0;
11790 add_loc_descr (&ret, op1);
11791 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
11792 if (STORE_FLAG_VALUE != 1)
11793 {
11794 add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (STORE_FLAG_VALUE));
11795 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
11796 }
11797 return ret;
11798 }
11799
11800 /* Return location descriptor for signed comparison OP RTL. */
11801
11802 static dw_loc_descr_ref
11803 scompare_loc_descriptor (enum dwarf_location_atom op, rtx rtl,
11804 machine_mode mem_mode)
11805 {
11806 machine_mode op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0));
11807 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1;
11808 int shift;
11809
11810 if (op_mode == VOIDmode)
11811 op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 1));
11812 if (op_mode == VOIDmode)
11813 return NULL;
11814
11815 if (dwarf_strict
11816 && (GET_MODE_CLASS (op_mode) != MODE_INT
11817 || GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
11818 return NULL;
11819
11820 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), op_mode, mem_mode,
11821 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11822 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), op_mode, mem_mode,
11823 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11824
11825 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
11826 return NULL;
11827
11828 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (op_mode) != MODE_INT
11829 || GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
11830 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
11831
11832 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
11833 {
11834 dw_die_ref type_die = base_type_for_mode (op_mode, 0);
11835 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
11836
11837 if (type_die == NULL)
11838 return NULL;
11839 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
11840 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
11841 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
11842 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
11843 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
11844 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
11845 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
11846 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
11847 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
11848 add_loc_descr (&op1, cvt);
11849 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
11850 }
11851
11852 shift = (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
11853 /* For eq/ne, if the operands are known to be zero-extended,
11854 there is no need to do the fancy shifting up. */
11855 if (op == DW_OP_eq || op == DW_OP_ne)
11856 {
11857 dw_loc_descr_ref last0, last1;
11858 for (last0 = op0; last0->dw_loc_next != NULL; last0 = last0->dw_loc_next)
11859 ;
11860 for (last1 = op1; last1->dw_loc_next != NULL; last1 = last1->dw_loc_next)
11861 ;
11862 /* deref_size zero extends, and for constants we can check
11863 whether they are zero extended or not. */
11864 if (((last0->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_deref_size
11865 && last0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int <= GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
11866 || (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
11867 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 0))
11868 == (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 0)) & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode))))
11869 && ((last1->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_deref_size
11870 && last1->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int <= GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
11871 || (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
11872 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
11873 == (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode)))))
11874 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
11875
11876 /* EQ/NE comparison against constant in narrower type than
11877 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE can be performed either as
11878 DW_OP_const1u <shift> DW_OP_shl DW_OP_const* <cst << shift>
11879 DW_OP_{eq,ne}
11880 or
11881 DW_OP_const*u <mode_mask> DW_OP_and DW_OP_const* <cst & mode_mask>
11882 DW_OP_{eq,ne}. Pick whatever is shorter. */
11883 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
11884 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (op_mode) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
11885 && (size_of_int_loc_descriptor (shift) + 1
11886 + size_of_int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) << shift)
11887 >= size_of_int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode)) + 1
11888 + size_of_int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
11889 & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode))))
11890 {
11891 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode)));
11892 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
11893 op1 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
11894 & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode));
11895 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
11896 }
11897 }
11898 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
11899 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
11900 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
11901 op1 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) << shift);
11902 else
11903 {
11904 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
11905 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
11906 }
11907 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
11908 }
11909
11910 /* Return location descriptor for unsigned comparison OP RTL. */
11911
11912 static dw_loc_descr_ref
11913 ucompare_loc_descriptor (enum dwarf_location_atom op, rtx rtl,
11914 machine_mode mem_mode)
11915 {
11916 machine_mode op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0));
11917 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1;
11918
11919 if (op_mode == VOIDmode)
11920 op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 1));
11921 if (op_mode == VOIDmode)
11922 return NULL;
11923 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (op_mode) != MODE_INT)
11924 return NULL;
11925
11926 if (dwarf_strict && GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
11927 return NULL;
11928
11929 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), op_mode, mem_mode,
11930 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11931 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), op_mode, mem_mode,
11932 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11933
11934 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
11935 return NULL;
11936
11937 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
11938 {
11939 HOST_WIDE_INT mask = GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode);
11940 dw_loc_descr_ref last0, last1;
11941 for (last0 = op0; last0->dw_loc_next != NULL; last0 = last0->dw_loc_next)
11942 ;
11943 for (last1 = op1; last1->dw_loc_next != NULL; last1 = last1->dw_loc_next)
11944 ;
11945 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
11946 op0 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 0)) & mask);
11947 /* deref_size zero extends, so no need to mask it again. */
11948 else if (last0->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_deref_size
11949 || last0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int > GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
11950 {
11951 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
11952 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
11953 }
11954 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
11955 op1 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) & mask);
11956 /* deref_size zero extends, so no need to mask it again. */
11957 else if (last1->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_deref_size
11958 || last1->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int > GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
11959 {
11960 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
11961 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
11962 }
11963 }
11964 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
11965 {
11966 HOST_WIDE_INT bias = 1;
11967 bias <<= (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * BITS_PER_UNIT - 1);
11968 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
11969 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
11970 op1 = int_loc_descriptor ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) bias
11971 + INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
11972 else
11973 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
11974 bias, 0));
11975 }
11976 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
11977 }
11978
11979 /* Return location descriptor for {U,S}{MIN,MAX}. */
11980
11981 static dw_loc_descr_ref
11982 minmax_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, machine_mode mode,
11983 machine_mode mem_mode)
11984 {
11985 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
11986 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1, ret;
11987 dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, drop_node;
11988
11989 if (dwarf_strict
11990 && (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
11991 || GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
11992 return NULL;
11993
11994 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
11995 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11996 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
11997 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11998
11999 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
12000 return NULL;
12001
12002 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
12003 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
12004 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
12005 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == UMIN || GET_CODE (rtl) == UMAX)
12006 {
12007 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
12008 {
12009 HOST_WIDE_INT mask = GET_MODE_MASK (mode);
12010 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
12011 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
12012 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
12013 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
12014 }
12015 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
12016 {
12017 HOST_WIDE_INT bias = 1;
12018 bias <<= (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * BITS_PER_UNIT - 1);
12019 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
12020 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
12021 }
12022 }
12023 else if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
12024 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
12025 {
12026 int shift = (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
12027 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
12028 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
12029 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
12030 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
12031 }
12032 else if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
12033 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
12034 {
12035 dw_die_ref type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, 0);
12036 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
12037 if (type_die == NULL)
12038 return NULL;
12039 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
12040 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
12041 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
12042 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
12043 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
12044 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
12045 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
12046 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
12047 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
12048 add_loc_descr (&op1, cvt);
12049 }
12050
12051 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SMIN || GET_CODE (rtl) == UMIN)
12052 op = DW_OP_lt;
12053 else
12054 op = DW_OP_gt;
12055 ret = op0;
12056 add_loc_descr (&ret, op1);
12057 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
12058 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
12059 add_loc_descr (&ret, bra_node);
12060 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
12061 drop_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
12062 add_loc_descr (&ret, drop_node);
12063 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
12064 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = drop_node;
12065 if ((GET_CODE (rtl) == SMIN || GET_CODE (rtl) == SMAX)
12066 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
12067 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
12068 ret = convert_descriptor_to_mode (mode, ret);
12069 return ret;
12070 }
12071
12072 /* Helper function for mem_loc_descriptor. Perform OP binary op,
12073 but after converting arguments to type_die, afterwards
12074 convert back to unsigned. */
12075
12076 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12077 typed_binop (enum dwarf_location_atom op, rtx rtl, dw_die_ref type_die,
12078 machine_mode mode, machine_mode mem_mode)
12079 {
12080 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt, op0, op1;
12081
12082 if (type_die == NULL)
12083 return NULL;
12084 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
12085 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12086 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
12087 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12088 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
12089 return NULL;
12090 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
12091 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
12092 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
12093 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
12094 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
12095 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
12096 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
12097 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
12098 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
12099 add_loc_descr (&op1, cvt);
12100 add_loc_descr (&op0, op1);
12101 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
12102 return convert_descriptor_to_mode (mode, op0);
12103 }
12104
12105 /* CLZ (where constV is CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO computed value,
12106 const0 is DW_OP_lit0 or corresponding typed constant,
12107 const1 is DW_OP_lit1 or corresponding typed constant
12108 and constMSB is constant with just the MSB bit set
12109 for the mode):
12110 DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L1> DW_OP_drop constV DW_OP_skip <L4>
12111 L1: const0 DW_OP_swap
12112 L2: DW_OP_dup constMSB DW_OP_and DW_OP_bra <L3> const1 DW_OP_shl
12113 DW_OP_swap DW_OP_plus_uconst <1> DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L2>
12114 L3: DW_OP_drop
12115 L4: DW_OP_nop
12116
12117 CTZ is similar:
12118 DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L1> DW_OP_drop constV DW_OP_skip <L4>
12119 L1: const0 DW_OP_swap
12120 L2: DW_OP_dup const1 DW_OP_and DW_OP_bra <L3> const1 DW_OP_shr
12121 DW_OP_swap DW_OP_plus_uconst <1> DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L2>
12122 L3: DW_OP_drop
12123 L4: DW_OP_nop
12124
12125 FFS is similar:
12126 DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L1> DW_OP_drop const0 DW_OP_skip <L4>
12127 L1: const1 DW_OP_swap
12128 L2: DW_OP_dup const1 DW_OP_and DW_OP_bra <L3> const1 DW_OP_shr
12129 DW_OP_swap DW_OP_plus_uconst <1> DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L2>
12130 L3: DW_OP_drop
12131 L4: DW_OP_nop */
12132
12133 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12134 clz_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, machine_mode mode,
12135 machine_mode mem_mode)
12136 {
12137 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, ret, tmp;
12138 HOST_WIDE_INT valv;
12139 dw_loc_descr_ref l1jump, l1label;
12140 dw_loc_descr_ref l2jump, l2label;
12141 dw_loc_descr_ref l3jump, l3label;
12142 dw_loc_descr_ref l4jump, l4label;
12143 rtx msb;
12144
12145 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
12146 || GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != mode)
12147 return NULL;
12148
12149 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
12150 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12151 if (op0 == NULL)
12152 return NULL;
12153 ret = op0;
12154 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CLZ)
12155 {
12156 if (!CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (mode, valv))
12157 valv = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
12158 }
12159 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == FFS)
12160 valv = 0;
12161 else if (!CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (mode, valv))
12162 valv = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
12163 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
12164 l1jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
12165 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1jump);
12166 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0));
12167 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (valv), mode, mem_mode,
12168 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12169 if (tmp == NULL)
12170 return NULL;
12171 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
12172 l4jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
12173 add_loc_descr (&ret, l4jump);
12174 l1label = mem_loc_descriptor (GET_CODE (rtl) == FFS
12175 ? const1_rtx : const0_rtx,
12176 mode, mem_mode,
12177 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12178 if (l1label == NULL)
12179 return NULL;
12180 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1label);
12181 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
12182 l2label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
12183 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2label);
12184 if (GET_CODE (rtl) != CLZ)
12185 msb = const1_rtx;
12186 else if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
12187 msb = GEN_INT ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1
12188 << (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 1));
12189 else
12190 msb = immed_wide_int_const
12191 (wi::set_bit_in_zero (GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) - 1,
12192 GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode)), mode);
12193 if (GET_CODE (msb) == CONST_INT && INTVAL (msb) < 0)
12194 tmp = new_loc_descr (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
12195 ? DW_OP_const4u : HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 64
12196 ? DW_OP_const8u : DW_OP_constu, INTVAL (msb), 0);
12197 else
12198 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (msb, mode, mem_mode,
12199 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12200 if (tmp == NULL)
12201 return NULL;
12202 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
12203 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
12204 l3jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
12205 add_loc_descr (&ret, l3jump);
12206 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const1_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
12207 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12208 if (tmp == NULL)
12209 return NULL;
12210 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
12211 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (GET_CODE (rtl) == CLZ
12212 ? DW_OP_shl : DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
12213 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
12214 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, 1, 0));
12215 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
12216 l2jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
12217 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2jump);
12218 l3label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
12219 add_loc_descr (&ret, l3label);
12220 l4label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
12221 add_loc_descr (&ret, l4label);
12222 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
12223 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l1label;
12224 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
12225 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l2label;
12226 l3jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
12227 l3jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l3label;
12228 l4jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
12229 l4jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l4label;
12230 return ret;
12231 }
12232
12233 /* POPCOUNT (const0 is DW_OP_lit0 or corresponding typed constant,
12234 const1 is DW_OP_lit1 or corresponding typed constant):
12235 const0 DW_OP_swap
12236 L1: DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L2> DW_OP_dup DW_OP_rot const1 DW_OP_and
12237 DW_OP_plus DW_OP_swap const1 DW_OP_shr DW_OP_skip <L1>
12238 L2: DW_OP_drop
12239
12240 PARITY is similar:
12241 L1: DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L2> DW_OP_dup DW_OP_rot const1 DW_OP_and
12242 DW_OP_xor DW_OP_swap const1 DW_OP_shr DW_OP_skip <L1>
12243 L2: DW_OP_drop */
12244
12245 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12246 popcount_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, machine_mode mode,
12247 machine_mode mem_mode)
12248 {
12249 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, ret, tmp;
12250 dw_loc_descr_ref l1jump, l1label;
12251 dw_loc_descr_ref l2jump, l2label;
12252
12253 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
12254 || GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != mode)
12255 return NULL;
12256
12257 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
12258 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12259 if (op0 == NULL)
12260 return NULL;
12261 ret = op0;
12262 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const0_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
12263 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12264 if (tmp == NULL)
12265 return NULL;
12266 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
12267 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
12268 l1label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
12269 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1label);
12270 l2jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
12271 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2jump);
12272 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
12273 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_rot, 0, 0));
12274 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const1_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
12275 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12276 if (tmp == NULL)
12277 return NULL;
12278 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
12279 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
12280 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (GET_CODE (rtl) == POPCOUNT
12281 ? DW_OP_plus : DW_OP_xor, 0, 0));
12282 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
12283 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const1_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
12284 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12285 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
12286 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
12287 l1jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
12288 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1jump);
12289 l2label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
12290 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2label);
12291 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
12292 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l1label;
12293 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
12294 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l2label;
12295 return ret;
12296 }
12297
12298 /* BSWAP (constS is initial shift count, either 56 or 24):
12299 constS const0
12300 L1: DW_OP_pick <2> constS DW_OP_pick <3> DW_OP_minus DW_OP_shr
12301 const255 DW_OP_and DW_OP_pick <2> DW_OP_shl DW_OP_or
12302 DW_OP_swap DW_OP_dup const0 DW_OP_eq DW_OP_bra <L2> const8
12303 DW_OP_minus DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L1>
12304 L2: DW_OP_drop DW_OP_swap DW_OP_drop */
12305
12306 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12307 bswap_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, machine_mode mode,
12308 machine_mode mem_mode)
12309 {
12310 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, ret, tmp;
12311 dw_loc_descr_ref l1jump, l1label;
12312 dw_loc_descr_ref l2jump, l2label;
12313
12314 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
12315 || BITS_PER_UNIT != 8
12316 || (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) != 32
12317 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) != 64))
12318 return NULL;
12319
12320 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
12321 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12322 if (op0 == NULL)
12323 return NULL;
12324
12325 ret = op0;
12326 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 8),
12327 mode, mem_mode,
12328 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12329 if (tmp == NULL)
12330 return NULL;
12331 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
12332 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const0_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
12333 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12334 if (tmp == NULL)
12335 return NULL;
12336 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
12337 l1label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, 2, 0);
12338 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1label);
12339 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 8),
12340 mode, mem_mode,
12341 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12342 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
12343 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, 3, 0));
12344 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
12345 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
12346 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (255), mode, mem_mode,
12347 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12348 if (tmp == NULL)
12349 return NULL;
12350 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
12351 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
12352 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, 2, 0));
12353 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
12354 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_or, 0, 0));
12355 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
12356 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
12357 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const0_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
12358 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12359 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
12360 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_eq, 0, 0));
12361 l2jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
12362 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2jump);
12363 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (8), mode, mem_mode,
12364 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12365 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
12366 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
12367 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
12368 l1jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
12369 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1jump);
12370 l2label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
12371 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2label);
12372 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
12373 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0));
12374 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
12375 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l1label;
12376 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
12377 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l2label;
12378 return ret;
12379 }
12380
12381 /* ROTATE (constMASK is mode mask, BITSIZE is bitsize of mode):
12382 DW_OP_over DW_OP_over DW_OP_shl [ constMASK DW_OP_and ] DW_OP_rot
12383 [ DW_OP_swap constMASK DW_OP_and DW_OP_swap ] DW_OP_neg
12384 DW_OP_plus_uconst <BITSIZE> DW_OP_shr DW_OP_or
12385
12386 ROTATERT is similar:
12387 DW_OP_over DW_OP_over DW_OP_neg DW_OP_plus_uconst <BITSIZE>
12388 DW_OP_shl [ constMASK DW_OP_and ] DW_OP_rot
12389 [ DW_OP_swap constMASK DW_OP_and DW_OP_swap ] DW_OP_shr DW_OP_or */
12390
12391 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12392 rotate_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, machine_mode mode,
12393 machine_mode mem_mode)
12394 {
12395 rtx rtlop1 = XEXP (rtl, 1);
12396 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1, ret, mask[2] = { NULL, NULL };
12397 int i;
12398
12399 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT)
12400 return NULL;
12401
12402 if (GET_MODE (rtlop1) != VOIDmode
12403 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (rtlop1)) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode))
12404 rtlop1 = gen_rtx_ZERO_EXTEND (mode, rtlop1);
12405 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
12406 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12407 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (rtlop1, mode, mem_mode,
12408 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12409 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
12410 return NULL;
12411 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
12412 for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
12413 {
12414 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
12415 mask[i] = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (GET_MODE_MASK (mode)),
12416 mode, mem_mode,
12417 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12418 else if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
12419 mask[i] = new_loc_descr (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
12420 ? DW_OP_const4u
12421 : HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 64
12422 ? DW_OP_const8u : DW_OP_constu,
12423 GET_MODE_MASK (mode), 0);
12424 else
12425 mask[i] = NULL;
12426 if (mask[i] == NULL)
12427 return NULL;
12428 add_loc_descr (&mask[i], new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
12429 }
12430 ret = op0;
12431 add_loc_descr (&ret, op1);
12432 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
12433 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
12434 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == ROTATERT)
12435 {
12436 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_neg, 0, 0));
12437 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
12438 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode), 0));
12439 }
12440 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
12441 if (mask[0] != NULL)
12442 add_loc_descr (&ret, mask[0]);
12443 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_rot, 0, 0));
12444 if (mask[1] != NULL)
12445 {
12446 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
12447 add_loc_descr (&ret, mask[1]);
12448 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
12449 }
12450 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == ROTATE)
12451 {
12452 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_neg, 0, 0));
12453 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
12454 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode), 0));
12455 }
12456 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
12457 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_or, 0, 0));
12458 return ret;
12459 }
12460
12461 /* Helper function for mem_loc_descriptor. Return DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref
12462 for DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF RTL. */
12463
12464 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12465 parameter_ref_descriptor (rtx rtl)
12466 {
12467 dw_loc_descr_ref ret;
12468 dw_die_ref ref;
12469
12470 if (dwarf_strict)
12471 return NULL;
12472 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF_DECL (rtl)) == PARM_DECL);
12473 ref = lookup_decl_die (DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF_DECL (rtl));
12474 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref, 0, 0);
12475 if (ref)
12476 {
12477 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
12478 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
12479 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
12480 }
12481 else
12482 {
12483 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_decl_ref;
12484 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref = DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF_DECL (rtl);
12485 }
12486 return ret;
12487 }
12488
12489 /* The following routine converts the RTL for a variable or parameter
12490 (resident in memory) into an equivalent Dwarf representation of a
12491 mechanism for getting the address of that same variable onto the top of a
12492 hypothetical "address evaluation" stack.
12493
12494 When creating memory location descriptors, we are effectively transforming
12495 the RTL for a memory-resident object into its Dwarf postfix expression
12496 equivalent. This routine recursively descends an RTL tree, turning
12497 it into Dwarf postfix code as it goes.
12498
12499 MODE is the mode that should be assumed for the rtl if it is VOIDmode.
12500
12501 MEM_MODE is the mode of the memory reference, needed to handle some
12502 autoincrement addressing modes.
12503
12504 Return 0 if we can't represent the location. */
12505
12506 dw_loc_descr_ref
12507 mem_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, machine_mode mode,
12508 machine_mode mem_mode,
12509 enum var_init_status initialized)
12510 {
12511 dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_result = NULL;
12512 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
12513 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1;
12514 rtx inner = NULL_RTX;
12515
12516 if (mode == VOIDmode)
12517 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
12518
12519 /* Note that for a dynamically sized array, the location we will generate a
12520 description of here will be the lowest numbered location which is
12521 actually within the array. That's *not* necessarily the same as the
12522 zeroth element of the array. */
12523
12524 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
12525
12526 if (mode != GET_MODE (rtl) && GET_MODE (rtl) != VOIDmode)
12527 return NULL;
12528
12529 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
12530 {
12531 case POST_INC:
12532 case POST_DEC:
12533 case POST_MODIFY:
12534 return mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode, initialized);
12535
12536 case SUBREG:
12537 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
12538 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
12539 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
12540 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
12541 contains the given subreg. */
12542 if (!subreg_lowpart_p (rtl))
12543 break;
12544 inner = SUBREG_REG (rtl);
12545 case TRUNCATE:
12546 if (inner == NULL_RTX)
12547 inner = XEXP (rtl, 0);
12548 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
12549 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (inner)) == MODE_INT
12550 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
12551 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
12552 || (mode == Pmode && mem_mode != VOIDmode)
12553 #endif
12554 )
12555 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (inner)) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
12556 {
12557 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (inner,
12558 GET_MODE (inner),
12559 mem_mode, initialized);
12560 break;
12561 }
12562 if (dwarf_strict)
12563 break;
12564 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (inner)))
12565 break;
12566 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) != GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (inner))
12567 && (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
12568 || GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (inner)) != MODE_INT))
12569 break;
12570 else
12571 {
12572 dw_die_ref type_die;
12573 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
12574
12575 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (inner,
12576 GET_MODE (inner),
12577 mem_mode, initialized);
12578 if (mem_loc_result == NULL)
12579 break;
12580 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode,
12581 GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT);
12582 if (type_die == NULL)
12583 {
12584 mem_loc_result = NULL;
12585 break;
12586 }
12587 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)
12588 != GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (inner)))
12589 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
12590 else
12591 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret, 0, 0);
12592 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
12593 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
12594 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
12595 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, cvt);
12596 }
12597 break;
12598
12599 case REG:
12600 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
12601 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
12602 && rtl != arg_pointer_rtx
12603 && rtl != frame_pointer_rtx
12604 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
12605 && (mode != Pmode || mem_mode == VOIDmode)
12606 #endif
12607 ))
12608 {
12609 dw_die_ref type_die;
12610 unsigned int dbx_regnum;
12611
12612 if (dwarf_strict)
12613 break;
12614 if (REGNO (rtl) > FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
12615 break;
12616 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode,
12617 GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT);
12618 if (type_die == NULL)
12619 break;
12620
12621 dbx_regnum = dbx_reg_number (rtl);
12622 if (dbx_regnum == IGNORED_DWARF_REGNUM)
12623 break;
12624 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_regval_type,
12625 dbx_regnum, 0);
12626 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
12627 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
12628 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
12629 break;
12630 }
12631 /* Whenever a register number forms a part of the description of the
12632 method for calculating the (dynamic) address of a memory resident
12633 object, DWARF rules require the register number be referred to as
12634 a "base register". This distinction is not based in any way upon
12635 what category of register the hardware believes the given register
12636 belongs to. This is strictly DWARF terminology we're dealing with
12637 here. Note that in cases where the location of a memory-resident
12638 data object could be expressed as: OP_ADD (OP_BASEREG (basereg),
12639 OP_CONST (0)) the actual DWARF location descriptor that we generate
12640 may just be OP_BASEREG (basereg). This may look deceptively like
12641 the object in question was allocated to a register (rather than in
12642 memory) so DWARF consumers need to be aware of the subtle
12643 distinction between OP_REG and OP_BASEREG. */
12644 if (REGNO (rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
12645 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (rtl, 0, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12646 else if (stack_realign_drap
12647 && crtl->drap_reg
12648 && crtl->args.internal_arg_pointer == rtl
12649 && REGNO (crtl->drap_reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
12650 {
12651 /* If RTL is internal_arg_pointer, which has been optimized
12652 out, use DRAP instead. */
12653 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (crtl->drap_reg, 0,
12654 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12655 }
12656 break;
12657
12658 case SIGN_EXTEND:
12659 case ZERO_EXTEND:
12660 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT)
12661 break;
12662 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
12663 mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12664 if (op0 == 0)
12665 break;
12666 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == ZERO_EXTEND
12667 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
12668 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
12669 < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
12670 /* If DW_OP_const{1,2,4}u won't be used, it is shorter
12671 to expand zero extend as two shifts instead of
12672 masking. */
12673 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) <= 4)
12674 {
12675 machine_mode imode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0));
12676 mem_loc_result = op0;
12677 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
12678 int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_MASK (imode)));
12679 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
12680 }
12681 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
12682 {
12683 int shift = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
12684 - GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)));
12685 shift *= BITS_PER_UNIT;
12686 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SIGN_EXTEND)
12687 op = DW_OP_shra;
12688 else
12689 op = DW_OP_shr;
12690 mem_loc_result = op0;
12691 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
12692 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
12693 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
12694 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
12695 }
12696 else if (!dwarf_strict)
12697 {
12698 dw_die_ref type_die1, type_die2;
12699 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
12700
12701 type_die1 = base_type_for_mode (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
12702 GET_CODE (rtl) == ZERO_EXTEND);
12703 if (type_die1 == NULL)
12704 break;
12705 type_die2 = base_type_for_mode (mode, 1);
12706 if (type_die2 == NULL)
12707 break;
12708 mem_loc_result = op0;
12709 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
12710 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
12711 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die1;
12712 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
12713 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, cvt);
12714 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
12715 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
12716 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die2;
12717 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
12718 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, cvt);
12719 }
12720 break;
12721
12722 case MEM:
12723 {
12724 rtx new_rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
12725 if (new_rtl != rtl)
12726 {
12727 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (new_rtl, mode, mem_mode,
12728 initialized);
12729 if (mem_loc_result != NULL)
12730 return mem_loc_result;
12731 }
12732 }
12733 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0),
12734 get_address_mode (rtl), mode,
12735 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12736 if (mem_loc_result == NULL)
12737 mem_loc_result = tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtl);
12738 if (mem_loc_result != NULL)
12739 {
12740 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
12741 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT)
12742 {
12743 dw_die_ref type_die;
12744 dw_loc_descr_ref deref;
12745
12746 if (dwarf_strict)
12747 return NULL;
12748 type_die
12749 = base_type_for_mode (mode, GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT);
12750 if (type_die == NULL)
12751 return NULL;
12752 deref = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_deref_type,
12753 GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), 0);
12754 deref->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
12755 deref->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
12756 deref->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
12757 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, deref);
12758 }
12759 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
12760 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0));
12761 else
12762 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
12763 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref_size,
12764 GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), 0));
12765 }
12766 break;
12767
12768 case LO_SUM:
12769 return mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode, initialized);
12770
12771 case LABEL_REF:
12772 /* Some ports can transform a symbol ref into a label ref, because
12773 the symbol ref is too far away and has to be dumped into a constant
12774 pool. */
12775 case CONST:
12776 case SYMBOL_REF:
12777 if ((GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
12778 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_PARTIAL_INT)
12779 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
12780 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
12781 && (mode != Pmode || mem_mode == VOIDmode)
12782 #endif
12783 ))
12784 break;
12785 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF
12786 && SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (rtl) != TLS_MODEL_NONE)
12787 {
12788 dw_loc_descr_ref temp;
12789
12790 /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the data. */
12791 if (!targetm.have_tls || !targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
12792 break;
12793
12794 temp = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_true);
12795
12796 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address, 0, 0);
12797 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, temp);
12798
12799 break;
12800 }
12801
12802 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
12803 {
12804 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST)
12805 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
12806 initialized);
12807 break;
12808 }
12809
12810 symref:
12811 mem_loc_result = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_false);
12812 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
12813 break;
12814
12815 case CONCAT:
12816 case CONCATN:
12817 case VAR_LOCATION:
12818 case DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR:
12819 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
12820 "CONCAT/CONCATN/VAR_LOCATION is handled only by loc_descriptor");
12821 return 0;
12822
12823 case ENTRY_VALUE:
12824 if (dwarf_strict)
12825 return NULL;
12826 if (REG_P (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl)))
12827 {
12828 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
12829 || GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
12830 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl), mode,
12831 VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12832 else
12833 {
12834 unsigned int dbx_regnum = dbx_reg_number (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl));
12835 if (dbx_regnum == IGNORED_DWARF_REGNUM)
12836 return NULL;
12837 op0 = one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_regnum,
12838 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12839 }
12840 }
12841 else if (MEM_P (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl))
12842 && REG_P (XEXP (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl), 0)))
12843 {
12844 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl), mode,
12845 VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12846 if (op0 && op0->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_fbreg)
12847 return NULL;
12848 }
12849 else
12850 gcc_unreachable ();
12851 if (op0 == NULL)
12852 return NULL;
12853 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_entry_value, 0, 0);
12854 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
12855 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = op0;
12856 break;
12857
12858 case DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF:
12859 mem_loc_result = parameter_ref_descriptor (rtl);
12860 break;
12861
12862 case PRE_MODIFY:
12863 /* Extract the PLUS expression nested inside and fall into
12864 PLUS code below. */
12865 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
12866 goto plus;
12867
12868 case PRE_INC:
12869 case PRE_DEC:
12870 /* Turn these into a PLUS expression and fall into the PLUS code
12871 below. */
12872 rtl = gen_rtx_PLUS (mode, XEXP (rtl, 0),
12873 gen_int_mode (GET_CODE (rtl) == PRE_INC
12874 ? GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mem_mode)
12875 : -GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mem_mode),
12876 mode));
12877
12878 /* ... fall through ... */
12879
12880 case PLUS:
12881 plus:
12882 if (is_based_loc (rtl)
12883 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
12884 || XEXP (rtl, 0) == arg_pointer_rtx
12885 || XEXP (rtl, 0) == frame_pointer_rtx)
12886 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT)
12887 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (XEXP (rtl, 0),
12888 INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)),
12889 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12890 else
12891 {
12892 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
12893 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12894 if (mem_loc_result == 0)
12895 break;
12896
12897 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
12898 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
12899 loc_descr_plus_const (&mem_loc_result, INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
12900 else
12901 {
12902 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
12903 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12904 if (op1 == 0)
12905 return NULL;
12906 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
12907 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
12908 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
12909 }
12910 }
12911 break;
12912
12913 /* If a pseudo-reg is optimized away, it is possible for it to
12914 be replaced with a MEM containing a multiply or shift. */
12915 case MINUS:
12916 op = DW_OP_minus;
12917 goto do_binop;
12918
12919 case MULT:
12920 op = DW_OP_mul;
12921 goto do_binop;
12922
12923 case DIV:
12924 if (!dwarf_strict
12925 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
12926 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
12927 {
12928 mem_loc_result = typed_binop (DW_OP_div, rtl,
12929 base_type_for_mode (mode, 0),
12930 mode, mem_mode);
12931 break;
12932 }
12933 op = DW_OP_div;
12934 goto do_binop;
12935
12936 case UMOD:
12937 op = DW_OP_mod;
12938 goto do_binop;
12939
12940 case ASHIFT:
12941 op = DW_OP_shl;
12942 goto do_shift;
12943
12944 case ASHIFTRT:
12945 op = DW_OP_shra;
12946 goto do_shift;
12947
12948 case LSHIFTRT:
12949 op = DW_OP_shr;
12950 goto do_shift;
12951
12952 do_shift:
12953 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT)
12954 break;
12955 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
12956 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12957 {
12958 rtx rtlop1 = XEXP (rtl, 1);
12959 if (GET_MODE (rtlop1) != VOIDmode
12960 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (rtlop1))
12961 < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode))
12962 rtlop1 = gen_rtx_ZERO_EXTEND (mode, rtlop1);
12963 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (rtlop1, mode, mem_mode,
12964 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12965 }
12966
12967 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
12968 break;
12969
12970 mem_loc_result = op0;
12971 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
12972 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
12973 break;
12974
12975 case AND:
12976 op = DW_OP_and;
12977 goto do_binop;
12978
12979 case IOR:
12980 op = DW_OP_or;
12981 goto do_binop;
12982
12983 case XOR:
12984 op = DW_OP_xor;
12985 goto do_binop;
12986
12987 do_binop:
12988 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
12989 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12990 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
12991 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12992
12993 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
12994 break;
12995
12996 mem_loc_result = op0;
12997 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
12998 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
12999 break;
13000
13001 case MOD:
13002 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE && !dwarf_strict)
13003 {
13004 mem_loc_result = typed_binop (DW_OP_mod, rtl,
13005 base_type_for_mode (mode, 0),
13006 mode, mem_mode);
13007 break;
13008 }
13009
13010 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
13011 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13012 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
13013 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13014
13015 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
13016 break;
13017
13018 mem_loc_result = op0;
13019 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
13020 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
13021 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
13022 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_div, 0, 0));
13023 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
13024 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
13025 break;
13026
13027 case UDIV:
13028 if (!dwarf_strict && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT)
13029 {
13030 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13031 {
13032 op = DW_OP_div;
13033 goto do_binop;
13034 }
13035 mem_loc_result = typed_binop (DW_OP_div, rtl,
13036 base_type_for_mode (mode, 1),
13037 mode, mem_mode);
13038 }
13039 break;
13040
13041 case NOT:
13042 op = DW_OP_not;
13043 goto do_unop;
13044
13045 case ABS:
13046 op = DW_OP_abs;
13047 goto do_unop;
13048
13049 case NEG:
13050 op = DW_OP_neg;
13051 goto do_unop;
13052
13053 do_unop:
13054 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
13055 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13056
13057 if (op0 == 0)
13058 break;
13059
13060 mem_loc_result = op0;
13061 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
13062 break;
13063
13064 case CONST_INT:
13065 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13066 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
13067 || (mode == Pmode
13068 && mem_mode != VOIDmode
13069 && trunc_int_for_mode (INTVAL (rtl), ptr_mode) == INTVAL (rtl))
13070 #endif
13071 )
13072 {
13073 mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl));
13074 break;
13075 }
13076 if (!dwarf_strict
13077 && (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
13078 || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT))
13079 {
13080 dw_die_ref type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, 1);
13081 machine_mode amode;
13082 if (type_die == NULL)
13083 return NULL;
13084 amode = mode_for_size (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * BITS_PER_UNIT,
13085 MODE_INT, 0);
13086 if (INTVAL (rtl) >= 0
13087 && amode != BLKmode
13088 && trunc_int_for_mode (INTVAL (rtl), amode) == INTVAL (rtl)
13089 /* const DW_OP_GNU_convert <XXX> vs.
13090 DW_OP_GNU_const_type <XXX, 1, const>. */
13091 && size_of_int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl)) + 1 + 1
13092 < (unsigned long) 1 + 1 + 1 + GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
13093 {
13094 mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl));
13095 op0 = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
13096 op0->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
13097 op0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
13098 op0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
13099 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op0);
13100 return mem_loc_result;
13101 }
13102 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_const_type, 0,
13103 INTVAL (rtl));
13104 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
13105 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
13106 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
13107 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13108 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
13109 else
13110 {
13111 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class
13112 = dw_val_class_const_double;
13113 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_double
13114 = double_int::from_shwi (INTVAL (rtl));
13115 }
13116 }
13117 break;
13118
13119 case CONST_DOUBLE:
13120 if (!dwarf_strict)
13121 {
13122 dw_die_ref type_die;
13123
13124 /* Note that if TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT == 0, a
13125 CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either a large integer
13126 or a floating-point constant. If TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT != 0,
13127 the value is always a floating point constant.
13128
13129 When it is an integer, a CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever
13130 the constant requires 2 HWIs to be adequately represented.
13131 We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks. */
13132 if (mode == VOIDmode
13133 || (GET_MODE (rtl) == VOIDmode
13134 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) != HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT))
13135 break;
13136 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode,
13137 GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT);
13138 if (type_die == NULL)
13139 return NULL;
13140 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_const_type, 0, 0);
13141 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
13142 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
13143 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
13144 #if TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT == 0
13145 if (!SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
13146 {
13147 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class
13148 = dw_val_class_const_double;
13149 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_double
13150 = rtx_to_double_int (rtl);
13151 }
13152 else
13153 #endif
13154 {
13155 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
13156 unsigned char *array = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length);
13157
13158 insert_float (rtl, array);
13159 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
13160 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = length / 4;
13161 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = 4;
13162 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
13163 }
13164 }
13165 break;
13166
13167 case CONST_WIDE_INT:
13168 if (!dwarf_strict)
13169 {
13170 dw_die_ref type_die;
13171
13172 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode,
13173 GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT);
13174 if (type_die == NULL)
13175 return NULL;
13176 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_const_type, 0, 0);
13177 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
13178 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
13179 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
13180 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class
13181 = dw_val_class_wide_int;
13182 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide = ggc_alloc<wide_int> ();
13183 *mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide = std::make_pair (rtl, mode);
13184 }
13185 break;
13186
13187 case EQ:
13188 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_eq, rtl, mem_mode);
13189 break;
13190
13191 case GE:
13192 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_ge, rtl, mem_mode);
13193 break;
13194
13195 case GT:
13196 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_gt, rtl, mem_mode);
13197 break;
13198
13199 case LE:
13200 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_le, rtl, mem_mode);
13201 break;
13202
13203 case LT:
13204 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_lt, rtl, mem_mode);
13205 break;
13206
13207 case NE:
13208 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_ne, rtl, mem_mode);
13209 break;
13210
13211 case GEU:
13212 mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_ge, rtl, mem_mode);
13213 break;
13214
13215 case GTU:
13216 mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_gt, rtl, mem_mode);
13217 break;
13218
13219 case LEU:
13220 mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_le, rtl, mem_mode);
13221 break;
13222
13223 case LTU:
13224 mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_lt, rtl, mem_mode);
13225 break;
13226
13227 case UMIN:
13228 case UMAX:
13229 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT)
13230 break;
13231 /* FALLTHRU */
13232 case SMIN:
13233 case SMAX:
13234 mem_loc_result = minmax_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode);
13235 break;
13236
13237 case ZERO_EXTRACT:
13238 case SIGN_EXTRACT:
13239 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
13240 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 2))
13241 && ((unsigned) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
13242 + (unsigned) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 2))
13243 <= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode))
13244 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
13245 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13246 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13247 {
13248 int shift, size;
13249 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
13250 mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13251 if (op0 == 0)
13252 break;
13253 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SIGN_EXTRACT)
13254 op = DW_OP_shra;
13255 else
13256 op = DW_OP_shr;
13257 mem_loc_result = op0;
13258 size = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
13259 shift = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 2));
13260 if (BITS_BIG_ENDIAN)
13261 shift = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
13262 - shift - size;
13263 if (shift + size != (int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13264 {
13265 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
13266 int_loc_descriptor (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13267 - shift - size));
13268 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
13269 }
13270 if (size != (int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13271 {
13272 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
13273 int_loc_descriptor (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - size));
13274 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
13275 }
13276 }
13277 break;
13278
13279 case IF_THEN_ELSE:
13280 {
13281 dw_loc_descr_ref op2, bra_node, drop_node;
13282 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0),
13283 GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == VOIDmode
13284 ? word_mode : GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
13285 mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13286 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
13287 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13288 op2 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 2), mode, mem_mode,
13289 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13290 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL || op2 == NULL)
13291 break;
13292
13293 mem_loc_result = op1;
13294 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op2);
13295 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op0);
13296 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
13297 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, bra_node);
13298 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
13299 drop_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
13300 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, drop_node);
13301 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
13302 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = drop_node;
13303 }
13304 break;
13305
13306 case FLOAT_EXTEND:
13307 case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
13308 case FLOAT:
13309 case UNSIGNED_FLOAT:
13310 case FIX:
13311 case UNSIGNED_FIX:
13312 if (!dwarf_strict)
13313 {
13314 dw_die_ref type_die;
13315 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
13316
13317 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
13318 mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13319 if (op0 == NULL)
13320 break;
13321 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) == MODE_INT
13322 && (GET_CODE (rtl) == FLOAT
13323 || GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
13324 <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
13325 {
13326 type_die = base_type_for_mode (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
13327 GET_CODE (rtl) == UNSIGNED_FLOAT);
13328 if (type_die == NULL)
13329 break;
13330 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
13331 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
13332 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
13333 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
13334 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
13335 }
13336 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, GET_CODE (rtl) == UNSIGNED_FIX);
13337 if (type_die == NULL)
13338 break;
13339 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
13340 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
13341 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
13342 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
13343 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
13344 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
13345 && (GET_CODE (rtl) == FIX
13346 || GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
13347 {
13348 op0 = convert_descriptor_to_mode (mode, op0);
13349 if (op0 == NULL)
13350 break;
13351 }
13352 mem_loc_result = op0;
13353 }
13354 break;
13355
13356 case CLZ:
13357 case CTZ:
13358 case FFS:
13359 mem_loc_result = clz_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode);
13360 break;
13361
13362 case POPCOUNT:
13363 case PARITY:
13364 mem_loc_result = popcount_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode);
13365 break;
13366
13367 case BSWAP:
13368 mem_loc_result = bswap_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode);
13369 break;
13370
13371 case ROTATE:
13372 case ROTATERT:
13373 mem_loc_result = rotate_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode);
13374 break;
13375
13376 case COMPARE:
13377 /* In theory, we could implement the above. */
13378 /* DWARF cannot represent the unsigned compare operations
13379 natively. */
13380 case SS_MULT:
13381 case US_MULT:
13382 case SS_DIV:
13383 case US_DIV:
13384 case SS_PLUS:
13385 case US_PLUS:
13386 case SS_MINUS:
13387 case US_MINUS:
13388 case SS_NEG:
13389 case US_NEG:
13390 case SS_ABS:
13391 case SS_ASHIFT:
13392 case US_ASHIFT:
13393 case SS_TRUNCATE:
13394 case US_TRUNCATE:
13395 case UNORDERED:
13396 case ORDERED:
13397 case UNEQ:
13398 case UNGE:
13399 case UNGT:
13400 case UNLE:
13401 case UNLT:
13402 case LTGT:
13403 case FRACT_CONVERT:
13404 case UNSIGNED_FRACT_CONVERT:
13405 case SAT_FRACT:
13406 case UNSIGNED_SAT_FRACT:
13407 case SQRT:
13408 case ASM_OPERANDS:
13409 case VEC_MERGE:
13410 case VEC_SELECT:
13411 case VEC_CONCAT:
13412 case VEC_DUPLICATE:
13413 case UNSPEC:
13414 case HIGH:
13415 case FMA:
13416 case STRICT_LOW_PART:
13417 case CONST_VECTOR:
13418 case CONST_FIXED:
13419 case CLRSB:
13420 case CLOBBER:
13421 /* If delegitimize_address couldn't do anything with the UNSPEC, we
13422 can't express it in the debug info. This can happen e.g. with some
13423 TLS UNSPECs. */
13424 break;
13425
13426 case CONST_STRING:
13427 resolve_one_addr (&rtl);
13428 goto symref;
13429
13430 default:
13431 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
13432 print_rtl (stderr, rtl);
13433 gcc_unreachable ();
13434 #else
13435 break;
13436 #endif
13437 }
13438
13439 if (mem_loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
13440 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
13441
13442 return mem_loc_result;
13443 }
13444
13445 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of two locations.
13446 This is typically a complex variable. */
13447
13448 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13449 concat_loc_descriptor (rtx x0, rtx x1, enum var_init_status initialized)
13450 {
13451 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
13452 dw_loc_descr_ref x0_ref
13453 = loc_descriptor (x0, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13454 dw_loc_descr_ref x1_ref
13455 = loc_descriptor (x1, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13456
13457 if (x0_ref == 0 || x1_ref == 0)
13458 return 0;
13459
13460 cc_loc_result = x0_ref;
13461 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x0)));
13462
13463 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, x1_ref);
13464 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x1)));
13465
13466 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
13467 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
13468
13469 return cc_loc_result;
13470 }
13471
13472 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of N
13473 locations. */
13474
13475 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13476 concatn_loc_descriptor (rtx concatn, enum var_init_status initialized)
13477 {
13478 unsigned int i;
13479 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
13480 unsigned int n = XVECLEN (concatn, 0);
13481
13482 for (i = 0; i < n; ++i)
13483 {
13484 dw_loc_descr_ref ref;
13485 rtx x = XVECEXP (concatn, 0, i);
13486
13487 ref = loc_descriptor (x, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13488 if (ref == NULL)
13489 return NULL;
13490
13491 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, ref);
13492 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)));
13493 }
13494
13495 if (cc_loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
13496 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
13497
13498 return cc_loc_result;
13499 }
13500
13501 /* Helper function for loc_descriptor. Return DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer
13502 for DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR RTL. */
13503
13504 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13505 implicit_ptr_descriptor (rtx rtl, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
13506 {
13507 dw_loc_descr_ref ret;
13508 dw_die_ref ref;
13509
13510 if (dwarf_strict)
13511 return NULL;
13512 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl)) == VAR_DECL
13513 || TREE_CODE (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl)) == PARM_DECL
13514 || TREE_CODE (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl)) == RESULT_DECL);
13515 ref = lookup_decl_die (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl));
13516 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer, 0, offset);
13517 ret->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
13518 if (ref)
13519 {
13520 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
13521 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
13522 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
13523 }
13524 else
13525 {
13526 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_decl_ref;
13527 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref = DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl);
13528 }
13529 return ret;
13530 }
13531
13532 /* Output a proper Dwarf location descriptor for a variable or parameter
13533 which is either allocated in a register or in a memory location. For a
13534 register, we just generate an OP_REG and the register number. For a
13535 memory location we provide a Dwarf postfix expression describing how to
13536 generate the (dynamic) address of the object onto the address stack.
13537
13538 MODE is mode of the decl if this loc_descriptor is going to be used in
13539 .debug_loc section where DW_OP_stack_value and DW_OP_implicit_value are
13540 allowed, VOIDmode otherwise.
13541
13542 If we don't know how to describe it, return 0. */
13543
13544 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13545 loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, machine_mode mode,
13546 enum var_init_status initialized)
13547 {
13548 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
13549
13550 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
13551 {
13552 case SUBREG:
13553 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
13554 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
13555 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
13556 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
13557 contains the given subreg. */
13558 if (REG_P (SUBREG_REG (rtl)) && subreg_lowpart_p (rtl))
13559 loc_result = loc_descriptor (SUBREG_REG (rtl),
13560 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (rtl)), initialized);
13561 else
13562 goto do_default;
13563 break;
13564
13565 case REG:
13566 loc_result = reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, initialized);
13567 break;
13568
13569 case MEM:
13570 loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), get_address_mode (rtl),
13571 GET_MODE (rtl), initialized);
13572 if (loc_result == NULL)
13573 loc_result = tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtl);
13574 if (loc_result == NULL)
13575 {
13576 rtx new_rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
13577 if (new_rtl != rtl)
13578 loc_result = loc_descriptor (new_rtl, mode, initialized);
13579 }
13580 break;
13581
13582 case CONCAT:
13583 loc_result = concat_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), XEXP (rtl, 1),
13584 initialized);
13585 break;
13586
13587 case CONCATN:
13588 loc_result = concatn_loc_descriptor (rtl, initialized);
13589 break;
13590
13591 case VAR_LOCATION:
13592 /* Single part. */
13593 if (GET_CODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (rtl)) != PARALLEL)
13594 {
13595 rtx loc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (rtl);
13596 if (GET_CODE (loc) == EXPR_LIST)
13597 loc = XEXP (loc, 0);
13598 loc_result = loc_descriptor (loc, mode, initialized);
13599 break;
13600 }
13601
13602 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
13603 /* FALLTHRU */
13604
13605 case PARALLEL:
13606 {
13607 rtvec par_elems = XVEC (rtl, 0);
13608 int num_elem = GET_NUM_ELEM (par_elems);
13609 machine_mode mode;
13610 int i;
13611
13612 /* Create the first one, so we have something to add to. */
13613 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0),
13614 VOIDmode, initialized);
13615 if (loc_result == NULL)
13616 return NULL;
13617 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0));
13618 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
13619 for (i = 1; i < num_elem; i++)
13620 {
13621 dw_loc_descr_ref temp;
13622
13623 temp = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0),
13624 VOIDmode, initialized);
13625 if (temp == NULL)
13626 return NULL;
13627 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, temp);
13628 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0));
13629 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
13630 }
13631 }
13632 break;
13633
13634 case CONST_INT:
13635 if (mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode)
13636 loc_result = address_of_int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode),
13637 INTVAL (rtl));
13638 break;
13639
13640 case CONST_DOUBLE:
13641 if (mode == VOIDmode)
13642 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
13643
13644 if (mode != VOIDmode && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
13645 {
13646 gcc_assert (mode == GET_MODE (rtl) || VOIDmode == GET_MODE (rtl));
13647
13648 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer
13649 or a floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever
13650 the constant requires more than one word in order to be
13651 adequately represented. We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks. */
13652 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
13653 GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), 0);
13654 #if TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT == 0
13655 if (!SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
13656 {
13657 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const_double;
13658 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_double
13659 = rtx_to_double_int (rtl);
13660 }
13661 else
13662 #endif
13663 {
13664 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
13665 unsigned char *array = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length);
13666
13667 insert_float (rtl, array);
13668 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
13669 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = length / 4;
13670 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = 4;
13671 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
13672 }
13673 }
13674 break;
13675
13676 case CONST_WIDE_INT:
13677 if (mode == VOIDmode)
13678 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
13679
13680 if (mode != VOIDmode && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
13681 {
13682 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
13683 GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), 0);
13684 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_wide_int;
13685 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide = ggc_alloc<wide_int> ();
13686 *loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide = std::make_pair (rtl, mode);
13687 }
13688 break;
13689
13690 case CONST_VECTOR:
13691 if (mode == VOIDmode)
13692 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
13693
13694 if (mode != VOIDmode && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
13695 {
13696 unsigned int elt_size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl));
13697 unsigned int length = CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl);
13698 unsigned char *array
13699 = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length * elt_size);
13700 unsigned int i;
13701 unsigned char *p;
13702 machine_mode imode = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
13703
13704 gcc_assert (mode == GET_MODE (rtl) || VOIDmode == GET_MODE (rtl));
13705 switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
13706 {
13707 case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
13708 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
13709 {
13710 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
13711 insert_wide_int (std::make_pair (elt, imode), p, elt_size);
13712 }
13713 break;
13714
13715 case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
13716 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
13717 {
13718 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
13719 insert_float (elt, p);
13720 }
13721 break;
13722
13723 default:
13724 gcc_unreachable ();
13725 }
13726
13727 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
13728 length * elt_size, 0);
13729 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
13730 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = length;
13731 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = elt_size;
13732 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
13733 }
13734 break;
13735
13736 case CONST:
13737 if (mode == VOIDmode
13738 || CONST_SCALAR_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
13739 || CONST_DOUBLE_AS_FLOAT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
13740 || GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_VECTOR)
13741 {
13742 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, initialized);
13743 break;
13744 }
13745 /* FALLTHROUGH */
13746 case SYMBOL_REF:
13747 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
13748 break;
13749 case LABEL_REF:
13750 if (mode != VOIDmode && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13751 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
13752 {
13753 loc_result = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_false);
13754 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
13755 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
13756 }
13757 break;
13758
13759 case DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR:
13760 loc_result = implicit_ptr_descriptor (rtl, 0);
13761 break;
13762
13763 case PLUS:
13764 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR
13765 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
13766 {
13767 loc_result
13768 = implicit_ptr_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
13769 break;
13770 }
13771 /* FALLTHRU */
13772 do_default:
13773 default:
13774 if ((GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT && GET_MODE (rtl) == mode
13775 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13776 && dwarf_version >= 4)
13777 || (!dwarf_strict && mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode))
13778 {
13779 /* Value expression. */
13780 loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, VOIDmode, initialized);
13781 if (loc_result)
13782 add_loc_descr (&loc_result,
13783 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
13784 }
13785 break;
13786 }
13787
13788 return loc_result;
13789 }
13790
13791 /* We need to figure out what section we should use as the base for the
13792 address ranges where a given location is valid.
13793 1. If this particular DECL has a section associated with it, use that.
13794 2. If this function has a section associated with it, use that.
13795 3. Otherwise, use the text section.
13796 XXX: If you split a variable across multiple sections, we won't notice. */
13797
13798 static const char *
13799 secname_for_decl (const_tree decl)
13800 {
13801 const char *secname;
13802
13803 if (VAR_OR_FUNCTION_DECL_P (decl)
13804 && (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) || TREE_PUBLIC (decl) || TREE_STATIC (decl))
13805 && DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
13806 secname = DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl);
13807 else if (current_function_decl && DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl))
13808 secname = DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl);
13809 else if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
13810 secname = crtl->subsections.cold_section_label;
13811 else
13812 secname = text_section_label;
13813
13814 return secname;
13815 }
13816
13817 /* Return true when DECL_BY_REFERENCE is defined and set for DECL. */
13818
13819 static bool
13820 decl_by_reference_p (tree decl)
13821 {
13822 return ((TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL
13823 || TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL)
13824 && DECL_BY_REFERENCE (decl));
13825 }
13826
13827 /* Helper function for dw_loc_list. Compute proper Dwarf location descriptor
13828 for VARLOC. */
13829
13830 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13831 dw_loc_list_1 (tree loc, rtx varloc, int want_address,
13832 enum var_init_status initialized)
13833 {
13834 int have_address = 0;
13835 dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
13836 machine_mode mode;
13837
13838 if (want_address != 2)
13839 {
13840 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (varloc) == VAR_LOCATION);
13841 /* Single part. */
13842 if (GET_CODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc)) != PARALLEL)
13843 {
13844 varloc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc);
13845 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == EXPR_LIST)
13846 varloc = XEXP (varloc, 0);
13847 mode = GET_MODE (varloc);
13848 if (MEM_P (varloc))
13849 {
13850 rtx addr = XEXP (varloc, 0);
13851 descr = mem_loc_descriptor (addr, get_address_mode (varloc),
13852 mode, initialized);
13853 if (descr)
13854 have_address = 1;
13855 else
13856 {
13857 rtx x = avoid_constant_pool_reference (varloc);
13858 if (x != varloc)
13859 descr = mem_loc_descriptor (x, mode, VOIDmode,
13860 initialized);
13861 }
13862 }
13863 else
13864 descr = mem_loc_descriptor (varloc, mode, VOIDmode, initialized);
13865 }
13866 else
13867 return 0;
13868 }
13869 else
13870 {
13871 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == VAR_LOCATION)
13872 mode = DECL_MODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (varloc));
13873 else
13874 mode = DECL_MODE (loc);
13875 descr = loc_descriptor (varloc, mode, initialized);
13876 have_address = 1;
13877 }
13878
13879 if (!descr)
13880 return 0;
13881
13882 if (want_address == 2 && !have_address
13883 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
13884 {
13885 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13886 {
13887 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
13888 "DWARF address size mismatch");
13889 return 0;
13890 }
13891 add_loc_descr (&descr, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
13892 have_address = 1;
13893 }
13894 /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address. */
13895 if (want_address && !have_address)
13896 {
13897 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
13898 "Want address and only have value");
13899 return 0;
13900 }
13901
13902 /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference. */
13903 if (!want_address && have_address)
13904 {
13905 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
13906 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
13907
13908 if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
13909 {
13910 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
13911 "DWARF address size mismatch");
13912 return 0;
13913 }
13914 else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13915 op = DW_OP_deref;
13916 else
13917 op = DW_OP_deref_size;
13918
13919 add_loc_descr (&descr, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
13920 }
13921
13922 return descr;
13923 }
13924
13925 /* Create a DW_OP_piece or DW_OP_bit_piece for bitsize, or return NULL
13926 if it is not possible. */
13927
13928 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13929 new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
13930 {
13931 if ((bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0 && offset == 0)
13932 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, bitsize / BITS_PER_UNIT, 0);
13933 else if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
13934 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bit_piece, bitsize, offset);
13935 else
13936 return NULL;
13937 }
13938
13939 /* Helper function for dw_loc_list. Compute proper Dwarf location descriptor
13940 for VAR_LOC_NOTE for variable DECL that has been optimized by SRA. */
13941
13942 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13943 dw_sra_loc_expr (tree decl, rtx loc)
13944 {
13945 rtx p;
13946 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT padsize = 0;
13947 dw_loc_descr_ref descr, *descr_tail;
13948 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT decl_size;
13949 rtx varloc;
13950 enum var_init_status initialized;
13951
13952 if (DECL_SIZE (decl) == NULL
13953 || !tree_fits_uhwi_p (DECL_SIZE (decl)))
13954 return NULL;
13955
13956 decl_size = tree_to_uhwi (DECL_SIZE (decl));
13957 descr = NULL;
13958 descr_tail = &descr;
13959
13960 for (p = loc; p; p = XEXP (p, 1))
13961 {
13962 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize = decl_piece_bitsize (p);
13963 rtx loc_note = *decl_piece_varloc_ptr (p);
13964 dw_loc_descr_ref cur_descr;
13965 dw_loc_descr_ref *tail, last = NULL;
13966 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT opsize = 0;
13967
13968 if (loc_note == NULL_RTX
13969 || NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note) == NULL_RTX)
13970 {
13971 padsize += bitsize;
13972 continue;
13973 }
13974 initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note);
13975 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (loc_note);
13976 cur_descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, 2, initialized);
13977 if (cur_descr == NULL)
13978 {
13979 padsize += bitsize;
13980 continue;
13981 }
13982
13983 /* Check that cur_descr either doesn't use
13984 DW_OP_*piece operations, or their sum is equal
13985 to bitsize. Otherwise we can't embed it. */
13986 for (tail = &cur_descr; *tail != NULL;
13987 tail = &(*tail)->dw_loc_next)
13988 if ((*tail)->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_piece)
13989 {
13990 opsize += (*tail)->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned
13991 * BITS_PER_UNIT;
13992 last = *tail;
13993 }
13994 else if ((*tail)->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bit_piece)
13995 {
13996 opsize += (*tail)->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
13997 last = *tail;
13998 }
13999
14000 if (last != NULL && opsize != bitsize)
14001 {
14002 padsize += bitsize;
14003 /* Discard the current piece of the descriptor and release any
14004 addr_table entries it uses. */
14005 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (cur_descr);
14006 continue;
14007 }
14008
14009 /* If there is a hole, add DW_OP_*piece after empty DWARF
14010 expression, which means that those bits are optimized out. */
14011 if (padsize)
14012 {
14013 if (padsize > decl_size)
14014 {
14015 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (cur_descr);
14016 goto discard_descr;
14017 }
14018 decl_size -= padsize;
14019 *descr_tail = new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (padsize, 0);
14020 if (*descr_tail == NULL)
14021 {
14022 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (cur_descr);
14023 goto discard_descr;
14024 }
14025 descr_tail = &(*descr_tail)->dw_loc_next;
14026 padsize = 0;
14027 }
14028 *descr_tail = cur_descr;
14029 descr_tail = tail;
14030 if (bitsize > decl_size)
14031 goto discard_descr;
14032 decl_size -= bitsize;
14033 if (last == NULL)
14034 {
14035 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
14036 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == VAR_LOCATION
14037 && GET_CODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc)) != PARALLEL)
14038 {
14039 varloc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc);
14040 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == EXPR_LIST)
14041 varloc = XEXP (varloc, 0);
14042 }
14043 do
14044 {
14045 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == CONST
14046 || GET_CODE (varloc) == SIGN_EXTEND
14047 || GET_CODE (varloc) == ZERO_EXTEND)
14048 varloc = XEXP (varloc, 0);
14049 else if (GET_CODE (varloc) == SUBREG)
14050 varloc = SUBREG_REG (varloc);
14051 else
14052 break;
14053 }
14054 while (1);
14055 /* DW_OP_bit_size offset should be zero for register
14056 or implicit location descriptions and empty location
14057 descriptions, but for memory addresses needs big endian
14058 adjustment. */
14059 if (MEM_P (varloc))
14060 {
14061 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT memsize
14062 = MEM_SIZE (varloc) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
14063 if (memsize != bitsize)
14064 {
14065 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN != WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
14066 && (memsize > BITS_PER_WORD || bitsize > BITS_PER_WORD))
14067 goto discard_descr;
14068 if (memsize < bitsize)
14069 goto discard_descr;
14070 if (BITS_BIG_ENDIAN)
14071 offset = memsize - bitsize;
14072 }
14073 }
14074
14075 *descr_tail = new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (bitsize, offset);
14076 if (*descr_tail == NULL)
14077 goto discard_descr;
14078 descr_tail = &(*descr_tail)->dw_loc_next;
14079 }
14080 }
14081
14082 /* If there were any non-empty expressions, add padding till the end of
14083 the decl. */
14084 if (descr != NULL && decl_size != 0)
14085 {
14086 *descr_tail = new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (decl_size, 0);
14087 if (*descr_tail == NULL)
14088 goto discard_descr;
14089 }
14090 return descr;
14091
14092 discard_descr:
14093 /* Discard the descriptor and release any addr_table entries it uses. */
14094 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (descr);
14095 return NULL;
14096 }
14097
14098 /* Return the dwarf representation of the location list LOC_LIST of
14099 DECL. WANT_ADDRESS has the same meaning as in loc_list_from_tree
14100 function. */
14101
14102 static dw_loc_list_ref
14103 dw_loc_list (var_loc_list *loc_list, tree decl, int want_address)
14104 {
14105 const char *endname, *secname;
14106 rtx varloc;
14107 enum var_init_status initialized;
14108 struct var_loc_node *node;
14109 dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
14110 char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
14111 dw_loc_list_ref list = NULL;
14112 dw_loc_list_ref *listp = &list;
14113
14114 /* Now that we know what section we are using for a base,
14115 actually construct the list of locations.
14116 The first location information is what is passed to the
14117 function that creates the location list, and the remaining
14118 locations just get added on to that list.
14119 Note that we only know the start address for a location
14120 (IE location changes), so to build the range, we use
14121 the range [current location start, next location start].
14122 This means we have to special case the last node, and generate
14123 a range of [last location start, end of function label]. */
14124
14125 secname = secname_for_decl (decl);
14126
14127 for (node = loc_list->first; node; node = node->next)
14128 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == EXPR_LIST
14129 || NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->loc) != NULL_RTX)
14130 {
14131 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == EXPR_LIST)
14132 {
14133 /* This requires DW_OP_{,bit_}piece, which is not usable
14134 inside DWARF expressions. */
14135 if (want_address != 2)
14136 continue;
14137 descr = dw_sra_loc_expr (decl, node->loc);
14138 if (descr == NULL)
14139 continue;
14140 }
14141 else
14142 {
14143 initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (node->loc);
14144 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->loc);
14145 descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, want_address, initialized);
14146 }
14147 if (descr)
14148 {
14149 bool range_across_switch = false;
14150 /* If section switch happens in between node->label
14151 and node->next->label (or end of function) and
14152 we can't emit it as a single entry list,
14153 emit two ranges, first one ending at the end
14154 of first partition and second one starting at the
14155 beginning of second partition. */
14156 if (node == loc_list->last_before_switch
14157 && (node != loc_list->first || loc_list->first->next)
14158 && current_function_decl)
14159 {
14160 endname = cfun->fde->dw_fde_end;
14161 range_across_switch = true;
14162 }
14163 /* The variable has a location between NODE->LABEL and
14164 NODE->NEXT->LABEL. */
14165 else if (node->next)
14166 endname = node->next->label;
14167 /* If the variable has a location at the last label
14168 it keeps its location until the end of function. */
14169 else if (!current_function_decl)
14170 endname = text_end_label;
14171 else
14172 {
14173 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
14174 current_function_funcdef_no);
14175 endname = ggc_strdup (label_id);
14176 }
14177
14178 *listp = new_loc_list (descr, node->label, endname, secname);
14179 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
14180 && node == loc_list->first
14181 && NOTE_P (node->loc)
14182 && strcmp (node->label, endname) == 0)
14183 (*listp)->force = true;
14184 listp = &(*listp)->dw_loc_next;
14185
14186 if (range_across_switch)
14187 {
14188 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == EXPR_LIST)
14189 descr = dw_sra_loc_expr (decl, node->loc);
14190 else
14191 {
14192 initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (node->loc);
14193 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->loc);
14194 descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, want_address,
14195 initialized);
14196 }
14197 gcc_assert (descr);
14198 /* The variable has a location between NODE->LABEL and
14199 NODE->NEXT->LABEL. */
14200 if (node->next)
14201 endname = node->next->label;
14202 else
14203 endname = cfun->fde->dw_fde_second_end;
14204 *listp = new_loc_list (descr,
14205 cfun->fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
14206 endname, secname);
14207 listp = &(*listp)->dw_loc_next;
14208 }
14209 }
14210 }
14211
14212 /* Try to avoid the overhead of a location list emitting a location
14213 expression instead, but only if we didn't have more than one
14214 location entry in the first place. If some entries were not
14215 representable, we don't want to pretend a single entry that was
14216 applies to the entire scope in which the variable is
14217 available. */
14218 if (list && loc_list->first->next)
14219 gen_llsym (list);
14220
14221 return list;
14222 }
14223
14224 /* Return if the loc_list has only single element and thus can be represented
14225 as location description. */
14226
14227 static bool
14228 single_element_loc_list_p (dw_loc_list_ref list)
14229 {
14230 gcc_assert (!list->dw_loc_next || list->ll_symbol);
14231 return !list->ll_symbol;
14232 }
14233
14234 /* To each location in list LIST add loc descr REF. */
14235
14236 static void
14237 add_loc_descr_to_each (dw_loc_list_ref list, dw_loc_descr_ref ref)
14238 {
14239 dw_loc_descr_ref copy;
14240 add_loc_descr (&list->expr, ref);
14241 list = list->dw_loc_next;
14242 while (list)
14243 {
14244 copy = ggc_alloc<dw_loc_descr_node> ();
14245 memcpy (copy, ref, sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
14246 add_loc_descr (&list->expr, copy);
14247 while (copy->dw_loc_next)
14248 {
14249 dw_loc_descr_ref new_copy = ggc_alloc<dw_loc_descr_node> ();
14250 memcpy (new_copy, copy->dw_loc_next, sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
14251 copy->dw_loc_next = new_copy;
14252 copy = new_copy;
14253 }
14254 list = list->dw_loc_next;
14255 }
14256 }
14257
14258 /* Given two lists RET and LIST
14259 produce location list that is result of adding expression in LIST
14260 to expression in RET on each position in program.
14261 Might be destructive on both RET and LIST.
14262
14263 TODO: We handle only simple cases of RET or LIST having at most one
14264 element. General case would inolve sorting the lists in program order
14265 and merging them that will need some additional work.
14266 Adding that will improve quality of debug info especially for SRA-ed
14267 structures. */
14268
14269 static void
14270 add_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *ret, dw_loc_list_ref list)
14271 {
14272 if (!list)
14273 return;
14274 if (!*ret)
14275 {
14276 *ret = list;
14277 return;
14278 }
14279 if (!list->dw_loc_next)
14280 {
14281 add_loc_descr_to_each (*ret, list->expr);
14282 return;
14283 }
14284 if (!(*ret)->dw_loc_next)
14285 {
14286 add_loc_descr_to_each (list, (*ret)->expr);
14287 *ret = list;
14288 return;
14289 }
14290 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, NULL_RTX,
14291 "Don't know how to merge two non-trivial"
14292 " location lists.\n");
14293 *ret = NULL;
14294 return;
14295 }
14296
14297 /* LOC is constant expression. Try a luck, look it up in constant
14298 pool and return its loc_descr of its address. */
14299
14300 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14301 cst_pool_loc_descr (tree loc)
14302 {
14303 /* Get an RTL for this, if something has been emitted. */
14304 rtx rtl = lookup_constant_def (loc);
14305
14306 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
14307 {
14308 gcc_assert (!rtl);
14309 return 0;
14310 }
14311 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF);
14312
14313 /* TODO: We might get more coverage if we was actually delaying expansion
14314 of all expressions till end of compilation when constant pools are fully
14315 populated. */
14316 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (rtl, 0))))
14317 {
14318 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14319 "CST value in contant pool but not marked.");
14320 return 0;
14321 }
14322 return mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), get_address_mode (rtl),
14323 GET_MODE (rtl), VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14324 }
14325
14326 /* Return dw_loc_list representing address of addr_expr LOC
14327 by looking for inner INDIRECT_REF expression and turning
14328 it into simple arithmetics.
14329
14330 See loc_list_from_tree for the meaning of CONTEXT. */
14331
14332 static dw_loc_list_ref
14333 loc_list_for_address_of_addr_expr_of_indirect_ref (tree loc, bool toplev,
14334 const loc_descr_context *context)
14335 {
14336 tree obj, offset;
14337 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
14338 machine_mode mode;
14339 int unsignedp, volatilep = 0;
14340 dw_loc_list_ref list_ret = NULL, list_ret1 = NULL;
14341
14342 obj = get_inner_reference (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0),
14343 &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
14344 &unsignedp, &volatilep, false);
14345 STRIP_NOPS (obj);
14346 if (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT)
14347 {
14348 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "bitfield access");
14349 return 0;
14350 }
14351 if (!INDIRECT_REF_P (obj))
14352 {
14353 expansion_failed (obj,
14354 NULL_RTX, "no indirect ref in inner refrence");
14355 return 0;
14356 }
14357 if (!offset && !bitpos)
14358 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (obj, 0), toplev ? 2 : 1,
14359 context);
14360 else if (toplev
14361 && int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14362 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
14363 {
14364 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (obj, 0), 0, context);
14365 if (!list_ret)
14366 return 0;
14367 if (offset)
14368 {
14369 /* Variable offset. */
14370 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (offset, 0, context);
14371 if (list_ret1 == 0)
14372 return 0;
14373 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
14374 if (!list_ret)
14375 return 0;
14376 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
14377 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
14378 }
14379 bytepos = bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
14380 if (bytepos > 0)
14381 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
14382 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
14383 bytepos, 0));
14384 else if (bytepos < 0)
14385 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, bytepos);
14386 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
14387 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
14388 }
14389 return list_ret;
14390 }
14391
14392
14393 /* Helper structure for location descriptions generation. */
14394 struct loc_descr_context
14395 {
14396 /* The type that is implicitly referenced by DW_OP_push_object_address, or
14397 NULL_TREE if DW_OP_push_object_address in invalid for this location
14398 description. This is used when processing PLACEHOLDER_EXPR nodes. */
14399 tree context_type;
14400 /* The ..._DECL node that should be translated as a
14401 DW_OP_push_object_address operation. */
14402 tree base_decl;
14403 };
14404
14405 /* Generate Dwarf location list representing LOC.
14406 If WANT_ADDRESS is false, expression computing LOC will be computed
14407 If WANT_ADDRESS is 1, expression computing address of LOC will be returned
14408 if WANT_ADDRESS is 2, expression computing address useable in location
14409 will be returned (i.e. DW_OP_reg can be used
14410 to refer to register values).
14411
14412 CONTEXT provides information to customize the location descriptions
14413 generation. Its context_type field specifies what type is implicitly
14414 referenced by DW_OP_push_object_address. If it is NULL_TREE, this operation
14415 will not be generated.
14416
14417 If CONTEXT is NULL, the behavior is the same as if both context_type and
14418 base_decl fields were NULL_TREE. */
14419
14420 static dw_loc_list_ref
14421 loc_list_from_tree (tree loc, int want_address,
14422 const struct loc_descr_context *context)
14423 {
14424 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = NULL, ret1 = NULL;
14425 dw_loc_list_ref list_ret = NULL, list_ret1 = NULL;
14426 int have_address = 0;
14427 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
14428
14429 /* ??? Most of the time we do not take proper care for sign/zero
14430 extending the values properly. Hopefully this won't be a real
14431 problem... */
14432
14433 if (context != NULL
14434 && context->base_decl == loc
14435 && want_address == 0)
14436 {
14437 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
14438 return new_loc_list (new_loc_descr (DW_OP_push_object_address, 0, 0),
14439 NULL, NULL, NULL);
14440 else
14441 return NULL;
14442 }
14443
14444 switch (TREE_CODE (loc))
14445 {
14446 case ERROR_MARK:
14447 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "ERROR_MARK");
14448 return 0;
14449
14450 case PLACEHOLDER_EXPR:
14451 /* This case involves extracting fields from an object to determine the
14452 position of other fields. It is supposed to appear only as the first
14453 operand of COMPONENT_REF nodes and to reference precisely the type
14454 that the context allows. */
14455 if (context != NULL
14456 && TREE_TYPE (loc) == context->context_type
14457 && want_address >= 1)
14458 {
14459 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
14460 {
14461 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_push_object_address, 0, 0);
14462 have_address = 1;
14463 break;
14464 }
14465 else
14466 return NULL;
14467 }
14468 else
14469 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14470 "PLACEHOLDER_EXPR for an unexpected type");
14471 break;
14472
14473 case CALL_EXPR:
14474 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "CALL_EXPR");
14475 /* There are no opcodes for these operations. */
14476 return 0;
14477
14478 case PREINCREMENT_EXPR:
14479 case PREDECREMENT_EXPR:
14480 case POSTINCREMENT_EXPR:
14481 case POSTDECREMENT_EXPR:
14482 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "PRE/POST INDCREMENT/DECREMENT");
14483 /* There are no opcodes for these operations. */
14484 return 0;
14485
14486 case ADDR_EXPR:
14487 /* If we already want an address, see if there is INDIRECT_REF inside
14488 e.g. for &this->field. */
14489 if (want_address)
14490 {
14491 list_ret = loc_list_for_address_of_addr_expr_of_indirect_ref
14492 (loc, want_address == 2, context);
14493 if (list_ret)
14494 have_address = 1;
14495 else if (decl_address_ip_invariant_p (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))
14496 && (ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
14497 have_address = 1;
14498 }
14499 /* Otherwise, process the argument and look for the address. */
14500 if (!list_ret && !ret)
14501 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 1, context);
14502 else
14503 {
14504 if (want_address)
14505 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "need address of ADDR_EXPR");
14506 return NULL;
14507 }
14508 break;
14509
14510 case VAR_DECL:
14511 if (DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (loc))
14512 {
14513 rtx rtl;
14514 enum dwarf_location_atom tls_op;
14515 enum dtprel_bool dtprel = dtprel_false;
14516
14517 if (targetm.have_tls)
14518 {
14519 /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the
14520 data. */
14521 if (!targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
14522 return 0;
14523
14524 /* The way DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address is specified, we
14525 can only look up addresses of objects in the current
14526 module. We used DW_OP_addr as first op, but that's
14527 wrong, because DW_OP_addr is relocated by the debug
14528 info consumer, while DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address
14529 operand shouldn't be. */
14530 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (loc) && !targetm.binds_local_p (loc))
14531 return 0;
14532 dtprel = dtprel_true;
14533 tls_op = DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address;
14534 }
14535 else
14536 {
14537 if (!targetm.emutls.debug_form_tls_address
14538 || !(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
14539 return 0;
14540 /* We stuffed the control variable into the DECL_VALUE_EXPR
14541 to signal (via DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P) that the decl should
14542 no longer appear in gimple code. We used the control
14543 variable in specific so that we could pick it up here. */
14544 loc = DECL_VALUE_EXPR (loc);
14545 tls_op = DW_OP_form_tls_address;
14546 }
14547
14548 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
14549 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
14550 return 0;
14551
14552 if (!MEM_P (rtl))
14553 return 0;
14554 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
14555 if (! CONSTANT_P (rtl))
14556 return 0;
14557
14558 ret = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel);
14559 ret1 = new_loc_descr (tls_op, 0, 0);
14560 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
14561
14562 have_address = 1;
14563 break;
14564 }
14565 /* FALLTHRU */
14566
14567 case PARM_DECL:
14568 case RESULT_DECL:
14569 if (DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (loc))
14570 return loc_list_from_tree (DECL_VALUE_EXPR (loc),
14571 want_address, context);
14572 /* FALLTHRU */
14573
14574 case FUNCTION_DECL:
14575 {
14576 rtx rtl;
14577 var_loc_list *loc_list = lookup_decl_loc (loc);
14578
14579 if (loc_list && loc_list->first)
14580 {
14581 list_ret = dw_loc_list (loc_list, loc, want_address);
14582 have_address = want_address != 0;
14583 break;
14584 }
14585 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
14586 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
14587 {
14588 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "DECL has no RTL");
14589 return 0;
14590 }
14591 else if (CONST_INT_P (rtl))
14592 {
14593 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
14594 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
14595 val &= GET_MODE_MASK (DECL_MODE (loc));
14596 ret = int_loc_descriptor (val);
14597 }
14598 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
14599 {
14600 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "CONST_STRING");
14601 return 0;
14602 }
14603 else if (CONSTANT_P (rtl) && const_ok_for_output (rtl))
14604 ret = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_false);
14605 else
14606 {
14607 machine_mode mode, mem_mode;
14608
14609 /* Certain constructs can only be represented at top-level. */
14610 if (want_address == 2)
14611 {
14612 ret = loc_descriptor (rtl, VOIDmode,
14613 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14614 have_address = 1;
14615 }
14616 else
14617 {
14618 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
14619 mem_mode = VOIDmode;
14620 if (MEM_P (rtl))
14621 {
14622 mem_mode = mode;
14623 mode = get_address_mode (rtl);
14624 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
14625 have_address = 1;
14626 }
14627 ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode,
14628 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14629 }
14630 if (!ret)
14631 expansion_failed (loc, rtl,
14632 "failed to produce loc descriptor for rtl");
14633 }
14634 }
14635 break;
14636
14637 case MEM_REF:
14638 if (!integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)))
14639 {
14640 have_address = 1;
14641 goto do_plus;
14642 }
14643 /* Fallthru. */
14644 case INDIRECT_REF:
14645 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
14646 have_address = 1;
14647 break;
14648
14649 case TARGET_MEM_REF:
14650 case SSA_NAME:
14651 case DEBUG_EXPR_DECL:
14652 return NULL;
14653
14654 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
14655 return loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), want_address, context);
14656
14657 CASE_CONVERT:
14658 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
14659 case SAVE_EXPR:
14660 case MODIFY_EXPR:
14661 return loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), want_address, context);
14662
14663 case COMPONENT_REF:
14664 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
14665 case ARRAY_REF:
14666 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
14667 case REALPART_EXPR:
14668 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
14669 {
14670 tree obj, offset;
14671 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
14672 machine_mode mode;
14673 int unsignedp, volatilep = 0;
14674
14675 obj = get_inner_reference (loc, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
14676 &unsignedp, &volatilep, false);
14677
14678 gcc_assert (obj != loc);
14679
14680 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (obj,
14681 want_address == 2
14682 && !bitpos && !offset ? 2 : 1,
14683 context);
14684 /* TODO: We can extract value of the small expression via shifting even
14685 for nonzero bitpos. */
14686 if (list_ret == 0)
14687 return 0;
14688 if (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0 || bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)
14689 {
14690 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14691 "bitfield access");
14692 return 0;
14693 }
14694
14695 if (offset != NULL_TREE)
14696 {
14697 /* Variable offset. */
14698 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (offset, 0, context);
14699 if (list_ret1 == 0)
14700 return 0;
14701 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
14702 if (!list_ret)
14703 return 0;
14704 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
14705 }
14706
14707 bytepos = bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
14708 if (bytepos > 0)
14709 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bytepos, 0));
14710 else if (bytepos < 0)
14711 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, bytepos);
14712
14713 have_address = 1;
14714 break;
14715 }
14716
14717 case INTEGER_CST:
14718 if ((want_address || !tree_fits_shwi_p (loc))
14719 && (ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
14720 have_address = 1;
14721 else if (want_address == 2
14722 && tree_fits_shwi_p (loc)
14723 && (ret = address_of_int_loc_descriptor
14724 (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)),
14725 tree_to_shwi (loc))))
14726 have_address = 1;
14727 else if (tree_fits_shwi_p (loc))
14728 ret = int_loc_descriptor (tree_to_shwi (loc));
14729 else
14730 {
14731 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14732 "Integer operand is not host integer");
14733 return 0;
14734 }
14735 break;
14736
14737 case CONSTRUCTOR:
14738 case REAL_CST:
14739 case STRING_CST:
14740 case COMPLEX_CST:
14741 if ((ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
14742 have_address = 1;
14743 else
14744 /* We can construct small constants here using int_loc_descriptor. */
14745 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14746 "constructor or constant not in constant pool");
14747 break;
14748
14749 case TRUTH_AND_EXPR:
14750 case TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR:
14751 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
14752 op = DW_OP_and;
14753 goto do_binop;
14754
14755 case TRUTH_XOR_EXPR:
14756 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
14757 op = DW_OP_xor;
14758 goto do_binop;
14759
14760 case TRUTH_OR_EXPR:
14761 case TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR:
14762 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
14763 op = DW_OP_or;
14764 goto do_binop;
14765
14766 case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
14767 case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
14768 case ROUND_DIV_EXPR:
14769 case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
14770 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
14771 return 0;
14772 op = DW_OP_div;
14773 goto do_binop;
14774
14775 case MINUS_EXPR:
14776 op = DW_OP_minus;
14777 goto do_binop;
14778
14779 case FLOOR_MOD_EXPR:
14780 case CEIL_MOD_EXPR:
14781 case ROUND_MOD_EXPR:
14782 case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
14783 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
14784 {
14785 op = DW_OP_mod;
14786 goto do_binop;
14787 }
14788 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
14789 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0, context);
14790 if (list_ret == 0 || list_ret1 == 0)
14791 return 0;
14792
14793 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
14794 if (list_ret == 0)
14795 return 0;
14796 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
14797 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
14798 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_div, 0, 0));
14799 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
14800 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
14801 break;
14802
14803 case MULT_EXPR:
14804 op = DW_OP_mul;
14805 goto do_binop;
14806
14807 case LSHIFT_EXPR:
14808 op = DW_OP_shl;
14809 goto do_binop;
14810
14811 case RSHIFT_EXPR:
14812 op = (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)) ? DW_OP_shr : DW_OP_shra);
14813 goto do_binop;
14814
14815 case POINTER_PLUS_EXPR:
14816 case PLUS_EXPR:
14817 do_plus:
14818 if (tree_fits_shwi_p (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)))
14819 {
14820 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
14821 if (list_ret == 0)
14822 return 0;
14823
14824 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, tree_to_shwi (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)));
14825 break;
14826 }
14827
14828 op = DW_OP_plus;
14829 goto do_binop;
14830
14831 case LE_EXPR:
14832 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
14833 return 0;
14834
14835 op = DW_OP_le;
14836 goto do_binop;
14837
14838 case GE_EXPR:
14839 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
14840 return 0;
14841
14842 op = DW_OP_ge;
14843 goto do_binop;
14844
14845 case LT_EXPR:
14846 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
14847 return 0;
14848
14849 op = DW_OP_lt;
14850 goto do_binop;
14851
14852 case GT_EXPR:
14853 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
14854 return 0;
14855
14856 op = DW_OP_gt;
14857 goto do_binop;
14858
14859 case EQ_EXPR:
14860 op = DW_OP_eq;
14861 goto do_binop;
14862
14863 case NE_EXPR:
14864 op = DW_OP_ne;
14865 goto do_binop;
14866
14867 do_binop:
14868 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
14869 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0, context);
14870 if (list_ret == 0 || list_ret1 == 0)
14871 return 0;
14872
14873 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
14874 if (list_ret == 0)
14875 return 0;
14876 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
14877 break;
14878
14879 case TRUTH_NOT_EXPR:
14880 case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
14881 op = DW_OP_not;
14882 goto do_unop;
14883
14884 case ABS_EXPR:
14885 op = DW_OP_abs;
14886 goto do_unop;
14887
14888 case NEGATE_EXPR:
14889 op = DW_OP_neg;
14890 goto do_unop;
14891
14892 do_unop:
14893 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
14894 if (list_ret == 0)
14895 return 0;
14896
14897 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
14898 break;
14899
14900 case MIN_EXPR:
14901 case MAX_EXPR:
14902 {
14903 const enum tree_code code =
14904 TREE_CODE (loc) == MIN_EXPR ? GT_EXPR : LT_EXPR;
14905
14906 loc = build3 (COND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (loc),
14907 build2 (code, integer_type_node,
14908 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)),
14909 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0));
14910 }
14911
14912 /* ... fall through ... */
14913
14914 case COND_EXPR:
14915 {
14916 dw_loc_descr_ref lhs
14917 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0, context);
14918 dw_loc_list_ref rhs
14919 = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 2), 0, context);
14920 dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, jump_node, tmp;
14921
14922 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
14923 if (list_ret == 0 || lhs == 0 || rhs == 0)
14924 return 0;
14925
14926 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
14927 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, bra_node);
14928
14929 add_loc_list (&list_ret, rhs);
14930 jump_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
14931 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, jump_node);
14932
14933 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, lhs);
14934 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14935 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = lhs;
14936
14937 /* ??? Need a node to point the skip at. Use a nop. */
14938 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
14939 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, tmp);
14940 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14941 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
14942 }
14943 break;
14944
14945 case FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
14946 return 0;
14947
14948 default:
14949 /* Leave front-end specific codes as simply unknown. This comes
14950 up, for instance, with the C STMT_EXPR. */
14951 if ((unsigned int) TREE_CODE (loc)
14952 >= (unsigned int) LAST_AND_UNUSED_TREE_CODE)
14953 {
14954 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14955 "language specific tree node");
14956 return 0;
14957 }
14958
14959 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
14960 /* Otherwise this is a generic code; we should just lists all of
14961 these explicitly. We forgot one. */
14962 gcc_unreachable ();
14963 #else
14964 /* In a release build, we want to degrade gracefully: better to
14965 generate incomplete debugging information than to crash. */
14966 return NULL;
14967 #endif
14968 }
14969
14970 if (!ret && !list_ret)
14971 return 0;
14972
14973 if (want_address == 2 && !have_address
14974 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
14975 {
14976 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14977 {
14978 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14979 "DWARF address size mismatch");
14980 return 0;
14981 }
14982 if (ret)
14983 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
14984 else
14985 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
14986 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
14987 have_address = 1;
14988 }
14989 /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address. */
14990 if (want_address && !have_address)
14991 {
14992 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14993 "Want address and only have value");
14994 return 0;
14995 }
14996
14997 gcc_assert (!ret || !list_ret);
14998
14999 /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference. */
15000 if (!want_address && have_address)
15001 {
15002 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
15003
15004 if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
15005 {
15006 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
15007 "DWARF address size mismatch");
15008 return 0;
15009 }
15010 else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15011 op = DW_OP_deref;
15012 else
15013 op = DW_OP_deref_size;
15014
15015 if (ret)
15016 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
15017 else
15018 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
15019 }
15020 if (ret)
15021 list_ret = new_loc_list (ret, NULL, NULL, NULL);
15022
15023 return list_ret;
15024 }
15025
15026 /* Same as above but return only single location expression. */
15027 static dw_loc_descr_ref
15028 loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree loc, int want_address,
15029 const struct loc_descr_context *context)
15030 {
15031 dw_loc_list_ref ret = loc_list_from_tree (loc, want_address, context);
15032 if (!ret)
15033 return NULL;
15034 if (ret->dw_loc_next)
15035 {
15036 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
15037 "Location list where only loc descriptor needed");
15038 return NULL;
15039 }
15040 return ret->expr;
15041 }
15042
15043 /* Given a value, round it up to the lowest multiple of `boundary'
15044 which is not less than the value itself. */
15045
15046 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
15047 ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT value, unsigned int boundary)
15048 {
15049 return (((value + boundary - 1) / boundary) * boundary);
15050 }
15051
15052 /* Given a pointer to what is assumed to be a FIELD_DECL node, return a
15053 pointer to the declared type for the relevant field variable, or return
15054 `integer_type_node' if the given node turns out to be an
15055 ERROR_MARK node. */
15056
15057 static inline tree
15058 field_type (const_tree decl)
15059 {
15060 tree type;
15061
15062 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
15063 return integer_type_node;
15064
15065 type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
15066 if (type == NULL_TREE)
15067 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
15068
15069 return type;
15070 }
15071
15072 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, return the alignment in bits for
15073 it, or else return BITS_PER_WORD if the node actually turns out to
15074 be an ERROR_MARK node. */
15075
15076 static inline unsigned
15077 simple_type_align_in_bits (const_tree type)
15078 {
15079 return (TREE_CODE (type) != ERROR_MARK) ? TYPE_ALIGN (type) : BITS_PER_WORD;
15080 }
15081
15082 static inline unsigned
15083 simple_decl_align_in_bits (const_tree decl)
15084 {
15085 return (TREE_CODE (decl) != ERROR_MARK) ? DECL_ALIGN (decl) : BITS_PER_WORD;
15086 }
15087
15088 /* Return the result of rounding T up to ALIGN. */
15089
15090 static inline offset_int
15091 round_up_to_align (const offset_int &t, unsigned int align)
15092 {
15093 return wi::udiv_trunc (t + align - 1, align) * align;
15094 }
15095
15096 /* Given a pointer to a FIELD_DECL, compute and return the byte offset of the
15097 lowest addressed byte of the "containing object" for the given FIELD_DECL,
15098 or return 0 if we are unable to determine what that offset is, either
15099 because the argument turns out to be a pointer to an ERROR_MARK node, or
15100 because the offset is actually variable. (We can't handle the latter case
15101 just yet). */
15102
15103 static HOST_WIDE_INT
15104 field_byte_offset (const_tree decl)
15105 {
15106 offset_int object_offset_in_bits;
15107 offset_int object_offset_in_bytes;
15108 offset_int bitpos_int;
15109
15110 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
15111 return 0;
15112
15113 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
15114
15115 /* We cannot yet cope with fields whose positions are variable, so
15116 for now, when we see such things, we simply return 0. Someday, we may
15117 be able to handle such cases, but it will be damn difficult. */
15118 if (TREE_CODE (bit_position (decl)) != INTEGER_CST)
15119 return 0;
15120
15121 bitpos_int = wi::to_offset (bit_position (decl));
15122
15123 if (PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS)
15124 {
15125 tree type;
15126 tree field_size_tree;
15127 offset_int deepest_bitpos;
15128 offset_int field_size_in_bits;
15129 unsigned int type_align_in_bits;
15130 unsigned int decl_align_in_bits;
15131 offset_int type_size_in_bits;
15132
15133 type = field_type (decl);
15134 type_size_in_bits = offset_int_type_size_in_bits (type);
15135 type_align_in_bits = simple_type_align_in_bits (type);
15136
15137 field_size_tree = DECL_SIZE (decl);
15138
15139 /* The size could be unspecified if there was an error, or for
15140 a flexible array member. */
15141 if (!field_size_tree)
15142 field_size_tree = bitsize_zero_node;
15143
15144 /* If the size of the field is not constant, use the type size. */
15145 if (TREE_CODE (field_size_tree) == INTEGER_CST)
15146 field_size_in_bits = wi::to_offset (field_size_tree);
15147 else
15148 field_size_in_bits = type_size_in_bits;
15149
15150 decl_align_in_bits = simple_decl_align_in_bits (decl);
15151
15152 /* The GCC front-end doesn't make any attempt to keep track of the
15153 starting bit offset (relative to the start of the containing
15154 structure type) of the hypothetical "containing object" for a
15155 bit-field. Thus, when computing the byte offset value for the
15156 start of the "containing object" of a bit-field, we must deduce
15157 this information on our own. This can be rather tricky to do in
15158 some cases. For example, handling the following structure type
15159 definition when compiling for an i386/i486 target (which only
15160 aligns long long's to 32-bit boundaries) can be very tricky:
15161
15162 struct S { int field1; long long field2:31; };
15163
15164 Fortunately, there is a simple rule-of-thumb which can be used
15165 in such cases. When compiling for an i386/i486, GCC will
15166 allocate 8 bytes for the structure shown above. It decides to
15167 do this based upon one simple rule for bit-field allocation.
15168 GCC allocates each "containing object" for each bit-field at
15169 the first (i.e. lowest addressed) legitimate alignment boundary
15170 (based upon the required minimum alignment for the declared
15171 type of the field) which it can possibly use, subject to the
15172 condition that there is still enough available space remaining
15173 in the containing object (when allocated at the selected point)
15174 to fully accommodate all of the bits of the bit-field itself.
15175
15176 This simple rule makes it obvious why GCC allocates 8 bytes for
15177 each object of the structure type shown above. When looking
15178 for a place to allocate the "containing object" for `field2',
15179 the compiler simply tries to allocate a 64-bit "containing
15180 object" at each successive 32-bit boundary (starting at zero)
15181 until it finds a place to allocate that 64- bit field such that
15182 at least 31 contiguous (and previously unallocated) bits remain
15183 within that selected 64 bit field. (As it turns out, for the
15184 example above, the compiler finds it is OK to allocate the
15185 "containing object" 64-bit field at bit-offset zero within the
15186 structure type.)
15187
15188 Here we attempt to work backwards from the limited set of facts
15189 we're given, and we try to deduce from those facts, where GCC
15190 must have believed that the containing object started (within
15191 the structure type). The value we deduce is then used (by the
15192 callers of this routine) to generate DW_AT_location and
15193 DW_AT_bit_offset attributes for fields (both bit-fields and, in
15194 the case of DW_AT_location, regular fields as well). */
15195
15196 /* Figure out the bit-distance from the start of the structure to
15197 the "deepest" bit of the bit-field. */
15198 deepest_bitpos = bitpos_int + field_size_in_bits;
15199
15200 /* This is the tricky part. Use some fancy footwork to deduce
15201 where the lowest addressed bit of the containing object must
15202 be. */
15203 object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
15204
15205 /* Round up to type_align by default. This works best for
15206 bitfields. */
15207 object_offset_in_bits
15208 = round_up_to_align (object_offset_in_bits, type_align_in_bits);
15209
15210 if (wi::gtu_p (object_offset_in_bits, bitpos_int))
15211 {
15212 object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
15213
15214 /* Round up to decl_align instead. */
15215 object_offset_in_bits
15216 = round_up_to_align (object_offset_in_bits, decl_align_in_bits);
15217 }
15218 }
15219 else
15220 object_offset_in_bits = bitpos_int;
15221
15222 object_offset_in_bytes
15223 = wi::lrshift (object_offset_in_bits, LOG2_BITS_PER_UNIT);
15224 return object_offset_in_bytes.to_shwi ();
15225 }
15226 \f
15227 /* The following routines define various Dwarf attributes and any data
15228 associated with them. */
15229
15230 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE.
15231
15232 This emits location attributes suitable for whole variables and
15233 whole parameters. Note that the location attributes for struct fields are
15234 generated by the routine `data_member_location_attribute' below. */
15235
15236 static inline void
15237 add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
15238 dw_loc_list_ref descr)
15239 {
15240 if (descr == 0)
15241 return;
15242 if (single_element_loc_list_p (descr))
15243 add_AT_loc (die, attr_kind, descr->expr);
15244 else
15245 add_AT_loc_list (die, attr_kind, descr);
15246 }
15247
15248 /* Add DW_AT_accessibility attribute to DIE if needed. */
15249
15250 static void
15251 add_accessibility_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
15252 {
15253 /* In DWARF3+ the default is DW_ACCESS_private only in DW_TAG_class_type
15254 children, otherwise the default is DW_ACCESS_public. In DWARF2
15255 the default has always been DW_ACCESS_public. */
15256 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
15257 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
15258 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
15259 {
15260 if (dwarf_version == 2
15261 || die->die_parent == NULL
15262 || die->die_parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_class_type)
15263 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
15264 }
15265 else if (dwarf_version > 2
15266 && die->die_parent
15267 && die->die_parent->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type)
15268 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
15269 }
15270
15271 /* Attach the specialized form of location attribute used for data members of
15272 struct and union types. In the special case of a FIELD_DECL node which
15273 represents a bit-field, the "offset" part of this special location
15274 descriptor must indicate the distance in bytes from the lowest-addressed
15275 byte of the containing struct or union type to the lowest-addressed byte of
15276 the "containing object" for the bit-field. (See the `field_byte_offset'
15277 function above).
15278
15279 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
15280 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
15281 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
15282 declared type of the individual bit-field itself (for GCC anyway... the
15283 DWARF spec doesn't actually mandate this). Note that it is the size (in
15284 bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object" which will be given in the
15285 DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field. (See the
15286 `byte_size_attribute' function below.) It is also used when calculating the
15287 value of the DW_AT_bit_offset attribute. (See the `bit_offset_attribute'
15288 function below.) */
15289
15290 static void
15291 add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
15292 {
15293 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
15294 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descr = 0;
15295
15296 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TREE_BINFO)
15297 {
15298 /* We're working on the TAG_inheritance for a base class. */
15299 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (decl) && is_cxx ())
15300 {
15301 /* For C++ virtual bases we can't just use BINFO_OFFSET, as they
15302 aren't at a fixed offset from all (sub)objects of the same
15303 type. We need to extract the appropriate offset from our
15304 vtable. The following dwarf expression means
15305
15306 BaseAddr = ObAddr + *((*ObAddr) - Offset)
15307
15308 This is specific to the V3 ABI, of course. */
15309
15310 dw_loc_descr_ref tmp;
15311
15312 /* Make a copy of the object address. */
15313 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
15314 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
15315
15316 /* Extract the vtable address. */
15317 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
15318 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
15319
15320 /* Calculate the address of the offset. */
15321 offset = tree_to_shwi (BINFO_VPTR_FIELD (decl));
15322 gcc_assert (offset < 0);
15323
15324 tmp = int_loc_descriptor (-offset);
15325 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
15326 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0);
15327 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
15328
15329 /* Extract the offset. */
15330 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
15331 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
15332
15333 /* Add it to the object address. */
15334 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0);
15335 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
15336 }
15337 else
15338 offset = tree_to_shwi (BINFO_OFFSET (decl));
15339 }
15340 else
15341 offset = field_byte_offset (decl);
15342
15343 if (! loc_descr)
15344 {
15345 if (dwarf_version > 2)
15346 {
15347 /* Don't need to output a location expression, just the constant. */
15348 if (offset < 0)
15349 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, offset);
15350 else
15351 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, offset);
15352 return;
15353 }
15354 else
15355 {
15356 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
15357
15358 /* The DWARF2 standard says that we should assume that the structure
15359 address is already on the stack, so we can specify a structure
15360 field address by using DW_OP_plus_uconst. */
15361 op = DW_OP_plus_uconst;
15362 loc_descr = new_loc_descr (op, offset, 0);
15363 }
15364 }
15365
15366 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, loc_descr);
15367 }
15368
15369 /* Writes integer values to dw_vec_const array. */
15370
15371 static void
15372 insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT val, unsigned int size, unsigned char *dest)
15373 {
15374 while (size != 0)
15375 {
15376 *dest++ = val & 0xff;
15377 val >>= 8;
15378 --size;
15379 }
15380 }
15381
15382 /* Reads integers from dw_vec_const array. Inverse of insert_int. */
15383
15384 static HOST_WIDE_INT
15385 extract_int (const unsigned char *src, unsigned int size)
15386 {
15387 HOST_WIDE_INT val = 0;
15388
15389 src += size;
15390 while (size != 0)
15391 {
15392 val <<= 8;
15393 val |= *--src & 0xff;
15394 --size;
15395 }
15396 return val;
15397 }
15398
15399 /* Writes wide_int values to dw_vec_const array. */
15400
15401 static void
15402 insert_wide_int (const wide_int &val, unsigned char *dest, int elt_size)
15403 {
15404 int i;
15405
15406 if (elt_size <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT/BITS_PER_UNIT)
15407 {
15408 insert_int ((HOST_WIDE_INT) val.elt (0), elt_size, dest);
15409 return;
15410 }
15411
15412 /* We'd have to extend this code to support odd sizes. */
15413 gcc_assert (elt_size % (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0);
15414
15415 int n = elt_size / (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT);
15416
15417 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
15418 for (i = n - 1; i >= 0; i--)
15419 {
15420 insert_int ((HOST_WIDE_INT) val.elt (i), sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), dest);
15421 dest += sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT);
15422 }
15423 else
15424 for (i = 0; i < n; i++)
15425 {
15426 insert_int ((HOST_WIDE_INT) val.elt (i), sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), dest);
15427 dest += sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT);
15428 }
15429 }
15430
15431 /* Writes floating point values to dw_vec_const array. */
15432
15433 static void
15434 insert_float (const_rtx rtl, unsigned char *array)
15435 {
15436 REAL_VALUE_TYPE rv;
15437 long val[4];
15438 int i;
15439
15440 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (rv, rtl);
15441 real_to_target (val, &rv, GET_MODE (rtl));
15442
15443 /* real_to_target puts 32-bit pieces in each long. Pack them. */
15444 for (i = 0; i < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / 4; i++)
15445 {
15446 insert_int (val[i], 4, array);
15447 array += 4;
15448 }
15449 }
15450
15451 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute for a variable or a parameter which
15452 does not have a "location" either in memory or in a register. These
15453 things can arise in GNU C when a constant is passed as an actual parameter
15454 to an inlined function. They can also arise in C++ where declared
15455 constants do not necessarily get memory "homes". */
15456
15457 static bool
15458 add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, rtx rtl)
15459 {
15460 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
15461 {
15462 case CONST_INT:
15463 {
15464 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
15465
15466 if (val < 0)
15467 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_const_value, val);
15468 else
15469 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_const_value, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) val);
15470 }
15471 return true;
15472
15473 case CONST_WIDE_INT:
15474 add_AT_wide (die, DW_AT_const_value,
15475 std::make_pair (rtl, GET_MODE (rtl)));
15476 return true;
15477
15478 case CONST_DOUBLE:
15479 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer or a
15480 floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever the
15481 constant requires more than one word in order to be adequately
15482 represented. */
15483 {
15484 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
15485
15486 if (TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT == 0 && !SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
15487 add_AT_double (die, DW_AT_const_value,
15488 CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (rtl), CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (rtl));
15489 else
15490 {
15491 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
15492 unsigned char *array = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length);
15493
15494 insert_float (rtl, array);
15495 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length / 4, 4, array);
15496 }
15497 }
15498 return true;
15499
15500 case CONST_VECTOR:
15501 {
15502 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
15503 unsigned int elt_size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode);
15504 unsigned int length = CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl);
15505 unsigned char *array
15506 = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length * elt_size);
15507 unsigned int i;
15508 unsigned char *p;
15509 machine_mode imode = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
15510
15511 switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
15512 {
15513 case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
15514 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
15515 {
15516 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
15517 insert_wide_int (std::make_pair (elt, imode), p, elt_size);
15518 }
15519 break;
15520
15521 case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
15522 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
15523 {
15524 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
15525 insert_float (elt, p);
15526 }
15527 break;
15528
15529 default:
15530 gcc_unreachable ();
15531 }
15532
15533 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length, elt_size, array);
15534 }
15535 return true;
15536
15537 case CONST_STRING:
15538 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
15539 {
15540 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result;
15541 resolve_one_addr (&rtl);
15542 rtl_addr:
15543 loc_result = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_false);
15544 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
15545 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_location, loc_result);
15546 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
15547 return true;
15548 }
15549 return false;
15550
15551 case CONST:
15552 if (CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
15553 return add_const_value_attribute (die, XEXP (rtl, 0));
15554 /* FALLTHROUGH */
15555 case SYMBOL_REF:
15556 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
15557 return false;
15558 case LABEL_REF:
15559 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
15560 goto rtl_addr;
15561 return false;
15562
15563 case PLUS:
15564 /* In cases where an inlined instance of an inline function is passed
15565 the address of an `auto' variable (which is local to the caller) we
15566 can get a situation where the DECL_RTL of the artificial local
15567 variable (for the inlining) which acts as a stand-in for the
15568 corresponding formal parameter (of the inline function) will look
15569 like (plus:SI (reg:SI FRAME_PTR) (const_int ...)). This is not
15570 exactly a compile-time constant expression, but it isn't the address
15571 of the (artificial) local variable either. Rather, it represents the
15572 *value* which the artificial local variable always has during its
15573 lifetime. We currently have no way to represent such quasi-constant
15574 values in Dwarf, so for now we just punt and generate nothing. */
15575 return false;
15576
15577 case HIGH:
15578 case CONST_FIXED:
15579 return false;
15580
15581 case MEM:
15582 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_STRING
15583 && MEM_READONLY_P (rtl)
15584 && GET_MODE (rtl) == BLKmode)
15585 {
15586 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_const_value, XSTR (XEXP (rtl, 0), 0));
15587 return true;
15588 }
15589 return false;
15590
15591 default:
15592 /* No other kinds of rtx should be possible here. */
15593 gcc_unreachable ();
15594 }
15595 return false;
15596 }
15597
15598 /* Determine whether the evaluation of EXPR references any variables
15599 or functions which aren't otherwise used (and therefore may not be
15600 output). */
15601 static tree
15602 reference_to_unused (tree * tp, int * walk_subtrees,
15603 void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
15604 {
15605 if (! EXPR_P (*tp) && ! CONSTANT_CLASS_P (*tp))
15606 *walk_subtrees = 0;
15607
15608 if (DECL_P (*tp) && ! TREE_PUBLIC (*tp) && ! TREE_USED (*tp)
15609 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (*tp))
15610 return *tp;
15611 /* ??? The C++ FE emits debug information for using decls, so
15612 putting gcc_unreachable here falls over. See PR31899. For now
15613 be conservative. */
15614 else if (!symtab->global_info_ready
15615 && (TREE_CODE (*tp) == VAR_DECL || TREE_CODE (*tp) == FUNCTION_DECL))
15616 return *tp;
15617 else if (TREE_CODE (*tp) == VAR_DECL)
15618 {
15619 varpool_node *node = varpool_node::get (*tp);
15620 if (!node || !node->definition)
15621 return *tp;
15622 }
15623 else if (TREE_CODE (*tp) == FUNCTION_DECL
15624 && (!DECL_EXTERNAL (*tp) || DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (*tp)))
15625 {
15626 /* The call graph machinery must have finished analyzing,
15627 optimizing and gimplifying the CU by now.
15628 So if *TP has no call graph node associated
15629 to it, it means *TP will not be emitted. */
15630 if (!cgraph_node::get (*tp))
15631 return *tp;
15632 }
15633 else if (TREE_CODE (*tp) == STRING_CST && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (*tp))
15634 return *tp;
15635
15636 return NULL_TREE;
15637 }
15638
15639 /* Generate an RTL constant from a decl initializer INIT with decl type TYPE,
15640 for use in a later add_const_value_attribute call. */
15641
15642 static rtx
15643 rtl_for_decl_init (tree init, tree type)
15644 {
15645 rtx rtl = NULL_RTX;
15646
15647 STRIP_NOPS (init);
15648
15649 /* If a variable is initialized with a string constant without embedded
15650 zeros, build CONST_STRING. */
15651 if (TREE_CODE (init) == STRING_CST && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
15652 {
15653 tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
15654 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
15655 machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (enttype);
15656
15657 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1
15658 && domain
15659 && integer_zerop (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain))
15660 && compare_tree_int (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain),
15661 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init) - 1) == 0
15662 && ((size_t) TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)
15663 == strlen (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)) + 1))
15664 {
15665 rtl = gen_rtx_CONST_STRING (VOIDmode,
15666 ggc_strdup (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)));
15667 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, rtl);
15668 MEM_READONLY_P (rtl) = 1;
15669 }
15670 }
15671 /* Other aggregates, and complex values, could be represented using
15672 CONCAT: FIXME! */
15673 else if (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type)
15674 || (TREE_CODE (init) == VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR
15675 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0))))
15676 || TREE_CODE (type) == COMPLEX_TYPE)
15677 ;
15678 /* Vectors only work if their mode is supported by the target.
15679 FIXME: generic vectors ought to work too. */
15680 else if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE
15681 && !VECTOR_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type)))
15682 ;
15683 /* If the initializer is something that we know will expand into an
15684 immediate RTL constant, expand it now. We must be careful not to
15685 reference variables which won't be output. */
15686 else if (initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type)
15687 && ! walk_tree (&init, reference_to_unused, NULL, NULL))
15688 {
15689 /* Convert vector CONSTRUCTOR initializers to VECTOR_CST if
15690 possible. */
15691 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
15692 switch (TREE_CODE (init))
15693 {
15694 case VECTOR_CST:
15695 break;
15696 case CONSTRUCTOR:
15697 if (TREE_CONSTANT (init))
15698 {
15699 vec<constructor_elt, va_gc> *elts = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init);
15700 bool constant_p = true;
15701 tree value;
15702 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ix;
15703
15704 /* Even when ctor is constant, it might contain non-*_CST
15705 elements (e.g. { 1.0/0.0 - 1.0/0.0, 0.0 }) and those don't
15706 belong into VECTOR_CST nodes. */
15707 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (elts, ix, value)
15708 if (!CONSTANT_CLASS_P (value))
15709 {
15710 constant_p = false;
15711 break;
15712 }
15713
15714 if (constant_p)
15715 {
15716 init = build_vector_from_ctor (type, elts);
15717 break;
15718 }
15719 }
15720 /* FALLTHRU */
15721
15722 default:
15723 return NULL;
15724 }
15725
15726 rtl = expand_expr (init, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_INITIALIZER);
15727
15728 /* If expand_expr returns a MEM, it wasn't immediate. */
15729 gcc_assert (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl));
15730 }
15731
15732 return rtl;
15733 }
15734
15735 /* Generate RTL for the variable DECL to represent its location. */
15736
15737 static rtx
15738 rtl_for_decl_location (tree decl)
15739 {
15740 rtx rtl;
15741
15742 /* Here we have to decide where we are going to say the parameter "lives"
15743 (as far as the debugger is concerned). We only have a couple of
15744 choices. GCC provides us with DECL_RTL and with DECL_INCOMING_RTL.
15745
15746 DECL_RTL normally indicates where the parameter lives during most of the
15747 activation of the function. If optimization is enabled however, this
15748 could be either NULL or else a pseudo-reg. Both of those cases indicate
15749 that the parameter doesn't really live anywhere (as far as the code
15750 generation parts of GCC are concerned) during most of the function's
15751 activation. That will happen (for example) if the parameter is never
15752 referenced within the function.
15753
15754 We could just generate a location descriptor here for all non-NULL
15755 non-pseudo values of DECL_RTL and ignore all of the rest, but we can be
15756 a little nicer than that if we also consider DECL_INCOMING_RTL in cases
15757 where DECL_RTL is NULL or is a pseudo-reg.
15758
15759 Note however that we can only get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL as
15760 a backup substitute for DECL_RTL in certain limited cases. In cases
15761 where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) indicates the same type as TREE_TYPE (decl),
15762 we can be sure that the parameter was passed using the same type as it is
15763 declared to have within the function, and that its DECL_INCOMING_RTL
15764 points us to a place where a value of that type is passed.
15765
15766 In cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) and TREE_TYPE (decl) are different,
15767 we cannot (in general) use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a substitute for DECL_RTL
15768 because in these cases DECL_INCOMING_RTL points us to a value of some
15769 type which is *different* from the type of the parameter itself. Thus,
15770 if we tried to use DECL_INCOMING_RTL to generate a location attribute in
15771 such cases, the debugger would end up (for example) trying to fetch a
15772 `float' from a place which actually contains the first part of a
15773 `double'. That would lead to really incorrect and confusing
15774 output at debug-time.
15775
15776 So, in general, we *do not* use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a backup for DECL_RTL
15777 in cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) != TREE_TYPE (decl). There
15778 are a couple of exceptions however. On little-endian machines we can
15779 get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL even when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
15780 not the same as TREE_TYPE (decl), but only when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
15781 an integral type that is smaller than TREE_TYPE (decl). These cases arise
15782 when (on a little-endian machine) a non-prototyped function has a
15783 parameter declared to be of type `short' or `char'. In such cases,
15784 TREE_TYPE (decl) will be `short' or `char', DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) will
15785 be `int', and DECL_INCOMING_RTL will point to the lowest-order byte of the
15786 passed `int' value. If the debugger then uses that address to fetch
15787 a `short' or a `char' (on a little-endian machine) the result will be
15788 the correct data, so we allow for such exceptional cases below.
15789
15790 Note that our goal here is to describe the place where the given formal
15791 parameter lives during most of the function's activation (i.e. between the
15792 end of the prologue and the start of the epilogue). We'll do that as best
15793 as we can. Note however that if the given formal parameter is modified
15794 sometime during the execution of the function, then a stack backtrace (at
15795 debug-time) will show the function as having been called with the *new*
15796 value rather than the value which was originally passed in. This happens
15797 rarely enough that it is not a major problem, but it *is* a problem, and
15798 I'd like to fix it.
15799
15800 A future version of dwarf2out.c may generate two additional attributes for
15801 any given DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE which will describe the "passed
15802 type" and the "passed location" for the given formal parameter in addition
15803 to the attributes we now generate to indicate the "declared type" and the
15804 "active location" for each parameter. This additional set of attributes
15805 could be used by debuggers for stack backtraces. Separately, note that
15806 sometimes DECL_RTL can be NULL and DECL_INCOMING_RTL can be NULL also.
15807 This happens (for example) for inlined-instances of inline function formal
15808 parameters which are never referenced. This really shouldn't be
15809 happening. All PARM_DECL nodes should get valid non-NULL
15810 DECL_INCOMING_RTL values. FIXME. */
15811
15812 /* Use DECL_RTL as the "location" unless we find something better. */
15813 rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
15814
15815 /* When generating abstract instances, ignore everything except
15816 constants, symbols living in memory, and symbols living in
15817 fixed registers. */
15818 if (! reload_completed)
15819 {
15820 if (rtl
15821 && (CONSTANT_P (rtl)
15822 || (MEM_P (rtl)
15823 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
15824 || (REG_P (rtl)
15825 && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
15826 && TREE_STATIC (decl))))
15827 {
15828 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
15829 return rtl;
15830 }
15831 rtl = NULL_RTX;
15832 }
15833 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL)
15834 {
15835 if (rtl == NULL_RTX
15836 || is_pseudo_reg (rtl)
15837 || (MEM_P (rtl)
15838 && is_pseudo_reg (XEXP (rtl, 0))
15839 && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl)
15840 && MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
15841 && GET_MODE (rtl) == GET_MODE (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))))
15842 {
15843 tree declared_type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
15844 tree passed_type = DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl);
15845 machine_mode dmode = TYPE_MODE (declared_type);
15846 machine_mode pmode = TYPE_MODE (passed_type);
15847
15848 /* This decl represents a formal parameter which was optimized out.
15849 Note that DECL_INCOMING_RTL may be NULL in here, but we handle
15850 all cases where (rtl == NULL_RTX) just below. */
15851 if (dmode == pmode)
15852 rtl = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
15853 else if ((rtl == NULL_RTX || is_pseudo_reg (rtl))
15854 && SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (dmode)
15855 && GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode) <= GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
15856 && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
15857 {
15858 rtx inc = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
15859 if (REG_P (inc))
15860 rtl = inc;
15861 else if (MEM_P (inc))
15862 {
15863 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
15864 rtl = adjust_address_nv (inc, dmode,
15865 GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
15866 - GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode));
15867 else
15868 rtl = inc;
15869 }
15870 }
15871 }
15872
15873 /* If the parm was passed in registers, but lives on the stack, then
15874 make a big endian correction if the mode of the type of the
15875 parameter is not the same as the mode of the rtl. */
15876 /* ??? This is the same series of checks that are made in dbxout.c before
15877 we reach the big endian correction code there. It isn't clear if all
15878 of these checks are necessary here, but keeping them all is the safe
15879 thing to do. */
15880 else if (MEM_P (rtl)
15881 && XEXP (rtl, 0) != const0_rtx
15882 && ! CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
15883 /* Not passed in memory. */
15884 && !MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
15885 /* Not passed by invisible reference. */
15886 && (!REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
15887 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
15888 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
15889 #if !HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
15890 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
15891 #endif
15892 )
15893 /* Big endian correction check. */
15894 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
15895 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) != GET_MODE (rtl)
15896 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
15897 < UNITS_PER_WORD))
15898 {
15899 machine_mode addr_mode = get_address_mode (rtl);
15900 int offset = (UNITS_PER_WORD
15901 - GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
15902
15903 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
15904 plus_constant (addr_mode, XEXP (rtl, 0), offset));
15905 }
15906 }
15907 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
15908 && rtl
15909 && MEM_P (rtl)
15910 && GET_MODE (rtl) != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))
15911 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
15912 {
15913 machine_mode addr_mode = get_address_mode (rtl);
15914 int rsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl));
15915 int dsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)));
15916
15917 /* If a variable is declared "register" yet is smaller than
15918 a register, then if we store the variable to memory, it
15919 looks like we're storing a register-sized value, when in
15920 fact we are not. We need to adjust the offset of the
15921 storage location to reflect the actual value's bytes,
15922 else gdb will not be able to display it. */
15923 if (rsize > dsize)
15924 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
15925 plus_constant (addr_mode, XEXP (rtl, 0),
15926 rsize - dsize));
15927 }
15928
15929 /* A variable with no DECL_RTL but a DECL_INITIAL is a compile-time constant,
15930 and will have been substituted directly into all expressions that use it.
15931 C does not have such a concept, but C++ and other languages do. */
15932 if (!rtl && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
15933 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (DECL_INITIAL (decl), TREE_TYPE (decl));
15934
15935 if (rtl)
15936 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
15937
15938 /* If we don't look past the constant pool, we risk emitting a
15939 reference to a constant pool entry that isn't referenced from
15940 code, and thus is not emitted. */
15941 if (rtl)
15942 rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
15943
15944 /* Try harder to get a rtl. If this symbol ends up not being emitted
15945 in the current CU, resolve_addr will remove the expression referencing
15946 it. */
15947 if (rtl == NULL_RTX
15948 && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
15949 && !DECL_EXTERNAL (decl)
15950 && TREE_STATIC (decl)
15951 && DECL_NAME (decl)
15952 && !DECL_HARD_REGISTER (decl)
15953 && DECL_MODE (decl) != VOIDmode)
15954 {
15955 rtl = make_decl_rtl_for_debug (decl);
15956 if (!MEM_P (rtl)
15957 || GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != SYMBOL_REF
15958 || SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != decl)
15959 rtl = NULL_RTX;
15960 }
15961
15962 return rtl;
15963 }
15964
15965 /* Check whether decl is a Fortran COMMON symbol. If not, NULL_TREE is
15966 returned. If so, the decl for the COMMON block is returned, and the
15967 value is the offset into the common block for the symbol. */
15968
15969 static tree
15970 fortran_common (tree decl, HOST_WIDE_INT *value)
15971 {
15972 tree val_expr, cvar;
15973 machine_mode mode;
15974 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
15975 tree offset;
15976 int unsignedp, volatilep = 0;
15977
15978 /* If the decl isn't a VAR_DECL, or if it isn't static, or if
15979 it does not have a value (the offset into the common area), or if it
15980 is thread local (as opposed to global) then it isn't common, and shouldn't
15981 be handled as such. */
15982 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != VAR_DECL
15983 || !TREE_STATIC (decl)
15984 || !DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (decl)
15985 || !is_fortran ())
15986 return NULL_TREE;
15987
15988 val_expr = DECL_VALUE_EXPR (decl);
15989 if (TREE_CODE (val_expr) != COMPONENT_REF)
15990 return NULL_TREE;
15991
15992 cvar = get_inner_reference (val_expr, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset,
15993 &mode, &unsignedp, &volatilep, true);
15994
15995 if (cvar == NULL_TREE
15996 || TREE_CODE (cvar) != VAR_DECL
15997 || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (cvar)
15998 || !TREE_PUBLIC (cvar))
15999 return NULL_TREE;
16000
16001 *value = 0;
16002 if (offset != NULL)
16003 {
16004 if (!tree_fits_shwi_p (offset))
16005 return NULL_TREE;
16006 *value = tree_to_shwi (offset);
16007 }
16008 if (bitpos != 0)
16009 *value += bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
16010
16011 return cvar;
16012 }
16013
16014 /* Generate *either* a DW_AT_location attribute or else a DW_AT_const_value
16015 data attribute for a variable or a parameter. We generate the
16016 DW_AT_const_value attribute only in those cases where the given variable
16017 or parameter does not have a true "location" either in memory or in a
16018 register. This can happen (for example) when a constant is passed as an
16019 actual argument in a call to an inline function. (It's possible that
16020 these things can crop up in other ways also.) Note that one type of
16021 constant value which can be passed into an inlined function is a constant
16022 pointer. This can happen for example if an actual argument in an inlined
16023 function call evaluates to a compile-time constant address.
16024
16025 CACHE_P is true if it is worth caching the location list for DECL,
16026 so that future calls can reuse it rather than regenerate it from scratch.
16027 This is true for BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VARS in inlined subroutines,
16028 since we will need to refer to them each time the function is inlined. */
16029
16030 static bool
16031 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl, bool cache_p,
16032 enum dwarf_attribute attr)
16033 {
16034 rtx rtl;
16035 dw_loc_list_ref list;
16036 var_loc_list *loc_list;
16037 cached_dw_loc_list *cache;
16038
16039 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
16040 return false;
16041
16042 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
16043 || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL);
16044
16045 /* Try to get some constant RTL for this decl, and use that as the value of
16046 the location. */
16047
16048 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (decl);
16049 if (rtl && (CONSTANT_P (rtl) || GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
16050 && add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl))
16051 return true;
16052
16053 /* See if we have single element location list that is equivalent to
16054 a constant value. That way we are better to use add_const_value_attribute
16055 rather than expanding constant value equivalent. */
16056 loc_list = lookup_decl_loc (decl);
16057 if (loc_list
16058 && loc_list->first
16059 && loc_list->first->next == NULL
16060 && NOTE_P (loc_list->first->loc)
16061 && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (loc_list->first->loc)
16062 && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_list->first->loc))
16063 {
16064 struct var_loc_node *node;
16065
16066 node = loc_list->first;
16067 rtl = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->loc);
16068 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == EXPR_LIST)
16069 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
16070 if ((CONSTANT_P (rtl) || GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
16071 && add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl))
16072 return true;
16073 }
16074 /* If this decl is from BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VARS, we might need its
16075 list several times. See if we've already cached the contents. */
16076 list = NULL;
16077 if (loc_list == NULL || cached_dw_loc_list_table == NULL)
16078 cache_p = false;
16079 if (cache_p)
16080 {
16081 cache = cached_dw_loc_list_table->find_with_hash (decl, DECL_UID (decl));
16082 if (cache)
16083 list = cache->loc_list;
16084 }
16085 if (list == NULL)
16086 {
16087 list = loc_list_from_tree (decl, decl_by_reference_p (decl) ? 0 : 2,
16088 NULL);
16089 /* It is usually worth caching this result if the decl is from
16090 BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VARS and if the list has at least two elements. */
16091 if (cache_p && list && list->dw_loc_next)
16092 {
16093 cached_dw_loc_list **slot
16094 = cached_dw_loc_list_table->find_slot_with_hash (decl,
16095 DECL_UID (decl),
16096 INSERT);
16097 cache = ggc_cleared_alloc<cached_dw_loc_list> ();
16098 cache->decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
16099 cache->loc_list = list;
16100 *slot = cache;
16101 }
16102 }
16103 if (list)
16104 {
16105 add_AT_location_description (die, attr, list);
16106 return true;
16107 }
16108 /* None of that worked, so it must not really have a location;
16109 try adding a constant value attribute from the DECL_INITIAL. */
16110 return tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (die, decl);
16111 }
16112
16113 /* Add VARIABLE and DIE into deferred locations list. */
16114
16115 static void
16116 defer_location (tree variable, dw_die_ref die)
16117 {
16118 deferred_locations entry;
16119 entry.variable = variable;
16120 entry.die = die;
16121 vec_safe_push (deferred_locations_list, entry);
16122 }
16123
16124 /* Helper function for tree_add_const_value_attribute. Natively encode
16125 initializer INIT into an array. Return true if successful. */
16126
16127 static bool
16128 native_encode_initializer (tree init, unsigned char *array, int size)
16129 {
16130 tree type;
16131
16132 if (init == NULL_TREE)
16133 return false;
16134
16135 STRIP_NOPS (init);
16136 switch (TREE_CODE (init))
16137 {
16138 case STRING_CST:
16139 type = TREE_TYPE (init);
16140 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
16141 {
16142 tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
16143 machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (enttype);
16144
16145 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT || GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) != 1)
16146 return false;
16147 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
16148 return false;
16149 if (size > TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init))
16150 {
16151 memcpy (array, TREE_STRING_POINTER (init),
16152 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init));
16153 memset (array + TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init),
16154 '\0', size - TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init));
16155 }
16156 else
16157 memcpy (array, TREE_STRING_POINTER (init), size);
16158 return true;
16159 }
16160 return false;
16161 case CONSTRUCTOR:
16162 type = TREE_TYPE (init);
16163 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
16164 return false;
16165 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
16166 {
16167 HOST_WIDE_INT min_index;
16168 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT cnt;
16169 int curpos = 0, fieldsize;
16170 constructor_elt *ce;
16171
16172 if (TYPE_DOMAIN (type) == NULL_TREE
16173 || !tree_fits_shwi_p (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type))))
16174 return false;
16175
16176 fieldsize = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (type));
16177 if (fieldsize <= 0)
16178 return false;
16179
16180 min_index = tree_to_shwi (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)));
16181 memset (array, '\0', size);
16182 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init), cnt, ce)
16183 {
16184 tree val = ce->value;
16185 tree index = ce->index;
16186 int pos = curpos;
16187 if (index && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
16188 pos = (tree_to_shwi (TREE_OPERAND (index, 0)) - min_index)
16189 * fieldsize;
16190 else if (index)
16191 pos = (tree_to_shwi (index) - min_index) * fieldsize;
16192
16193 if (val)
16194 {
16195 STRIP_NOPS (val);
16196 if (!native_encode_initializer (val, array + pos, fieldsize))
16197 return false;
16198 }
16199 curpos = pos + fieldsize;
16200 if (index && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
16201 {
16202 int count = tree_to_shwi (TREE_OPERAND (index, 1))
16203 - tree_to_shwi (TREE_OPERAND (index, 0));
16204 while (count-- > 0)
16205 {
16206 if (val)
16207 memcpy (array + curpos, array + pos, fieldsize);
16208 curpos += fieldsize;
16209 }
16210 }
16211 gcc_assert (curpos <= size);
16212 }
16213 return true;
16214 }
16215 else if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
16216 || TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE)
16217 {
16218 tree field = NULL_TREE;
16219 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT cnt;
16220 constructor_elt *ce;
16221
16222 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
16223 return false;
16224
16225 if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE)
16226 field = TYPE_FIELDS (type);
16227
16228 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init), cnt, ce)
16229 {
16230 tree val = ce->value;
16231 int pos, fieldsize;
16232
16233 if (ce->index != 0)
16234 field = ce->index;
16235
16236 if (val)
16237 STRIP_NOPS (val);
16238
16239 if (field == NULL_TREE || DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
16240 return false;
16241
16242 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (field)) == ARRAY_TYPE
16243 && TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (field))
16244 && ! TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (field))))
16245 return false;
16246 else if (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field) == NULL_TREE
16247 || !tree_fits_shwi_p (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field)))
16248 return false;
16249 fieldsize = tree_to_shwi (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field));
16250 pos = int_byte_position (field);
16251 gcc_assert (pos + fieldsize <= size);
16252 if (val
16253 && !native_encode_initializer (val, array + pos, fieldsize))
16254 return false;
16255 }
16256 return true;
16257 }
16258 return false;
16259 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
16260 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
16261 return native_encode_initializer (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0), array, size);
16262 default:
16263 return native_encode_expr (init, array, size) == size;
16264 }
16265 }
16266
16267 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIE. The value of the
16268 attribute is the const value T. */
16269
16270 static bool
16271 tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree t)
16272 {
16273 tree init;
16274 tree type = TREE_TYPE (t);
16275 rtx rtl;
16276
16277 if (!t || !TREE_TYPE (t) || TREE_TYPE (t) == error_mark_node)
16278 return false;
16279
16280 init = t;
16281 gcc_assert (!DECL_P (init));
16282
16283 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (init, type);
16284 if (rtl)
16285 return add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl);
16286 /* If the host and target are sane, try harder. */
16287 else if (CHAR_BIT == 8 && BITS_PER_UNIT == 8
16288 && initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type))
16289 {
16290 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (init));
16291 if (size > 0 && (int) size == size)
16292 {
16293 unsigned char *array = ggc_cleared_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (size);
16294
16295 if (native_encode_initializer (init, array, size))
16296 {
16297 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, size, 1, array);
16298 return true;
16299 }
16300 ggc_free (array);
16301 }
16302 }
16303 return false;
16304 }
16305
16306 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute to VAR_DIE. The value of the
16307 attribute is the const value of T, where T is an integral constant
16308 variable with static storage duration
16309 (so it can't be a PARM_DECL or a RESULT_DECL). */
16310
16311 static bool
16312 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (dw_die_ref var_die, tree decl)
16313 {
16314
16315 if (!decl
16316 || (TREE_CODE (decl) != VAR_DECL
16317 && TREE_CODE (decl) != CONST_DECL)
16318 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
16319 && !TREE_STATIC (decl)))
16320 return false;
16321
16322 if (TREE_READONLY (decl)
16323 && ! TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl)
16324 && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
16325 /* OK */;
16326 else
16327 return false;
16328
16329 /* Don't add DW_AT_const_value if abstract origin already has one. */
16330 if (get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_const_value))
16331 return false;
16332
16333 return tree_add_const_value_attribute (var_die, DECL_INITIAL (decl));
16334 }
16335
16336 /* Convert the CFI instructions for the current function into a
16337 location list. This is used for DW_AT_frame_base when we targeting
16338 a dwarf2 consumer that does not support the dwarf3
16339 DW_OP_call_frame_cfa. OFFSET is a constant to be added to all CFA
16340 expressions. */
16341
16342 static dw_loc_list_ref
16343 convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
16344 {
16345 int ix;
16346 dw_fde_ref fde;
16347 dw_loc_list_ref list, *list_tail;
16348 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
16349 dw_cfa_location last_cfa, next_cfa;
16350 const char *start_label, *last_label, *section;
16351 dw_cfa_location remember;
16352
16353 fde = cfun->fde;
16354 gcc_assert (fde != NULL);
16355
16356 section = secname_for_decl (current_function_decl);
16357 list_tail = &list;
16358 list = NULL;
16359
16360 memset (&next_cfa, 0, sizeof (next_cfa));
16361 next_cfa.reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
16362 remember = next_cfa;
16363
16364 start_label = fde->dw_fde_begin;
16365
16366 /* ??? Bald assumption that the CIE opcode list does not contain
16367 advance opcodes. */
16368 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*cie_cfi_vec, ix, cfi)
16369 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa, &remember);
16370
16371 last_cfa = next_cfa;
16372 last_label = start_label;
16373
16374 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index == 0)
16375 {
16376 /* If the first partition contained no CFI adjustments, the
16377 CIE opcodes apply to the whole first partition. */
16378 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
16379 fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_end, section);
16380 list_tail =&(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
16381 start_label = last_label = fde->dw_fde_second_begin;
16382 }
16383
16384 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (fde->dw_fde_cfi, ix, cfi)
16385 {
16386 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
16387 {
16388 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
16389 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
16390 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
16391 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
16392 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
16393 {
16394 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
16395 start_label, last_label, section);
16396
16397 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
16398 last_cfa = next_cfa;
16399 start_label = last_label;
16400 }
16401 last_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
16402 break;
16403
16404 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
16405 /* The encoding is complex enough that we should never emit this. */
16406 gcc_unreachable ();
16407
16408 default:
16409 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa, &remember);
16410 break;
16411 }
16412 if (ix + 1 == fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index)
16413 {
16414 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
16415 {
16416 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
16417 start_label, last_label, section);
16418
16419 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
16420 last_cfa = next_cfa;
16421 start_label = last_label;
16422 }
16423 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
16424 start_label, fde->dw_fde_end, section);
16425 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
16426 start_label = last_label = fde->dw_fde_second_begin;
16427 }
16428 }
16429
16430 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
16431 {
16432 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
16433 start_label, last_label, section);
16434 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
16435 start_label = last_label;
16436 }
16437
16438 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&next_cfa, offset),
16439 start_label,
16440 fde->dw_fde_second_begin
16441 ? fde->dw_fde_second_end : fde->dw_fde_end,
16442 section);
16443
16444 if (list && list->dw_loc_next)
16445 gen_llsym (list);
16446
16447 return list;
16448 }
16449
16450 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the
16451 frame base (often the same as the CFA), and store it in
16452 frame_pointer_fb_offset. OFFSET is added to the displacement
16453 before the latter is negated. */
16454
16455 static void
16456 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
16457 {
16458 rtx reg, elim;
16459
16460 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
16461 reg = frame_pointer_rtx;
16462 offset += FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
16463 #else
16464 reg = arg_pointer_rtx;
16465 offset += ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
16466 #endif
16467
16468 elim = (ira_use_lra_p
16469 ? lra_eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX)
16470 : eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX));
16471 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
16472 {
16473 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
16474 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
16475 }
16476
16477 frame_pointer_fb_offset = -offset;
16478
16479 /* ??? AVR doesn't set up valid eliminations when there is no stack frame
16480 in which to eliminate. This is because it's stack pointer isn't
16481 directly accessible as a register within the ISA. To work around
16482 this, assume that while we cannot provide a proper value for
16483 frame_pointer_fb_offset, we won't need one either. */
16484 frame_pointer_fb_offset_valid
16485 = ((SUPPORTS_STACK_ALIGNMENT
16486 && (elim == hard_frame_pointer_rtx
16487 || elim == stack_pointer_rtx))
16488 || elim == (frame_pointer_needed
16489 ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
16490 : stack_pointer_rtx));
16491 }
16492
16493 /* Generate a DW_AT_name attribute given some string value to be included as
16494 the value of the attribute. */
16495
16496 static void
16497 add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref die, const char *name_string)
16498 {
16499 if (name_string != NULL && *name_string != 0)
16500 {
16501 if (demangle_name_func)
16502 name_string = (*demangle_name_func) (name_string);
16503
16504 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name, name_string);
16505 }
16506 }
16507
16508 /* Retrieve the descriptive type of TYPE, if any, make sure it has a
16509 DIE and attach a DW_AT_GNAT_descriptive_type attribute to the DIE
16510 of TYPE accordingly.
16511
16512 ??? This is a temporary measure until after we're able to generate
16513 regular DWARF for the complex Ada type system. */
16514
16515 static void
16516 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree type,
16517 dw_die_ref context_die)
16518 {
16519 tree dtype;
16520 dw_die_ref dtype_die;
16521
16522 if (!lang_hooks.types.descriptive_type)
16523 return;
16524
16525 dtype = lang_hooks.types.descriptive_type (type);
16526 if (!dtype)
16527 return;
16528
16529 dtype_die = lookup_type_die (dtype);
16530 if (!dtype_die)
16531 {
16532 gen_type_die (dtype, context_die);
16533 dtype_die = lookup_type_die (dtype);
16534 gcc_assert (dtype_die);
16535 }
16536
16537 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_GNAT_descriptive_type, dtype_die);
16538 }
16539
16540 /* Retrieve the comp_dir string suitable for use with DW_AT_comp_dir. */
16541
16542 static const char *
16543 comp_dir_string (void)
16544 {
16545 const char *wd;
16546 char *wd1;
16547 static const char *cached_wd = NULL;
16548
16549 if (cached_wd != NULL)
16550 return cached_wd;
16551
16552 wd = get_src_pwd ();
16553 if (wd == NULL)
16554 return NULL;
16555
16556 if (DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR)
16557 {
16558 int wdlen;
16559
16560 wdlen = strlen (wd);
16561 wd1 = ggc_vec_alloc<char> (wdlen + 2);
16562 strcpy (wd1, wd);
16563 wd1 [wdlen] = DIR_SEPARATOR;
16564 wd1 [wdlen + 1] = 0;
16565 wd = wd1;
16566 }
16567
16568 cached_wd = remap_debug_filename (wd);
16569 return cached_wd;
16570 }
16571
16572 /* Generate a DW_AT_comp_dir attribute for DIE. */
16573
16574 static void
16575 add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref die)
16576 {
16577 const char * wd = comp_dir_string ();
16578 if (wd != NULL)
16579 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_comp_dir, wd);
16580 }
16581
16582 /* Given a tree node VALUE describing a scalar attribute ATTR (i.e. a bound, a
16583 pointer computation, ...), output a representation for that bound according
16584 to the accepted FORMS (see enum dw_scalar_form) and add it to DIE. See
16585 loc_list_from_tree for the meaning of CONTEXT. */
16586
16587 static void
16588 add_scalar_info (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr, tree value,
16589 int forms, const struct loc_descr_context *context)
16590 {
16591 dw_die_ref ctx, decl_die;
16592 dw_loc_list_ref list;
16593
16594 bool strip_conversions = true;
16595
16596 while (strip_conversions)
16597 switch (TREE_CODE (value))
16598 {
16599 case ERROR_MARK:
16600 case SAVE_EXPR:
16601 return;
16602
16603 CASE_CONVERT:
16604 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
16605 value = TREE_OPERAND (value, 0);
16606 break;
16607
16608 default:
16609 strip_conversions = false;
16610 break;
16611 }
16612
16613 /* If possible and permitted, output the attribute as a constant. */
16614 if ((forms & dw_scalar_form_constant) != 0
16615 && TREE_CODE (value) == INTEGER_CST)
16616 {
16617 unsigned int prec = simple_type_size_in_bits (TREE_TYPE (value));
16618
16619 /* If HOST_WIDE_INT is big enough then represent the bound as
16620 a constant value. We need to choose a form based on
16621 whether the type is signed or unsigned. We cannot just
16622 call add_AT_unsigned if the value itself is positive
16623 (add_AT_unsigned might add the unsigned value encoded as
16624 DW_FORM_data[1248]). Some DWARF consumers will lookup the
16625 bounds type and then sign extend any unsigned values found
16626 for signed types. This is needed only for
16627 DW_AT_{lower,upper}_bound, since for most other attributes,
16628 consumers will treat DW_FORM_data[1248] as unsigned values,
16629 regardless of the underlying type. */
16630 if (prec <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
16631 || tree_fits_uhwi_p (value))
16632 {
16633 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (value)))
16634 add_AT_unsigned (die, attr, TREE_INT_CST_LOW (value));
16635 else
16636 add_AT_int (die, attr, TREE_INT_CST_LOW (value));
16637 }
16638 else
16639 /* Otherwise represent the bound as an unsigned value with
16640 the precision of its type. The precision and signedness
16641 of the type will be necessary to re-interpret it
16642 unambiguously. */
16643 add_AT_wide (die, attr, value);
16644 return;
16645 }
16646
16647 /* Otherwise, if it's possible and permitted too, output a reference to
16648 another DIE. */
16649 if ((forms & dw_scalar_form_reference) != 0)
16650 {
16651 tree decl = NULL_TREE;
16652
16653 /* Some type attributes reference an outer type. For instance, the upper
16654 bound of an array may reference an embedding record (this happens in
16655 Ada). */
16656 if (TREE_CODE (value) == COMPONENT_REF
16657 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (value, 0)) == PLACEHOLDER_EXPR
16658 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (value, 1)) == FIELD_DECL)
16659 decl = TREE_OPERAND (value, 1);
16660
16661 else if (TREE_CODE (value) == VAR_DECL
16662 || TREE_CODE (value) == PARM_DECL
16663 || TREE_CODE (value) == RESULT_DECL)
16664 decl = value;
16665
16666 if (decl != NULL_TREE)
16667 {
16668 dw_die_ref decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
16669
16670 /* ??? Can this happen, or should the variable have been bound
16671 first? Probably it can, since I imagine that we try to create
16672 the types of parameters in the order in which they exist in
16673 the list, and won't have created a forward reference to a
16674 later parameter. */
16675 if (decl_die != NULL)
16676 {
16677 add_AT_die_ref (die, attr, decl_die);
16678 return;
16679 }
16680 }
16681 }
16682
16683 /* Last chance: try to create a stack operation procedure to evaluate the
16684 value. Do nothing if even that is not possible or permitted. */
16685 if ((forms & dw_scalar_form_exprloc) == 0)
16686 return;
16687
16688 list = loc_list_from_tree (value, 2, context);
16689 if (list == NULL || single_element_loc_list_p (list))
16690 {
16691 /* If this attribute is not a reference nor constant, it is
16692 a DWARF expression rather than location description. For that
16693 loc_list_from_tree (value, 0, &context) is needed. */
16694 dw_loc_list_ref list2 = loc_list_from_tree (value, 0, context);
16695 if (list2 && single_element_loc_list_p (list2))
16696 {
16697 add_AT_loc (die, attr, list2->expr);
16698 return;
16699 }
16700 }
16701
16702 /* If that failed to give a single element location list, fall back to
16703 outputting this as a reference... still if permitted. */
16704 if (list == NULL || (forms & dw_scalar_form_reference) == 0)
16705 return;
16706
16707 if (current_function_decl == 0)
16708 ctx = comp_unit_die ();
16709 else
16710 ctx = lookup_decl_die (current_function_decl);
16711
16712 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, ctx, value);
16713 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
16714 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (value), TYPE_QUAL_CONST, ctx);
16715 add_AT_location_description (decl_die, DW_AT_location, list);
16716 add_AT_die_ref (die, attr, decl_die);
16717 }
16718
16719 /* Return the default for DW_AT_lower_bound, or -1 if there is not any
16720 default. */
16721
16722 static int
16723 lower_bound_default (void)
16724 {
16725 switch (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language))
16726 {
16727 case DW_LANG_C:
16728 case DW_LANG_C89:
16729 case DW_LANG_C99:
16730 case DW_LANG_C11:
16731 case DW_LANG_C_plus_plus:
16732 case DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_11:
16733 case DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_14:
16734 case DW_LANG_ObjC:
16735 case DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus:
16736 case DW_LANG_Java:
16737 return 0;
16738 case DW_LANG_Fortran77:
16739 case DW_LANG_Fortran90:
16740 case DW_LANG_Fortran95:
16741 case DW_LANG_Fortran03:
16742 case DW_LANG_Fortran08:
16743 return 1;
16744 case DW_LANG_UPC:
16745 case DW_LANG_D:
16746 case DW_LANG_Python:
16747 return dwarf_version >= 4 ? 0 : -1;
16748 case DW_LANG_Ada95:
16749 case DW_LANG_Ada83:
16750 case DW_LANG_Cobol74:
16751 case DW_LANG_Cobol85:
16752 case DW_LANG_Pascal83:
16753 case DW_LANG_Modula2:
16754 case DW_LANG_PLI:
16755 return dwarf_version >= 4 ? 1 : -1;
16756 default:
16757 return -1;
16758 }
16759 }
16760
16761 /* Given a tree node describing an array bound (either lower or upper) output
16762 a representation for that bound. */
16763
16764 static void
16765 add_bound_info (dw_die_ref subrange_die, enum dwarf_attribute bound_attr,
16766 tree bound, const struct loc_descr_context *context)
16767 {
16768 int dflt;
16769
16770 while (1)
16771 switch (TREE_CODE (bound))
16772 {
16773 /* Strip all conversions. */
16774 CASE_CONVERT:
16775 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
16776 bound = TREE_OPERAND (bound, 0);
16777 break;
16778
16779 /* All fixed-bounds are represented by INTEGER_CST nodes. Lower bounds
16780 are even omitted when they are the default. */
16781 case INTEGER_CST:
16782 /* If the value for this bound is the default one, we can even omit the
16783 attribute. */
16784 if (bound_attr == DW_AT_lower_bound
16785 && tree_fits_shwi_p (bound)
16786 && (dflt = lower_bound_default ()) != -1
16787 && tree_to_shwi (bound) == dflt)
16788 return;
16789
16790 /* FALLTHRU */
16791
16792 default:
16793 add_scalar_info (subrange_die, bound_attr, bound,
16794 dw_scalar_form_constant
16795 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
16796 | dw_scalar_form_reference,
16797 context);
16798 return;
16799 }
16800 }
16801
16802 /* Add subscript info to TYPE_DIE, describing an array TYPE, collapsing
16803 possibly nested array subscripts in a flat sequence if COLLAPSE_P is true.
16804 Note that the block of subscript information for an array type also
16805 includes information about the element type of the given array type. */
16806
16807 static void
16808 add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref type_die, tree type, bool collapse_p)
16809 {
16810 unsigned dimension_number;
16811 tree lower, upper;
16812 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
16813
16814 for (dimension_number = 0;
16815 TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE && (dimension_number == 0 || collapse_p);
16816 type = TREE_TYPE (type), dimension_number++)
16817 {
16818 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
16819
16820 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type) && is_fortran () && dimension_number > 0)
16821 break;
16822
16823 /* Arrays come in three flavors: Unspecified bounds, fixed bounds,
16824 and (in GNU C only) variable bounds. Handle all three forms
16825 here. */
16826 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, type_die, NULL);
16827 if (domain)
16828 {
16829 /* We have an array type with specified bounds. */
16830 lower = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain);
16831 upper = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain);
16832
16833 /* Define the index type. */
16834 if (TREE_TYPE (domain))
16835 {
16836 /* ??? This is probably an Ada unnamed subrange type. Ignore the
16837 TREE_TYPE field. We can't emit debug info for this
16838 because it is an unnamed integral type. */
16839 if (TREE_CODE (domain) == INTEGER_TYPE
16840 && TYPE_NAME (domain) == NULL_TREE
16841 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == INTEGER_TYPE
16842 && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == NULL_TREE)
16843 ;
16844 else
16845 add_type_attribute (subrange_die, TREE_TYPE (domain),
16846 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, type_die);
16847 }
16848
16849 /* ??? If upper is NULL, the array has unspecified length,
16850 but it does have a lower bound. This happens with Fortran
16851 dimension arr(N:*)
16852 Since the debugger is definitely going to need to know N
16853 to produce useful results, go ahead and output the lower
16854 bound solo, and hope the debugger can cope. */
16855
16856 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, lower, NULL);
16857 if (upper)
16858 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, upper, NULL);
16859 }
16860
16861 /* Otherwise we have an array type with an unspecified length. The
16862 DWARF-2 spec does not say how to handle this; let's just leave out the
16863 bounds. */
16864 }
16865 }
16866
16867 /* Add a DW_AT_byte_size attribute to DIE with TREE_NODE's size. */
16868
16869 static void
16870 add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree tree_node)
16871 {
16872 dw_die_ref decl_die;
16873 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
16874
16875 switch (TREE_CODE (tree_node))
16876 {
16877 case ERROR_MARK:
16878 size = 0;
16879 break;
16880 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
16881 case RECORD_TYPE:
16882 case UNION_TYPE:
16883 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
16884 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (tree_node)) == VAR_DECL
16885 && (decl_die = lookup_decl_die (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (tree_node))))
16886 {
16887 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_byte_size, decl_die);
16888 return;
16889 }
16890 size = int_size_in_bytes (tree_node);
16891 break;
16892 case FIELD_DECL:
16893 /* For a data member of a struct or union, the DW_AT_byte_size is
16894 generally given as the number of bytes normally allocated for an
16895 object of the *declared* type of the member itself. This is true
16896 even for bit-fields. */
16897 size = int_size_in_bytes (field_type (tree_node));
16898 break;
16899 default:
16900 gcc_unreachable ();
16901 }
16902
16903 /* Note that `size' might be -1 when we get to this point. If it is, that
16904 indicates that the byte size of the entity in question is variable. We
16905 have no good way of expressing this fact in Dwarf at the present time,
16906 when location description was not used by the caller code instead. */
16907 if (size >= 0)
16908 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
16909 }
16910
16911 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit-field, output an attribute
16912 which specifies the distance in bits from the highest order bit of the
16913 "containing object" for the bit-field to the highest order bit of the
16914 bit-field itself.
16915
16916 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
16917 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
16918 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
16919 declared type of the individual bit-field itself. The determination of the
16920 exact location of the "containing object" for a bit-field is rather
16921 complicated. It's handled by the `field_byte_offset' function (above).
16922
16923 Note that it is the size (in bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object"
16924 which will be given in the DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field.
16925 (See `byte_size_attribute' above). */
16926
16927 static inline void
16928 add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
16929 {
16930 HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bytes = field_byte_offset (decl);
16931 tree type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
16932 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
16933 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_object_bit_offset;
16934 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_field_bit_offset;
16935 HOST_WIDE_INT bit_offset;
16936
16937 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
16938 gcc_assert (type && TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
16939
16940 /* We can't yet handle bit-fields whose offsets are variable, so if we
16941 encounter such things, just return without generating any attribute
16942 whatsoever. Likewise for variable or too large size. */
16943 if (! tree_fits_shwi_p (bit_position (decl))
16944 || ! tree_fits_uhwi_p (DECL_SIZE (decl)))
16945 return;
16946
16947 bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
16948
16949 /* Note that the bit offset is always the distance (in bits) from the
16950 highest-order bit of the "containing object" to the highest-order bit of
16951 the bit-field itself. Since the "high-order end" of any object or field
16952 is different on big-endian and little-endian machines, the computation
16953 below must take account of these differences. */
16954 highest_order_object_bit_offset = object_offset_in_bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
16955 highest_order_field_bit_offset = bitpos_int;
16956
16957 if (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
16958 {
16959 highest_order_field_bit_offset += tree_to_shwi (DECL_SIZE (decl));
16960 highest_order_object_bit_offset += simple_type_size_in_bits (type);
16961 }
16962
16963 bit_offset
16964 = (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
16965 ? highest_order_object_bit_offset - highest_order_field_bit_offset
16966 : highest_order_field_bit_offset - highest_order_object_bit_offset);
16967
16968 if (bit_offset < 0)
16969 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_bit_offset, bit_offset);
16970 else
16971 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_offset, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) bit_offset);
16972 }
16973
16974 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit field, output an attribute
16975 which specifies the length in bits of the given field. */
16976
16977 static inline void
16978 add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
16979 {
16980 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
16981 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL
16982 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl));
16983
16984 if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (DECL_SIZE (decl)))
16985 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_size, tree_to_uhwi (DECL_SIZE (decl)));
16986 }
16987
16988 /* If the compiled language is ANSI C, then add a 'prototyped'
16989 attribute, if arg types are given for the parameters of a function. */
16990
16991 static inline void
16992 add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_type)
16993 {
16994 switch (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language))
16995 {
16996 case DW_LANG_C:
16997 case DW_LANG_C89:
16998 case DW_LANG_C99:
16999 case DW_LANG_C11:
17000 case DW_LANG_ObjC:
17001 if (prototype_p (func_type))
17002 add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_prototyped, 1);
17003 break;
17004 default:
17005 break;
17006 }
17007 }
17008
17009 /* Add an 'abstract_origin' attribute below a given DIE. The DIE is found
17010 by looking in either the type declaration or object declaration
17011 equate table. */
17012
17013 static inline dw_die_ref
17014 add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree origin)
17015 {
17016 dw_die_ref origin_die = NULL;
17017
17018 if (TREE_CODE (origin) != FUNCTION_DECL)
17019 {
17020 /* We may have gotten separated from the block for the inlined
17021 function, if we're in an exception handler or some such; make
17022 sure that the abstract function has been written out.
17023
17024 Doing this for nested functions is wrong, however; functions are
17025 distinct units, and our context might not even be inline. */
17026 tree fn = origin;
17027
17028 if (TYPE_P (fn))
17029 fn = TYPE_STUB_DECL (fn);
17030
17031 fn = decl_function_context (fn);
17032 if (fn)
17033 dwarf2out_abstract_function (fn);
17034 }
17035
17036 if (DECL_P (origin))
17037 origin_die = lookup_decl_die (origin);
17038 else if (TYPE_P (origin))
17039 origin_die = lookup_type_die (origin);
17040
17041 /* XXX: Functions that are never lowered don't always have correct block
17042 trees (in the case of java, they simply have no block tree, in some other
17043 languages). For these functions, there is nothing we can really do to
17044 output correct debug info for inlined functions in all cases. Rather
17045 than die, we'll just produce deficient debug info now, in that we will
17046 have variables without a proper abstract origin. In the future, when all
17047 functions are lowered, we should re-add a gcc_assert (origin_die)
17048 here. */
17049
17050 if (origin_die)
17051 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, origin_die);
17052 return origin_die;
17053 }
17054
17055 /* We do not currently support the pure_virtual attribute. */
17056
17057 static inline void
17058 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_decl)
17059 {
17060 if (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl))
17061 {
17062 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
17063
17064 if (tree_fits_shwi_p (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl)))
17065 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_vtable_elem_location,
17066 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_constu,
17067 tree_to_shwi (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl)),
17068 0));
17069
17070 /* GNU extension: Record what type this method came from originally. */
17071 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
17072 && DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl))
17073 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_containing_type,
17074 lookup_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl)));
17075 }
17076 }
17077 \f
17078 /* Add a DW_AT_linkage_name or DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name attribute for the
17079 given decl. This used to be a vendor extension until after DWARF 4
17080 standardized it. */
17081
17082 static void
17083 add_linkage_attr (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
17084 {
17085 const char *name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl));
17086
17087 /* Mimic what assemble_name_raw does with a leading '*'. */
17088 if (name[0] == '*')
17089 name = &name[1];
17090
17091 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
17092 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_linkage_name, name);
17093 else
17094 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name, name);
17095 }
17096
17097 /* Add source coordinate attributes for the given decl. */
17098
17099 static void
17100 add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
17101 {
17102 expanded_location s;
17103
17104 if (LOCATION_LOCUS (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl)) == UNKNOWN_LOCATION)
17105 return;
17106 s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
17107 add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
17108 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
17109 }
17110
17111 /* Add DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name attribute for the given decl. */
17112
17113 static void
17114 add_linkage_name (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
17115 {
17116 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_NONE
17117 && (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL)
17118 && TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
17119 && !(TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_REGISTER (decl))
17120 && die->die_tag != DW_TAG_member)
17121 {
17122 /* Defer until we have an assembler name set. */
17123 if (!DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME_SET_P (decl))
17124 {
17125 limbo_die_node *asm_name;
17126
17127 asm_name = ggc_cleared_alloc<limbo_die_node> ();
17128 asm_name->die = die;
17129 asm_name->created_for = decl;
17130 asm_name->next = deferred_asm_name;
17131 deferred_asm_name = asm_name;
17132 }
17133 else if (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl))
17134 add_linkage_attr (die, decl);
17135 }
17136 }
17137
17138 /* Add a DW_AT_name attribute and source coordinate attribute for the
17139 given decl, but only if it actually has a name. */
17140
17141 static void
17142 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
17143 {
17144 tree decl_name;
17145
17146 decl_name = DECL_NAME (decl);
17147 if (decl_name != NULL && IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name) != NULL)
17148 {
17149 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 0);
17150 if (name)
17151 add_name_attribute (die, name);
17152 if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
17153 add_src_coords_attributes (die, decl);
17154
17155 add_linkage_name (die, decl);
17156 }
17157
17158 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
17159 /* Get the function's name, as described by its RTL. This may be different
17160 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
17161 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
17162 {
17163 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address,
17164 XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0), false);
17165 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
17166 }
17167 #endif /* VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO */
17168 }
17169
17170 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
17171 /* Output the debug main pointer die for VMS */
17172
17173 void
17174 dwarf2out_vms_debug_main_pointer (void)
17175 {
17176 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
17177 dw_die_ref die;
17178
17179 /* Allocate the VMS debug main subprogram die. */
17180 die = ggc_cleared_alloc<die_node> ();
17181 die->die_tag = DW_TAG_subprogram;
17182 add_name_attribute (die, VMS_DEBUG_MAIN_POINTER);
17183 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, PROLOGUE_END_LABEL,
17184 current_function_funcdef_no);
17185 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_entry_pc, label);
17186
17187 /* Make it the first child of comp_unit_die (). */
17188 die->die_parent = comp_unit_die ();
17189 if (comp_unit_die ()->die_child)
17190 {
17191 die->die_sib = comp_unit_die ()->die_child->die_sib;
17192 comp_unit_die ()->die_child->die_sib = die;
17193 }
17194 else
17195 {
17196 die->die_sib = die;
17197 comp_unit_die ()->die_child = die;
17198 }
17199 }
17200 #endif /* VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO */
17201
17202 /* Push a new declaration scope. */
17203
17204 static void
17205 push_decl_scope (tree scope)
17206 {
17207 vec_safe_push (decl_scope_table, scope);
17208 }
17209
17210 /* Pop a declaration scope. */
17211
17212 static inline void
17213 pop_decl_scope (void)
17214 {
17215 decl_scope_table->pop ();
17216 }
17217
17218 /* walk_tree helper function for uses_local_type, below. */
17219
17220 static tree
17221 uses_local_type_r (tree *tp, int *walk_subtrees, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
17222 {
17223 if (!TYPE_P (*tp))
17224 *walk_subtrees = 0;
17225 else
17226 {
17227 tree name = TYPE_NAME (*tp);
17228 if (name && DECL_P (name) && decl_function_context (name))
17229 return *tp;
17230 }
17231 return NULL_TREE;
17232 }
17233
17234 /* If TYPE involves a function-local type (including a local typedef to a
17235 non-local type), returns that type; otherwise returns NULL_TREE. */
17236
17237 static tree
17238 uses_local_type (tree type)
17239 {
17240 tree used = walk_tree_without_duplicates (&type, uses_local_type_r, NULL);
17241 return used;
17242 }
17243
17244 /* Return the DIE for the scope that immediately contains this type.
17245 Non-named types that do not involve a function-local type get global
17246 scope. Named types nested in namespaces or other types get their
17247 containing scope. All other types (i.e. function-local named types) get
17248 the current active scope. */
17249
17250 static dw_die_ref
17251 scope_die_for (tree t, dw_die_ref context_die)
17252 {
17253 dw_die_ref scope_die = NULL;
17254 tree containing_scope;
17255
17256 /* Non-types always go in the current scope. */
17257 gcc_assert (TYPE_P (t));
17258
17259 /* Use the scope of the typedef, rather than the scope of the type
17260 it refers to. */
17261 if (TYPE_NAME (t) && DECL_P (TYPE_NAME (t)))
17262 containing_scope = DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (t));
17263 else
17264 containing_scope = TYPE_CONTEXT (t);
17265
17266 /* Use the containing namespace if there is one. */
17267 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
17268 {
17269 if (context_die == lookup_decl_die (containing_scope))
17270 /* OK */;
17271 else if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
17272 context_die = get_context_die (containing_scope);
17273 else
17274 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
17275 }
17276
17277 /* Ignore function type "scopes" from the C frontend. They mean that
17278 a tagged type is local to a parmlist of a function declarator, but
17279 that isn't useful to DWARF. */
17280 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == FUNCTION_TYPE)
17281 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
17282
17283 if (SCOPE_FILE_SCOPE_P (containing_scope))
17284 {
17285 /* If T uses a local type keep it local as well, to avoid references
17286 to function-local DIEs from outside the function. */
17287 if (current_function_decl && uses_local_type (t))
17288 scope_die = context_die;
17289 else
17290 scope_die = comp_unit_die ();
17291 }
17292 else if (TYPE_P (containing_scope))
17293 {
17294 /* For types, we can just look up the appropriate DIE. */
17295 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
17296 scope_die = get_context_die (containing_scope);
17297 else
17298 {
17299 scope_die = lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (containing_scope);
17300 if (scope_die == NULL)
17301 scope_die = comp_unit_die ();
17302 }
17303 }
17304 else
17305 scope_die = context_die;
17306
17307 return scope_die;
17308 }
17309
17310 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is internal to a function. */
17311
17312 static inline int
17313 local_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
17314 {
17315 for (; context_die; context_die = context_die->die_parent)
17316 if (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine
17317 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
17318 return 1;
17319
17320 return 0;
17321 }
17322
17323 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class. */
17324
17325 static inline int
17326 class_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
17327 {
17328 return (context_die
17329 && (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
17330 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type
17331 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_interface_type
17332 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type));
17333 }
17334
17335 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class or namespace, for deciding
17336 whether or not to treat a DIE in this context as a declaration. */
17337
17338 static inline int
17339 class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
17340 {
17341 return (class_scope_p (context_die)
17342 || (context_die && context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace));
17343 }
17344
17345 /* Many forms of DIEs require a "type description" attribute. This
17346 routine locates the proper "type descriptor" die for the type given
17347 by 'type' plus any additional qualifiers given by 'cv_quals', and
17348 adds a DW_AT_type attribute below the given die. */
17349
17350 static void
17351 add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref object_die, tree type, int cv_quals,
17352 dw_die_ref context_die)
17353 {
17354 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
17355 dw_die_ref type_die = NULL;
17356
17357 /* ??? If this type is an unnamed subrange type of an integral, floating-point
17358 or fixed-point type, use the inner type. This is because we have no
17359 support for unnamed types in base_type_die. This can happen if this is
17360 an Ada subrange type. Correct solution is emit a subrange type die. */
17361 if ((code == INTEGER_TYPE || code == REAL_TYPE || code == FIXED_POINT_TYPE)
17362 && TREE_TYPE (type) != 0 && TYPE_NAME (type) == 0)
17363 type = TREE_TYPE (type), code = TREE_CODE (type);
17364
17365 if (code == ERROR_MARK
17366 /* Handle a special case. For functions whose return type is void, we
17367 generate *no* type attribute. (Note that no object may have type
17368 `void', so this only applies to function return types). */
17369 || code == VOID_TYPE)
17370 return;
17371
17372 type_die = modified_type_die (type,
17373 cv_quals | TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (type),
17374 context_die);
17375
17376 if (type_die != NULL)
17377 add_AT_die_ref (object_die, DW_AT_type, type_die);
17378 }
17379
17380 /* Given an object die, add the calling convention attribute for the
17381 function call type. */
17382 static void
17383 add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref subr_die, tree decl)
17384 {
17385 enum dwarf_calling_convention value = DW_CC_normal;
17386
17387 value = ((enum dwarf_calling_convention)
17388 targetm.dwarf_calling_convention (TREE_TYPE (decl)));
17389
17390 if (is_fortran ()
17391 && !strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl)), "MAIN__"))
17392 {
17393 /* DWARF 2 doesn't provide a way to identify a program's source-level
17394 entry point. DW_AT_calling_convention attributes are only meant
17395 to describe functions' calling conventions. However, lacking a
17396 better way to signal the Fortran main program, we used this for
17397 a long time, following existing custom. Now, DWARF 4 has
17398 DW_AT_main_subprogram, which we add below, but some tools still
17399 rely on the old way, which we thus keep. */
17400 value = DW_CC_program;
17401
17402 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
17403 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_main_subprogram, 1);
17404 }
17405
17406 /* Only add the attribute if the backend requests it, and
17407 is not DW_CC_normal. */
17408 if (value && (value != DW_CC_normal))
17409 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_calling_convention, value);
17410 }
17411
17412 /* Given a tree pointer to a struct, class, union, or enum type node, return
17413 a pointer to the (string) tag name for the given type, or zero if the type
17414 was declared without a tag. */
17415
17416 static const char *
17417 type_tag (const_tree type)
17418 {
17419 const char *name = 0;
17420
17421 if (TYPE_NAME (type) != 0)
17422 {
17423 tree t = 0;
17424
17425 /* Find the IDENTIFIER_NODE for the type name. */
17426 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE
17427 && !TYPE_NAMELESS (type))
17428 t = TYPE_NAME (type);
17429
17430 /* The g++ front end makes the TYPE_NAME of *each* tagged type point to
17431 a TYPE_DECL node, regardless of whether or not a `typedef' was
17432 involved. */
17433 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
17434 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (TYPE_NAME (type)))
17435 {
17436 /* We want to be extra verbose. Don't call dwarf_name if
17437 DECL_NAME isn't set. The default hook for decl_printable_name
17438 doesn't like that, and in this context it's correct to return
17439 0, instead of "<anonymous>" or the like. */
17440 if (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type))
17441 && !DECL_NAMELESS (TYPE_NAME (type)))
17442 name = lang_hooks.dwarf_name (TYPE_NAME (type), 2);
17443 }
17444
17445 /* Now get the name as a string, or invent one. */
17446 if (!name && t != 0)
17447 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t);
17448 }
17449
17450 return (name == 0 || *name == '\0') ? 0 : name;
17451 }
17452
17453 /* Return the type associated with a data member, make a special check
17454 for bit field types. */
17455
17456 static inline tree
17457 member_declared_type (const_tree member)
17458 {
17459 return (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member)
17460 ? DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member) : TREE_TYPE (member));
17461 }
17462
17463 /* Get the decl's label, as described by its RTL. This may be different
17464 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
17465
17466 #if 0
17467 static const char *
17468 decl_start_label (tree decl)
17469 {
17470 rtx x;
17471 const char *fnname;
17472
17473 x = DECL_RTL (decl);
17474 gcc_assert (MEM_P (x));
17475
17476 x = XEXP (x, 0);
17477 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF);
17478
17479 fnname = XSTR (x, 0);
17480 return fnname;
17481 }
17482 #endif
17483 \f
17484 /* These routines generate the internal representation of the DIE's for
17485 the compilation unit. Debugging information is collected by walking
17486 the declaration trees passed in from dwarf2out_decl(). */
17487
17488 static void
17489 gen_array_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
17490 {
17491 dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
17492 dw_die_ref array_die;
17493
17494 /* GNU compilers represent multidimensional array types as sequences of one
17495 dimensional array types whose element types are themselves array types.
17496 We sometimes squish that down to a single array_type DIE with multiple
17497 subscripts in the Dwarf debugging info. The draft Dwarf specification
17498 say that we are allowed to do this kind of compression in C, because
17499 there is no difference between an array of arrays and a multidimensional
17500 array. We don't do this for Ada to remain as close as possible to the
17501 actual representation, which is especially important against the language
17502 flexibilty wrt arrays of variable size. */
17503
17504 bool collapse_nested_arrays = !is_ada ();
17505 tree element_type;
17506
17507 /* Emit DW_TAG_string_type for Fortran character types (with kind 1 only, as
17508 DW_TAG_string_type doesn't have DW_AT_type attribute). */
17509 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type)
17510 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
17511 && is_fortran ()
17512 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == TYPE_MODE (char_type_node))
17513 {
17514 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
17515
17516 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_string_type, scope_die, type);
17517 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
17518 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
17519 size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
17520 if (size >= 0)
17521 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
17522 else if (TYPE_DOMAIN (type) != NULL_TREE
17523 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)) != NULL_TREE
17524 && DECL_P (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type))))
17525 {
17526 tree szdecl = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type));
17527 dw_loc_list_ref loc = loc_list_from_tree (szdecl, 2, NULL);
17528
17529 size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (szdecl));
17530 if (loc && size > 0)
17531 {
17532 add_AT_location_description (array_die, DW_AT_string_length, loc);
17533 if (size != DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
17534 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
17535 }
17536 }
17537 return;
17538 }
17539
17540 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
17541 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
17542 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
17543
17544 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
17545 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_GNU_vector, 1);
17546
17547 /* For Fortran multidimensional arrays use DW_ORD_col_major ordering. */
17548 if (is_fortran ()
17549 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
17550 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == ARRAY_TYPE
17551 && !TYPE_STRING_FLAG (TREE_TYPE (type)))
17552 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_col_major);
17553
17554 #if 0
17555 /* We default the array ordering. SDB will probably do
17556 the right things even if DW_AT_ordering is not present. It's not even
17557 an issue until we start to get into multidimensional arrays anyway. If
17558 SDB is ever caught doing the Wrong Thing for multi-dimensional arrays,
17559 then we'll have to put the DW_AT_ordering attribute back in. (But if
17560 and when we find out that we need to put these in, we will only do so
17561 for multidimensional arrays. */
17562 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_row_major);
17563 #endif
17564
17565 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
17566 {
17567 /* For VECTOR_TYPEs we use an array die with appropriate bounds. */
17568 dw_die_ref subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, array_die, NULL);
17569 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, size_zero_node, NULL);
17570 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound,
17571 size_int (TYPE_VECTOR_SUBPARTS (type) - 1), NULL);
17572 }
17573 else
17574 add_subscript_info (array_die, type, collapse_nested_arrays);
17575
17576 /* Add representation of the type of the elements of this array type and
17577 emit the corresponding DIE if we haven't done it already. */
17578 element_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
17579 if (collapse_nested_arrays)
17580 while (TREE_CODE (element_type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
17581 {
17582 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (element_type) && is_fortran ())
17583 break;
17584 element_type = TREE_TYPE (element_type);
17585 }
17586
17587 add_type_attribute (array_die, element_type, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, context_die);
17588
17589 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (array_die, type, context_die);
17590 if (TYPE_ARTIFICIAL (type))
17591 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
17592
17593 if (get_AT (array_die, DW_AT_name))
17594 add_pubtype (type, array_die);
17595 }
17596
17597 /* This routine generates DIE for array with hidden descriptor, details
17598 are filled into *info by a langhook. */
17599
17600 static void
17601 gen_descr_array_type_die (tree type, struct array_descr_info *info,
17602 dw_die_ref context_die)
17603 {
17604 const dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
17605 const dw_die_ref array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
17606 const struct loc_descr_context context = { type, info->base_decl };
17607 int dim;
17608
17609 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
17610 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
17611
17612 if (info->ndimensions > 1)
17613 switch (info->ordering)
17614 {
17615 case array_descr_ordering_row_major:
17616 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_row_major);
17617 break;
17618 case array_descr_ordering_column_major:
17619 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_col_major);
17620 break;
17621 default:
17622 break;
17623 }
17624
17625 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
17626 {
17627 if (info->data_location)
17628 add_scalar_info (array_die, DW_AT_data_location, info->data_location,
17629 dw_scalar_form_exprloc, &context);
17630 if (info->associated)
17631 add_scalar_info (array_die, DW_AT_associated, info->associated,
17632 dw_scalar_form_constant
17633 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
17634 | dw_scalar_form_reference, &context);
17635 if (info->allocated)
17636 add_scalar_info (array_die, DW_AT_allocated, info->allocated,
17637 dw_scalar_form_constant
17638 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
17639 | dw_scalar_form_reference, &context);
17640 }
17641
17642 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (array_die, type, context_die);
17643
17644 for (dim = 0; dim < info->ndimensions; dim++)
17645 {
17646 dw_die_ref subrange_die
17647 = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, array_die, NULL);
17648
17649 if (info->dimen[dim].bounds_type)
17650 add_type_attribute (subrange_die,
17651 info->dimen[dim].bounds_type, 0,
17652 context_die);
17653 if (info->dimen[dim].lower_bound)
17654 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound,
17655 info->dimen[dim].lower_bound, &context);
17656 if (info->dimen[dim].upper_bound)
17657 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound,
17658 info->dimen[dim].upper_bound, &context);
17659 if ((dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict) && info->dimen[dim].stride)
17660 add_scalar_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_stride,
17661 info->dimen[dim].stride,
17662 dw_scalar_form_constant
17663 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
17664 | dw_scalar_form_reference,
17665 &context);
17666 }
17667
17668 gen_type_die (info->element_type, context_die);
17669 add_type_attribute (array_die, info->element_type, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED,
17670 context_die);
17671
17672 if (get_AT (array_die, DW_AT_name))
17673 add_pubtype (type, array_die);
17674 }
17675
17676 #if 0
17677 static void
17678 gen_entry_point_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
17679 {
17680 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
17681 dw_die_ref decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_entry_point, context_die, decl);
17682
17683 if (origin != NULL)
17684 add_abstract_origin_attribute (decl_die, origin);
17685 else
17686 {
17687 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
17688 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
17689 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, context_die);
17690 }
17691
17692 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl))
17693 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
17694 else
17695 add_AT_lbl_id (decl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, decl_start_label (decl));
17696 }
17697 #endif
17698
17699 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
17700 emit full debugging info for them. */
17701
17702 static void
17703 retry_incomplete_types (void)
17704 {
17705 int i;
17706
17707 for (i = vec_safe_length (incomplete_types) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
17708 if (should_emit_struct_debug ((*incomplete_types)[i], DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
17709 gen_type_die ((*incomplete_types)[i], comp_unit_die ());
17710 }
17711
17712 /* Determine what tag to use for a record type. */
17713
17714 static enum dwarf_tag
17715 record_type_tag (tree type)
17716 {
17717 if (! lang_hooks.types.classify_record)
17718 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
17719
17720 switch (lang_hooks.types.classify_record (type))
17721 {
17722 case RECORD_IS_STRUCT:
17723 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
17724
17725 case RECORD_IS_CLASS:
17726 return DW_TAG_class_type;
17727
17728 case RECORD_IS_INTERFACE:
17729 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
17730 return DW_TAG_interface_type;
17731 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
17732
17733 default:
17734 gcc_unreachable ();
17735 }
17736 }
17737
17738 /* Generate a DIE to represent an enumeration type. Note that these DIEs
17739 include all of the information about the enumeration values also. Each
17740 enumerated type name/value is listed as a child of the enumerated type
17741 DIE. */
17742
17743 static dw_die_ref
17744 gen_enumeration_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
17745 {
17746 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
17747
17748 if (type_die == NULL)
17749 {
17750 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type,
17751 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
17752 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
17753 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
17754 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
17755 {
17756 if (ENUM_IS_SCOPED (type))
17757 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_enum_class, 1);
17758 if (ENUM_IS_OPAQUE (type))
17759 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
17760 }
17761 }
17762 else if (! TYPE_SIZE (type))
17763 return type_die;
17764 else
17765 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
17766
17767 /* Handle a GNU C/C++ extension, i.e. incomplete enum types. If the
17768 given enum type is incomplete, do not generate the DW_AT_byte_size
17769 attribute or the DW_AT_element_list attribute. */
17770 if (TYPE_SIZE (type))
17771 {
17772 tree link;
17773
17774 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
17775 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
17776 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
17777 {
17778 tree underlying = lang_hooks.types.enum_underlying_base_type (type);
17779 add_type_attribute (type_die, underlying, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED,
17780 context_die);
17781 }
17782 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
17783 {
17784 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
17785 add_accessibility_attribute (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
17786 }
17787
17788 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
17789 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
17790 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
17791 add_child_die (scope_die_for (type, context_die), type_die);
17792
17793 for (link = TYPE_VALUES (type);
17794 link != NULL; link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
17795 {
17796 dw_die_ref enum_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumerator, type_die, link);
17797 tree value = TREE_VALUE (link);
17798
17799 add_name_attribute (enum_die,
17800 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (TREE_PURPOSE (link)));
17801
17802 if (TREE_CODE (value) == CONST_DECL)
17803 value = DECL_INITIAL (value);
17804
17805 if (simple_type_size_in_bits (TREE_TYPE (value))
17806 <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT || tree_fits_shwi_p (value))
17807 {
17808 /* For constant forms created by add_AT_unsigned DWARF
17809 consumers (GDB, elfutils, etc.) always zero extend
17810 the value. Only when the actual value is negative
17811 do we need to use add_AT_int to generate a constant
17812 form that can represent negative values. */
17813 HOST_WIDE_INT val = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (value);
17814 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (value)) || val >= 0)
17815 add_AT_unsigned (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value,
17816 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) val);
17817 else
17818 add_AT_int (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value, val);
17819 }
17820 else
17821 /* Enumeration constants may be wider than HOST_WIDE_INT. Handle
17822 that here. TODO: This should be re-worked to use correct
17823 signed/unsigned double tags for all cases. */
17824 add_AT_wide (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value, value);
17825 }
17826
17827 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (type_die, type, context_die);
17828 if (TYPE_ARTIFICIAL (type))
17829 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
17830 }
17831 else
17832 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
17833
17834 add_pubtype (type, type_die);
17835
17836 return type_die;
17837 }
17838
17839 /* Generate a DIE to represent either a real live formal parameter decl or to
17840 represent just the type of some formal parameter position in some function
17841 type.
17842
17843 Note that this routine is a bit unusual because its argument may be a
17844 ..._DECL node (i.e. either a PARM_DECL or perhaps a VAR_DECL which
17845 represents an inlining of some PARM_DECL) or else some sort of a ..._TYPE
17846 node. If it's the former then this function is being called to output a
17847 DIE to represent a formal parameter object (or some inlining thereof). If
17848 it's the latter, then this function is only being called to output a
17849 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE to stand as a placeholder for some formal
17850 argument type of some subprogram type.
17851 If EMIT_NAME_P is true, name and source coordinate attributes
17852 are emitted. */
17853
17854 static dw_die_ref
17855 gen_formal_parameter_die (tree node, tree origin, bool emit_name_p,
17856 dw_die_ref context_die)
17857 {
17858 tree node_or_origin = node ? node : origin;
17859 tree ultimate_origin;
17860 dw_die_ref parm_die
17861 = new_die (DW_TAG_formal_parameter, context_die, node);
17862
17863 switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (node_or_origin)))
17864 {
17865 case tcc_declaration:
17866 ultimate_origin = decl_ultimate_origin (node_or_origin);
17867 if (node || ultimate_origin)
17868 origin = ultimate_origin;
17869 if (origin != NULL)
17870 add_abstract_origin_attribute (parm_die, origin);
17871 else if (emit_name_p)
17872 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (parm_die, node);
17873 if (origin == NULL
17874 || (! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (node_or_origin)
17875 && variably_modified_type_p (TREE_TYPE (node_or_origin),
17876 decl_function_context
17877 (node_or_origin))))
17878 {
17879 tree type = TREE_TYPE (node_or_origin);
17880 if (decl_by_reference_p (node_or_origin))
17881 add_type_attribute (parm_die, TREE_TYPE (type),
17882 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, context_die);
17883 else
17884 add_type_attribute (parm_die, type,
17885 decl_quals (node_or_origin),
17886 context_die);
17887 }
17888 if (origin == NULL && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (node))
17889 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
17890
17891 if (node && node != origin)
17892 equate_decl_number_to_die (node, parm_die);
17893 if (! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (node_or_origin))
17894 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (parm_die, node_or_origin,
17895 node == NULL, DW_AT_location);
17896
17897 break;
17898
17899 case tcc_type:
17900 /* We were called with some kind of a ..._TYPE node. */
17901 add_type_attribute (parm_die, node_or_origin, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED,
17902 context_die);
17903 break;
17904
17905 default:
17906 gcc_unreachable ();
17907 }
17908
17909 return parm_die;
17910 }
17911
17912 /* Generate and return a DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack. Also generate
17913 children DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs representing the arguments of the
17914 parameter pack.
17915
17916 PARM_PACK must be a function parameter pack.
17917 PACK_ARG is the first argument of the parameter pack. Its TREE_CHAIN
17918 must point to the subsequent arguments of the function PACK_ARG belongs to.
17919 SUBR_DIE is the DIE of the function PACK_ARG belongs to.
17920 If NEXT_ARG is non NULL, *NEXT_ARG is set to the function argument
17921 following the last one for which a DIE was generated. */
17922
17923 static dw_die_ref
17924 gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (tree parm_pack,
17925 tree pack_arg,
17926 dw_die_ref subr_die,
17927 tree *next_arg)
17928 {
17929 tree arg;
17930 dw_die_ref parm_pack_die;
17931
17932 gcc_assert (parm_pack
17933 && lang_hooks.function_parameter_pack_p (parm_pack)
17934 && subr_die);
17935
17936 parm_pack_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack, subr_die, parm_pack);
17937 add_src_coords_attributes (parm_pack_die, parm_pack);
17938
17939 for (arg = pack_arg; arg; arg = DECL_CHAIN (arg))
17940 {
17941 if (! lang_hooks.decls.function_parm_expanded_from_pack_p (arg,
17942 parm_pack))
17943 break;
17944 gen_formal_parameter_die (arg, NULL,
17945 false /* Don't emit name attribute. */,
17946 parm_pack_die);
17947 }
17948 if (next_arg)
17949 *next_arg = arg;
17950 return parm_pack_die;
17951 }
17952
17953 /* Generate a special type of DIE used as a stand-in for a trailing ellipsis
17954 at the end of an (ANSI prototyped) formal parameters list. */
17955
17956 static void
17957 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree decl_or_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
17958 {
17959 new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters, context_die, decl_or_type);
17960 }
17961
17962 /* Generate a list of nameless DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs (and perhaps a
17963 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE) to represent the types of the formal
17964 parameters as specified in some function type specification (except for
17965 those which appear as part of a function *definition*). */
17966
17967 static void
17968 gen_formal_types_die (tree function_or_method_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
17969 {
17970 tree link;
17971 tree formal_type = NULL;
17972 tree first_parm_type;
17973 tree arg;
17974
17975 if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == FUNCTION_DECL)
17976 {
17977 arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (function_or_method_type);
17978 function_or_method_type = TREE_TYPE (function_or_method_type);
17979 }
17980 else
17981 arg = NULL_TREE;
17982
17983 first_parm_type = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
17984
17985 /* Make our first pass over the list of formal parameter types and output a
17986 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE for each one. */
17987 for (link = first_parm_type; link; )
17988 {
17989 dw_die_ref parm_die;
17990
17991 formal_type = TREE_VALUE (link);
17992 if (formal_type == void_type_node)
17993 break;
17994
17995 /* Output a (nameless) DIE to represent the formal parameter itself. */
17996 if (!POINTER_BOUNDS_TYPE_P (formal_type))
17997 {
17998 parm_die = gen_formal_parameter_die (formal_type, NULL,
17999 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
18000 context_die);
18001 if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == METHOD_TYPE
18002 && link == first_parm_type)
18003 {
18004 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
18005 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
18006 add_AT_die_ref (context_die, DW_AT_object_pointer, parm_die);
18007 }
18008 else if (arg && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (arg))
18009 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
18010 }
18011
18012 link = TREE_CHAIN (link);
18013 if (arg)
18014 arg = DECL_CHAIN (arg);
18015 }
18016
18017 /* If this function type has an ellipsis, add a
18018 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE to the end of the parameter list. */
18019 if (formal_type != void_type_node)
18020 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (function_or_method_type, context_die);
18021
18022 /* Make our second (and final) pass over the list of formal parameter types
18023 and output DIEs to represent those types (as necessary). */
18024 for (link = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
18025 link && TREE_VALUE (link);
18026 link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
18027 gen_type_die (TREE_VALUE (link), context_die);
18028 }
18029
18030 /* We want to generate the DIE for TYPE so that we can generate the
18031 die for MEMBER, which has been defined; we will need to refer back
18032 to the member declaration nested within TYPE. If we're trying to
18033 generate minimal debug info for TYPE, processing TYPE won't do the
18034 trick; we need to attach the member declaration by hand. */
18035
18036 static void
18037 gen_type_die_for_member (tree type, tree member, dw_die_ref context_die)
18038 {
18039 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
18040
18041 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
18042 emitted the member decl for this function. Emit it now. */
18043 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
18044 && TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))
18045 && ! lookup_decl_die (member))
18046 {
18047 dw_die_ref type_die;
18048 gcc_assert (!decl_ultimate_origin (member));
18049
18050 push_decl_scope (type);
18051 type_die = lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (type);
18052 if (TREE_CODE (member) == FUNCTION_DECL)
18053 gen_subprogram_die (member, type_die);
18054 else if (TREE_CODE (member) == FIELD_DECL)
18055 {
18056 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle
18057 C++ anonymous unions and structs. */
18058 if (DECL_NAME (member) != NULL_TREE
18059 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == UNION_TYPE
18060 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == RECORD_TYPE)
18061 {
18062 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (member), type_die);
18063 gen_field_die (member, type_die);
18064 }
18065 }
18066 else
18067 gen_variable_die (member, NULL_TREE, type_die);
18068
18069 pop_decl_scope ();
18070 }
18071 }
18072 \f
18073 /* Forward declare these functions, because they are mutually recursive
18074 with their set_block_* pairing functions. */
18075 static void set_decl_origin_self (tree);
18076 static void set_decl_abstract_flags (tree, vec<tree> &);
18077
18078 /* Given a pointer to some BLOCK node, if the BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for the
18079 given BLOCK node is NULL, set the BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for the node so
18080 that it points to the node itself, thus indicating that the node is its
18081 own (abstract) origin. Additionally, if the BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for
18082 the given node is NULL, recursively descend the decl/block tree which
18083 it is the root of, and for each other ..._DECL or BLOCK node contained
18084 therein whose DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGINs or BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGINs are also
18085 still NULL, set *their* DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN or BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN
18086 values to point to themselves. */
18087
18088 static void
18089 set_block_origin_self (tree stmt)
18090 {
18091 if (BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (stmt) == NULL_TREE)
18092 {
18093 BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (stmt) = stmt;
18094
18095 {
18096 tree local_decl;
18097
18098 for (local_decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt);
18099 local_decl != NULL_TREE;
18100 local_decl = DECL_CHAIN (local_decl))
18101 /* Do not recurse on nested functions since the inlining status
18102 of parent and child can be different as per the DWARF spec. */
18103 if (TREE_CODE (local_decl) != FUNCTION_DECL
18104 && !DECL_EXTERNAL (local_decl))
18105 set_decl_origin_self (local_decl);
18106 }
18107
18108 {
18109 tree subblock;
18110
18111 for (subblock = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
18112 subblock != NULL_TREE;
18113 subblock = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblock))
18114 set_block_origin_self (subblock); /* Recurse. */
18115 }
18116 }
18117 }
18118
18119 /* Given a pointer to some ..._DECL node, if the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for
18120 the given ..._DECL node is NULL, set the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for the
18121 node to so that it points to the node itself, thus indicating that the
18122 node represents its own (abstract) origin. Additionally, if the
18123 DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for the given node is NULL, recursively descend
18124 the decl/block tree of which the given node is the root of, and for
18125 each other ..._DECL or BLOCK node contained therein whose
18126 DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGINs or BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGINs are also still NULL,
18127 set *their* DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN or BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN values to
18128 point to themselves. */
18129
18130 static void
18131 set_decl_origin_self (tree decl)
18132 {
18133 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == NULL_TREE)
18134 {
18135 DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) = decl;
18136 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
18137 {
18138 tree arg;
18139
18140 for (arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl); arg; arg = DECL_CHAIN (arg))
18141 DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (arg) = arg;
18142 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE
18143 && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != error_mark_node)
18144 set_block_origin_self (DECL_INITIAL (decl));
18145 }
18146 }
18147 }
18148 \f
18149 /* Given a pointer to some BLOCK node, set the BLOCK_ABSTRACT flag to 1
18150 and if it wasn't 1 before, push it to abstract_vec vector.
18151 For all local decls and all local sub-blocks (recursively) do it
18152 too. */
18153
18154 static void
18155 set_block_abstract_flags (tree stmt, vec<tree> &abstract_vec)
18156 {
18157 tree local_decl;
18158 tree subblock;
18159 unsigned int i;
18160
18161 if (!BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
18162 {
18163 abstract_vec.safe_push (stmt);
18164 BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt) = 1;
18165 }
18166
18167 for (local_decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt);
18168 local_decl != NULL_TREE;
18169 local_decl = DECL_CHAIN (local_decl))
18170 if (! DECL_EXTERNAL (local_decl))
18171 set_decl_abstract_flags (local_decl, abstract_vec);
18172
18173 for (i = 0; i < BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (stmt); i++)
18174 {
18175 local_decl = BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VAR (stmt, i);
18176 if ((TREE_CODE (local_decl) == VAR_DECL && !TREE_STATIC (local_decl))
18177 || TREE_CODE (local_decl) == PARM_DECL)
18178 set_decl_abstract_flags (local_decl, abstract_vec);
18179 }
18180
18181 for (subblock = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
18182 subblock != NULL_TREE;
18183 subblock = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblock))
18184 set_block_abstract_flags (subblock, abstract_vec);
18185 }
18186
18187 /* Given a pointer to some ..._DECL node, set DECL_ABSTRACT_P flag on it
18188 to 1 and if it wasn't 1 before, push to abstract_vec vector.
18189 In the case where the decl is a FUNCTION_DECL also set the abstract
18190 flags for all of the parameters, local vars, local
18191 blocks and sub-blocks (recursively). */
18192
18193 static void
18194 set_decl_abstract_flags (tree decl, vec<tree> &abstract_vec)
18195 {
18196 if (!DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl))
18197 {
18198 abstract_vec.safe_push (decl);
18199 DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl) = 1;
18200 }
18201
18202 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
18203 {
18204 tree arg;
18205
18206 for (arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl); arg; arg = DECL_CHAIN (arg))
18207 if (!DECL_ABSTRACT_P (arg))
18208 {
18209 abstract_vec.safe_push (arg);
18210 DECL_ABSTRACT_P (arg) = 1;
18211 }
18212 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE
18213 && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != error_mark_node)
18214 set_block_abstract_flags (DECL_INITIAL (decl), abstract_vec);
18215 }
18216 }
18217
18218 /* Generate the DWARF2 info for the "abstract" instance of a function which we
18219 may later generate inlined and/or out-of-line instances of. */
18220
18221 static void
18222 dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree decl)
18223 {
18224 dw_die_ref old_die;
18225 tree save_fn;
18226 tree context;
18227 hash_table<decl_loc_hasher> *old_decl_loc_table;
18228 hash_table<dw_loc_list_hasher> *old_cached_dw_loc_list_table;
18229 int old_call_site_count, old_tail_call_site_count;
18230 struct call_arg_loc_node *old_call_arg_locations;
18231
18232 /* Make sure we have the actual abstract inline, not a clone. */
18233 decl = DECL_ORIGIN (decl);
18234
18235 old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
18236 if (old_die && get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
18237 /* We've already generated the abstract instance. */
18238 return;
18239
18240 /* We can be called while recursively when seeing block defining inlined subroutine
18241 DIE. Be sure to not clobber the outer location table nor use it or we would
18242 get locations in abstract instantces. */
18243 old_decl_loc_table = decl_loc_table;
18244 decl_loc_table = NULL;
18245 old_cached_dw_loc_list_table = cached_dw_loc_list_table;
18246 cached_dw_loc_list_table = NULL;
18247 old_call_arg_locations = call_arg_locations;
18248 call_arg_locations = NULL;
18249 old_call_site_count = call_site_count;
18250 call_site_count = -1;
18251 old_tail_call_site_count = tail_call_site_count;
18252 tail_call_site_count = -1;
18253
18254 /* Be sure we've emitted the in-class declaration DIE (if any) first, so
18255 we don't get confused by DECL_ABSTRACT_P. */
18256 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
18257 {
18258 context = decl_class_context (decl);
18259 if (context)
18260 gen_type_die_for_member
18261 (context, decl, decl_function_context (decl) ? NULL : comp_unit_die ());
18262 }
18263
18264 /* Pretend we've just finished compiling this function. */
18265 save_fn = current_function_decl;
18266 current_function_decl = decl;
18267
18268 auto_vec<tree, 64> abstract_vec;
18269 set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, abstract_vec);
18270 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
18271 unsigned int i;
18272 tree t;
18273 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (abstract_vec, i, t)
18274 if (TREE_CODE (t) == BLOCK)
18275 BLOCK_ABSTRACT (t) = 0;
18276 else
18277 DECL_ABSTRACT_P (t) = 0;
18278
18279 current_function_decl = save_fn;
18280 decl_loc_table = old_decl_loc_table;
18281 cached_dw_loc_list_table = old_cached_dw_loc_list_table;
18282 call_arg_locations = old_call_arg_locations;
18283 call_site_count = old_call_site_count;
18284 tail_call_site_count = old_tail_call_site_count;
18285 }
18286
18287 /* Helper function of premark_used_types() which gets called through
18288 htab_traverse.
18289
18290 Marks the DIE of a given type in *SLOT as perennial, so it never gets
18291 marked as unused by prune_unused_types. */
18292
18293 bool
18294 premark_used_types_helper (tree const &type, void *)
18295 {
18296 dw_die_ref die;
18297
18298 die = lookup_type_die (type);
18299 if (die != NULL)
18300 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
18301 return true;
18302 }
18303
18304 /* Helper function of premark_types_used_by_global_vars which gets called
18305 through htab_traverse.
18306
18307 Marks the DIE of a given type in *SLOT as perennial, so it never gets
18308 marked as unused by prune_unused_types. The DIE of the type is marked
18309 only if the global variable using the type will actually be emitted. */
18310
18311 int
18312 premark_types_used_by_global_vars_helper (types_used_by_vars_entry **slot,
18313 void *)
18314 {
18315 struct types_used_by_vars_entry *entry;
18316 dw_die_ref die;
18317
18318 entry = (struct types_used_by_vars_entry *) *slot;
18319 gcc_assert (entry->type != NULL
18320 && entry->var_decl != NULL);
18321 die = lookup_type_die (entry->type);
18322 if (die)
18323 {
18324 /* Ask cgraph if the global variable really is to be emitted.
18325 If yes, then we'll keep the DIE of ENTRY->TYPE. */
18326 varpool_node *node = varpool_node::get (entry->var_decl);
18327 if (node && node->definition)
18328 {
18329 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
18330 /* Keep the parent DIEs as well. */
18331 while ((die = die->die_parent) && die->die_perennial_p == 0)
18332 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
18333 }
18334 }
18335 return 1;
18336 }
18337
18338 /* Mark all members of used_types_hash as perennial. */
18339
18340 static void
18341 premark_used_types (struct function *fun)
18342 {
18343 if (fun && fun->used_types_hash)
18344 fun->used_types_hash->traverse<void *, premark_used_types_helper> (NULL);
18345 }
18346
18347 /* Mark all members of types_used_by_vars_entry as perennial. */
18348
18349 static void
18350 premark_types_used_by_global_vars (void)
18351 {
18352 if (types_used_by_vars_hash)
18353 types_used_by_vars_hash
18354 ->traverse<void *, premark_types_used_by_global_vars_helper> (NULL);
18355 }
18356
18357 /* Generate a DW_TAG_GNU_call_site DIE in function DECL under SUBR_DIE
18358 for CA_LOC call arg loc node. */
18359
18360 static dw_die_ref
18361 gen_call_site_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref subr_die,
18362 struct call_arg_loc_node *ca_loc)
18363 {
18364 dw_die_ref stmt_die = NULL, die;
18365 tree block = ca_loc->block;
18366
18367 while (block
18368 && block != DECL_INITIAL (decl)
18369 && TREE_CODE (block) == BLOCK)
18370 {
18371 if (block_map.length () > BLOCK_NUMBER (block))
18372 stmt_die = block_map[BLOCK_NUMBER (block)];
18373 if (stmt_die)
18374 break;
18375 block = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (block);
18376 }
18377 if (stmt_die == NULL)
18378 stmt_die = subr_die;
18379 die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_call_site, stmt_die, NULL_TREE);
18380 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_low_pc, ca_loc->label);
18381 if (ca_loc->tail_call_p)
18382 add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_GNU_tail_call, 1);
18383 if (ca_loc->symbol_ref)
18384 {
18385 dw_die_ref tdie = lookup_decl_die (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (ca_loc->symbol_ref));
18386 if (tdie)
18387 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, tdie);
18388 else
18389 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, ca_loc->symbol_ref, false);
18390 }
18391 return die;
18392 }
18393
18394 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared function (either file-scope or
18395 block-local). */
18396
18397 static void
18398 gen_subprogram_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
18399 {
18400 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
18401 dw_die_ref subr_die;
18402 tree outer_scope;
18403 dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
18404 int declaration = (current_function_decl != decl
18405 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
18406
18407 premark_used_types (DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl));
18408
18409 /* It is possible to have both DECL_ABSTRACT_P and DECLARATION be true if we
18410 started to generate the abstract instance of an inline, decided to output
18411 its containing class, and proceeded to emit the declaration of the inline
18412 from the member list for the class. If so, DECLARATION takes priority;
18413 we'll get back to the abstract instance when done with the class. */
18414
18415 /* The class-scope declaration DIE must be the primary DIE. */
18416 if (origin && declaration && class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die))
18417 {
18418 origin = NULL;
18419 gcc_assert (!old_die);
18420 }
18421
18422 /* Now that the C++ front end lazily declares artificial member fns, we
18423 might need to retrofit the declaration into its class. */
18424 if (!declaration && !origin && !old_die
18425 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl) && TYPE_P (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
18426 && !class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
18427 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
18428 old_die = force_decl_die (decl);
18429
18430 if (origin != NULL)
18431 {
18432 gcc_assert (!declaration || local_scope_p (context_die));
18433
18434 /* Fixup die_parent for the abstract instance of a nested
18435 inline function. */
18436 if (old_die && old_die->die_parent == NULL)
18437 add_child_die (context_die, old_die);
18438
18439 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
18440 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, origin);
18441 /* This is where the actual code for a cloned function is.
18442 Let's emit linkage name attribute for it. This helps
18443 debuggers to e.g, set breakpoints into
18444 constructors/destructors when the user asks "break
18445 K::K". */
18446 add_linkage_name (subr_die, decl);
18447 }
18448 else if (old_die)
18449 {
18450 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
18451 struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
18452
18453 if (!get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration)
18454 /* We can have a normal definition following an inline one in the
18455 case of redefinition of GNU C extern inlines.
18456 It seems reasonable to use AT_specification in this case. */
18457 && !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
18458 {
18459 /* Detect and ignore this case, where we are trying to output
18460 something we have already output. */
18461 return;
18462 }
18463
18464 /* If the definition comes from the same place as the declaration,
18465 maybe use the old DIE. We always want the DIE for this function
18466 that has the *_pc attributes to be under comp_unit_die so the
18467 debugger can find it. We also need to do this for abstract
18468 instances of inlines, since the spec requires the out-of-line copy
18469 to have the same parent. For local class methods, this doesn't
18470 apply; we just use the old DIE. */
18471 if ((is_cu_die (old_die->die_parent) || context_die == NULL)
18472 && (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
18473 || (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) == file_index
18474 && (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
18475 == (unsigned) s.line))))
18476 {
18477 subr_die = old_die;
18478
18479 /* Clear out the declaration attribute and the formal parameters.
18480 Do not remove all children, because it is possible that this
18481 declaration die was forced using force_decl_die(). In such
18482 cases die that forced declaration die (e.g. TAG_imported_module)
18483 is one of the children that we do not want to remove. */
18484 remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration);
18485 remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_object_pointer);
18486 remove_child_TAG (subr_die, DW_TAG_formal_parameter);
18487 }
18488 else
18489 {
18490 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
18491 add_AT_specification (subr_die, old_die);
18492 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
18493 if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
18494 add_AT_file (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
18495 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
18496 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
18497
18498 /* If the prototype had an 'auto' or 'decltype(auto)' return type,
18499 emit the real type on the definition die. */
18500 if (is_cxx() && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
18501 {
18502 dw_die_ref die = get_AT_ref (old_die, DW_AT_type);
18503 if (die == auto_die || die == decltype_auto_die)
18504 add_type_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
18505 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, context_die);
18506 }
18507 }
18508 }
18509 else
18510 {
18511 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
18512
18513 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
18514 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
18515
18516 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (subr_die, decl);
18517 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
18518 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
18519 {
18520 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
18521 add_type_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
18522 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, context_die);
18523 }
18524
18525 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (subr_die, decl);
18526 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
18527 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
18528
18529 if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl) && (dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict))
18530 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_noreturn, 1);
18531
18532 add_accessibility_attribute (subr_die, decl);
18533 }
18534
18535 if (declaration)
18536 {
18537 if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
18538 {
18539 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
18540
18541 /* If this is an explicit function declaration then generate
18542 a DW_AT_explicit attribute. */
18543 if (lang_hooks.decls.function_decl_explicit_p (decl)
18544 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
18545 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_explicit, 1);
18546
18547 /* If this is a C++11 deleted special function member then generate
18548 a DW_AT_GNU_deleted attribute. */
18549 if (lang_hooks.decls.function_decl_deleted_p (decl)
18550 && (! dwarf_strict))
18551 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_GNU_deleted, 1);
18552
18553 /* The first time we see a member function, it is in the context of
18554 the class to which it belongs. We make sure of this by emitting
18555 the class first. The next time is the definition, which is
18556 handled above. The two may come from the same source text.
18557
18558 Note that force_decl_die() forces function declaration die. It is
18559 later reused to represent definition. */
18560 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
18561 }
18562 }
18563 else if (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl))
18564 {
18565 if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl))
18566 {
18567 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
18568 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_inlined);
18569 else
18570 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_not_inlined);
18571 }
18572 else
18573 {
18574 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
18575 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_inlined);
18576 else
18577 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_not_inlined);
18578 }
18579
18580 if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl)
18581 && lookup_attribute ("artificial", DECL_ATTRIBUTES (decl)))
18582 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
18583
18584 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
18585 }
18586 else if (!DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
18587 {
18588 HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_fb_offset;
18589 struct function *fun = DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl);
18590
18591 if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
18592 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
18593
18594 gcc_checking_assert (fun);
18595 if (!flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
18596 {
18597 dw_fde_ref fde = fun->fde;
18598 if (fde->dw_fde_begin)
18599 {
18600 /* We have already generated the labels. */
18601 add_AT_low_high_pc (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_begin,
18602 fde->dw_fde_end, false);
18603 }
18604 else
18605 {
18606 /* Create start/end labels and add the range. */
18607 char label_id_low[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
18608 char label_id_high[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
18609 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id_low, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
18610 current_function_funcdef_no);
18611 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id_high, FUNC_END_LABEL,
18612 current_function_funcdef_no);
18613 add_AT_low_high_pc (subr_die, label_id_low, label_id_high,
18614 false);
18615 }
18616
18617 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
18618 /* HP OpenVMS Industry Standard 64: DWARF Extensions
18619 Section 2.3 Prologue and Epilogue Attributes:
18620 When a breakpoint is set on entry to a function, it is generally
18621 desirable for execution to be suspended, not on the very first
18622 instruction of the function, but rather at a point after the
18623 function's frame has been set up, after any language defined local
18624 declaration processing has been completed, and before execution of
18625 the first statement of the function begins. Debuggers generally
18626 cannot properly determine where this point is. Similarly for a
18627 breakpoint set on exit from a function. The prologue and epilogue
18628 attributes allow a compiler to communicate the location(s) to use. */
18629
18630 {
18631 if (fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue)
18632 add_AT_vms_delta (subr_die, DW_AT_HP_prologue,
18633 fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue);
18634
18635 if (fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue)
18636 add_AT_vms_delta (subr_die, DW_AT_HP_epilogue,
18637 fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue);
18638 }
18639 #endif
18640
18641 }
18642 else
18643 {
18644 /* Generate pubnames entries for the split function code ranges. */
18645 dw_fde_ref fde = fun->fde;
18646
18647 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin)
18648 {
18649 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
18650 {
18651 /* We should use ranges for non-contiguous code section
18652 addresses. Use the actual code range for the initial
18653 section, since the HOT/COLD labels might precede an
18654 alignment offset. */
18655 bool range_list_added = false;
18656 add_ranges_by_labels (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_begin,
18657 fde->dw_fde_end, &range_list_added,
18658 false);
18659 add_ranges_by_labels (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
18660 fde->dw_fde_second_end,
18661 &range_list_added, false);
18662 if (range_list_added)
18663 add_ranges (NULL);
18664 }
18665 else
18666 {
18667 /* There is no real support in DW2 for this .. so we make
18668 a work-around. First, emit the pub name for the segment
18669 containing the function label. Then make and emit a
18670 simplified subprogram DIE for the second segment with the
18671 name pre-fixed by __hot/cold_sect_of_. We use the same
18672 linkage name for the second die so that gdb will find both
18673 sections when given "b foo". */
18674 const char *name = NULL;
18675 tree decl_name = DECL_NAME (decl);
18676 dw_die_ref seg_die;
18677
18678 /* Do the 'primary' section. */
18679 add_AT_low_high_pc (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_begin,
18680 fde->dw_fde_end, false);
18681
18682 /* Build a minimal DIE for the secondary section. */
18683 seg_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram,
18684 subr_die->die_parent, decl);
18685
18686 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
18687 add_AT_flag (seg_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
18688
18689 if (decl_name != NULL
18690 && IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name) != NULL)
18691 {
18692 name = dwarf2_name (decl, 1);
18693 if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
18694 add_src_coords_attributes (seg_die, decl);
18695
18696 add_linkage_name (seg_die, decl);
18697 }
18698 gcc_assert (name != NULL);
18699 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (seg_die, decl);
18700 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
18701 add_AT_flag (seg_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
18702
18703 name = concat ("__second_sect_of_", name, NULL);
18704 add_AT_low_high_pc (seg_die, fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
18705 fde->dw_fde_second_end, false);
18706 add_name_attribute (seg_die, name);
18707 if (want_pubnames ())
18708 add_pubname_string (name, seg_die);
18709 }
18710 }
18711 else
18712 add_AT_low_high_pc (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_end,
18713 false);
18714 }
18715
18716 cfa_fb_offset = CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (decl);
18717
18718 /* We define the "frame base" as the function's CFA. This is more
18719 convenient for several reasons: (1) It's stable across the prologue
18720 and epilogue, which makes it better than just a frame pointer,
18721 (2) With dwarf3, there exists a one-byte encoding that allows us
18722 to reference the .debug_frame data by proxy, but failing that,
18723 (3) We can at least reuse the code inspection and interpretation
18724 code that determines the CFA position at various points in the
18725 function. */
18726 if (dwarf_version >= 3 && targetm.debug_unwind_info () == UI_DWARF2)
18727 {
18728 dw_loc_descr_ref op = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_call_frame_cfa, 0, 0);
18729 add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, op);
18730 }
18731 else
18732 {
18733 dw_loc_list_ref list = convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (cfa_fb_offset);
18734 if (list->dw_loc_next)
18735 add_AT_loc_list (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list);
18736 else
18737 add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list->expr);
18738 }
18739
18740 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to
18741 the CFA. The former is what all stack slots and argument slots
18742 will reference in the rtl; the latter is what we've told the
18743 debugger about. We'll need to adjust all frame_base references
18744 by this displacement. */
18745 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (cfa_fb_offset);
18746
18747 if (fun->static_chain_decl)
18748 add_AT_location_description (subr_die, DW_AT_static_link,
18749 loc_list_from_tree (fun->static_chain_decl, 2, NULL));
18750 }
18751
18752 /* Generate child dies for template paramaters. */
18753 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
18754 gen_generic_params_dies (decl);
18755
18756 /* Now output descriptions of the arguments for this function. This gets
18757 (unnecessarily?) complex because of the fact that the DECL_ARGUMENT list
18758 for a FUNCTION_DECL doesn't indicate cases where there was a trailing
18759 `...' at the end of the formal parameter list. In order to find out if
18760 there was a trailing ellipsis or not, we must instead look at the type
18761 associated with the FUNCTION_DECL. This will be a node of type
18762 FUNCTION_TYPE. If the chain of type nodes hanging off of this
18763 FUNCTION_TYPE node ends with a void_type_node then there should *not* be
18764 an ellipsis at the end. */
18765
18766 /* In the case where we are describing a mere function declaration, all we
18767 need to do here (and all we *can* do here) is to describe the *types* of
18768 its formal parameters. */
18769 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
18770 ;
18771 else if (declaration)
18772 gen_formal_types_die (decl, subr_die);
18773 else
18774 {
18775 /* Generate DIEs to represent all known formal parameters. */
18776 tree parm = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl);
18777 tree generic_decl = lang_hooks.decls.get_generic_function_decl (decl);
18778 tree generic_decl_parm = generic_decl
18779 ? DECL_ARGUMENTS (generic_decl)
18780 : NULL;
18781
18782 /* Now we want to walk the list of parameters of the function and
18783 emit their relevant DIEs.
18784
18785 We consider the case of DECL being an instance of a generic function
18786 as well as it being a normal function.
18787
18788 If DECL is an instance of a generic function we walk the
18789 parameters of the generic function declaration _and_ the parameters of
18790 DECL itself. This is useful because we want to emit specific DIEs for
18791 function parameter packs and those are declared as part of the
18792 generic function declaration. In that particular case,
18793 the parameter pack yields a DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack DIE.
18794 That DIE has children DIEs representing the set of arguments
18795 of the pack. Note that the set of pack arguments can be empty.
18796 In that case, the DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack DIE will not have any
18797 children DIE.
18798
18799 Otherwise, we just consider the parameters of DECL. */
18800 while (generic_decl_parm || parm)
18801 {
18802 if (generic_decl_parm
18803 && lang_hooks.function_parameter_pack_p (generic_decl_parm))
18804 gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (generic_decl_parm,
18805 parm, subr_die,
18806 &parm);
18807 else if (parm && !POINTER_BOUNDS_P (parm))
18808 {
18809 dw_die_ref parm_die = gen_decl_die (parm, NULL, subr_die);
18810
18811 if (parm == DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl)
18812 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == METHOD_TYPE
18813 && parm_die
18814 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
18815 add_AT_die_ref (subr_die, DW_AT_object_pointer, parm_die);
18816
18817 parm = DECL_CHAIN (parm);
18818 }
18819 else if (parm)
18820 parm = DECL_CHAIN (parm);
18821
18822 if (generic_decl_parm)
18823 generic_decl_parm = DECL_CHAIN (generic_decl_parm);
18824 }
18825
18826 /* Decide whether we need an unspecified_parameters DIE at the end.
18827 There are 2 more cases to do this for: 1) the ansi ... declaration -
18828 this is detectable when the end of the arg list is not a
18829 void_type_node 2) an unprototyped function declaration (not a
18830 definition). This just means that we have no info about the
18831 parameters at all. */
18832 if (prototype_p (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
18833 {
18834 /* This is the prototyped case, check for.... */
18835 if (stdarg_p (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
18836 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
18837 }
18838 else if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
18839 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
18840 }
18841
18842 /* Output Dwarf info for all of the stuff within the body of the function
18843 (if it has one - it may be just a declaration). */
18844 outer_scope = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
18845
18846 /* OUTER_SCOPE is a pointer to the outermost BLOCK node created to represent
18847 a function. This BLOCK actually represents the outermost binding contour
18848 for the function, i.e. the contour in which the function's formal
18849 parameters and labels get declared. Curiously, it appears that the front
18850 end doesn't actually put the PARM_DECL nodes for the current function onto
18851 the BLOCK_VARS list for this outer scope, but are strung off of the
18852 DECL_ARGUMENTS list for the function instead.
18853
18854 The BLOCK_VARS list for the `outer_scope' does provide us with a list of
18855 the LABEL_DECL nodes for the function however, and we output DWARF info
18856 for those in decls_for_scope. Just within the `outer_scope' there will be
18857 a BLOCK node representing the function's outermost pair of curly braces,
18858 and any blocks used for the base and member initializers of a C++
18859 constructor function. */
18860 if (! declaration && outer_scope && TREE_CODE (outer_scope) != ERROR_MARK)
18861 {
18862 int call_site_note_count = 0;
18863 int tail_call_site_note_count = 0;
18864
18865 /* Emit a DW_TAG_variable DIE for a named return value. */
18866 if (DECL_NAME (DECL_RESULT (decl)))
18867 gen_decl_die (DECL_RESULT (decl), NULL, subr_die);
18868
18869 decls_for_scope (outer_scope, subr_die);
18870
18871 if (call_arg_locations && !dwarf_strict)
18872 {
18873 struct call_arg_loc_node *ca_loc;
18874 for (ca_loc = call_arg_locations; ca_loc; ca_loc = ca_loc->next)
18875 {
18876 dw_die_ref die = NULL;
18877 rtx tloc = NULL_RTX, tlocc = NULL_RTX;
18878 rtx arg, next_arg;
18879
18880 for (arg = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (ca_loc->call_arg_loc_note);
18881 arg; arg = next_arg)
18882 {
18883 dw_loc_descr_ref reg, val;
18884 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1));
18885 dw_die_ref cdie, tdie = NULL;
18886
18887 next_arg = XEXP (arg, 1);
18888 if (REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0))
18889 && next_arg
18890 && MEM_P (XEXP (XEXP (next_arg, 0), 0))
18891 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (next_arg, 0), 0), 0))
18892 && REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0))
18893 == REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (next_arg, 0), 0), 0)))
18894 next_arg = XEXP (next_arg, 1);
18895 if (mode == VOIDmode)
18896 {
18897 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0));
18898 if (mode == VOIDmode)
18899 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (arg, 0));
18900 }
18901 if (mode == VOIDmode || mode == BLKmode)
18902 continue;
18903 if (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0) == pc_rtx)
18904 {
18905 gcc_assert (ca_loc->symbol_ref == NULL_RTX);
18906 tloc = XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1);
18907 continue;
18908 }
18909 else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0)) == CLOBBER
18910 && XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0), 0) == pc_rtx)
18911 {
18912 gcc_assert (ca_loc->symbol_ref == NULL_RTX);
18913 tlocc = XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1);
18914 continue;
18915 }
18916 reg = NULL;
18917 if (REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0)))
18918 reg = reg_loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0),
18919 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
18920 else if (MEM_P (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0)))
18921 {
18922 rtx mem = XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0);
18923 reg = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (mem, 0),
18924 get_address_mode (mem),
18925 GET_MODE (mem),
18926 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
18927 }
18928 else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0))
18929 == DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF)
18930 {
18931 tree tdecl
18932 = DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF_DECL (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0));
18933 tdie = lookup_decl_die (tdecl);
18934 if (tdie == NULL)
18935 continue;
18936 }
18937 else
18938 continue;
18939 if (reg == NULL
18940 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0))
18941 != DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF)
18942 continue;
18943 val = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1), mode,
18944 VOIDmode,
18945 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
18946 if (val == NULL)
18947 continue;
18948 if (die == NULL)
18949 die = gen_call_site_die (decl, subr_die, ca_loc);
18950 cdie = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_call_site_parameter, die,
18951 NULL_TREE);
18952 if (reg != NULL)
18953 add_AT_loc (cdie, DW_AT_location, reg);
18954 else if (tdie != NULL)
18955 add_AT_die_ref (cdie, DW_AT_abstract_origin, tdie);
18956 add_AT_loc (cdie, DW_AT_GNU_call_site_value, val);
18957 if (next_arg != XEXP (arg, 1))
18958 {
18959 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 1), 0), 1));
18960 if (mode == VOIDmode)
18961 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 1), 0), 0));
18962 val = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 1),
18963 0), 1),
18964 mode, VOIDmode,
18965 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
18966 if (val != NULL)
18967 add_AT_loc (cdie, DW_AT_GNU_call_site_data_value, val);
18968 }
18969 }
18970 if (die == NULL
18971 && (ca_loc->symbol_ref || tloc))
18972 die = gen_call_site_die (decl, subr_die, ca_loc);
18973 if (die != NULL && (tloc != NULL_RTX || tlocc != NULL_RTX))
18974 {
18975 dw_loc_descr_ref tval = NULL;
18976
18977 if (tloc != NULL_RTX)
18978 tval = mem_loc_descriptor (tloc,
18979 GET_MODE (tloc) == VOIDmode
18980 ? Pmode : GET_MODE (tloc),
18981 VOIDmode,
18982 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
18983 if (tval)
18984 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_GNU_call_site_target, tval);
18985 else if (tlocc != NULL_RTX)
18986 {
18987 tval = mem_loc_descriptor (tlocc,
18988 GET_MODE (tlocc) == VOIDmode
18989 ? Pmode : GET_MODE (tlocc),
18990 VOIDmode,
18991 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
18992 if (tval)
18993 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_GNU_call_site_target_clobbered,
18994 tval);
18995 }
18996 }
18997 if (die != NULL)
18998 {
18999 call_site_note_count++;
19000 if (ca_loc->tail_call_p)
19001 tail_call_site_note_count++;
19002 }
19003 }
19004 }
19005 call_arg_locations = NULL;
19006 call_arg_loc_last = NULL;
19007 if (tail_call_site_count >= 0
19008 && tail_call_site_count == tail_call_site_note_count
19009 && !dwarf_strict)
19010 {
19011 if (call_site_count >= 0
19012 && call_site_count == call_site_note_count)
19013 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_GNU_all_call_sites, 1);
19014 else
19015 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_GNU_all_tail_call_sites, 1);
19016 }
19017 call_site_count = -1;
19018 tail_call_site_count = -1;
19019 }
19020
19021 if (subr_die != old_die)
19022 /* Add the calling convention attribute if requested. */
19023 add_calling_convention_attribute (subr_die, decl);
19024 }
19025
19026 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct). */
19027
19028 hashval_t
19029 block_die_hasher::hash (die_struct *d)
19030 {
19031 return (hashval_t) d->decl_id ^ htab_hash_pointer (d->die_parent);
19032 }
19033
19034 /* Return nonzero if decl_id and die_parent of die_struct X is the same
19035 as decl_id and die_parent of die_struct Y. */
19036
19037 bool
19038 block_die_hasher::equal (die_struct *x, die_struct *y)
19039 {
19040 return x->decl_id == y->decl_id && x->die_parent == y->die_parent;
19041 }
19042
19043 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared data object.
19044 Either DECL or ORIGIN must be non-null. */
19045
19046 static void
19047 gen_variable_die (tree decl, tree origin, dw_die_ref context_die)
19048 {
19049 HOST_WIDE_INT off = 0;
19050 tree com_decl;
19051 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
19052 tree ultimate_origin;
19053 dw_die_ref var_die;
19054 dw_die_ref old_die = decl ? lookup_decl_die (decl) : NULL;
19055 dw_die_ref origin_die;
19056 bool declaration = (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl_or_origin)
19057 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
19058 bool specialization_p = false;
19059
19060 ultimate_origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl_or_origin);
19061 if (decl || ultimate_origin)
19062 origin = ultimate_origin;
19063 com_decl = fortran_common (decl_or_origin, &off);
19064
19065 /* Symbol in common gets emitted as a child of the common block, in the form
19066 of a data member. */
19067 if (com_decl)
19068 {
19069 dw_die_ref com_die;
19070 dw_loc_list_ref loc;
19071 die_node com_die_arg;
19072
19073 var_die = lookup_decl_die (decl_or_origin);
19074 if (var_die)
19075 {
19076 if (get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_location) == NULL)
19077 {
19078 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, off ? 1 : 2, NULL);
19079 if (loc)
19080 {
19081 if (off)
19082 {
19083 /* Optimize the common case. */
19084 if (single_element_loc_list_p (loc)
19085 && loc->expr->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr
19086 && loc->expr->dw_loc_next == NULL
19087 && GET_CODE (loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr)
19088 == SYMBOL_REF)
19089 {
19090 rtx x = loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr;
19091 loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr
19092 = plus_constant (GET_MODE (x), x , off);
19093 }
19094 else
19095 loc_list_plus_const (loc, off);
19096 }
19097 add_AT_location_description (var_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
19098 remove_AT (var_die, DW_AT_declaration);
19099 }
19100 }
19101 return;
19102 }
19103
19104 if (common_block_die_table == NULL)
19105 common_block_die_table = hash_table<block_die_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
19106
19107 com_die_arg.decl_id = DECL_UID (com_decl);
19108 com_die_arg.die_parent = context_die;
19109 com_die = common_block_die_table->find (&com_die_arg);
19110 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2, NULL);
19111 if (com_die == NULL)
19112 {
19113 const char *cnam
19114 = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (com_decl));
19115 die_node **slot;
19116
19117 com_die = new_die (DW_TAG_common_block, context_die, decl);
19118 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (com_die, com_decl);
19119 if (loc)
19120 {
19121 add_AT_location_description (com_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
19122 /* Avoid sharing the same loc descriptor between
19123 DW_TAG_common_block and DW_TAG_variable. */
19124 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2, NULL);
19125 }
19126 else if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
19127 add_AT_flag (com_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
19128 if (want_pubnames ())
19129 add_pubname_string (cnam, com_die); /* ??? needed? */
19130 com_die->decl_id = DECL_UID (com_decl);
19131 slot = common_block_die_table->find_slot (com_die, INSERT);
19132 *slot = com_die;
19133 }
19134 else if (get_AT (com_die, DW_AT_location) == NULL && loc)
19135 {
19136 add_AT_location_description (com_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
19137 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2, NULL);
19138 remove_AT (com_die, DW_AT_declaration);
19139 }
19140 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, com_die, decl);
19141 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl);
19142 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (decl), decl_quals (decl),
19143 context_die);
19144 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
19145 if (loc)
19146 {
19147 if (off)
19148 {
19149 /* Optimize the common case. */
19150 if (single_element_loc_list_p (loc)
19151 && loc->expr->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr
19152 && loc->expr->dw_loc_next == NULL
19153 && GET_CODE (loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr) == SYMBOL_REF)
19154 {
19155 rtx x = loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr;
19156 loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr
19157 = plus_constant (GET_MODE (x), x, off);
19158 }
19159 else
19160 loc_list_plus_const (loc, off);
19161 }
19162 add_AT_location_description (var_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
19163 }
19164 else if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
19165 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
19166 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
19167 return;
19168 }
19169
19170 /* If the compiler emitted a definition for the DECL declaration
19171 and if we already emitted a DIE for it, don't emit a second
19172 DIE for it again. Allow re-declarations of DECLs that are
19173 inside functions, though. */
19174 if (old_die && declaration && !local_scope_p (context_die))
19175 return;
19176
19177 /* For static data members, the declaration in the class is supposed
19178 to have DW_TAG_member tag; the specification should still be
19179 DW_TAG_variable referencing the DW_TAG_member DIE. */
19180 if (declaration && class_scope_p (context_die))
19181 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
19182 else
19183 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, context_die, decl);
19184
19185 origin_die = NULL;
19186 if (origin != NULL)
19187 origin_die = add_abstract_origin_attribute (var_die, origin);
19188
19189 /* Loop unrolling can create multiple blocks that refer to the same
19190 static variable, so we must test for the DW_AT_declaration flag.
19191
19192 ??? Loop unrolling/reorder_blocks should perhaps be rewritten to
19193 copy decls and set the DECL_ABSTRACT_P flag on them instead of
19194 sharing them.
19195
19196 ??? Duplicated blocks have been rewritten to use .debug_ranges.
19197
19198 ??? The declare_in_namespace support causes us to get two DIEs for one
19199 variable, both of which are declarations. We want to avoid considering
19200 one to be a specification, so we must test that this DIE is not a
19201 declaration. */
19202 else if (old_die && TREE_STATIC (decl) && ! declaration
19203 && get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration) == 1)
19204 {
19205 /* This is a definition of a C++ class level static. */
19206 add_AT_specification (var_die, old_die);
19207 specialization_p = true;
19208 if (DECL_NAME (decl))
19209 {
19210 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
19211 struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
19212
19213 if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
19214 add_AT_file (var_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
19215
19216 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
19217 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
19218
19219 if (old_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_member)
19220 add_linkage_name (var_die, decl);
19221 }
19222 }
19223 else
19224 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl);
19225
19226 if ((origin == NULL && !specialization_p)
19227 || (origin != NULL
19228 && !DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl_or_origin)
19229 && variably_modified_type_p (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin),
19230 decl_function_context
19231 (decl_or_origin))))
19232 {
19233 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin);
19234
19235 if (decl_by_reference_p (decl_or_origin))
19236 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (type), TYPE_UNQUALIFIED,
19237 context_die);
19238 else
19239 add_type_attribute (var_die, type, decl_quals (decl_or_origin),
19240 context_die);
19241 }
19242
19243 if (origin == NULL && !specialization_p)
19244 {
19245 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
19246 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
19247
19248 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
19249 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
19250
19251 add_accessibility_attribute (var_die, decl);
19252 }
19253
19254 if (declaration)
19255 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
19256
19257 if (decl && (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl) || declaration || old_die == NULL))
19258 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
19259
19260 if (! declaration
19261 && (! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl_or_origin)
19262 /* Local static vars are shared between all clones/inlines,
19263 so emit DW_AT_location on the abstract DIE if DECL_RTL is
19264 already set. */
19265 || (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == VAR_DECL
19266 && TREE_STATIC (decl_or_origin)
19267 && DECL_RTL_SET_P (decl_or_origin)))
19268 /* When abstract origin already has DW_AT_location attribute, no need
19269 to add it again. */
19270 && (origin_die == NULL || get_AT (origin_die, DW_AT_location) == NULL))
19271 {
19272 if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == VAR_DECL && TREE_STATIC (decl_or_origin)
19273 && !TREE_SYMBOL_REFERENCED (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl_or_origin)))
19274 defer_location (decl_or_origin, var_die);
19275 else
19276 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl_or_origin,
19277 decl == NULL, DW_AT_location);
19278 add_pubname (decl_or_origin, var_die);
19279 }
19280 else
19281 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (var_die, decl_or_origin);
19282 }
19283
19284 /* Generate a DIE to represent a named constant. */
19285
19286 static void
19287 gen_const_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
19288 {
19289 dw_die_ref const_die;
19290 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
19291
19292 const_die = new_die (DW_TAG_constant, context_die, decl);
19293 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (const_die, decl);
19294 add_type_attribute (const_die, type, TYPE_QUAL_CONST, context_die);
19295 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
19296 add_AT_flag (const_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
19297 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
19298 add_AT_flag (const_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
19299 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (const_die, decl);
19300 }
19301
19302 /* Generate a DIE to represent a label identifier. */
19303
19304 static void
19305 gen_label_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
19306 {
19307 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
19308 dw_die_ref lbl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_label, context_die, decl);
19309 rtx insn;
19310 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
19311
19312 if (origin != NULL)
19313 add_abstract_origin_attribute (lbl_die, origin);
19314 else
19315 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (lbl_die, decl);
19316
19317 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl))
19318 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, lbl_die);
19319 else
19320 {
19321 insn = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
19322
19323 /* Deleted labels are programmer specified labels which have been
19324 eliminated because of various optimizations. We still emit them
19325 here so that it is possible to put breakpoints on them. */
19326 if (insn
19327 && (LABEL_P (insn)
19328 || ((NOTE_P (insn)
19329 && NOTE_KIND (insn) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED_LABEL))))
19330 {
19331 /* When optimization is enabled (via -O) some parts of the compiler
19332 (e.g. jump.c and cse.c) may try to delete CODE_LABEL insns which
19333 represent source-level labels which were explicitly declared by
19334 the user. This really shouldn't be happening though, so catch
19335 it if it ever does happen. */
19336 gcc_assert (!as_a<rtx_insn *> (insn)->deleted ());
19337
19338 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "L", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn));
19339 add_AT_lbl_id (lbl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
19340 }
19341 else if (insn
19342 && NOTE_P (insn)
19343 && NOTE_KIND (insn) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED_DEBUG_LABEL
19344 && CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn) != -1)
19345 {
19346 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LDL", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn));
19347 add_AT_lbl_id (lbl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
19348 }
19349 }
19350 }
19351
19352 /* A helper function for gen_inlined_subroutine_die. Add source coordinate
19353 attributes to the DIE for a block STMT, to describe where the inlined
19354 function was called from. This is similar to add_src_coords_attributes. */
19355
19356 static inline void
19357 add_call_src_coords_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
19358 {
19359 expanded_location s = expand_location (BLOCK_SOURCE_LOCATION (stmt));
19360
19361 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
19362 {
19363 add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_call_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
19364 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_call_line, s.line);
19365 }
19366 }
19367
19368
19369 /* A helper function for gen_lexical_block_die and gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
19370 Add low_pc and high_pc attributes to the DIE for a block STMT. */
19371
19372 static inline void
19373 add_high_low_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
19374 {
19375 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
19376
19377 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt)
19378 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
19379 {
19380 tree chain, superblock = NULL_TREE;
19381 dw_die_ref pdie;
19382 dw_attr_ref attr = NULL;
19383
19384 if (inlined_function_outer_scope_p (stmt))
19385 {
19386 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
19387 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
19388 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_entry_pc, label);
19389 }
19390
19391 /* Optimize duplicate .debug_ranges lists or even tails of
19392 lists. If this BLOCK has same ranges as its supercontext,
19393 lookup DW_AT_ranges attribute in the supercontext (and
19394 recursively so), verify that the ranges_table contains the
19395 right values and use it instead of adding a new .debug_range. */
19396 for (chain = stmt, pdie = die;
19397 BLOCK_SAME_RANGE (chain);
19398 chain = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (chain))
19399 {
19400 dw_attr_ref new_attr;
19401
19402 pdie = pdie->die_parent;
19403 if (pdie == NULL)
19404 break;
19405 if (BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (chain) == NULL_TREE)
19406 break;
19407 new_attr = get_AT (pdie, DW_AT_ranges);
19408 if (new_attr == NULL
19409 || new_attr->dw_attr_val.val_class != dw_val_class_range_list)
19410 break;
19411 attr = new_attr;
19412 superblock = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (chain);
19413 }
19414 if (attr != NULL
19415 && (ranges_table[attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset
19416 / 2 / DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE].num
19417 == BLOCK_NUMBER (superblock))
19418 && BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (superblock))
19419 {
19420 unsigned long off = attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset
19421 / 2 / DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
19422 unsigned long supercnt = 0, thiscnt = 0;
19423 for (chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (superblock);
19424 chain; chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain))
19425 {
19426 ++supercnt;
19427 gcc_checking_assert (ranges_table[off + supercnt].num
19428 == BLOCK_NUMBER (chain));
19429 }
19430 gcc_checking_assert (ranges_table[off + supercnt + 1].num == 0);
19431 for (chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt);
19432 chain; chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain))
19433 ++thiscnt;
19434 gcc_assert (supercnt >= thiscnt);
19435 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges,
19436 ((off + supercnt - thiscnt)
19437 * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE),
19438 false);
19439 return;
19440 }
19441
19442 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, add_ranges (stmt), false);
19443
19444 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt);
19445 do
19446 {
19447 add_ranges (chain);
19448 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain);
19449 }
19450 while (chain);
19451 add_ranges (NULL);
19452 }
19453 else
19454 {
19455 char label_high[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
19456 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
19457 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
19458 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_high, BLOCK_END_LABEL,
19459 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
19460 add_AT_low_high_pc (die, label, label_high, false);
19461 }
19462 }
19463
19464 /* Generate a DIE for a lexical block. */
19465
19466 static void
19467 gen_lexical_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die)
19468 {
19469 dw_die_ref stmt_die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, context_die, stmt);
19470
19471 if (call_arg_locations)
19472 {
19473 if (block_map.length () <= BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt))
19474 block_map.safe_grow_cleared (BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt) + 1);
19475 block_map[BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt)] = stmt_die;
19476 }
19477
19478 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt) && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt))
19479 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, stmt_die);
19480
19481 decls_for_scope (stmt, stmt_die);
19482 }
19483
19484 /* Generate a DIE for an inlined subprogram. */
19485
19486 static void
19487 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die)
19488 {
19489 tree decl;
19490
19491 /* The instance of function that is effectively being inlined shall not
19492 be abstract. */
19493 gcc_assert (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt));
19494
19495 decl = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
19496
19497 /* Emit info for the abstract instance first, if we haven't yet. We
19498 must emit this even if the block is abstract, otherwise when we
19499 emit the block below (or elsewhere), we may end up trying to emit
19500 a die whose origin die hasn't been emitted, and crashing. */
19501 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
19502
19503 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
19504 {
19505 dw_die_ref subr_die
19506 = new_die (DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine, context_die, stmt);
19507
19508 if (call_arg_locations)
19509 {
19510 if (block_map.length () <= BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt))
19511 block_map.safe_grow_cleared (BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt) + 1);
19512 block_map[BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt)] = subr_die;
19513 }
19514 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, decl);
19515 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt))
19516 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
19517 add_call_src_coords_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
19518
19519 decls_for_scope (stmt, subr_die);
19520 }
19521 }
19522
19523 /* Generate a DIE for a field in a record, or structure. */
19524
19525 static void
19526 gen_field_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
19527 {
19528 dw_die_ref decl_die;
19529
19530 if (TREE_TYPE (decl) == error_mark_node)
19531 return;
19532
19533 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
19534 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
19535 add_type_attribute (decl_die, member_declared_type (decl),
19536 decl_quals (decl), context_die);
19537
19538 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl))
19539 {
19540 add_byte_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
19541 add_bit_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
19542 add_bit_offset_attribute (decl_die, decl);
19543 }
19544
19545 if (TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)) != UNION_TYPE)
19546 add_data_member_location_attribute (decl_die, decl);
19547
19548 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
19549 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
19550
19551 add_accessibility_attribute (decl_die, decl);
19552
19553 /* Equate decl number to die, so that we can look up this decl later on. */
19554 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
19555 }
19556
19557 #if 0
19558 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
19559 Use modified_type_die instead.
19560 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
19561 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
19562
19563 static void
19564 gen_pointer_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
19565 {
19566 dw_die_ref ptr_die
19567 = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
19568
19569 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
19570 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), TYPE_UNQUALIFIED,
19571 context_die);
19572 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
19573 }
19574
19575 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
19576 Use modified_type_die instead.
19577 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
19578 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
19579
19580 static void
19581 gen_reference_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
19582 {
19583 dw_die_ref ref_die, scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
19584
19585 if (TYPE_REF_IS_RVALUE (type) && dwarf_version >= 4)
19586 ref_die = new_die (DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type, scope_die, type);
19587 else
19588 ref_die = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, scope_die, type);
19589
19590 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ref_die);
19591 add_type_attribute (ref_die, TREE_TYPE (type), TYPE_UNQUALIFIED,
19592 context_die);
19593 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
19594 }
19595 #endif
19596
19597 /* Generate a DIE for a pointer to a member type. */
19598
19599 static void
19600 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
19601 {
19602 dw_die_ref ptr_die
19603 = new_die (DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type,
19604 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
19605
19606 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
19607 add_AT_die_ref (ptr_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
19608 lookup_type_die (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type)));
19609 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), TYPE_UNQUALIFIED,
19610 context_die);
19611 }
19612
19613 typedef const char *dchar_p; /* For DEF_VEC_P. */
19614
19615 static char *producer_string;
19616
19617 /* Return a heap allocated producer string including command line options
19618 if -grecord-gcc-switches. */
19619
19620 static char *
19621 gen_producer_string (void)
19622 {
19623 size_t j;
19624 auto_vec<dchar_p> switches;
19625 const char *language_string = lang_hooks.name;
19626 char *producer, *tail;
19627 const char *p;
19628 size_t len = dwarf_record_gcc_switches ? 0 : 3;
19629 size_t plen = strlen (language_string) + 1 + strlen (version_string);
19630
19631 for (j = 1; dwarf_record_gcc_switches && j < save_decoded_options_count; j++)
19632 switch (save_decoded_options[j].opt_index)
19633 {
19634 case OPT_o:
19635 case OPT_d:
19636 case OPT_dumpbase:
19637 case OPT_dumpdir:
19638 case OPT_auxbase:
19639 case OPT_auxbase_strip:
19640 case OPT_quiet:
19641 case OPT_version:
19642 case OPT_v:
19643 case OPT_w:
19644 case OPT_L:
19645 case OPT_D:
19646 case OPT_I:
19647 case OPT_U:
19648 case OPT_SPECIAL_unknown:
19649 case OPT_SPECIAL_ignore:
19650 case OPT_SPECIAL_program_name:
19651 case OPT_SPECIAL_input_file:
19652 case OPT_grecord_gcc_switches:
19653 case OPT_gno_record_gcc_switches:
19654 case OPT__output_pch_:
19655 case OPT_fdiagnostics_show_location_:
19656 case OPT_fdiagnostics_show_option:
19657 case OPT_fdiagnostics_show_caret:
19658 case OPT_fdiagnostics_color_:
19659 case OPT_fverbose_asm:
19660 case OPT____:
19661 case OPT__sysroot_:
19662 case OPT_nostdinc:
19663 case OPT_nostdinc__:
19664 case OPT_fpreprocessed:
19665 case OPT_fltrans_output_list_:
19666 case OPT_fresolution_:
19667 /* Ignore these. */
19668 continue;
19669 default:
19670 if (cl_options[save_decoded_options[j].opt_index].flags
19671 & CL_NO_DWARF_RECORD)
19672 continue;
19673 gcc_checking_assert (save_decoded_options[j].canonical_option[0][0]
19674 == '-');
19675 switch (save_decoded_options[j].canonical_option[0][1])
19676 {
19677 case 'M':
19678 case 'i':
19679 case 'W':
19680 continue;
19681 case 'f':
19682 if (strncmp (save_decoded_options[j].canonical_option[0] + 2,
19683 "dump", 4) == 0)
19684 continue;
19685 break;
19686 default:
19687 break;
19688 }
19689 switches.safe_push (save_decoded_options[j].orig_option_with_args_text);
19690 len += strlen (save_decoded_options[j].orig_option_with_args_text) + 1;
19691 break;
19692 }
19693
19694 producer = XNEWVEC (char, plen + 1 + len + 1);
19695 tail = producer;
19696 sprintf (tail, "%s %s", language_string, version_string);
19697 tail += plen;
19698
19699 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (switches, j, p)
19700 {
19701 len = strlen (p);
19702 *tail = ' ';
19703 memcpy (tail + 1, p, len);
19704 tail += len + 1;
19705 }
19706
19707 *tail = '\0';
19708 return producer;
19709 }
19710
19711 /* Given a C and/or C++ language/version string return the "highest".
19712 C++ is assumed to be "higher" than C in this case. Used for merging
19713 LTO translation unit languages. */
19714 static const char *
19715 highest_c_language (const char *lang1, const char *lang2)
19716 {
19717 if (strcmp ("GNU C++14", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C++14", lang2) == 0)
19718 return "GNU C++14";
19719 if (strcmp ("GNU C++11", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C++11", lang2) == 0)
19720 return "GNU C++11";
19721 if (strcmp ("GNU C++98", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C++98", lang2) == 0)
19722 return "GNU C++98";
19723
19724 if (strcmp ("GNU C11", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C11", lang2) == 0)
19725 return "GNU C11";
19726 if (strcmp ("GNU C99", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C99", lang2) == 0)
19727 return "GNU C99";
19728 if (strcmp ("GNU C89", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C89", lang2) == 0)
19729 return "GNU C89";
19730
19731 gcc_unreachable ();
19732 }
19733
19734
19735 /* Generate the DIE for the compilation unit. */
19736
19737 static dw_die_ref
19738 gen_compile_unit_die (const char *filename)
19739 {
19740 dw_die_ref die;
19741 const char *language_string = lang_hooks.name;
19742 int language;
19743
19744 die = new_die (DW_TAG_compile_unit, NULL, NULL);
19745
19746 if (filename)
19747 {
19748 add_name_attribute (die, filename);
19749 /* Don't add cwd for <built-in>. */
19750 if (!IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (filename) && filename[0] != '<')
19751 add_comp_dir_attribute (die);
19752 }
19753
19754 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_producer, producer_string ? producer_string : "");
19755
19756 /* If our producer is LTO try to figure out a common language to use
19757 from the global list of translation units. */
19758 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU GIMPLE") == 0)
19759 {
19760 unsigned i;
19761 tree t;
19762 const char *common_lang = NULL;
19763
19764 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (all_translation_units, i, t)
19765 {
19766 if (!TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t))
19767 continue;
19768 if (!common_lang)
19769 common_lang = TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t);
19770 else if (strcmp (common_lang, TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t)) == 0)
19771 ;
19772 else if (strncmp (common_lang, "GNU C", 5) == 0
19773 && strncmp (TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t), "GNU C", 5) == 0)
19774 /* Mixing C and C++ is ok, use C++ in that case. */
19775 common_lang = highest_c_language (common_lang,
19776 TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t));
19777 else
19778 {
19779 /* Fall back to C. */
19780 common_lang = NULL;
19781 break;
19782 }
19783 }
19784
19785 if (common_lang)
19786 language_string = common_lang;
19787 }
19788
19789 language = DW_LANG_C;
19790 if (strncmp (language_string, "GNU C", 5) == 0
19791 && ISDIGIT (language_string[5]))
19792 {
19793 language = DW_LANG_C89;
19794 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
19795 {
19796 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C89") != 0)
19797 language = DW_LANG_C99;
19798
19799 if (dwarf_version >= 5 /* || !dwarf_strict */)
19800 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C11") == 0)
19801 language = DW_LANG_C11;
19802 }
19803 }
19804 else if (strncmp (language_string, "GNU C++", 7) == 0)
19805 {
19806 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus;
19807 if (dwarf_version >= 5 /* || !dwarf_strict */)
19808 {
19809 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++11") == 0)
19810 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_11;
19811 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++14") == 0)
19812 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_14;
19813 }
19814 }
19815 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU F77") == 0)
19816 language = DW_LANG_Fortran77;
19817 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Pascal") == 0)
19818 language = DW_LANG_Pascal83;
19819 else if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
19820 {
19821 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Ada") == 0)
19822 language = DW_LANG_Ada95;
19823 else if (strncmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran", 11) == 0)
19824 {
19825 language = DW_LANG_Fortran95;
19826 if (dwarf_version >= 5 /* || !dwarf_strict */)
19827 {
19828 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran2003") == 0)
19829 language = DW_LANG_Fortran03;
19830 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran2008") == 0)
19831 language = DW_LANG_Fortran08;
19832 }
19833 }
19834 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Java") == 0)
19835 language = DW_LANG_Java;
19836 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C") == 0)
19837 language = DW_LANG_ObjC;
19838 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C++") == 0)
19839 language = DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus;
19840 else if (dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
19841 {
19842 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Go") == 0)
19843 language = DW_LANG_Go;
19844 }
19845 }
19846 /* Use a degraded Fortran setting in strict DWARF2 so is_fortran works. */
19847 else if (strncmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran", 11) == 0)
19848 language = DW_LANG_Fortran90;
19849
19850 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_language, language);
19851
19852 switch (language)
19853 {
19854 case DW_LANG_Fortran77:
19855 case DW_LANG_Fortran90:
19856 case DW_LANG_Fortran95:
19857 case DW_LANG_Fortran03:
19858 case DW_LANG_Fortran08:
19859 /* Fortran has case insensitive identifiers and the front-end
19860 lowercases everything. */
19861 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_identifier_case, DW_ID_down_case);
19862 break;
19863 default:
19864 /* The default DW_ID_case_sensitive doesn't need to be specified. */
19865 break;
19866 }
19867 return die;
19868 }
19869
19870 /* Generate the DIE for a base class. */
19871
19872 static void
19873 gen_inheritance_die (tree binfo, tree access, dw_die_ref context_die)
19874 {
19875 dw_die_ref die = new_die (DW_TAG_inheritance, context_die, binfo);
19876
19877 add_type_attribute (die, BINFO_TYPE (binfo), TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, context_die);
19878 add_data_member_location_attribute (die, binfo);
19879
19880 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (binfo))
19881 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
19882
19883 /* In DWARF3+ the default is DW_ACCESS_private only in DW_TAG_class_type
19884 children, otherwise the default is DW_ACCESS_public. In DWARF2
19885 the default has always been DW_ACCESS_private. */
19886 if (access == access_public_node)
19887 {
19888 if (dwarf_version == 2
19889 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type)
19890 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
19891 }
19892 else if (access == access_protected_node)
19893 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
19894 else if (dwarf_version > 2
19895 && context_die->die_tag != DW_TAG_class_type)
19896 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
19897 }
19898
19899 /* Generate a DIE for a class member. */
19900
19901 static void
19902 gen_member_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
19903 {
19904 tree member;
19905 tree binfo = TYPE_BINFO (type);
19906 dw_die_ref child;
19907
19908 /* If this is not an incomplete type, output descriptions of each of its
19909 members. Note that as we output the DIEs necessary to represent the
19910 members of this record or union type, we will also be trying to output
19911 DIEs to represent the *types* of those members. However the `type'
19912 function (above) will specifically avoid generating type DIEs for member
19913 types *within* the list of member DIEs for this (containing) type except
19914 for those types (of members) which are explicitly marked as also being
19915 members of this (containing) type themselves. The g++ front- end can
19916 force any given type to be treated as a member of some other (containing)
19917 type by setting the TYPE_CONTEXT of the given (member) type to point to
19918 the TREE node representing the appropriate (containing) type. */
19919
19920 /* First output info about the base classes. */
19921 if (binfo)
19922 {
19923 vec<tree, va_gc> *accesses = BINFO_BASE_ACCESSES (binfo);
19924 int i;
19925 tree base;
19926
19927 for (i = 0; BINFO_BASE_ITERATE (binfo, i, base); i++)
19928 gen_inheritance_die (base,
19929 (accesses ? (*accesses)[i] : access_public_node),
19930 context_die);
19931 }
19932
19933 /* Now output info about the data members and type members. */
19934 for (member = TYPE_FIELDS (type); member; member = DECL_CHAIN (member))
19935 {
19936 /* If we thought we were generating minimal debug info for TYPE
19937 and then changed our minds, some of the member declarations
19938 may have already been defined. Don't define them again, but
19939 do put them in the right order. */
19940
19941 child = lookup_decl_die (member);
19942 if (child)
19943 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
19944 else
19945 gen_decl_die (member, NULL, context_die);
19946 }
19947
19948 /* Now output info about the function members (if any). */
19949 for (member = TYPE_METHODS (type); member; member = DECL_CHAIN (member))
19950 {
19951 /* Don't include clones in the member list. */
19952 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (member))
19953 continue;
19954 /* Nor constructors for anonymous classes. */
19955 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (member)
19956 && dwarf2_name (member, 0) == NULL)
19957 continue;
19958
19959 child = lookup_decl_die (member);
19960 if (child)
19961 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
19962 else
19963 gen_decl_die (member, NULL, context_die);
19964 }
19965 }
19966
19967 /* Generate a DIE for a structure or union type. If TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG
19968 is set, we pretend that the type was never defined, so we only get the
19969 member DIEs needed by later specification DIEs. */
19970
19971 static void
19972 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die,
19973 enum debug_info_usage usage)
19974 {
19975 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
19976 dw_die_ref scope_die = 0;
19977 int nested = 0;
19978 int complete = (TYPE_SIZE (type)
19979 && (! TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
19980 || ! TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))));
19981 int ns_decl = (context_die && context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace);
19982 complete = complete && should_emit_struct_debug (type, usage);
19983
19984 if (type_die && ! complete)
19985 return;
19986
19987 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
19988 && (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
19989 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)) == NAMESPACE_DECL))
19990 nested = 1;
19991
19992 scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
19993
19994 /* Generate child dies for template paramaters. */
19995 if (!type_die && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
19996 schedule_generic_params_dies_gen (type);
19997
19998 if (! type_die || (nested && is_cu_die (scope_die)))
19999 /* First occurrence of type or toplevel definition of nested class. */
20000 {
20001 dw_die_ref old_die = type_die;
20002
20003 type_die = new_die (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
20004 ? record_type_tag (type) : DW_TAG_union_type,
20005 scope_die, type);
20006 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
20007 if (old_die)
20008 add_AT_specification (type_die, old_die);
20009 else
20010 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
20011 }
20012 else
20013 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
20014
20015 /* If this type has been completed, then give it a byte_size attribute and
20016 then give a list of members. */
20017 if (complete && !ns_decl)
20018 {
20019 /* Prevent infinite recursion in cases where the type of some member of
20020 this type is expressed in terms of this type itself. */
20021 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
20022 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
20023 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
20024 {
20025 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
20026 add_accessibility_attribute (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
20027 }
20028
20029 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
20030 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
20031 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
20032 add_child_die (scope_die, type_die);
20033
20034 push_decl_scope (type);
20035 gen_member_die (type, type_die);
20036 pop_decl_scope ();
20037
20038 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (type_die, type, context_die);
20039 if (TYPE_ARTIFICIAL (type))
20040 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
20041
20042 /* GNU extension: Record what type our vtable lives in. */
20043 if (TYPE_VFIELD (type))
20044 {
20045 tree vtype = DECL_FCONTEXT (TYPE_VFIELD (type));
20046
20047 gen_type_die (vtype, context_die);
20048 add_AT_die_ref (type_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
20049 lookup_type_die (vtype));
20050 }
20051 }
20052 else
20053 {
20054 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
20055
20056 /* We don't need to do this for function-local types. */
20057 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
20058 && ! decl_function_context (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)))
20059 vec_safe_push (incomplete_types, type);
20060 }
20061
20062 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
20063 add_pubtype (type, type_die);
20064 }
20065
20066 /* Generate a DIE for a subroutine _type_. */
20067
20068 static void
20069 gen_subroutine_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
20070 {
20071 tree return_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
20072 dw_die_ref subr_die
20073 = new_die (DW_TAG_subroutine_type,
20074 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
20075
20076 equate_type_number_to_die (type, subr_die);
20077 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, type);
20078 add_type_attribute (subr_die, return_type, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, context_die);
20079 gen_formal_types_die (type, subr_die);
20080
20081 if (get_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_name))
20082 add_pubtype (type, subr_die);
20083 }
20084
20085 /* Generate a DIE for a type definition. */
20086
20087 static void
20088 gen_typedef_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
20089 {
20090 dw_die_ref type_die;
20091 tree origin;
20092
20093 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
20094 return;
20095
20096 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl) = 1;
20097 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_typedef, context_die, decl);
20098 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
20099 if (origin != NULL)
20100 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, origin);
20101 else
20102 {
20103 tree type;
20104
20105 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (type_die, decl);
20106 if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl))
20107 {
20108 type = DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl);
20109
20110 gcc_assert (type != TREE_TYPE (decl));
20111 equate_type_number_to_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), type_die);
20112 }
20113 else
20114 {
20115 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
20116
20117 if (is_naming_typedef_decl (TYPE_NAME (type)))
20118 {
20119 /* Here, we are in the case of decl being a typedef naming
20120 an anonymous type, e.g:
20121 typedef struct {...} foo;
20122 In that case TREE_TYPE (decl) is not a typedef variant
20123 type and TYPE_NAME of the anonymous type is set to the
20124 TYPE_DECL of the typedef. This construct is emitted by
20125 the C++ FE.
20126
20127 TYPE is the anonymous struct named by the typedef
20128 DECL. As we need the DW_AT_type attribute of the
20129 DW_TAG_typedef to point to the DIE of TYPE, let's
20130 generate that DIE right away. add_type_attribute
20131 called below will then pick (via lookup_type_die) that
20132 anonymous struct DIE. */
20133 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
20134 gen_tagged_type_die (type, context_die, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
20135
20136 /* This is a GNU Extension. We are adding a
20137 DW_AT_linkage_name attribute to the DIE of the
20138 anonymous struct TYPE. The value of that attribute
20139 is the name of the typedef decl naming the anonymous
20140 struct. This greatly eases the work of consumers of
20141 this debug info. */
20142 add_linkage_attr (lookup_type_die (type), decl);
20143 }
20144 }
20145
20146 add_type_attribute (type_die, type, decl_quals (decl), context_die);
20147
20148 if (is_naming_typedef_decl (decl))
20149 /* We want that all subsequent calls to lookup_type_die with
20150 TYPE in argument yield the DW_TAG_typedef we have just
20151 created. */
20152 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
20153
20154 add_accessibility_attribute (type_die, decl);
20155 }
20156
20157 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl))
20158 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, type_die);
20159
20160 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
20161 add_pubtype (decl, type_die);
20162 }
20163
20164 /* Generate a DIE for a struct, class, enum or union type. */
20165
20166 static void
20167 gen_tagged_type_die (tree type,
20168 dw_die_ref context_die,
20169 enum debug_info_usage usage)
20170 {
20171 int need_pop;
20172
20173 if (type == NULL_TREE
20174 || !is_tagged_type (type))
20175 return;
20176
20177 /* If this is a nested type whose containing class hasn't been written
20178 out yet, writing it out will cover this one, too. This does not apply
20179 to instantiations of member class templates; they need to be added to
20180 the containing class as they are generated. FIXME: This hurts the
20181 idea of combining type decls from multiple TUs, since we can't predict
20182 what set of template instantiations we'll get. */
20183 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
20184 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
20185 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
20186 {
20187 gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_CONTEXT (type), context_die, usage);
20188
20189 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
20190 return;
20191
20192 /* If that failed, attach ourselves to the stub. */
20193 push_decl_scope (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
20194 context_die = lookup_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
20195 need_pop = 1;
20196 }
20197 else if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
20198 && (TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)) == FUNCTION_DECL))
20199 {
20200 /* If this type is local to a function that hasn't been written
20201 out yet, use a NULL context for now; it will be fixed up in
20202 decls_for_scope. */
20203 context_die = lookup_decl_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
20204 /* A declaration DIE doesn't count; nested types need to go in the
20205 specification. */
20206 if (context_die && is_declaration_die (context_die))
20207 context_die = NULL;
20208 need_pop = 0;
20209 }
20210 else
20211 {
20212 context_die = declare_in_namespace (type, context_die);
20213 need_pop = 0;
20214 }
20215
20216 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE)
20217 {
20218 /* This might have been written out by the call to
20219 declare_in_namespace. */
20220 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
20221 gen_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
20222 }
20223 else
20224 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (type, context_die, usage);
20225
20226 if (need_pop)
20227 pop_decl_scope ();
20228
20229 /* Don't set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN on an incomplete struct; we want to fix
20230 it up if it is ever completed. gen_*_type_die will set it for us
20231 when appropriate. */
20232 }
20233
20234 /* Generate a type description DIE. */
20235
20236 static void
20237 gen_type_die_with_usage (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die,
20238 enum debug_info_usage usage)
20239 {
20240 struct array_descr_info info;
20241
20242 if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
20243 return;
20244
20245 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
20246 if (type)
20247 verify_type (type);
20248 #endif
20249
20250 if (TYPE_NAME (type) != NULL_TREE
20251 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
20252 && is_redundant_typedef (TYPE_NAME (type))
20253 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)))
20254 /* The DECL of this type is a typedef we don't want to emit debug
20255 info for but we want debug info for its underlying typedef.
20256 This can happen for e.g, the injected-class-name of a C++
20257 type. */
20258 type = DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type));
20259
20260 /* If TYPE is a typedef type variant, let's generate debug info
20261 for the parent typedef which TYPE is a type of. */
20262 if (typedef_variant_p (type))
20263 {
20264 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
20265 return;
20266
20267 /* Prevent broken recursion; we can't hand off to the same type. */
20268 gcc_assert (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)) != type);
20269
20270 /* Give typedefs the right scope. */
20271 context_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
20272
20273 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
20274
20275 gen_decl_die (TYPE_NAME (type), NULL, context_die);
20276 return;
20277 }
20278
20279 /* If type is an anonymous tagged type named by a typedef, let's
20280 generate debug info for the typedef. */
20281 if (is_naming_typedef_decl (TYPE_NAME (type)))
20282 {
20283 /* Use the DIE of the containing namespace as the parent DIE of
20284 the type description DIE we want to generate. */
20285 if (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type))
20286 && TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type))) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
20287 context_die = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type)));
20288
20289 gen_decl_die (TYPE_NAME (type), NULL, context_die);
20290 return;
20291 }
20292
20293 /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version
20294 of this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so
20295 get the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this type
20296 now. (Vectors are special because the debugging info is in the
20297 cloned type itself). */
20298 if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
20299 type = type_main_variant (type);
20300
20301 /* If this is an array type with hidden descriptor, handle it first. */
20302 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type)
20303 && lang_hooks.types.get_array_descr_info)
20304 {
20305 memset (&info, 0, sizeof (info));
20306 if (lang_hooks.types.get_array_descr_info (type, &info))
20307 {
20308 gen_descr_array_type_die (type, &info, context_die);
20309 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
20310 return;
20311 }
20312 }
20313
20314 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
20315 return;
20316
20317 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
20318 {
20319 case ERROR_MARK:
20320 break;
20321
20322 case POINTER_TYPE:
20323 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
20324 /* We must set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN in case this is a recursive type. This
20325 ensures that the gen_type_die recursion will terminate even if the
20326 type is recursive. Recursive types are possible in Ada. */
20327 /* ??? We could perhaps do this for all types before the switch
20328 statement. */
20329 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
20330
20331 /* For these types, all that is required is that we output a DIE (or a
20332 set of DIEs) to represent the "basis" type. */
20333 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
20334 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
20335 break;
20336
20337 case OFFSET_TYPE:
20338 /* This code is used for C++ pointer-to-data-member types.
20339 Output a description of the relevant class type. */
20340 gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type), context_die,
20341 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
20342
20343 /* Output a description of the type of the object pointed to. */
20344 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
20345 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
20346
20347 /* Now output a DIE to represent this pointer-to-data-member type
20348 itself. */
20349 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (type, context_die);
20350 break;
20351
20352 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
20353 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
20354 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
20355 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
20356 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
20357 break;
20358
20359 case METHOD_TYPE:
20360 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
20361 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
20362 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
20363 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
20364 break;
20365
20366 case ARRAY_TYPE:
20367 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
20368 break;
20369
20370 case VECTOR_TYPE:
20371 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
20372 break;
20373
20374 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
20375 case RECORD_TYPE:
20376 case UNION_TYPE:
20377 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
20378 gen_tagged_type_die (type, context_die, usage);
20379 return;
20380
20381 case VOID_TYPE:
20382 case INTEGER_TYPE:
20383 case REAL_TYPE:
20384 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
20385 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
20386 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
20387 case POINTER_BOUNDS_TYPE:
20388 /* No DIEs needed for fundamental types. */
20389 break;
20390
20391 case NULLPTR_TYPE:
20392 case LANG_TYPE:
20393 /* Just use DW_TAG_unspecified_type. */
20394 {
20395 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
20396 if (type_die == NULL)
20397 {
20398 tree name = TYPE_IDENTIFIER (type);
20399 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_type, comp_unit_die (),
20400 type);
20401 add_name_attribute (type_die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
20402 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
20403 }
20404 }
20405 break;
20406
20407 default:
20408 if (is_cxx_auto (type))
20409 {
20410 tree name = TYPE_IDENTIFIER (type);
20411 dw_die_ref *die = (name == get_identifier ("auto")
20412 ? &auto_die : &decltype_auto_die);
20413 if (!*die)
20414 {
20415 *die = new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_type,
20416 comp_unit_die (), NULL_TREE);
20417 add_name_attribute (*die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
20418 }
20419 equate_type_number_to_die (type, *die);
20420 break;
20421 }
20422 gcc_unreachable ();
20423 }
20424
20425 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
20426 }
20427
20428 static void
20429 gen_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
20430 {
20431 gen_type_die_with_usage (type, context_die, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
20432 }
20433
20434 /* Generate a DW_TAG_lexical_block DIE followed by DIEs to represent all of the
20435 things which are local to the given block. */
20436
20437 static void
20438 gen_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die)
20439 {
20440 int must_output_die = 0;
20441 bool inlined_func;
20442
20443 /* Ignore blocks that are NULL. */
20444 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
20445 return;
20446
20447 inlined_func = inlined_function_outer_scope_p (stmt);
20448
20449 /* If the block is one fragment of a non-contiguous block, do not
20450 process the variables, since they will have been done by the
20451 origin block. Do process subblocks. */
20452 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (stmt))
20453 {
20454 tree sub;
20455
20456 for (sub = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt); sub; sub = BLOCK_CHAIN (sub))
20457 gen_block_die (sub, context_die);
20458
20459 return;
20460 }
20461
20462 /* Determine if we need to output any Dwarf DIEs at all to represent this
20463 block. */
20464 if (inlined_func)
20465 /* The outer scopes for inlinings *must* always be represented. We
20466 generate DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIEs for them. (See below.) */
20467 must_output_die = 1;
20468 else
20469 {
20470 /* Determine if this block directly contains any "significant"
20471 local declarations which we will need to output DIEs for. */
20472 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20473 /* We are not in terse mode so *any* local declaration counts
20474 as being a "significant" one. */
20475 must_output_die = ((BLOCK_VARS (stmt) != NULL
20476 || BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (stmt))
20477 && (TREE_USED (stmt)
20478 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt)
20479 || BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt)));
20480 else if ((TREE_USED (stmt)
20481 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt)
20482 || BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
20483 && !dwarf2out_ignore_block (stmt))
20484 must_output_die = 1;
20485 }
20486
20487 /* It would be a waste of space to generate a Dwarf DW_TAG_lexical_block
20488 DIE for any block which contains no significant local declarations at
20489 all. Rather, in such cases we just call `decls_for_scope' so that any
20490 needed Dwarf info for any sub-blocks will get properly generated. Note
20491 that in terse mode, our definition of what constitutes a "significant"
20492 local declaration gets restricted to include only inlined function
20493 instances and local (nested) function definitions. */
20494 if (must_output_die)
20495 {
20496 if (inlined_func)
20497 {
20498 /* If STMT block is abstract, that means we have been called
20499 indirectly from dwarf2out_abstract_function.
20500 That function rightfully marks the descendent blocks (of
20501 the abstract function it is dealing with) as being abstract,
20502 precisely to prevent us from emitting any
20503 DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIE as a descendent
20504 of an abstract function instance. So in that case, we should
20505 not call gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
20506
20507 Later though, when cgraph asks dwarf2out to emit info
20508 for the concrete instance of the function decl into which
20509 the concrete instance of STMT got inlined, the later will lead
20510 to the generation of a DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIE. */
20511 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
20512 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (stmt, context_die);
20513 }
20514 else
20515 gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die);
20516 }
20517 else
20518 decls_for_scope (stmt, context_die);
20519 }
20520
20521 /* Process variable DECL (or variable with origin ORIGIN) within
20522 block STMT and add it to CONTEXT_DIE. */
20523 static void
20524 process_scope_var (tree stmt, tree decl, tree origin, dw_die_ref context_die)
20525 {
20526 dw_die_ref die;
20527 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
20528
20529 if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == FUNCTION_DECL)
20530 die = lookup_decl_die (decl_or_origin);
20531 else if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == TYPE_DECL
20532 && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl_or_origin))
20533 die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin));
20534 else
20535 die = NULL;
20536
20537 if (die != NULL && die->die_parent == NULL)
20538 add_child_die (context_die, die);
20539 else if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == IMPORTED_DECL)
20540 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (decl_or_origin, DECL_NAME (decl_or_origin),
20541 stmt, context_die);
20542 else
20543 gen_decl_die (decl, origin, context_die);
20544 }
20545
20546 /* Generate all of the decls declared within a given scope and (recursively)
20547 all of its sub-blocks. */
20548
20549 static void
20550 decls_for_scope (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die)
20551 {
20552 tree decl;
20553 unsigned int i;
20554 tree subblocks;
20555
20556 /* Ignore NULL blocks. */
20557 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
20558 return;
20559
20560 /* Output the DIEs to represent all of the data objects and typedefs
20561 declared directly within this block but not within any nested
20562 sub-blocks. Also, nested function and tag DIEs have been
20563 generated with a parent of NULL; fix that up now. We don't
20564 have to do this if we're at -g1. */
20565 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20566 {
20567 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt); decl != NULL; decl = DECL_CHAIN (decl))
20568 process_scope_var (stmt, decl, NULL_TREE, context_die);
20569 for (i = 0; i < BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (stmt); i++)
20570 process_scope_var (stmt, NULL, BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VAR (stmt, i),
20571 context_die);
20572 }
20573
20574 /* Even if we're at -g1, we need to process the subblocks in order to get
20575 inlined call information. */
20576
20577 /* Output the DIEs to represent all sub-blocks (and the items declared
20578 therein) of this block. */
20579 for (subblocks = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
20580 subblocks != NULL;
20581 subblocks = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblocks))
20582 gen_block_die (subblocks, context_die);
20583 }
20584
20585 /* Is this a typedef we can avoid emitting? */
20586
20587 static inline int
20588 is_redundant_typedef (const_tree decl)
20589 {
20590 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
20591 return 1;
20592
20593 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
20594 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
20595 && is_tagged_type (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
20596 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))) == TYPE_DECL
20597 && DECL_NAME (decl) == DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))))
20598 /* Also ignore the artificial member typedef for the class name. */
20599 return 1;
20600
20601 return 0;
20602 }
20603
20604 /* Return TRUE if TYPE is a typedef that names a type for linkage
20605 purposes. This kind of typedefs is produced by the C++ FE for
20606 constructs like:
20607
20608 typedef struct {...} foo;
20609
20610 In that case, there is no typedef variant type produced for foo.
20611 Rather, the TREE_TYPE of the TYPE_DECL of foo is the anonymous
20612 struct type. */
20613
20614 static bool
20615 is_naming_typedef_decl (const_tree decl)
20616 {
20617 if (decl == NULL_TREE
20618 || TREE_CODE (decl) != TYPE_DECL
20619 || !is_tagged_type (TREE_TYPE (decl))
20620 || DECL_IS_BUILTIN (decl)
20621 || is_redundant_typedef (decl)
20622 /* It looks like Ada produces TYPE_DECLs that are very similar
20623 to C++ naming typedefs but that have different
20624 semantics. Let's be specific to c++ for now. */
20625 || !is_cxx ())
20626 return FALSE;
20627
20628 return (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl) == NULL_TREE
20629 && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == decl
20630 && (TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl))
20631 != TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
20632 }
20633
20634 /* Returns the DIE for a context. */
20635
20636 static inline dw_die_ref
20637 get_context_die (tree context)
20638 {
20639 if (context)
20640 {
20641 /* Find die that represents this context. */
20642 if (TYPE_P (context))
20643 {
20644 context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (context);
20645 return strip_naming_typedef (context, force_type_die (context));
20646 }
20647 else
20648 return force_decl_die (context);
20649 }
20650 return comp_unit_die ();
20651 }
20652
20653 /* Returns the DIE for decl. A DIE will always be returned. */
20654
20655 static dw_die_ref
20656 force_decl_die (tree decl)
20657 {
20658 dw_die_ref decl_die;
20659 unsigned saved_external_flag;
20660 tree save_fn = NULL_TREE;
20661 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
20662 if (!decl_die)
20663 {
20664 dw_die_ref context_die = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
20665
20666 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
20667 if (decl_die)
20668 return decl_die;
20669
20670 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
20671 {
20672 case FUNCTION_DECL:
20673 /* Clear current_function_decl, so that gen_subprogram_die thinks
20674 that this is a declaration. At this point, we just want to force
20675 declaration die. */
20676 save_fn = current_function_decl;
20677 current_function_decl = NULL_TREE;
20678 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
20679 current_function_decl = save_fn;
20680 break;
20681
20682 case VAR_DECL:
20683 /* Set external flag to force declaration die. Restore it after
20684 gen_decl_die() call. */
20685 saved_external_flag = DECL_EXTERNAL (decl);
20686 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = 1;
20687 gen_decl_die (decl, NULL, context_die);
20688 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = saved_external_flag;
20689 break;
20690
20691 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
20692 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
20693 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
20694 else
20695 /* DWARF2 has neither DW_TAG_module, nor DW_TAG_namespace. */
20696 decl_die = comp_unit_die ();
20697 break;
20698
20699 case TRANSLATION_UNIT_DECL:
20700 decl_die = comp_unit_die ();
20701 break;
20702
20703 default:
20704 gcc_unreachable ();
20705 }
20706
20707 /* We should be able to find the DIE now. */
20708 if (!decl_die)
20709 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
20710 gcc_assert (decl_die);
20711 }
20712
20713 return decl_die;
20714 }
20715
20716 /* Returns the DIE for TYPE, that must not be a base type. A DIE is
20717 always returned. */
20718
20719 static dw_die_ref
20720 force_type_die (tree type)
20721 {
20722 dw_die_ref type_die;
20723
20724 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
20725 if (!type_die)
20726 {
20727 dw_die_ref context_die = get_context_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
20728
20729 type_die = modified_type_die (type, TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (type),
20730 context_die);
20731 gcc_assert (type_die);
20732 }
20733 return type_die;
20734 }
20735
20736 /* Force out any required namespaces to be able to output DECL,
20737 and return the new context_die for it, if it's changed. */
20738
20739 static dw_die_ref
20740 setup_namespace_context (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
20741 {
20742 tree context = (DECL_P (thing)
20743 ? DECL_CONTEXT (thing) : TYPE_CONTEXT (thing));
20744 if (context && TREE_CODE (context) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
20745 /* Force out the namespace. */
20746 context_die = force_decl_die (context);
20747
20748 return context_die;
20749 }
20750
20751 /* Emit a declaration DIE for THING (which is either a DECL or a tagged
20752 type) within its namespace, if appropriate.
20753
20754 For compatibility with older debuggers, namespace DIEs only contain
20755 declarations; all definitions are emitted at CU scope. */
20756
20757 static dw_die_ref
20758 declare_in_namespace (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
20759 {
20760 dw_die_ref ns_context;
20761
20762 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20763 return context_die;
20764
20765 /* External declarations in the local scope only need to be emitted
20766 once, not once in the namespace and once in the scope.
20767
20768 This avoids declaring the `extern' below in the
20769 namespace DIE as well as in the innermost scope:
20770
20771 namespace S
20772 {
20773 int i=5;
20774 int foo()
20775 {
20776 int i=8;
20777 extern int i;
20778 return i;
20779 }
20780 }
20781 */
20782 if (DECL_P (thing) && DECL_EXTERNAL (thing) && local_scope_p (context_die))
20783 return context_die;
20784
20785 /* If this decl is from an inlined function, then don't try to emit it in its
20786 namespace, as we will get confused. It would have already been emitted
20787 when the abstract instance of the inline function was emitted anyways. */
20788 if (DECL_P (thing) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (thing))
20789 return context_die;
20790
20791 ns_context = setup_namespace_context (thing, context_die);
20792
20793 if (ns_context != context_die)
20794 {
20795 if (is_fortran ())
20796 return ns_context;
20797 if (DECL_P (thing))
20798 gen_decl_die (thing, NULL, ns_context);
20799 else
20800 gen_type_die (thing, ns_context);
20801 }
20802 return context_die;
20803 }
20804
20805 /* Generate a DIE for a namespace or namespace alias. */
20806
20807 static void
20808 gen_namespace_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
20809 {
20810 dw_die_ref namespace_die;
20811
20812 /* Namespace aliases have a DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN of the namespace
20813 they are an alias of. */
20814 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == NULL)
20815 {
20816 /* Output a real namespace or module. */
20817 context_die = setup_namespace_context (decl, comp_unit_die ());
20818 namespace_die = new_die (is_fortran ()
20819 ? DW_TAG_module : DW_TAG_namespace,
20820 context_die, decl);
20821 /* For Fortran modules defined in different CU don't add src coords. */
20822 if (namespace_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_module && DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
20823 {
20824 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 0);
20825 if (name)
20826 add_name_attribute (namespace_die, name);
20827 }
20828 else
20829 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
20830 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
20831 add_AT_flag (namespace_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
20832 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
20833 }
20834 else
20835 {
20836 /* Output a namespace alias. */
20837
20838 /* Force out the namespace we are an alias of, if necessary. */
20839 dw_die_ref origin_die
20840 = force_decl_die (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
20841
20842 if (DECL_FILE_SCOPE_P (decl)
20843 || TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
20844 context_die = setup_namespace_context (decl, comp_unit_die ());
20845 /* Now create the namespace alias DIE. */
20846 namespace_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration, context_die, decl);
20847 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
20848 add_AT_die_ref (namespace_die, DW_AT_import, origin_die);
20849 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
20850 }
20851 /* Bypass dwarf2_name's check for DECL_NAMELESS. */
20852 if (want_pubnames ())
20853 add_pubname_string (lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, 1), namespace_die);
20854 }
20855
20856 /* Generate Dwarf debug information for a decl described by DECL.
20857 The return value is currently only meaningful for PARM_DECLs,
20858 for all other decls it returns NULL. */
20859
20860 static dw_die_ref
20861 gen_decl_die (tree decl, tree origin, dw_die_ref context_die)
20862 {
20863 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
20864 tree class_origin = NULL, ultimate_origin;
20865
20866 if (DECL_P (decl_or_origin) && DECL_IGNORED_P (decl_or_origin))
20867 return NULL;
20868
20869 /* Ignore pointer bounds decls. */
20870 if (DECL_P (decl_or_origin)
20871 && TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin)
20872 && POINTER_BOUNDS_P (decl_or_origin))
20873 return NULL;
20874
20875 switch (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin))
20876 {
20877 case ERROR_MARK:
20878 break;
20879
20880 case CONST_DECL:
20881 if (!is_fortran () && !is_ada ())
20882 {
20883 /* The individual enumerators of an enum type get output when we output
20884 the Dwarf representation of the relevant enum type itself. */
20885 break;
20886 }
20887
20888 /* Emit its type. */
20889 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
20890
20891 /* And its containing namespace. */
20892 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
20893
20894 gen_const_die (decl, context_die);
20895 break;
20896
20897 case FUNCTION_DECL:
20898 /* Don't output any DIEs to represent mere function declarations,
20899 unless they are class members or explicit block externs. */
20900 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl_or_origin) == NULL_TREE
20901 && DECL_FILE_SCOPE_P (decl_or_origin)
20902 && (current_function_decl == NULL_TREE
20903 || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl_or_origin)))
20904 break;
20905
20906 #if 0
20907 /* FIXME */
20908 /* This doesn't work because the C frontend sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN
20909 on local redeclarations of global functions. That seems broken. */
20910 if (current_function_decl != decl)
20911 /* This is only a declaration. */;
20912 #endif
20913
20914 /* If we're emitting a clone, emit info for the abstract instance. */
20915 if (origin || DECL_ORIGIN (decl) != decl)
20916 dwarf2out_abstract_function (origin
20917 ? DECL_ORIGIN (origin)
20918 : DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
20919
20920 /* If we're emitting an out-of-line copy of an inline function,
20921 emit info for the abstract instance and set up to refer to it. */
20922 else if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl)
20923 && ! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl)
20924 && ! class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
20925 /* dwarf2out_abstract_function won't emit a die if this is just
20926 a declaration. We must avoid setting DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN in
20927 that case, because that works only if we have a die. */
20928 && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE)
20929 {
20930 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
20931 set_decl_origin_self (decl);
20932 }
20933
20934 /* Otherwise we're emitting the primary DIE for this decl. */
20935 else if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20936 {
20937 /* Before we describe the FUNCTION_DECL itself, make sure that we
20938 have its containing type. */
20939 if (!origin)
20940 origin = decl_class_context (decl);
20941 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
20942 gen_type_die (origin, context_die);
20943
20944 /* And its return type. */
20945 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)), context_die);
20946
20947 /* And its virtual context. */
20948 if (DECL_VINDEX (decl) != NULL_TREE)
20949 gen_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl), context_die);
20950
20951 /* Make sure we have a member DIE for decl. */
20952 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
20953 gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
20954
20955 /* And its containing namespace. */
20956 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
20957 }
20958
20959 /* Now output a DIE to represent the function itself. */
20960 if (decl)
20961 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
20962 break;
20963
20964 case TYPE_DECL:
20965 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
20966 actual typedefs. */
20967 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20968 break;
20969
20970 /* In the special case of a TYPE_DECL node representing the declaration
20971 of some type tag, if the given TYPE_DECL is marked as having been
20972 instantiated from some other (original) TYPE_DECL node (e.g. one which
20973 was generated within the original definition of an inline function) we
20974 used to generate a special (abbreviated) DW_TAG_structure_type,
20975 DW_TAG_union_type, or DW_TAG_enumeration_type DIE here. But nothing
20976 should be actually referencing those DIEs, as variable DIEs with that
20977 type would be emitted already in the abstract origin, so it was always
20978 removed during unused type prunning. Don't add anything in this
20979 case. */
20980 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl) && decl_ultimate_origin (decl) != NULL_TREE)
20981 break;
20982
20983 if (is_redundant_typedef (decl))
20984 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
20985 else
20986 /* Output a DIE to represent the typedef itself. */
20987 gen_typedef_die (decl, context_die);
20988 break;
20989
20990 case LABEL_DECL:
20991 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
20992 gen_label_die (decl, context_die);
20993 break;
20994
20995 case VAR_DECL:
20996 case RESULT_DECL:
20997 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
20998 variable declarations or definitions. */
20999 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
21000 break;
21001
21002 /* Output any DIEs that are needed to specify the type of this data
21003 object. */
21004 if (decl_by_reference_p (decl_or_origin))
21005 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin)), context_die);
21006 else
21007 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin), context_die);
21008
21009 /* And its containing type. */
21010 class_origin = decl_class_context (decl_or_origin);
21011 if (class_origin != NULL_TREE)
21012 gen_type_die_for_member (class_origin, decl_or_origin, context_die);
21013
21014 /* And its containing namespace. */
21015 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl_or_origin, context_die);
21016
21017 /* Now output the DIE to represent the data object itself. This gets
21018 complicated because of the possibility that the VAR_DECL really
21019 represents an inlined instance of a formal parameter for an inline
21020 function. */
21021 ultimate_origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl_or_origin);
21022 if (ultimate_origin != NULL_TREE
21023 && TREE_CODE (ultimate_origin) == PARM_DECL)
21024 gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, origin,
21025 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
21026 context_die);
21027 else
21028 gen_variable_die (decl, origin, context_die);
21029 break;
21030
21031 case FIELD_DECL:
21032 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle C++
21033 anonymous unions and structs. */
21034 if (DECL_NAME (decl) != NULL_TREE
21035 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == UNION_TYPE
21036 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == RECORD_TYPE)
21037 {
21038 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (decl), context_die);
21039 gen_field_die (decl, context_die);
21040 }
21041 break;
21042
21043 case PARM_DECL:
21044 if (DECL_BY_REFERENCE (decl_or_origin))
21045 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin)), context_die);
21046 else
21047 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin), context_die);
21048 return gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, origin,
21049 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
21050 context_die);
21051
21052 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
21053 case IMPORTED_DECL:
21054 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
21055 gen_namespace_die (decl, context_die);
21056 break;
21057
21058 case NAMELIST_DECL:
21059 gen_namelist_decl (DECL_NAME (decl), context_die,
21060 NAMELIST_DECL_ASSOCIATED_DECL (decl));
21061 break;
21062
21063 default:
21064 /* Probably some frontend-internal decl. Assume we don't care. */
21065 gcc_assert ((int)TREE_CODE (decl) > NUM_TREE_CODES);
21066 break;
21067 }
21068
21069 return NULL;
21070 }
21071 \f
21072 /* Output debug information for global decl DECL. Called from toplev.c after
21073 compilation proper has finished. */
21074
21075 static void
21076 dwarf2out_global_decl (tree decl)
21077 {
21078 /* Output DWARF2 information for file-scope tentative data object
21079 declarations, file-scope (extern) function declarations (which
21080 had no corresponding body) and file-scope tagged type declarations
21081 and definitions which have not yet been forced out. */
21082 if ((TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || !DECL_INITIAL (decl))
21083 && !POINTER_BOUNDS_P (decl))
21084 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
21085 }
21086
21087 /* Output debug information for type decl DECL. Called from toplev.c
21088 and from language front ends (to record built-in types). */
21089 static void
21090 dwarf2out_type_decl (tree decl, int local)
21091 {
21092 if (!local)
21093 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
21094 }
21095
21096 /* Output debug information for imported module or decl DECL.
21097 NAME is non-NULL name in the lexical block if the decl has been renamed.
21098 LEXICAL_BLOCK is the lexical block (which TREE_CODE is a BLOCK)
21099 that DECL belongs to.
21100 LEXICAL_BLOCK_DIE is the DIE of LEXICAL_BLOCK. */
21101 static void
21102 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (tree decl,
21103 tree name,
21104 tree lexical_block,
21105 dw_die_ref lexical_block_die)
21106 {
21107 expanded_location xloc;
21108 dw_die_ref imported_die = NULL;
21109 dw_die_ref at_import_die;
21110
21111 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == IMPORTED_DECL)
21112 {
21113 xloc = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
21114 decl = IMPORTED_DECL_ASSOCIATED_DECL (decl);
21115 gcc_assert (decl);
21116 }
21117 else
21118 xloc = expand_location (input_location);
21119
21120 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == CONST_DECL)
21121 {
21122 at_import_die = force_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
21123 /* For namespace N { typedef void T; } using N::T; base_type_die
21124 returns NULL, but DW_TAG_imported_declaration requires
21125 the DW_AT_import tag. Force creation of DW_TAG_typedef. */
21126 if (!at_import_die)
21127 {
21128 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL);
21129 gen_typedef_die (decl, get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)));
21130 at_import_die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
21131 gcc_assert (at_import_die);
21132 }
21133 }
21134 else
21135 {
21136 at_import_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
21137 if (!at_import_die)
21138 {
21139 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
21140 emitted the member decl for this field. Emit it now. */
21141 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL)
21142 {
21143 tree type = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
21144
21145 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
21146 && TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
21147 && !should_emit_struct_debug (TYPE_CONTEXT (type),
21148 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
21149 return;
21150 gen_type_die_for_member (type, decl,
21151 get_context_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)));
21152 }
21153 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == NAMELIST_DECL)
21154 at_import_die = gen_namelist_decl (DECL_NAME (decl),
21155 get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)),
21156 NULL_TREE);
21157 else
21158 at_import_die = force_decl_die (decl);
21159 }
21160 }
21161
21162 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
21163 {
21164 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
21165 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_module,
21166 lexical_block_die,
21167 lexical_block);
21168 else
21169 return;
21170 }
21171 else
21172 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration,
21173 lexical_block_die,
21174 lexical_block);
21175
21176 add_AT_file (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (xloc.file));
21177 add_AT_unsigned (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_line, xloc.line);
21178 if (name)
21179 add_AT_string (imported_die, DW_AT_name,
21180 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
21181 add_AT_die_ref (imported_die, DW_AT_import, at_import_die);
21182 }
21183
21184 /* Output debug information for imported module or decl DECL.
21185 NAME is non-NULL name in context if the decl has been renamed.
21186 CHILD is true if decl is one of the renamed decls as part of
21187 importing whole module. */
21188
21189 static void
21190 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree decl, tree name, tree context,
21191 bool child)
21192 {
21193 /* dw_die_ref at_import_die; */
21194 dw_die_ref scope_die;
21195
21196 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
21197 return;
21198
21199 gcc_assert (decl);
21200
21201 /* To emit DW_TAG_imported_module or DW_TAG_imported_decl, we need two DIEs.
21202 We need decl DIE for reference and scope die. First, get DIE for the decl
21203 itself. */
21204
21205 /* Get the scope die for decl context. Use comp_unit_die for global module
21206 or decl. If die is not found for non globals, force new die. */
21207 if (context
21208 && TYPE_P (context)
21209 && !should_emit_struct_debug (context, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
21210 return;
21211
21212 if (!(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
21213 return;
21214
21215 scope_die = get_context_die (context);
21216
21217 if (child)
21218 {
21219 gcc_assert (scope_die->die_child);
21220 gcc_assert (scope_die->die_child->die_tag == DW_TAG_imported_module);
21221 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) != NAMESPACE_DECL);
21222 scope_die = scope_die->die_child;
21223 }
21224
21225 /* OK, now we have DIEs for decl as well as scope. Emit imported die. */
21226 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (decl, name, context, scope_die);
21227
21228 }
21229
21230 /* Output debug information for namelists. */
21231
21232 static dw_die_ref
21233 gen_namelist_decl (tree name, dw_die_ref scope_die, tree item_decls)
21234 {
21235 dw_die_ref nml_die, nml_item_die, nml_item_ref_die;
21236 tree value;
21237 unsigned i;
21238
21239 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
21240 return NULL;
21241
21242 gcc_assert (scope_die != NULL);
21243 nml_die = new_die (DW_TAG_namelist, scope_die, NULL);
21244 add_AT_string (nml_die, DW_AT_name, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
21245
21246 /* If there are no item_decls, we have a nondefining namelist, e.g.
21247 with USE association; hence, set DW_AT_declaration. */
21248 if (item_decls == NULL_TREE)
21249 {
21250 add_AT_flag (nml_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
21251 return nml_die;
21252 }
21253
21254 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (item_decls), i, value)
21255 {
21256 nml_item_ref_die = lookup_decl_die (value);
21257 if (!nml_item_ref_die)
21258 nml_item_ref_die = force_decl_die (value);
21259
21260 nml_item_die = new_die (DW_TAG_namelist_item, nml_die, NULL);
21261 add_AT_die_ref (nml_item_die, DW_AT_namelist_items, nml_item_ref_die);
21262 }
21263 return nml_die;
21264 }
21265
21266
21267 /* Write the debugging output for DECL. */
21268
21269 static void
21270 dwarf2out_decl (tree decl)
21271 {
21272 dw_die_ref context_die = comp_unit_die ();
21273
21274 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
21275 {
21276 case ERROR_MARK:
21277 return;
21278
21279 case FUNCTION_DECL:
21280 /* What we would really like to do here is to filter out all mere
21281 file-scope declarations of file-scope functions which are never
21282 referenced later within this translation unit (and keep all of ones
21283 that *are* referenced later on) but we aren't clairvoyant, so we have
21284 no idea which functions will be referenced in the future (i.e. later
21285 on within the current translation unit). So here we just ignore all
21286 file-scope function declarations which are not also definitions. If
21287 and when the debugger needs to know something about these functions,
21288 it will have to hunt around and find the DWARF information associated
21289 with the definition of the function.
21290
21291 We can't just check DECL_EXTERNAL to find out which FUNCTION_DECL
21292 nodes represent definitions and which ones represent mere
21293 declarations. We have to check DECL_INITIAL instead. That's because
21294 the C front-end supports some weird semantics for "extern inline"
21295 function definitions. These can get inlined within the current
21296 translation unit (and thus, we need to generate Dwarf info for their
21297 abstract instances so that the Dwarf info for the concrete inlined
21298 instances can have something to refer to) but the compiler never
21299 generates any out-of-lines instances of such things (despite the fact
21300 that they *are* definitions).
21301
21302 The important point is that the C front-end marks these "extern
21303 inline" functions as DECL_EXTERNAL, but we need to generate DWARF for
21304 them anyway. Note that the C++ front-end also plays some similar games
21305 for inline function definitions appearing within include files which
21306 also contain `#pragma interface' pragmas.
21307
21308 If we are called from dwarf2out_abstract_function output a DIE
21309 anyway. We can end up here this way with early inlining and LTO
21310 where the inlined function is output in a different LTRANS unit
21311 or not at all. */
21312 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE
21313 && ! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl))
21314 return;
21315
21316 /* If we're a nested function, initially use a parent of NULL; if we're
21317 a plain function, this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. If
21318 we're a method, it will be ignored, since we already have a DIE. */
21319 if (decl_function_context (decl)
21320 /* But if we're in terse mode, we don't care about scope. */
21321 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
21322 context_die = NULL;
21323 break;
21324
21325 case VAR_DECL:
21326 /* Ignore this VAR_DECL if it refers to a file-scope extern data object
21327 declaration and if the declaration was never even referenced from
21328 within this entire compilation unit. We suppress these DIEs in
21329 order to save space in the .debug section (by eliminating entries
21330 which are probably useless). Note that we must not suppress
21331 block-local extern declarations (whether used or not) because that
21332 would screw-up the debugger's name lookup mechanism and cause it to
21333 miss things which really ought to be in scope at a given point. */
21334 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) && !TREE_USED (decl))
21335 return;
21336
21337 /* For local statics lookup proper context die. */
21338 if (TREE_STATIC (decl)
21339 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
21340 && TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)) == FUNCTION_DECL)
21341 context_die = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
21342
21343 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
21344 variable declarations or definitions. */
21345 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
21346 return;
21347 break;
21348
21349 case CONST_DECL:
21350 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
21351 return;
21352 if (!is_fortran () && !is_ada ())
21353 return;
21354 if (TREE_STATIC (decl) && decl_function_context (decl))
21355 context_die = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
21356 break;
21357
21358 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
21359 case IMPORTED_DECL:
21360 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
21361 return;
21362 if (lookup_decl_die (decl) != NULL)
21363 return;
21364 break;
21365
21366 case TYPE_DECL:
21367 /* Don't emit stubs for types unless they are needed by other DIEs. */
21368 if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (decl))
21369 return;
21370
21371 /* Don't bother trying to generate any DIEs to represent any of the
21372 normal built-in types for the language we are compiling. */
21373 if (DECL_IS_BUILTIN (decl))
21374 return;
21375
21376 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs for types. */
21377 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
21378 return;
21379
21380 /* If we're a function-scope tag, initially use a parent of NULL;
21381 this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. */
21382 if (decl_function_context (decl))
21383 context_die = NULL;
21384
21385 break;
21386
21387 case NAMELIST_DECL:
21388 break;
21389
21390 default:
21391 return;
21392 }
21393
21394 gen_decl_die (decl, NULL, context_die);
21395 }
21396
21397 /* Write the debugging output for DECL. */
21398
21399 static void
21400 dwarf2out_function_decl (tree decl)
21401 {
21402 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
21403 call_arg_locations = NULL;
21404 call_arg_loc_last = NULL;
21405 call_site_count = -1;
21406 tail_call_site_count = -1;
21407 block_map.release ();
21408 decl_loc_table->empty ();
21409 cached_dw_loc_list_table->empty ();
21410 }
21411
21412 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code for
21413 a lexical block. */
21414
21415 static void
21416 dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
21417 unsigned int blocknum)
21418 {
21419 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
21420 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, blocknum);
21421 }
21422
21423 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code for a
21424 lexical block. */
21425
21426 static void
21427 dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int blocknum)
21428 {
21429 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
21430 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_END_LABEL, blocknum);
21431 }
21432
21433 /* Returns nonzero if it is appropriate not to emit any debugging
21434 information for BLOCK, because it doesn't contain any instructions.
21435
21436 Don't allow this for blocks with nested functions or local classes
21437 as we would end up with orphans, and in the presence of scheduling
21438 we may end up calling them anyway. */
21439
21440 static bool
21441 dwarf2out_ignore_block (const_tree block)
21442 {
21443 tree decl;
21444 unsigned int i;
21445
21446 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (block); decl; decl = DECL_CHAIN (decl))
21447 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
21448 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
21449 return 0;
21450 for (i = 0; i < BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (block); i++)
21451 {
21452 decl = BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VAR (block, i);
21453 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
21454 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
21455 return 0;
21456 }
21457
21458 return 1;
21459 }
21460
21461 /* Hash table routines for file_hash. */
21462
21463 bool
21464 dwarf_file_hasher::equal (dwarf_file_data *p1, const char *p2)
21465 {
21466 return filename_cmp (p1->filename, p2) == 0;
21467 }
21468
21469 hashval_t
21470 dwarf_file_hasher::hash (dwarf_file_data *p)
21471 {
21472 return htab_hash_string (p->filename);
21473 }
21474
21475 /* Lookup FILE_NAME (in the list of filenames that we know about here in
21476 dwarf2out.c) and return its "index". The index of each (known) filename is
21477 just a unique number which is associated with only that one filename. We
21478 need such numbers for the sake of generating labels (in the .debug_sfnames
21479 section) and references to those files numbers (in the .debug_srcinfo
21480 and.debug_macinfo sections). If the filename given as an argument is not
21481 found in our current list, add it to the list and assign it the next
21482 available unique index number. In order to speed up searches, we remember
21483 the index of the filename was looked up last. This handles the majority of
21484 all searches. */
21485
21486 static struct dwarf_file_data *
21487 lookup_filename (const char *file_name)
21488 {
21489 struct dwarf_file_data * created;
21490
21491 /* Check to see if the file name that was searched on the previous
21492 call matches this file name. If so, return the index. */
21493 if (file_table_last_lookup
21494 && (file_name == file_table_last_lookup->filename
21495 || filename_cmp (file_table_last_lookup->filename, file_name) == 0))
21496 return file_table_last_lookup;
21497
21498 /* Didn't match the previous lookup, search the table. */
21499 dwarf_file_data **slot
21500 = file_table->find_slot_with_hash (file_name, htab_hash_string (file_name),
21501 INSERT);
21502 if (*slot)
21503 return *slot;
21504
21505 created = ggc_alloc<dwarf_file_data> ();
21506 created->filename = file_name;
21507 created->emitted_number = 0;
21508 *slot = created;
21509 return created;
21510 }
21511
21512 /* If the assembler will construct the file table, then translate the compiler
21513 internal file table number into the assembler file table number, and emit
21514 a .file directive if we haven't already emitted one yet. The file table
21515 numbers are different because we prune debug info for unused variables and
21516 types, which may include filenames. */
21517
21518 static int
21519 maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data * fd)
21520 {
21521 if (! fd->emitted_number)
21522 {
21523 if (last_emitted_file)
21524 fd->emitted_number = last_emitted_file->emitted_number + 1;
21525 else
21526 fd->emitted_number = 1;
21527 last_emitted_file = fd;
21528
21529 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
21530 {
21531 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.file %u ", fd->emitted_number);
21532 output_quoted_string (asm_out_file,
21533 remap_debug_filename (fd->filename));
21534 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
21535 }
21536 }
21537
21538 return fd->emitted_number;
21539 }
21540
21541 /* Schedule generation of a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIE.
21542 That generation should happen after function debug info has been
21543 generated. The value of the attribute is the constant value of ARG. */
21544
21545 static void
21546 append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (dw_die_ref die, tree arg)
21547 {
21548 die_arg_entry entry;
21549
21550 if (!die || !arg)
21551 return;
21552
21553 if (!tmpl_value_parm_die_table)
21554 vec_alloc (tmpl_value_parm_die_table, 32);
21555
21556 entry.die = die;
21557 entry.arg = arg;
21558 vec_safe_push (tmpl_value_parm_die_table, entry);
21559 }
21560
21561 /* Return TRUE if T is an instance of generic type, FALSE
21562 otherwise. */
21563
21564 static bool
21565 generic_type_p (tree t)
21566 {
21567 if (t == NULL_TREE || !TYPE_P (t))
21568 return false;
21569 return lang_hooks.get_innermost_generic_parms (t) != NULL_TREE;
21570 }
21571
21572 /* Schedule the generation of the generic parameter dies for the
21573 instance of generic type T. The proper generation itself is later
21574 done by gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies. */
21575
21576 static void
21577 schedule_generic_params_dies_gen (tree t)
21578 {
21579 if (!generic_type_p (t))
21580 return;
21581
21582 if (!generic_type_instances)
21583 vec_alloc (generic_type_instances, 256);
21584
21585 vec_safe_push (generic_type_instances, t);
21586 }
21587
21588 /* Add a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIEs that were scheduled
21589 by append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table. This function must
21590 be called after function DIEs have been generated. */
21591
21592 static void
21593 gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute (void)
21594 {
21595 if (tmpl_value_parm_die_table)
21596 {
21597 unsigned i;
21598 die_arg_entry *e;
21599
21600 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*tmpl_value_parm_die_table, i, e)
21601 tree_add_const_value_attribute (e->die, e->arg);
21602 }
21603 }
21604
21605 /* Generate generic parameters DIEs for instances of generic types
21606 that have been previously scheduled by
21607 schedule_generic_params_dies_gen. This function must be called
21608 after all the types of the CU have been laid out. */
21609
21610 static void
21611 gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies (void)
21612 {
21613 unsigned i;
21614 tree t;
21615
21616 if (!generic_type_instances)
21617 return;
21618
21619 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*generic_type_instances, i, t)
21620 if (COMPLETE_TYPE_P (t))
21621 gen_generic_params_dies (t);
21622 }
21623
21624
21625 /* Replace DW_AT_name for the decl with name. */
21626
21627 static void
21628 dwarf2out_set_name (tree decl, tree name)
21629 {
21630 dw_die_ref die;
21631 dw_attr_ref attr;
21632 const char *dname;
21633
21634 die = TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (decl);
21635 if (!die)
21636 return;
21637
21638 dname = dwarf2_name (name, 0);
21639 if (!dname)
21640 return;
21641
21642 attr = get_AT (die, DW_AT_name);
21643 if (attr)
21644 {
21645 struct indirect_string_node *node;
21646
21647 node = find_AT_string (dname);
21648 /* replace the string. */
21649 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
21650 }
21651
21652 else
21653 add_name_attribute (die, dname);
21654 }
21655
21656 /* True if before or during processing of the first function being emitted. */
21657 static bool in_first_function_p = true;
21658 /* True if loc_note during dwarf2out_var_location call might still be
21659 before first real instruction at address equal to .Ltext0. */
21660 static bool maybe_at_text_label_p = true;
21661 /* One above highest N where .LVLN label might be equal to .Ltext0 label. */
21662 static unsigned int first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label;
21663
21664 /* Called by the final INSN scan whenever we see a var location. We
21665 use it to drop labels in the right places, and throw the location in
21666 our lookup table. */
21667
21668 static void
21669 dwarf2out_var_location (rtx_insn *loc_note)
21670 {
21671 char loclabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES + 2];
21672 struct var_loc_node *newloc;
21673 rtx_insn *next_real, *next_note;
21674 static const char *last_label;
21675 static const char *last_postcall_label;
21676 static bool last_in_cold_section_p;
21677 static rtx_insn *expected_next_loc_note;
21678 tree decl;
21679 bool var_loc_p;
21680
21681 if (!NOTE_P (loc_note))
21682 {
21683 if (CALL_P (loc_note))
21684 {
21685 call_site_count++;
21686 if (SIBLING_CALL_P (loc_note))
21687 tail_call_site_count++;
21688 }
21689 return;
21690 }
21691
21692 var_loc_p = NOTE_KIND (loc_note) == NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION;
21693 if (var_loc_p && !DECL_P (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note)))
21694 return;
21695
21696 /* Optimize processing a large consecutive sequence of location
21697 notes so we don't spend too much time in next_real_insn. If the
21698 next insn is another location note, remember the next_real_insn
21699 calculation for next time. */
21700 next_real = cached_next_real_insn;
21701 if (next_real)
21702 {
21703 if (expected_next_loc_note != loc_note)
21704 next_real = NULL;
21705 }
21706
21707 next_note = NEXT_INSN (loc_note);
21708 if (! next_note
21709 || next_note->deleted ()
21710 || ! NOTE_P (next_note)
21711 || (NOTE_KIND (next_note) != NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION
21712 && NOTE_KIND (next_note) != NOTE_INSN_CALL_ARG_LOCATION))
21713 next_note = NULL;
21714
21715 if (! next_real)
21716 next_real = next_real_insn (loc_note);
21717
21718 if (next_note)
21719 {
21720 expected_next_loc_note = next_note;
21721 cached_next_real_insn = next_real;
21722 }
21723 else
21724 cached_next_real_insn = NULL;
21725
21726 /* If there are no instructions which would be affected by this note,
21727 don't do anything. */
21728 if (var_loc_p
21729 && next_real == NULL_RTX
21730 && !NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (loc_note))
21731 return;
21732
21733 if (next_real == NULL_RTX)
21734 next_real = get_last_insn ();
21735
21736 /* If there were any real insns between note we processed last time
21737 and this note (or if it is the first note), clear
21738 last_{,postcall_}label so that they are not reused this time. */
21739 if (last_var_location_insn == NULL_RTX
21740 || last_var_location_insn != next_real
21741 || last_in_cold_section_p != in_cold_section_p)
21742 {
21743 last_label = NULL;
21744 last_postcall_label = NULL;
21745 }
21746
21747 if (var_loc_p)
21748 {
21749 decl = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note);
21750 newloc = add_var_loc_to_decl (decl, loc_note,
21751 NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (loc_note)
21752 ? last_postcall_label : last_label);
21753 if (newloc == NULL)
21754 return;
21755 }
21756 else
21757 {
21758 decl = NULL_TREE;
21759 newloc = NULL;
21760 }
21761
21762 /* If there were no real insns between note we processed last time
21763 and this note, use the label we emitted last time. Otherwise
21764 create a new label and emit it. */
21765 if (last_label == NULL)
21766 {
21767 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loclabel, "LVL", loclabel_num);
21768 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, "LVL", loclabel_num);
21769 loclabel_num++;
21770 last_label = ggc_strdup (loclabel);
21771 /* See if loclabel might be equal to .Ltext0. If yes,
21772 bump first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label. */
21773 if (!have_multiple_function_sections
21774 && in_first_function_p
21775 && maybe_at_text_label_p)
21776 {
21777 static rtx_insn *last_start;
21778 rtx_insn *insn;
21779 for (insn = loc_note; insn; insn = previous_insn (insn))
21780 if (insn == last_start)
21781 break;
21782 else if (!NONDEBUG_INSN_P (insn))
21783 continue;
21784 else
21785 {
21786 rtx body = PATTERN (insn);
21787 if (GET_CODE (body) == USE || GET_CODE (body) == CLOBBER)
21788 continue;
21789 /* Inline asm could occupy zero bytes. */
21790 else if (GET_CODE (body) == ASM_INPUT
21791 || asm_noperands (body) >= 0)
21792 continue;
21793 #ifdef HAVE_attr_length
21794 else if (get_attr_min_length (insn) == 0)
21795 continue;
21796 #endif
21797 else
21798 {
21799 /* Assume insn has non-zero length. */
21800 maybe_at_text_label_p = false;
21801 break;
21802 }
21803 }
21804 if (maybe_at_text_label_p)
21805 {
21806 last_start = loc_note;
21807 first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label = loclabel_num;
21808 }
21809 }
21810 }
21811
21812 if (!var_loc_p)
21813 {
21814 struct call_arg_loc_node *ca_loc
21815 = ggc_cleared_alloc<call_arg_loc_node> ();
21816 rtx_insn *prev = prev_real_insn (loc_note);
21817 rtx x;
21818 ca_loc->call_arg_loc_note = loc_note;
21819 ca_loc->next = NULL;
21820 ca_loc->label = last_label;
21821 gcc_assert (prev
21822 && (CALL_P (prev)
21823 || (NONJUMP_INSN_P (prev)
21824 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (prev)) == SEQUENCE
21825 && CALL_P (XVECEXP (PATTERN (prev), 0, 0)))));
21826 if (!CALL_P (prev))
21827 prev = as_a <rtx_sequence *> (PATTERN (prev))->insn (0);
21828 ca_loc->tail_call_p = SIBLING_CALL_P (prev);
21829 x = get_call_rtx_from (PATTERN (prev));
21830 if (x)
21831 {
21832 x = XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0);
21833 if (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF
21834 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (x)
21835 && TREE_CODE (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (x)) == FUNCTION_DECL)
21836 ca_loc->symbol_ref = x;
21837 }
21838 ca_loc->block = insn_scope (prev);
21839 if (call_arg_locations)
21840 call_arg_loc_last->next = ca_loc;
21841 else
21842 call_arg_locations = ca_loc;
21843 call_arg_loc_last = ca_loc;
21844 }
21845 else if (!NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (loc_note))
21846 newloc->label = last_label;
21847 else
21848 {
21849 if (!last_postcall_label)
21850 {
21851 sprintf (loclabel, "%s-1", last_label);
21852 last_postcall_label = ggc_strdup (loclabel);
21853 }
21854 newloc->label = last_postcall_label;
21855 }
21856
21857 last_var_location_insn = next_real;
21858 last_in_cold_section_p = in_cold_section_p;
21859 }
21860
21861 /* Note in one location list that text section has changed. */
21862
21863 int
21864 var_location_switch_text_section_1 (var_loc_list **slot, void *)
21865 {
21866 var_loc_list *list = *slot;
21867 if (list->first)
21868 list->last_before_switch
21869 = list->last->next ? list->last->next : list->last;
21870 return 1;
21871 }
21872
21873 /* Note in all location lists that text section has changed. */
21874
21875 static void
21876 var_location_switch_text_section (void)
21877 {
21878 if (decl_loc_table == NULL)
21879 return;
21880
21881 decl_loc_table->traverse<void *, var_location_switch_text_section_1> (NULL);
21882 }
21883
21884 /* Create a new line number table. */
21885
21886 static dw_line_info_table *
21887 new_line_info_table (void)
21888 {
21889 dw_line_info_table *table;
21890
21891 table = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_line_info_table_struct> ();
21892 table->file_num = 1;
21893 table->line_num = 1;
21894 table->is_stmt = DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START;
21895
21896 return table;
21897 }
21898
21899 /* Lookup the "current" table into which we emit line info, so
21900 that we don't have to do it for every source line. */
21901
21902 static void
21903 set_cur_line_info_table (section *sec)
21904 {
21905 dw_line_info_table *table;
21906
21907 if (sec == text_section)
21908 table = text_section_line_info;
21909 else if (sec == cold_text_section)
21910 {
21911 table = cold_text_section_line_info;
21912 if (!table)
21913 {
21914 cold_text_section_line_info = table = new_line_info_table ();
21915 table->end_label = cold_end_label;
21916 }
21917 }
21918 else
21919 {
21920 const char *end_label;
21921
21922 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
21923 {
21924 if (in_cold_section_p)
21925 end_label = crtl->subsections.cold_section_end_label;
21926 else
21927 end_label = crtl->subsections.hot_section_end_label;
21928 }
21929 else
21930 {
21931 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
21932 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_END_LABEL,
21933 current_function_funcdef_no);
21934 end_label = ggc_strdup (label);
21935 }
21936
21937 table = new_line_info_table ();
21938 table->end_label = end_label;
21939
21940 vec_safe_push (separate_line_info, table);
21941 }
21942
21943 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
21944 table->is_stmt = (cur_line_info_table
21945 ? cur_line_info_table->is_stmt
21946 : DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START);
21947 cur_line_info_table = table;
21948 }
21949
21950
21951 /* We need to reset the locations at the beginning of each
21952 function. We can't do this in the end_function hook, because the
21953 declarations that use the locations won't have been output when
21954 that hook is called. Also compute have_multiple_function_sections here. */
21955
21956 static void
21957 dwarf2out_begin_function (tree fun)
21958 {
21959 section *sec = function_section (fun);
21960
21961 if (sec != text_section)
21962 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
21963
21964 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition && !cold_text_section)
21965 {
21966 gcc_assert (current_function_decl == fun);
21967 cold_text_section = unlikely_text_section ();
21968 switch_to_section (cold_text_section);
21969 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, cold_text_section_label);
21970 switch_to_section (sec);
21971 }
21972
21973 dwarf2out_note_section_used ();
21974 call_site_count = 0;
21975 tail_call_site_count = 0;
21976
21977 set_cur_line_info_table (sec);
21978 }
21979
21980 /* Helper function of dwarf2out_end_function, called only after emitting
21981 the very first function into assembly. Check if some .debug_loc range
21982 might end with a .LVL* label that could be equal to .Ltext0.
21983 In that case we must force using absolute addresses in .debug_loc ranges,
21984 because this range could be .LVLN-.Ltext0 .. .LVLM-.Ltext0 for
21985 .LVLN == .LVLM == .Ltext0, thus 0 .. 0, which is a .debug_loc
21986 list terminator.
21987 Set have_multiple_function_sections to true in that case and
21988 terminate htab traversal. */
21989
21990 int
21991 find_empty_loc_ranges_at_text_label (var_loc_list **slot, int)
21992 {
21993 var_loc_list *entry = *slot;
21994 struct var_loc_node *node;
21995
21996 node = entry->first;
21997 if (node && node->next && node->next->label)
21998 {
21999 unsigned int i;
22000 const char *label = node->next->label;
22001 char loclabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
22002
22003 for (i = 0; i < first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label; i++)
22004 {
22005 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loclabel, "LVL", i);
22006 if (strcmp (label, loclabel) == 0)
22007 {
22008 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
22009 return 0;
22010 }
22011 }
22012 }
22013 return 1;
22014 }
22015
22016 /* Hook called after emitting a function into assembly.
22017 This does something only for the very first function emitted. */
22018
22019 static void
22020 dwarf2out_end_function (unsigned int)
22021 {
22022 if (in_first_function_p
22023 && !have_multiple_function_sections
22024 && first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label
22025 && decl_loc_table)
22026 decl_loc_table->traverse<int, find_empty_loc_ranges_at_text_label> (0);
22027 in_first_function_p = false;
22028 maybe_at_text_label_p = false;
22029 }
22030
22031 /* Add OPCODE+VAL as an entry at the end of the opcode array in TABLE. */
22032
22033 static void
22034 push_dw_line_info_entry (dw_line_info_table *table,
22035 enum dw_line_info_opcode opcode, unsigned int val)
22036 {
22037 dw_line_info_entry e;
22038 e.opcode = opcode;
22039 e.val = val;
22040 vec_safe_push (table->entries, e);
22041 }
22042
22043 /* Output a label to mark the beginning of a source code line entry
22044 and record information relating to this source line, in
22045 'line_info_table' for later output of the .debug_line section. */
22046 /* ??? The discriminator parameter ought to be unsigned. */
22047
22048 static void
22049 dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int line, const char *filename,
22050 int discriminator, bool is_stmt)
22051 {
22052 unsigned int file_num;
22053 dw_line_info_table *table;
22054
22055 if (debug_info_level < DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE || line == 0)
22056 return;
22057
22058 /* The discriminator column was added in dwarf4. Simplify the below
22059 by simply removing it if we're not supposed to output it. */
22060 if (dwarf_version < 4 && dwarf_strict)
22061 discriminator = 0;
22062
22063 table = cur_line_info_table;
22064 file_num = maybe_emit_file (lookup_filename (filename));
22065
22066 /* ??? TODO: Elide duplicate line number entries. Traditionally,
22067 the debugger has used the second (possibly duplicate) line number
22068 at the beginning of the function to mark the end of the prologue.
22069 We could eliminate any other duplicates within the function. For
22070 Dwarf3, we ought to include the DW_LNS_set_prologue_end mark in
22071 that second line number entry. */
22072 /* Recall that this end-of-prologue indication is *not* the same thing
22073 as the end_prologue debug hook. The NOTE_INSN_PROLOGUE_END note,
22074 to which the hook corresponds, follows the last insn that was
22075 emitted by gen_prologue. What we need is to precede the first insn
22076 that had been emitted after NOTE_INSN_FUNCTION_BEG, i.e. the first
22077 insn that corresponds to something the user wrote. These may be
22078 very different locations once scheduling is enabled. */
22079
22080 if (0 && file_num == table->file_num
22081 && line == table->line_num
22082 && discriminator == table->discrim_num
22083 && is_stmt == table->is_stmt)
22084 return;
22085
22086 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
22087
22088 /* If requested, emit something human-readable. */
22089 if (flag_debug_asm)
22090 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s %s:%d\n", ASM_COMMENT_START, filename, line);
22091
22092 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
22093 {
22094 /* Emit the .loc directive understood by GNU as. */
22095 /* "\t.loc %u %u 0 is_stmt %u discriminator %u",
22096 file_num, line, is_stmt, discriminator */
22097 fputs ("\t.loc ", asm_out_file);
22098 fprint_ul (asm_out_file, file_num);
22099 putc (' ', asm_out_file);
22100 fprint_ul (asm_out_file, line);
22101 putc (' ', asm_out_file);
22102 putc ('0', asm_out_file);
22103
22104 if (is_stmt != table->is_stmt)
22105 {
22106 fputs (" is_stmt ", asm_out_file);
22107 putc (is_stmt ? '1' : '0', asm_out_file);
22108 }
22109 if (SUPPORTS_DISCRIMINATOR && discriminator != 0)
22110 {
22111 gcc_assert (discriminator > 0);
22112 fputs (" discriminator ", asm_out_file);
22113 fprint_ul (asm_out_file, (unsigned long) discriminator);
22114 }
22115 putc ('\n', asm_out_file);
22116 }
22117 else
22118 {
22119 unsigned int label_num = ++line_info_label_num;
22120
22121 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, LINE_CODE_LABEL, label_num);
22122
22123 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_address, label_num);
22124 if (file_num != table->file_num)
22125 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_file, file_num);
22126 if (discriminator != table->discrim_num)
22127 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_discriminator, discriminator);
22128 if (is_stmt != table->is_stmt)
22129 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_negate_stmt, 0);
22130 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_line, line);
22131 }
22132
22133 table->file_num = file_num;
22134 table->line_num = line;
22135 table->discrim_num = discriminator;
22136 table->is_stmt = is_stmt;
22137 table->in_use = true;
22138 }
22139
22140 /* Record the beginning of a new source file. */
22141
22142 static void
22143 dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned int lineno, const char *filename)
22144 {
22145 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
22146 {
22147 /* Record the beginning of the file for break_out_includes. */
22148 dw_die_ref bincl_die;
22149
22150 bincl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL, comp_unit_die (), NULL);
22151 add_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name, remap_debug_filename (filename));
22152 }
22153
22154 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
22155 {
22156 macinfo_entry e;
22157 e.code = DW_MACINFO_start_file;
22158 e.lineno = lineno;
22159 e.info = ggc_strdup (filename);
22160 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
22161 }
22162 }
22163
22164 /* Record the end of a source file. */
22165
22166 static void
22167 dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
22168 {
22169 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
22170 /* Record the end of the file for break_out_includes. */
22171 new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL, comp_unit_die (), NULL);
22172
22173 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
22174 {
22175 macinfo_entry e;
22176 e.code = DW_MACINFO_end_file;
22177 e.lineno = lineno;
22178 e.info = NULL;
22179 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
22180 }
22181 }
22182
22183 /* Called from debug_define in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
22184 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
22185 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
22186
22187 static void
22188 dwarf2out_define (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
22189 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
22190 {
22191 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
22192 {
22193 macinfo_entry e;
22194 /* Insert a dummy first entry to be able to optimize the whole
22195 predefined macro block using DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include. */
22196 if (macinfo_table->is_empty () && lineno <= 1)
22197 {
22198 e.code = 0;
22199 e.lineno = 0;
22200 e.info = NULL;
22201 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
22202 }
22203 e.code = DW_MACINFO_define;
22204 e.lineno = lineno;
22205 e.info = ggc_strdup (buffer);
22206 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
22207 }
22208 }
22209
22210 /* Called from debug_undef in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
22211 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
22212 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
22213
22214 static void
22215 dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
22216 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
22217 {
22218 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
22219 {
22220 macinfo_entry e;
22221 /* Insert a dummy first entry to be able to optimize the whole
22222 predefined macro block using DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include. */
22223 if (macinfo_table->is_empty () && lineno <= 1)
22224 {
22225 e.code = 0;
22226 e.lineno = 0;
22227 e.info = NULL;
22228 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
22229 }
22230 e.code = DW_MACINFO_undef;
22231 e.lineno = lineno;
22232 e.info = ggc_strdup (buffer);
22233 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
22234 }
22235 }
22236
22237 /* Helpers to manipulate hash table of CUs. */
22238
22239 struct macinfo_entry_hasher : typed_noop_remove <macinfo_entry>
22240 {
22241 typedef macinfo_entry *value_type;
22242 typedef macinfo_entry *compare_type;
22243 static inline hashval_t hash (const macinfo_entry *);
22244 static inline bool equal (const macinfo_entry *, const macinfo_entry *);
22245 };
22246
22247 inline hashval_t
22248 macinfo_entry_hasher::hash (const macinfo_entry *entry)
22249 {
22250 return htab_hash_string (entry->info);
22251 }
22252
22253 inline bool
22254 macinfo_entry_hasher::equal (const macinfo_entry *entry1,
22255 const macinfo_entry *entry2)
22256 {
22257 return !strcmp (entry1->info, entry2->info);
22258 }
22259
22260 typedef hash_table<macinfo_entry_hasher> macinfo_hash_type;
22261
22262 /* Output a single .debug_macinfo entry. */
22263
22264 static void
22265 output_macinfo_op (macinfo_entry *ref)
22266 {
22267 int file_num;
22268 size_t len;
22269 struct indirect_string_node *node;
22270 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
22271 struct dwarf_file_data *fd;
22272
22273 switch (ref->code)
22274 {
22275 case DW_MACINFO_start_file:
22276 fd = lookup_filename (ref->info);
22277 file_num = maybe_emit_file (fd);
22278 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_start_file, "Start new file");
22279 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ref->lineno,
22280 "Included from line number %lu",
22281 (unsigned long) ref->lineno);
22282 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (file_num, "file %s", ref->info);
22283 break;
22284 case DW_MACINFO_end_file:
22285 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_end_file, "End file");
22286 break;
22287 case DW_MACINFO_define:
22288 case DW_MACINFO_undef:
22289 len = strlen (ref->info) + 1;
22290 if (!dwarf_strict
22291 && len > DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
22292 && !DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET
22293 && (debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) != 0)
22294 {
22295 ref->code = ref->code == DW_MACINFO_define
22296 ? DW_MACRO_GNU_define_indirect
22297 : DW_MACRO_GNU_undef_indirect;
22298 output_macinfo_op (ref);
22299 return;
22300 }
22301 dw2_asm_output_data (1, ref->code,
22302 ref->code == DW_MACINFO_define
22303 ? "Define macro" : "Undefine macro");
22304 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ref->lineno, "At line number %lu",
22305 (unsigned long) ref->lineno);
22306 dw2_asm_output_nstring (ref->info, -1, "The macro");
22307 break;
22308 case DW_MACRO_GNU_define_indirect:
22309 case DW_MACRO_GNU_undef_indirect:
22310 node = find_AT_string (ref->info);
22311 gcc_assert (node
22312 && ((node->form == DW_FORM_strp)
22313 || (node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index)));
22314 dw2_asm_output_data (1, ref->code,
22315 ref->code == DW_MACRO_GNU_define_indirect
22316 ? "Define macro indirect"
22317 : "Undefine macro indirect");
22318 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ref->lineno, "At line number %lu",
22319 (unsigned long) ref->lineno);
22320 if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp)
22321 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, node->label,
22322 debug_str_section, "The macro: \"%s\"",
22323 ref->info);
22324 else
22325 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (node->index, "The macro: \"%s\"",
22326 ref->info);
22327 break;
22328 case DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include:
22329 dw2_asm_output_data (1, ref->code, "Transparent include");
22330 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label,
22331 DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL, ref->lineno);
22332 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, label, NULL, NULL);
22333 break;
22334 default:
22335 fprintf (asm_out_file, "%s unrecognized macinfo code %lu\n",
22336 ASM_COMMENT_START, (unsigned long) ref->code);
22337 break;
22338 }
22339 }
22340
22341 /* Attempt to make a sequence of define/undef macinfo ops shareable with
22342 other compilation unit .debug_macinfo sections. IDX is the first
22343 index of a define/undef, return the number of ops that should be
22344 emitted in a comdat .debug_macinfo section and emit
22345 a DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include entry referencing it.
22346 If the define/undef entry should be emitted normally, return 0. */
22347
22348 static unsigned
22349 optimize_macinfo_range (unsigned int idx, vec<macinfo_entry, va_gc> *files,
22350 macinfo_hash_type **macinfo_htab)
22351 {
22352 macinfo_entry *first, *second, *cur, *inc;
22353 char linebuf[sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT) * 3 + 1];
22354 unsigned char checksum[16];
22355 struct md5_ctx ctx;
22356 char *grp_name, *tail;
22357 const char *base;
22358 unsigned int i, count, encoded_filename_len, linebuf_len;
22359 macinfo_entry **slot;
22360
22361 first = &(*macinfo_table)[idx];
22362 second = &(*macinfo_table)[idx + 1];
22363
22364 /* Optimize only if there are at least two consecutive define/undef ops,
22365 and either all of them are before first DW_MACINFO_start_file
22366 with lineno {0,1} (i.e. predefined macro block), or all of them are
22367 in some included header file. */
22368 if (second->code != DW_MACINFO_define && second->code != DW_MACINFO_undef)
22369 return 0;
22370 if (vec_safe_is_empty (files))
22371 {
22372 if (first->lineno > 1 || second->lineno > 1)
22373 return 0;
22374 }
22375 else if (first->lineno == 0)
22376 return 0;
22377
22378 /* Find the last define/undef entry that can be grouped together
22379 with first and at the same time compute md5 checksum of their
22380 codes, linenumbers and strings. */
22381 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
22382 for (i = idx; macinfo_table->iterate (i, &cur); i++)
22383 if (cur->code != DW_MACINFO_define && cur->code != DW_MACINFO_undef)
22384 break;
22385 else if (vec_safe_is_empty (files) && cur->lineno > 1)
22386 break;
22387 else
22388 {
22389 unsigned char code = cur->code;
22390 md5_process_bytes (&code, 1, &ctx);
22391 checksum_uleb128 (cur->lineno, &ctx);
22392 md5_process_bytes (cur->info, strlen (cur->info) + 1, &ctx);
22393 }
22394 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
22395 count = i - idx;
22396
22397 /* From the containing include filename (if any) pick up just
22398 usable characters from its basename. */
22399 if (vec_safe_is_empty (files))
22400 base = "";
22401 else
22402 base = lbasename (files->last ().info);
22403 for (encoded_filename_len = 0, i = 0; base[i]; i++)
22404 if (ISIDNUM (base[i]) || base[i] == '.')
22405 encoded_filename_len++;
22406 /* Count . at the end. */
22407 if (encoded_filename_len)
22408 encoded_filename_len++;
22409
22410 sprintf (linebuf, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, first->lineno);
22411 linebuf_len = strlen (linebuf);
22412
22413 /* The group name format is: wmN.[<encoded filename>.]<lineno>.<md5sum> */
22414 grp_name = XALLOCAVEC (char, 4 + encoded_filename_len + linebuf_len + 1
22415 + 16 * 2 + 1);
22416 memcpy (grp_name, DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? "wm4." : "wm8.", 4);
22417 tail = grp_name + 4;
22418 if (encoded_filename_len)
22419 {
22420 for (i = 0; base[i]; i++)
22421 if (ISIDNUM (base[i]) || base[i] == '.')
22422 *tail++ = base[i];
22423 *tail++ = '.';
22424 }
22425 memcpy (tail, linebuf, linebuf_len);
22426 tail += linebuf_len;
22427 *tail++ = '.';
22428 for (i = 0; i < 16; i++)
22429 sprintf (tail + i * 2, "%02x", checksum[i] & 0xff);
22430
22431 /* Construct a macinfo_entry for DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include
22432 in the empty vector entry before the first define/undef. */
22433 inc = &(*macinfo_table)[idx - 1];
22434 inc->code = DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include;
22435 inc->lineno = 0;
22436 inc->info = ggc_strdup (grp_name);
22437 if (!*macinfo_htab)
22438 *macinfo_htab = new macinfo_hash_type (10);
22439 /* Avoid emitting duplicates. */
22440 slot = (*macinfo_htab)->find_slot (inc, INSERT);
22441 if (*slot != NULL)
22442 {
22443 inc->code = 0;
22444 inc->info = NULL;
22445 /* If such an entry has been used before, just emit
22446 a DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include op. */
22447 inc = *slot;
22448 output_macinfo_op (inc);
22449 /* And clear all macinfo_entry in the range to avoid emitting them
22450 in the second pass. */
22451 for (i = idx; macinfo_table->iterate (i, &cur) && i < idx + count; i++)
22452 {
22453 cur->code = 0;
22454 cur->info = NULL;
22455 }
22456 }
22457 else
22458 {
22459 *slot = inc;
22460 inc->lineno = (*macinfo_htab)->elements ();
22461 output_macinfo_op (inc);
22462 }
22463 return count;
22464 }
22465
22466 /* Save any strings needed by the macinfo table in the debug str
22467 table. All strings must be collected into the table by the time
22468 index_string is called. */
22469
22470 static void
22471 save_macinfo_strings (void)
22472 {
22473 unsigned len;
22474 unsigned i;
22475 macinfo_entry *ref;
22476
22477 for (i = 0; macinfo_table && macinfo_table->iterate (i, &ref); i++)
22478 {
22479 switch (ref->code)
22480 {
22481 /* Match the logic in output_macinfo_op to decide on
22482 indirect strings. */
22483 case DW_MACINFO_define:
22484 case DW_MACINFO_undef:
22485 len = strlen (ref->info) + 1;
22486 if (!dwarf_strict
22487 && len > DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
22488 && !DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET
22489 && (debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) != 0)
22490 set_indirect_string (find_AT_string (ref->info));
22491 break;
22492 case DW_MACRO_GNU_define_indirect:
22493 case DW_MACRO_GNU_undef_indirect:
22494 set_indirect_string (find_AT_string (ref->info));
22495 break;
22496 default:
22497 break;
22498 }
22499 }
22500 }
22501
22502 /* Output macinfo section(s). */
22503
22504 static void
22505 output_macinfo (void)
22506 {
22507 unsigned i;
22508 unsigned long length = vec_safe_length (macinfo_table);
22509 macinfo_entry *ref;
22510 vec<macinfo_entry, va_gc> *files = NULL;
22511 macinfo_hash_type *macinfo_htab = NULL;
22512
22513 if (! length)
22514 return;
22515
22516 /* output_macinfo* uses these interchangeably. */
22517 gcc_assert ((int) DW_MACINFO_define == (int) DW_MACRO_GNU_define
22518 && (int) DW_MACINFO_undef == (int) DW_MACRO_GNU_undef
22519 && (int) DW_MACINFO_start_file == (int) DW_MACRO_GNU_start_file
22520 && (int) DW_MACINFO_end_file == (int) DW_MACRO_GNU_end_file);
22521
22522 /* For .debug_macro emit the section header. */
22523 if (!dwarf_strict)
22524 {
22525 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 4, "DWARF macro version number");
22526 if (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8)
22527 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 3, "Flags: 64-bit, lineptr present");
22528 else
22529 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 2, "Flags: 32-bit, lineptr present");
22530 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
22531 (!dwarf_split_debug_info ? debug_line_section_label
22532 : debug_skeleton_line_section_label),
22533 debug_line_section, NULL);
22534 }
22535
22536 /* In the first loop, it emits the primary .debug_macinfo section
22537 and after each emitted op the macinfo_entry is cleared.
22538 If a longer range of define/undef ops can be optimized using
22539 DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include, the
22540 DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include op is emitted and kept in
22541 the vector before the first define/undef in the range and the
22542 whole range of define/undef ops is not emitted and kept. */
22543 for (i = 0; macinfo_table->iterate (i, &ref); i++)
22544 {
22545 switch (ref->code)
22546 {
22547 case DW_MACINFO_start_file:
22548 vec_safe_push (files, *ref);
22549 break;
22550 case DW_MACINFO_end_file:
22551 if (!vec_safe_is_empty (files))
22552 files->pop ();
22553 break;
22554 case DW_MACINFO_define:
22555 case DW_MACINFO_undef:
22556 if (!dwarf_strict
22557 && HAVE_COMDAT_GROUP
22558 && vec_safe_length (files) != 1
22559 && i > 0
22560 && i + 1 < length
22561 && (*macinfo_table)[i - 1].code == 0)
22562 {
22563 unsigned count = optimize_macinfo_range (i, files, &macinfo_htab);
22564 if (count)
22565 {
22566 i += count - 1;
22567 continue;
22568 }
22569 }
22570 break;
22571 case 0:
22572 /* A dummy entry may be inserted at the beginning to be able
22573 to optimize the whole block of predefined macros. */
22574 if (i == 0)
22575 continue;
22576 default:
22577 break;
22578 }
22579 output_macinfo_op (ref);
22580 ref->info = NULL;
22581 ref->code = 0;
22582 }
22583
22584 if (!macinfo_htab)
22585 return;
22586
22587 delete macinfo_htab;
22588 macinfo_htab = NULL;
22589
22590 /* If any DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include were used, on those
22591 DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include entries terminate the
22592 current chain and switch to a new comdat .debug_macinfo
22593 section and emit the define/undef entries within it. */
22594 for (i = 0; macinfo_table->iterate (i, &ref); i++)
22595 switch (ref->code)
22596 {
22597 case 0:
22598 continue;
22599 case DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include:
22600 {
22601 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
22602 tree comdat_key = get_identifier (ref->info);
22603 /* Terminate the previous .debug_macinfo section. */
22604 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
22605 targetm.asm_out.named_section (DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION,
22606 SECTION_DEBUG
22607 | SECTION_LINKONCE,
22608 comdat_key);
22609 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label,
22610 DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL,
22611 ref->lineno);
22612 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
22613 ref->code = 0;
22614 ref->info = NULL;
22615 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 4, "DWARF macro version number");
22616 if (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8)
22617 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1, "Flags: 64-bit");
22618 else
22619 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Flags: 32-bit");
22620 }
22621 break;
22622 case DW_MACINFO_define:
22623 case DW_MACINFO_undef:
22624 output_macinfo_op (ref);
22625 ref->code = 0;
22626 ref->info = NULL;
22627 break;
22628 default:
22629 gcc_unreachable ();
22630 }
22631 }
22632
22633 /* Set up for Dwarf output at the start of compilation. */
22634
22635 static void
22636 dwarf2out_init (const char *filename ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
22637 {
22638 /* This option is currently broken, see (PR53118 and PR46102). */
22639 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups
22640 && strstr (lang_hooks.name, "C++"))
22641 {
22642 warning (0, "-feliminate-dwarf2-dups is broken for C++, ignoring");
22643 flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups = 0;
22644 }
22645
22646 /* Allocate the file_table. */
22647 file_table = hash_table<dwarf_file_hasher>::create_ggc (50);
22648
22649 /* Allocate the decl_die_table. */
22650 decl_die_table = hash_table<decl_die_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
22651
22652 /* Allocate the decl_loc_table. */
22653 decl_loc_table = hash_table<decl_loc_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
22654
22655 /* Allocate the cached_dw_loc_list_table. */
22656 cached_dw_loc_list_table = hash_table<dw_loc_list_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
22657
22658 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the decl_scope_table. */
22659 vec_alloc (decl_scope_table, 256);
22660
22661 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the abbrev_die_table. */
22662 abbrev_die_table = ggc_cleared_vec_alloc<dw_die_ref>
22663 (ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT);
22664 abbrev_die_table_allocated = ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
22665 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused. */
22666 abbrev_die_table_in_use = 1;
22667
22668 /* Allocate the pubtypes and pubnames vectors. */
22669 vec_alloc (pubname_table, 32);
22670 vec_alloc (pubtype_table, 32);
22671
22672 vec_alloc (incomplete_types, 64);
22673
22674 vec_alloc (used_rtx_array, 32);
22675
22676 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
22677 {
22678 debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_INFO_SECTION,
22679 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
22680 debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION,
22681 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
22682 debug_loc_section = get_section (DEBUG_LOC_SECTION,
22683 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
22684 }
22685 else
22686 {
22687 debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_DWO_INFO_SECTION,
22688 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
22689 debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION,
22690 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
22691 NULL);
22692 debug_addr_section = get_section (DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION,
22693 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
22694 debug_skeleton_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_INFO_SECTION,
22695 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
22696 debug_skeleton_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION,
22697 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
22698 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_abbrev_section_label,
22699 DEBUG_SKELETON_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
22700
22701 /* Somewhat confusing detail: The skeleton_[abbrev|info] sections stay in
22702 the main .o, but the skeleton_line goes into the split off dwo. */
22703 debug_skeleton_line_section
22704 = get_section (DEBUG_DWO_LINE_SECTION,
22705 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
22706 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_line_section_label,
22707 DEBUG_SKELETON_LINE_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
22708 debug_str_offsets_section = get_section (DEBUG_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION,
22709 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
22710 NULL);
22711 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_info_section_label,
22712 DEBUG_SKELETON_INFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
22713 debug_loc_section = get_section (DEBUG_DWO_LOC_SECTION,
22714 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
22715 debug_str_dwo_section = get_section (DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION,
22716 DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION_FLAGS, NULL);
22717 }
22718 debug_aranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION,
22719 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
22720 debug_macinfo_section = get_section (dwarf_strict
22721 ? DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION
22722 : DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION,
22723 DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_FLAGS, NULL);
22724 debug_line_section = get_section (DEBUG_LINE_SECTION,
22725 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
22726 debug_pubnames_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION,
22727 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
22728 debug_pubtypes_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION,
22729 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
22730 debug_str_section = get_section (DEBUG_STR_SECTION,
22731 DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS, NULL);
22732 debug_ranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION,
22733 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
22734 debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
22735 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
22736
22737 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_end_label, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
22738 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (abbrev_section_label,
22739 DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
22740 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_section_label, TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
22741 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_text_section_label,
22742 COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
22743 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_end_label, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
22744
22745 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_info_section_label,
22746 DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
22747 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_line_section_label,
22748 DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
22749 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (ranges_section_label,
22750 DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
22751 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_addr_section_label,
22752 DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
22753 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (macinfo_section_label,
22754 dwarf_strict
22755 ? DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
22756 : DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
22757 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loc_section_label, DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
22758
22759 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
22760 vec_alloc (macinfo_table, 64);
22761
22762 switch_to_section (text_section);
22763 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, text_section_label);
22764
22765 /* Make sure the line number table for .text always exists. */
22766 text_section_line_info = new_line_info_table ();
22767 text_section_line_info->end_label = text_end_label;
22768 }
22769
22770 /* Called before compile () starts outputtting functions, variables
22771 and toplevel asms into assembly. */
22772
22773 static void
22774 dwarf2out_assembly_start (void)
22775 {
22776 if (HAVE_GAS_CFI_SECTIONS_DIRECTIVE
22777 && dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ()
22778 && (!(flag_unwind_tables || flag_exceptions)
22779 || targetm_common.except_unwind_info (&global_options) != UI_DWARF2))
22780 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_sections\t.debug_frame\n");
22781 }
22782
22783 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
22784 htab_traverse. Assign a string its index. All strings must be
22785 collected into the table by the time index_string is called,
22786 because the indexing code relies on htab_traverse to traverse nodes
22787 in the same order for each run. */
22788
22789 int
22790 index_string (indirect_string_node **h, unsigned int *index)
22791 {
22792 indirect_string_node *node = *h;
22793
22794 find_string_form (node);
22795 if (node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index && node->refcount > 0)
22796 {
22797 gcc_assert (node->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
22798 node->index = *index;
22799 *index += 1;
22800 }
22801 return 1;
22802 }
22803
22804 /* A helper function for output_indirect_strings called through
22805 htab_traverse. Output the offset to a string and update the
22806 current offset. */
22807
22808 int
22809 output_index_string_offset (indirect_string_node **h, unsigned int *offset)
22810 {
22811 indirect_string_node *node = *h;
22812
22813 if (node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index && node->refcount > 0)
22814 {
22815 /* Assert that this node has been assigned an index. */
22816 gcc_assert (node->index != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED
22817 && node->index != NOT_INDEXED);
22818 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, *offset,
22819 "indexed string 0x%x: %s", node->index, node->str);
22820 *offset += strlen (node->str) + 1;
22821 }
22822 return 1;
22823 }
22824
22825 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
22826 htab_traverse. Output the indexed string. */
22827
22828 int
22829 output_index_string (indirect_string_node **h, unsigned int *cur_idx)
22830 {
22831 struct indirect_string_node *node = *h;
22832
22833 if (node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index && node->refcount > 0)
22834 {
22835 /* Assert that the strings are output in the same order as their
22836 indexes were assigned. */
22837 gcc_assert (*cur_idx == node->index);
22838 assemble_string (node->str, strlen (node->str) + 1);
22839 *cur_idx += 1;
22840 }
22841 return 1;
22842 }
22843
22844 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
22845 htab_traverse. Emit one queued .debug_str string. */
22846
22847 int
22848 output_indirect_string (indirect_string_node **h, void *)
22849 {
22850 struct indirect_string_node *node = *h;
22851
22852 node->form = find_string_form (node);
22853 if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp && node->refcount > 0)
22854 {
22855 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, node->label);
22856 assemble_string (node->str, strlen (node->str) + 1);
22857 }
22858
22859 return 1;
22860 }
22861
22862 /* Output the indexed string table. */
22863
22864 static void
22865 output_indirect_strings (void)
22866 {
22867 switch_to_section (debug_str_section);
22868 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
22869 debug_str_hash->traverse<void *, output_indirect_string> (NULL);
22870 else
22871 {
22872 unsigned int offset = 0;
22873 unsigned int cur_idx = 0;
22874
22875 skeleton_debug_str_hash->traverse<void *, output_indirect_string> (NULL);
22876
22877 switch_to_section (debug_str_offsets_section);
22878 debug_str_hash->traverse_noresize
22879 <unsigned int *, output_index_string_offset> (&offset);
22880 switch_to_section (debug_str_dwo_section);
22881 debug_str_hash->traverse_noresize<unsigned int *, output_index_string>
22882 (&cur_idx);
22883 }
22884 }
22885
22886 /* Callback for htab_traverse to assign an index to an entry in the
22887 table, and to write that entry to the .debug_addr section. */
22888
22889 int
22890 output_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry **slot, unsigned int *cur_index)
22891 {
22892 addr_table_entry *entry = *slot;
22893
22894 if (entry->refcount == 0)
22895 {
22896 gcc_assert (entry->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED
22897 || entry->index == NOT_INDEXED);
22898 return 1;
22899 }
22900
22901 gcc_assert (entry->index == *cur_index);
22902 (*cur_index)++;
22903
22904 switch (entry->kind)
22905 {
22906 case ate_kind_rtx:
22907 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, entry->addr.rtl,
22908 "0x%x", entry->index);
22909 break;
22910 case ate_kind_rtx_dtprel:
22911 gcc_assert (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel);
22912 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file,
22913 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
22914 entry->addr.rtl);
22915 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
22916 break;
22917 case ate_kind_label:
22918 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, entry->addr.label,
22919 "0x%x", entry->index);
22920 break;
22921 default:
22922 gcc_unreachable ();
22923 }
22924 return 1;
22925 }
22926
22927 /* Produce the .debug_addr section. */
22928
22929 static void
22930 output_addr_table (void)
22931 {
22932 unsigned int index = 0;
22933 if (addr_index_table == NULL || addr_index_table->size () == 0)
22934 return;
22935
22936 switch_to_section (debug_addr_section);
22937 addr_index_table
22938 ->traverse_noresize<unsigned int *, output_addr_table_entry> (&index);
22939 }
22940
22941 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
22942 /* Verify that all marks are clear. */
22943
22944 static void
22945 verify_marks_clear (dw_die_ref die)
22946 {
22947 dw_die_ref c;
22948
22949 gcc_assert (! die->die_mark);
22950 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, verify_marks_clear (c));
22951 }
22952 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
22953
22954 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children.
22955 Be cool if the mark isn't set. */
22956
22957 static void
22958 prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
22959 {
22960 dw_die_ref c;
22961
22962 if (die->die_mark)
22963 die->die_mark = 0;
22964 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unmark_dies (c));
22965 }
22966
22967 /* Given DIE that we're marking as used, find any other dies
22968 it references as attributes and mark them as used. */
22969
22970 static void
22971 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref die)
22972 {
22973 dw_attr_ref a;
22974 unsigned ix;
22975
22976 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
22977 {
22978 if (a->dw_attr_val.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref)
22979 {
22980 /* A reference to another DIE.
22981 Make sure that it will get emitted.
22982 If it was broken out into a comdat group, don't follow it. */
22983 if (! AT_ref (a)->comdat_type_p
22984 || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification)
22985 prune_unused_types_mark (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
22986 }
22987 /* Set the string's refcount to 0 so that prune_unused_types_mark
22988 accounts properly for it. */
22989 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
22990 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount = 0;
22991 }
22992 }
22993
22994 /* Mark the generic parameters and arguments children DIEs of DIE. */
22995
22996 static void
22997 prune_unused_types_mark_generic_parms_dies (dw_die_ref die)
22998 {
22999 dw_die_ref c;
23000
23001 if (die == NULL || die->die_child == NULL)
23002 return;
23003 c = die->die_child;
23004 do
23005 {
23006 if (is_template_parameter (c))
23007 prune_unused_types_mark (c, 1);
23008 c = c->die_sib;
23009 } while (c && c != die->die_child);
23010 }
23011
23012 /* Mark DIE as being used. If DOKIDS is true, then walk down
23013 to DIE's children. */
23014
23015 static void
23016 prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref die, int dokids)
23017 {
23018 dw_die_ref c;
23019
23020 if (die->die_mark == 0)
23021 {
23022 /* We haven't done this node yet. Mark it as used. */
23023 die->die_mark = 1;
23024 /* If this is the DIE of a generic type instantiation,
23025 mark the children DIEs that describe its generic parms and
23026 args. */
23027 prune_unused_types_mark_generic_parms_dies (die);
23028
23029 /* We also have to mark its parents as used.
23030 (But we don't want to mark our parent's kids due to this,
23031 unless it is a class.) */
23032 if (die->die_parent)
23033 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_parent,
23034 class_scope_p (die->die_parent));
23035
23036 /* Mark any referenced nodes. */
23037 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
23038
23039 /* If this node is a specification,
23040 also mark the definition, if it exists. */
23041 if (get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_declaration) && die->die_definition)
23042 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_definition, 1);
23043 }
23044
23045 if (dokids && die->die_mark != 2)
23046 {
23047 /* We need to walk the children, but haven't done so yet.
23048 Remember that we've walked the kids. */
23049 die->die_mark = 2;
23050
23051 /* If this is an array type, we need to make sure our
23052 kids get marked, even if they're types. If we're
23053 breaking out types into comdat sections, do this
23054 for all type definitions. */
23055 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_array_type
23056 || (use_debug_types
23057 && is_type_die (die) && ! is_declaration_die (die)))
23058 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_mark (c, 1));
23059 else
23060 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
23061 }
23062 }
23063
23064 /* For local classes, look if any static member functions were emitted
23065 and if so, mark them. */
23066
23067 static void
23068 prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (dw_die_ref die)
23069 {
23070 dw_die_ref c;
23071
23072 if (die->die_mark == 2)
23073 return;
23074
23075 switch (die->die_tag)
23076 {
23077 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
23078 case DW_TAG_union_type:
23079 case DW_TAG_class_type:
23080 break;
23081
23082 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
23083 if (!get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_declaration)
23084 || die->die_definition != NULL)
23085 prune_unused_types_mark (die, 1);
23086 return;
23087
23088 default:
23089 return;
23090 }
23091
23092 /* Mark children. */
23093 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (c));
23094 }
23095
23096 /* Walk the tree DIE and mark types that we actually use. */
23097
23098 static void
23099 prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref die)
23100 {
23101 dw_die_ref c;
23102
23103 /* Don't do anything if this node is already marked and
23104 children have been marked as well. */
23105 if (die->die_mark == 2)
23106 return;
23107
23108 switch (die->die_tag)
23109 {
23110 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
23111 case DW_TAG_union_type:
23112 case DW_TAG_class_type:
23113 if (die->die_perennial_p)
23114 break;
23115
23116 for (c = die->die_parent; c; c = c->die_parent)
23117 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
23118 break;
23119
23120 /* Finding used static member functions inside of classes
23121 is needed just for local classes, because for other classes
23122 static member function DIEs with DW_AT_specification
23123 are emitted outside of the DW_TAG_*_type. If we ever change
23124 it, we'd need to call this even for non-local classes. */
23125 if (c)
23126 prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (die);
23127
23128 /* It's a type node --- don't mark it. */
23129 return;
23130
23131 case DW_TAG_const_type:
23132 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
23133 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
23134 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
23135 case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
23136 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
23137 case DW_TAG_typedef:
23138 case DW_TAG_array_type:
23139 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
23140 case DW_TAG_friend:
23141 case DW_TAG_variant_part:
23142 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
23143 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
23144 case DW_TAG_string_type:
23145 case DW_TAG_set_type:
23146 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
23147 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
23148 case DW_TAG_file_type:
23149 if (die->die_perennial_p)
23150 break;
23151
23152 /* It's a type node --- don't mark it. */
23153 return;
23154
23155 default:
23156 /* Mark everything else. */
23157 break;
23158 }
23159
23160 if (die->die_mark == 0)
23161 {
23162 die->die_mark = 1;
23163
23164 /* Now, mark any dies referenced from here. */
23165 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
23166 }
23167
23168 die->die_mark = 2;
23169
23170 /* Mark children. */
23171 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
23172 }
23173
23174 /* Increment the string counts on strings referred to from DIE's
23175 attributes. */
23176
23177 static void
23178 prune_unused_types_update_strings (dw_die_ref die)
23179 {
23180 dw_attr_ref a;
23181 unsigned ix;
23182
23183 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
23184 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
23185 {
23186 struct indirect_string_node *s = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
23187 s->refcount++;
23188 /* Avoid unnecessarily putting strings that are used less than
23189 twice in the hash table. */
23190 if (s->refcount
23191 == ((DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS & SECTION_MERGE) ? 1 : 2))
23192 {
23193 indirect_string_node **slot
23194 = debug_str_hash->find_slot_with_hash (s->str,
23195 htab_hash_string (s->str),
23196 INSERT);
23197 gcc_assert (*slot == NULL);
23198 *slot = s;
23199 }
23200 }
23201 }
23202
23203 /* Remove from the tree DIE any dies that aren't marked. */
23204
23205 static void
23206 prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref die)
23207 {
23208 dw_die_ref c;
23209
23210 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
23211 prune_unused_types_update_strings (die);
23212
23213 if (! die->die_child)
23214 return;
23215
23216 c = die->die_child;
23217 do {
23218 dw_die_ref prev = c;
23219 for (c = c->die_sib; ! c->die_mark; c = c->die_sib)
23220 if (c == die->die_child)
23221 {
23222 /* No marked children between 'prev' and the end of the list. */
23223 if (prev == c)
23224 /* No marked children at all. */
23225 die->die_child = NULL;
23226 else
23227 {
23228 prev->die_sib = c->die_sib;
23229 die->die_child = prev;
23230 }
23231 return;
23232 }
23233
23234 if (c != prev->die_sib)
23235 prev->die_sib = c;
23236 prune_unused_types_prune (c);
23237 } while (c != die->die_child);
23238 }
23239
23240 /* Remove dies representing declarations that we never use. */
23241
23242 static void
23243 prune_unused_types (void)
23244 {
23245 unsigned int i;
23246 limbo_die_node *node;
23247 comdat_type_node *ctnode;
23248 pubname_ref pub;
23249 dw_die_ref base_type;
23250
23251 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
23252 /* All the marks should already be clear. */
23253 verify_marks_clear (comp_unit_die ());
23254 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
23255 verify_marks_clear (node->die);
23256 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
23257 verify_marks_clear (ctnode->root_die);
23258 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
23259
23260 /* Mark types that are used in global variables. */
23261 premark_types_used_by_global_vars ();
23262
23263 /* Set the mark on nodes that are actually used. */
23264 prune_unused_types_walk (comp_unit_die ());
23265 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
23266 prune_unused_types_walk (node->die);
23267 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
23268 {
23269 prune_unused_types_walk (ctnode->root_die);
23270 prune_unused_types_mark (ctnode->type_die, 1);
23271 }
23272
23273 /* Also set the mark on nodes referenced from the pubname_table. Enumerators
23274 are unusual in that they are pubnames that are the children of pubtypes.
23275 They should only be marked via their parent DW_TAG_enumeration_type die,
23276 not as roots in themselves. */
23277 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*pubname_table, i, pub)
23278 if (pub->die->die_tag != DW_TAG_enumerator)
23279 prune_unused_types_mark (pub->die, 1);
23280 for (i = 0; base_types.iterate (i, &base_type); i++)
23281 prune_unused_types_mark (base_type, 1);
23282
23283 if (debug_str_hash)
23284 debug_str_hash->empty ();
23285 if (skeleton_debug_str_hash)
23286 skeleton_debug_str_hash->empty ();
23287 prune_unused_types_prune (comp_unit_die ());
23288 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
23289 prune_unused_types_prune (node->die);
23290 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
23291 prune_unused_types_prune (ctnode->root_die);
23292
23293 /* Leave the marks clear. */
23294 prune_unmark_dies (comp_unit_die ());
23295 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
23296 prune_unmark_dies (node->die);
23297 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
23298 prune_unmark_dies (ctnode->root_die);
23299 }
23300
23301 /* Set the parameter to true if there are any relative pathnames in
23302 the file table. */
23303 int
23304 file_table_relative_p (dwarf_file_data **slot, bool *p)
23305 {
23306 struct dwarf_file_data *d = *slot;
23307 if (!IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (d->filename))
23308 {
23309 *p = true;
23310 return 0;
23311 }
23312 return 1;
23313 }
23314
23315 /* Helpers to manipulate hash table of comdat type units. */
23316
23317 struct comdat_type_hasher : typed_noop_remove <comdat_type_node>
23318 {
23319 typedef comdat_type_node *value_type;
23320 typedef comdat_type_node *compare_type;
23321 static inline hashval_t hash (const comdat_type_node *);
23322 static inline bool equal (const comdat_type_node *, const comdat_type_node *);
23323 };
23324
23325 inline hashval_t
23326 comdat_type_hasher::hash (const comdat_type_node *type_node)
23327 {
23328 hashval_t h;
23329 memcpy (&h, type_node->signature, sizeof (h));
23330 return h;
23331 }
23332
23333 inline bool
23334 comdat_type_hasher::equal (const comdat_type_node *type_node_1,
23335 const comdat_type_node *type_node_2)
23336 {
23337 return (! memcmp (type_node_1->signature, type_node_2->signature,
23338 DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE));
23339 }
23340
23341 /* Move a DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name attribute just added to dw_die_ref
23342 to the location it would have been added, should we know its
23343 DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME when we added other attributes. This will
23344 probably improve compactness of debug info, removing equivalent
23345 abbrevs, and hide any differences caused by deferring the
23346 computation of the assembler name, triggered by e.g. PCH. */
23347
23348 static inline void
23349 move_linkage_attr (dw_die_ref die)
23350 {
23351 unsigned ix = vec_safe_length (die->die_attr);
23352 dw_attr_node linkage = (*die->die_attr)[ix - 1];
23353
23354 gcc_assert (linkage.dw_attr == DW_AT_linkage_name
23355 || linkage.dw_attr == DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name);
23356
23357 while (--ix > 0)
23358 {
23359 dw_attr_node *prev = &(*die->die_attr)[ix - 1];
23360
23361 if (prev->dw_attr == DW_AT_decl_line || prev->dw_attr == DW_AT_name)
23362 break;
23363 }
23364
23365 if (ix != vec_safe_length (die->die_attr) - 1)
23366 {
23367 die->die_attr->pop ();
23368 die->die_attr->quick_insert (ix, linkage);
23369 }
23370 }
23371
23372 /* Helper function for resolve_addr, mark DW_TAG_base_type nodes
23373 referenced from typed stack ops and count how often they are used. */
23374
23375 static void
23376 mark_base_types (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
23377 {
23378 dw_die_ref base_type = NULL;
23379
23380 for (; loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
23381 {
23382 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
23383 {
23384 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
23385 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
23386 base_type = loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die;
23387 break;
23388 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
23389 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
23390 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
23391 continue;
23392 /* FALLTHRU */
23393 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
23394 base_type = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
23395 break;
23396 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
23397 mark_base_types (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc);
23398 continue;
23399 default:
23400 continue;
23401 }
23402 gcc_assert (base_type->die_parent == comp_unit_die ());
23403 if (base_type->die_mark)
23404 base_type->die_mark++;
23405 else
23406 {
23407 base_types.safe_push (base_type);
23408 base_type->die_mark = 1;
23409 }
23410 }
23411 }
23412
23413 /* Comparison function for sorting marked base types. */
23414
23415 static int
23416 base_type_cmp (const void *x, const void *y)
23417 {
23418 dw_die_ref dx = *(const dw_die_ref *) x;
23419 dw_die_ref dy = *(const dw_die_ref *) y;
23420 unsigned int byte_size1, byte_size2;
23421 unsigned int encoding1, encoding2;
23422 if (dx->die_mark > dy->die_mark)
23423 return -1;
23424 if (dx->die_mark < dy->die_mark)
23425 return 1;
23426 byte_size1 = get_AT_unsigned (dx, DW_AT_byte_size);
23427 byte_size2 = get_AT_unsigned (dy, DW_AT_byte_size);
23428 if (byte_size1 < byte_size2)
23429 return 1;
23430 if (byte_size1 > byte_size2)
23431 return -1;
23432 encoding1 = get_AT_unsigned (dx, DW_AT_encoding);
23433 encoding2 = get_AT_unsigned (dy, DW_AT_encoding);
23434 if (encoding1 < encoding2)
23435 return 1;
23436 if (encoding1 > encoding2)
23437 return -1;
23438 return 0;
23439 }
23440
23441 /* Move base types marked by mark_base_types as early as possible
23442 in the CU, sorted by decreasing usage count both to make the
23443 uleb128 references as small as possible and to make sure they
23444 will have die_offset already computed by calc_die_sizes when
23445 sizes of typed stack loc ops is computed. */
23446
23447 static void
23448 move_marked_base_types (void)
23449 {
23450 unsigned int i;
23451 dw_die_ref base_type, die, c;
23452
23453 if (base_types.is_empty ())
23454 return;
23455
23456 /* Sort by decreasing usage count, they will be added again in that
23457 order later on. */
23458 base_types.qsort (base_type_cmp);
23459 die = comp_unit_die ();
23460 c = die->die_child;
23461 do
23462 {
23463 dw_die_ref prev = c;
23464 c = c->die_sib;
23465 while (c->die_mark)
23466 {
23467 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
23468 /* As base types got marked, there must be at least
23469 one node other than DW_TAG_base_type. */
23470 gcc_assert (c != c->die_sib);
23471 c = c->die_sib;
23472 }
23473 }
23474 while (c != die->die_child);
23475 gcc_assert (die->die_child);
23476 c = die->die_child;
23477 for (i = 0; base_types.iterate (i, &base_type); i++)
23478 {
23479 base_type->die_mark = 0;
23480 base_type->die_sib = c->die_sib;
23481 c->die_sib = base_type;
23482 c = base_type;
23483 }
23484 }
23485
23486 /* Helper function for resolve_addr, attempt to resolve
23487 one CONST_STRING, return true if successful. Similarly verify that
23488 SYMBOL_REFs refer to variables emitted in the current CU. */
23489
23490 static bool
23491 resolve_one_addr (rtx *addr)
23492 {
23493 rtx rtl = *addr;
23494
23495 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
23496 {
23497 size_t len = strlen (XSTR (rtl, 0)) + 1;
23498 tree t = build_string (len, XSTR (rtl, 0));
23499 tree tlen = size_int (len - 1);
23500 TREE_TYPE (t)
23501 = build_array_type (char_type_node, build_index_type (tlen));
23502 rtl = lookup_constant_def (t);
23503 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
23504 return false;
23505 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
23506 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF
23507 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl)
23508 && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl)))
23509 return false;
23510 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
23511 *addr = rtl;
23512 return true;
23513 }
23514
23515 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF
23516 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl))
23517 {
23518 if (TREE_CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
23519 {
23520 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (DECL_INITIAL (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl))))
23521 return false;
23522 }
23523 else if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl)))
23524 return false;
23525 }
23526
23527 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST)
23528 {
23529 subrtx_ptr_iterator::array_type array;
23530 FOR_EACH_SUBRTX_PTR (iter, array, &XEXP (rtl, 0), ALL)
23531 if (!resolve_one_addr (*iter))
23532 return false;
23533 }
23534
23535 return true;
23536 }
23537
23538 /* For STRING_CST, return SYMBOL_REF of its constant pool entry,
23539 if possible, and create DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure that can be referenced
23540 from DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer if the string hasn't been seen yet. */
23541
23542 static rtx
23543 string_cst_pool_decl (tree t)
23544 {
23545 rtx rtl = output_constant_def (t, 1);
23546 unsigned char *array;
23547 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
23548 tree decl;
23549 size_t len;
23550 dw_die_ref ref;
23551
23552 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
23553 return NULL_RTX;
23554 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
23555 if (GET_CODE (rtl) != SYMBOL_REF
23556 || SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl) == NULL_TREE)
23557 return NULL_RTX;
23558
23559 decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl);
23560 if (!lookup_decl_die (decl))
23561 {
23562 len = TREE_STRING_LENGTH (t);
23563 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
23564 ref = new_die (DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure, comp_unit_die (), decl);
23565 array = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (len);
23566 memcpy (array, TREE_STRING_POINTER (t), len);
23567 l = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value, len, 0);
23568 l->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
23569 l->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = len;
23570 l->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = 1;
23571 l->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
23572 add_AT_loc (ref, DW_AT_location, l);
23573 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, ref);
23574 }
23575 return rtl;
23576 }
23577
23578 /* Helper function of resolve_addr_in_expr. LOC is
23579 a DW_OP_addr followed by DW_OP_stack_value, either at the start
23580 of exprloc or after DW_OP_{,bit_}piece, and val_addr can't be
23581 resolved. Replace it (both DW_OP_addr and DW_OP_stack_value)
23582 with DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer if possible
23583 and return true, if unsuccessful, return false. */
23584
23585 static bool
23586 optimize_one_addr_into_implicit_ptr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
23587 {
23588 rtx rtl = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr;
23589 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
23590 dw_die_ref ref = NULL;
23591 tree decl;
23592
23593 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST
23594 && GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == PLUS
23595 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 0), 1)))
23596 {
23597 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 0), 1));
23598 rtl = XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 0), 0);
23599 }
23600 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
23601 {
23602 size_t len = strlen (XSTR (rtl, 0)) + 1;
23603 tree t = build_string (len, XSTR (rtl, 0));
23604 tree tlen = size_int (len - 1);
23605
23606 TREE_TYPE (t)
23607 = build_array_type (char_type_node, build_index_type (tlen));
23608 rtl = string_cst_pool_decl (t);
23609 if (!rtl)
23610 return false;
23611 }
23612 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl))
23613 {
23614 decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl);
23615 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && !DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
23616 {
23617 ref = lookup_decl_die (decl);
23618 if (ref && (get_AT (ref, DW_AT_location)
23619 || get_AT (ref, DW_AT_const_value)))
23620 {
23621 loc->dw_loc_opc = DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer;
23622 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
23623 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry = NULL;
23624 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
23625 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
23626 loc->dw_loc_next = loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_next;
23627 loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int = offset;
23628 return true;
23629 }
23630 }
23631 }
23632 return false;
23633 }
23634
23635 /* Helper function for resolve_addr, handle one location
23636 expression, return false if at least one CONST_STRING or SYMBOL_REF in
23637 the location list couldn't be resolved. */
23638
23639 static bool
23640 resolve_addr_in_expr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
23641 {
23642 dw_loc_descr_ref keep = NULL;
23643 for (dw_loc_descr_ref prev = NULL; loc; prev = loc, loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
23644 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
23645 {
23646 case DW_OP_addr:
23647 if (!resolve_one_addr (&loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr))
23648 {
23649 if ((prev == NULL
23650 || prev->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_piece
23651 || prev->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bit_piece)
23652 && loc->dw_loc_next
23653 && loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_stack_value
23654 && !dwarf_strict
23655 && optimize_one_addr_into_implicit_ptr (loc))
23656 break;
23657 return false;
23658 }
23659 break;
23660 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
23661 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
23662 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_addr_index
23663 || (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_const_index && loc->dtprel))
23664 {
23665 rtx rtl = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->addr.rtl;
23666 if (!resolve_one_addr (&rtl))
23667 return false;
23668 remove_addr_table_entry (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry);
23669 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry =
23670 add_addr_table_entry (rtl, ate_kind_rtx);
23671 }
23672 break;
23673 case DW_OP_const4u:
23674 case DW_OP_const8u:
23675 if (loc->dtprel
23676 && !resolve_one_addr (&loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr))
23677 return false;
23678 break;
23679 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
23680 if (size_of_loc_descr (loc)
23681 > size_of_int_loc_descriptor (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned)
23682 + 1
23683 && loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned > 0)
23684 {
23685 dw_loc_descr_ref repl
23686 = int_loc_descriptor (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
23687 add_loc_descr (&repl, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
23688 add_loc_descr (&repl, loc->dw_loc_next);
23689 *loc = *repl;
23690 }
23691 break;
23692 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
23693 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class == dw_val_class_addr
23694 && !resolve_one_addr (&loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_addr))
23695 return false;
23696 break;
23697 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
23698 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
23699 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_decl_ref)
23700 {
23701 dw_die_ref ref
23702 = lookup_decl_die (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref);
23703 if (ref == NULL)
23704 return false;
23705 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
23706 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
23707 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
23708 }
23709 break;
23710 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
23711 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
23712 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
23713 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
23714 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
23715 while (loc->dw_loc_next
23716 && loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_convert)
23717 {
23718 dw_die_ref base1, base2;
23719 unsigned enc1, enc2, size1, size2;
23720 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_regval_type
23721 || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_deref_type)
23722 base1 = loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die;
23723 else if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class
23724 == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
23725 break;
23726 else
23727 base1 = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
23728 if (loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class
23729 == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
23730 break;
23731 base2 = loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
23732 gcc_assert (base1->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type
23733 && base2->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type);
23734 enc1 = get_AT_unsigned (base1, DW_AT_encoding);
23735 enc2 = get_AT_unsigned (base2, DW_AT_encoding);
23736 size1 = get_AT_unsigned (base1, DW_AT_byte_size);
23737 size2 = get_AT_unsigned (base2, DW_AT_byte_size);
23738 if (size1 == size2
23739 && (((enc1 == DW_ATE_unsigned || enc1 == DW_ATE_signed)
23740 && (enc2 == DW_ATE_unsigned || enc2 == DW_ATE_signed)
23741 && loc != keep)
23742 || enc1 == enc2))
23743 {
23744 /* Optimize away next DW_OP_GNU_convert after
23745 adjusting LOC's base type die reference. */
23746 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_regval_type
23747 || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_deref_type)
23748 loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die = base2;
23749 else
23750 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = base2;
23751 loc->dw_loc_next = loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_next;
23752 continue;
23753 }
23754 /* Don't change integer DW_OP_GNU_convert after e.g. floating
23755 point typed stack entry. */
23756 else if (enc1 != DW_ATE_unsigned && enc1 != DW_ATE_signed)
23757 keep = loc->dw_loc_next;
23758 break;
23759 }
23760 break;
23761 default:
23762 break;
23763 }
23764 return true;
23765 }
23766
23767 /* Helper function of resolve_addr. DIE had DW_AT_location of
23768 DW_OP_addr alone, which referred to DECL in DW_OP_addr's operand
23769 and DW_OP_addr couldn't be resolved. resolve_addr has already
23770 removed the DW_AT_location attribute. This function attempts to
23771 add a new DW_AT_location attribute with DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer
23772 to it or DW_AT_const_value attribute, if possible. */
23773
23774 static void
23775 optimize_location_into_implicit_ptr (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
23776 {
23777 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != VAR_DECL
23778 || lookup_decl_die (decl) != die
23779 || DECL_EXTERNAL (decl)
23780 || !TREE_STATIC (decl)
23781 || DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE
23782 || DECL_P (DECL_INITIAL (decl))
23783 || get_AT (die, DW_AT_const_value))
23784 return;
23785
23786 tree init = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
23787 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
23788 /* For variables that have been optimized away and thus
23789 don't have a memory location, see if we can emit
23790 DW_AT_const_value instead. */
23791 if (tree_add_const_value_attribute (die, init))
23792 return;
23793 if (dwarf_strict)
23794 return;
23795 /* If init is ADDR_EXPR or POINTER_PLUS_EXPR of ADDR_EXPR,
23796 and ADDR_EXPR refers to a decl that has DW_AT_location or
23797 DW_AT_const_value (but isn't addressable, otherwise
23798 resolving the original DW_OP_addr wouldn't fail), see if
23799 we can add DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer. */
23800 STRIP_NOPS (init);
23801 if (TREE_CODE (init) == POINTER_PLUS_EXPR
23802 && tree_fits_shwi_p (TREE_OPERAND (init, 1)))
23803 {
23804 offset = tree_to_shwi (TREE_OPERAND (init, 1));
23805 init = TREE_OPERAND (init, 0);
23806 STRIP_NOPS (init);
23807 }
23808 if (TREE_CODE (init) != ADDR_EXPR)
23809 return;
23810 if ((TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0)) == STRING_CST
23811 && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0)))
23812 || (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0)) == VAR_DECL
23813 && !DECL_EXTERNAL (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0))
23814 && TREE_OPERAND (init, 0) != decl))
23815 {
23816 dw_die_ref ref;
23817 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
23818
23819 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0)) == STRING_CST)
23820 {
23821 rtx rtl = string_cst_pool_decl (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0));
23822 if (!rtl)
23823 return;
23824 decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl);
23825 }
23826 else
23827 decl = TREE_OPERAND (init, 0);
23828 ref = lookup_decl_die (decl);
23829 if (ref == NULL
23830 || (!get_AT (ref, DW_AT_location)
23831 && !get_AT (ref, DW_AT_const_value)))
23832 return;
23833 l = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer, 0, offset);
23834 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
23835 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
23836 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
23837 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_location, l);
23838 }
23839 }
23840
23841 /* Resolve DW_OP_addr and DW_AT_const_value CONST_STRING arguments to
23842 an address in .rodata section if the string literal is emitted there,
23843 or remove the containing location list or replace DW_AT_const_value
23844 with DW_AT_location and empty location expression, if it isn't found
23845 in .rodata. Similarly for SYMBOL_REFs, keep only those that refer
23846 to something that has been emitted in the current CU. */
23847
23848 static void
23849 resolve_addr (dw_die_ref die)
23850 {
23851 dw_die_ref c;
23852 dw_attr_ref a;
23853 dw_loc_list_ref *curr, *start, loc;
23854 unsigned ix;
23855
23856 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
23857 switch (AT_class (a))
23858 {
23859 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
23860 start = curr = AT_loc_list_ptr (a);
23861 loc = *curr;
23862 gcc_assert (loc);
23863 /* The same list can be referenced more than once. See if we have
23864 already recorded the result from a previous pass. */
23865 if (loc->replaced)
23866 *curr = loc->dw_loc_next;
23867 else if (!loc->resolved_addr)
23868 {
23869 /* As things stand, we do not expect or allow one die to
23870 reference a suffix of another die's location list chain.
23871 References must be identical or completely separate.
23872 There is therefore no need to cache the result of this
23873 pass on any list other than the first; doing so
23874 would lead to unnecessary writes. */
23875 while (*curr)
23876 {
23877 gcc_assert (!(*curr)->replaced && !(*curr)->resolved_addr);
23878 if (!resolve_addr_in_expr ((*curr)->expr))
23879 {
23880 dw_loc_list_ref next = (*curr)->dw_loc_next;
23881 dw_loc_descr_ref l = (*curr)->expr;
23882
23883 if (next && (*curr)->ll_symbol)
23884 {
23885 gcc_assert (!next->ll_symbol);
23886 next->ll_symbol = (*curr)->ll_symbol;
23887 }
23888 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
23889 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (l);
23890 *curr = next;
23891 }
23892 else
23893 {
23894 mark_base_types ((*curr)->expr);
23895 curr = &(*curr)->dw_loc_next;
23896 }
23897 }
23898 if (loc == *start)
23899 loc->resolved_addr = 1;
23900 else
23901 {
23902 loc->replaced = 1;
23903 loc->dw_loc_next = *start;
23904 }
23905 }
23906 if (!*start)
23907 {
23908 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
23909 ix--;
23910 }
23911 break;
23912 case dw_val_class_loc:
23913 {
23914 dw_loc_descr_ref l = AT_loc (a);
23915 /* For -gdwarf-2 don't attempt to optimize
23916 DW_AT_data_member_location containing
23917 DW_OP_plus_uconst - older consumers might
23918 rely on it being that op instead of a more complex,
23919 but shorter, location description. */
23920 if ((dwarf_version > 2
23921 || a->dw_attr != DW_AT_data_member_location
23922 || l == NULL
23923 || l->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_plus_uconst
23924 || l->dw_loc_next != NULL)
23925 && !resolve_addr_in_expr (l))
23926 {
23927 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
23928 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (l);
23929 if (l != NULL
23930 && l->dw_loc_next == NULL
23931 && l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr
23932 && GET_CODE (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr) == SYMBOL_REF
23933 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr)
23934 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_location)
23935 {
23936 tree decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr);
23937 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
23938 ix--;
23939 optimize_location_into_implicit_ptr (die, decl);
23940 break;
23941 }
23942 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
23943 ix--;
23944 }
23945 else
23946 mark_base_types (l);
23947 }
23948 break;
23949 case dw_val_class_addr:
23950 if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_const_value
23951 && !resolve_one_addr (&a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr))
23952 {
23953 if (AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
23954 remove_addr_table_entry (a->dw_attr_val.val_entry);
23955 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
23956 ix--;
23957 }
23958 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_call_site
23959 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_abstract_origin)
23960 {
23961 tree tdecl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr);
23962 dw_die_ref tdie = lookup_decl_die (tdecl);
23963 if (tdie == NULL
23964 && DECL_EXTERNAL (tdecl)
23965 && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (tdecl) == NULL_TREE)
23966 {
23967 force_decl_die (tdecl);
23968 tdie = lookup_decl_die (tdecl);
23969 }
23970 if (tdie)
23971 {
23972 a->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
23973 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = tdie;
23974 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
23975 }
23976 else
23977 {
23978 if (AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
23979 remove_addr_table_entry (a->dw_attr_val.val_entry);
23980 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
23981 ix--;
23982 }
23983 }
23984 break;
23985 default:
23986 break;
23987 }
23988
23989 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, resolve_addr (c));
23990 }
23991 \f
23992 /* Helper routines for optimize_location_lists.
23993 This pass tries to share identical local lists in .debug_loc
23994 section. */
23995
23996 /* Iteratively hash operands of LOC opcode into HSTATE. */
23997
23998 static void
23999 hash_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, inchash::hash &hstate)
24000 {
24001 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
24002 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
24003
24004 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
24005 {
24006 case DW_OP_const4u:
24007 case DW_OP_const8u:
24008 if (loc->dtprel)
24009 goto hash_addr;
24010 /* FALLTHRU */
24011 case DW_OP_const1u:
24012 case DW_OP_const1s:
24013 case DW_OP_const2u:
24014 case DW_OP_const2s:
24015 case DW_OP_const4s:
24016 case DW_OP_const8s:
24017 case DW_OP_constu:
24018 case DW_OP_consts:
24019 case DW_OP_pick:
24020 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
24021 case DW_OP_breg0:
24022 case DW_OP_breg1:
24023 case DW_OP_breg2:
24024 case DW_OP_breg3:
24025 case DW_OP_breg4:
24026 case DW_OP_breg5:
24027 case DW_OP_breg6:
24028 case DW_OP_breg7:
24029 case DW_OP_breg8:
24030 case DW_OP_breg9:
24031 case DW_OP_breg10:
24032 case DW_OP_breg11:
24033 case DW_OP_breg12:
24034 case DW_OP_breg13:
24035 case DW_OP_breg14:
24036 case DW_OP_breg15:
24037 case DW_OP_breg16:
24038 case DW_OP_breg17:
24039 case DW_OP_breg18:
24040 case DW_OP_breg19:
24041 case DW_OP_breg20:
24042 case DW_OP_breg21:
24043 case DW_OP_breg22:
24044 case DW_OP_breg23:
24045 case DW_OP_breg24:
24046 case DW_OP_breg25:
24047 case DW_OP_breg26:
24048 case DW_OP_breg27:
24049 case DW_OP_breg28:
24050 case DW_OP_breg29:
24051 case DW_OP_breg30:
24052 case DW_OP_breg31:
24053 case DW_OP_regx:
24054 case DW_OP_fbreg:
24055 case DW_OP_piece:
24056 case DW_OP_deref_size:
24057 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
24058 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_int);
24059 break;
24060 case DW_OP_skip:
24061 case DW_OP_bra:
24062 {
24063 int offset;
24064
24065 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
24066 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
24067 hstate.add_object (offset);
24068 }
24069 break;
24070 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
24071 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_unsigned);
24072 switch (val2->val_class)
24073 {
24074 case dw_val_class_const:
24075 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_int);
24076 break;
24077 case dw_val_class_vec:
24078 {
24079 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
24080 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
24081
24082 hstate.add_int (elt_size);
24083 hstate.add_int (len);
24084 hstate.add (val2->v.val_vec.array, len * elt_size);
24085 }
24086 break;
24087 case dw_val_class_const_double:
24088 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_double.low);
24089 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_double.high);
24090 break;
24091 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
24092 hstate.add (val2->v.val_wide->get_val (),
24093 get_full_len (*val2->v.val_wide)
24094 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
24095 break;
24096 case dw_val_class_addr:
24097 inchash::add_rtx (val2->v.val_addr, hstate);
24098 break;
24099 default:
24100 gcc_unreachable ();
24101 }
24102 break;
24103 case DW_OP_bregx:
24104 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
24105 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_int);
24106 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_int);
24107 break;
24108 case DW_OP_addr:
24109 hash_addr:
24110 if (loc->dtprel)
24111 {
24112 unsigned char dtprel = 0xd1;
24113 hstate.add_object (dtprel);
24114 }
24115 inchash::add_rtx (val1->v.val_addr, hstate);
24116 break;
24117 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
24118 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
24119 {
24120 if (loc->dtprel)
24121 {
24122 unsigned char dtprel = 0xd1;
24123 hstate.add_object (dtprel);
24124 }
24125 inchash::add_rtx (val1->val_entry->addr.rtl, hstate);
24126 }
24127 break;
24128 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
24129 hstate.add_int (val2->v.val_int);
24130 break;
24131 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
24132 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_loc);
24133 break;
24134 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
24135 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
24136 {
24137 unsigned int byte_size
24138 = get_AT_unsigned (val2->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_byte_size);
24139 unsigned int encoding
24140 = get_AT_unsigned (val2->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_encoding);
24141 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_int);
24142 hstate.add_object (byte_size);
24143 hstate.add_object (encoding);
24144 }
24145 break;
24146 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
24147 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
24148 if (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
24149 {
24150 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_unsigned);
24151 break;
24152 }
24153 /* FALLTHRU */
24154 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
24155 {
24156 unsigned int byte_size
24157 = get_AT_unsigned (val1->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_byte_size);
24158 unsigned int encoding
24159 = get_AT_unsigned (val1->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_encoding);
24160 hstate.add_object (byte_size);
24161 hstate.add_object (encoding);
24162 if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_GNU_const_type)
24163 break;
24164 hstate.add_object (val2->val_class);
24165 switch (val2->val_class)
24166 {
24167 case dw_val_class_const:
24168 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_int);
24169 break;
24170 case dw_val_class_vec:
24171 {
24172 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
24173 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
24174
24175 hstate.add_object (elt_size);
24176 hstate.add_object (len);
24177 hstate.add (val2->v.val_vec.array, len * elt_size);
24178 }
24179 break;
24180 case dw_val_class_const_double:
24181 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_double.low);
24182 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_double.high);
24183 break;
24184 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
24185 hstate.add (val2->v.val_wide->get_val (),
24186 get_full_len (*val2->v.val_wide)
24187 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
24188 break;
24189 default:
24190 gcc_unreachable ();
24191 }
24192 }
24193 break;
24194
24195 default:
24196 /* Other codes have no operands. */
24197 break;
24198 }
24199 }
24200
24201 /* Iteratively hash the whole DWARF location expression LOC into HSTATE. */
24202
24203 static inline void
24204 hash_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, inchash::hash &hstate)
24205 {
24206 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
24207 bool sizes_computed = false;
24208 /* Compute sizes, so that DW_OP_skip/DW_OP_bra can be checksummed. */
24209 size_of_locs (loc);
24210
24211 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
24212 {
24213 enum dwarf_location_atom opc = l->dw_loc_opc;
24214 hstate.add_object (opc);
24215 if ((opc == DW_OP_skip || opc == DW_OP_bra) && !sizes_computed)
24216 {
24217 size_of_locs (loc);
24218 sizes_computed = true;
24219 }
24220 hash_loc_operands (l, hstate);
24221 }
24222 }
24223
24224 /* Compute hash of the whole location list LIST_HEAD. */
24225
24226 static inline void
24227 hash_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref list_head)
24228 {
24229 dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head;
24230 inchash::hash hstate;
24231
24232 for (curr = list_head; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
24233 {
24234 hstate.add (curr->begin, strlen (curr->begin) + 1);
24235 hstate.add (curr->end, strlen (curr->end) + 1);
24236 if (curr->section)
24237 hstate.add (curr->section, strlen (curr->section) + 1);
24238 hash_locs (curr->expr, hstate);
24239 }
24240 list_head->hash = hstate.end ();
24241 }
24242
24243 /* Return true if X and Y opcodes have the same operands. */
24244
24245 static inline bool
24246 compare_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref x, dw_loc_descr_ref y)
24247 {
24248 dw_val_ref valx1 = &x->dw_loc_oprnd1;
24249 dw_val_ref valx2 = &x->dw_loc_oprnd2;
24250 dw_val_ref valy1 = &y->dw_loc_oprnd1;
24251 dw_val_ref valy2 = &y->dw_loc_oprnd2;
24252
24253 switch (x->dw_loc_opc)
24254 {
24255 case DW_OP_const4u:
24256 case DW_OP_const8u:
24257 if (x->dtprel)
24258 goto hash_addr;
24259 /* FALLTHRU */
24260 case DW_OP_const1u:
24261 case DW_OP_const1s:
24262 case DW_OP_const2u:
24263 case DW_OP_const2s:
24264 case DW_OP_const4s:
24265 case DW_OP_const8s:
24266 case DW_OP_constu:
24267 case DW_OP_consts:
24268 case DW_OP_pick:
24269 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
24270 case DW_OP_breg0:
24271 case DW_OP_breg1:
24272 case DW_OP_breg2:
24273 case DW_OP_breg3:
24274 case DW_OP_breg4:
24275 case DW_OP_breg5:
24276 case DW_OP_breg6:
24277 case DW_OP_breg7:
24278 case DW_OP_breg8:
24279 case DW_OP_breg9:
24280 case DW_OP_breg10:
24281 case DW_OP_breg11:
24282 case DW_OP_breg12:
24283 case DW_OP_breg13:
24284 case DW_OP_breg14:
24285 case DW_OP_breg15:
24286 case DW_OP_breg16:
24287 case DW_OP_breg17:
24288 case DW_OP_breg18:
24289 case DW_OP_breg19:
24290 case DW_OP_breg20:
24291 case DW_OP_breg21:
24292 case DW_OP_breg22:
24293 case DW_OP_breg23:
24294 case DW_OP_breg24:
24295 case DW_OP_breg25:
24296 case DW_OP_breg26:
24297 case DW_OP_breg27:
24298 case DW_OP_breg28:
24299 case DW_OP_breg29:
24300 case DW_OP_breg30:
24301 case DW_OP_breg31:
24302 case DW_OP_regx:
24303 case DW_OP_fbreg:
24304 case DW_OP_piece:
24305 case DW_OP_deref_size:
24306 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
24307 return valx1->v.val_int == valy1->v.val_int;
24308 case DW_OP_skip:
24309 case DW_OP_bra:
24310 /* If splitting debug info, the use of DW_OP_GNU_addr_index
24311 can cause irrelevant differences in dw_loc_addr. */
24312 gcc_assert (valx1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc
24313 && valy1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc
24314 && (dwarf_split_debug_info
24315 || x->dw_loc_addr == y->dw_loc_addr));
24316 return valx1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr == valy1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr;
24317 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
24318 if (valx1->v.val_unsigned != valy1->v.val_unsigned
24319 || valx2->val_class != valy2->val_class)
24320 return false;
24321 switch (valx2->val_class)
24322 {
24323 case dw_val_class_const:
24324 return valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
24325 case dw_val_class_vec:
24326 return valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size == valy2->v.val_vec.elt_size
24327 && valx2->v.val_vec.length == valy2->v.val_vec.length
24328 && memcmp (valx2->v.val_vec.array, valy2->v.val_vec.array,
24329 valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size
24330 * valx2->v.val_vec.length) == 0;
24331 case dw_val_class_const_double:
24332 return valx2->v.val_double.low == valy2->v.val_double.low
24333 && valx2->v.val_double.high == valy2->v.val_double.high;
24334 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
24335 return *valx2->v.val_wide == *valy2->v.val_wide;
24336 case dw_val_class_addr:
24337 return rtx_equal_p (valx2->v.val_addr, valy2->v.val_addr);
24338 default:
24339 gcc_unreachable ();
24340 }
24341 case DW_OP_bregx:
24342 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
24343 return valx1->v.val_int == valy1->v.val_int
24344 && valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
24345 case DW_OP_addr:
24346 hash_addr:
24347 return rtx_equal_p (valx1->v.val_addr, valy1->v.val_addr);
24348 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
24349 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
24350 {
24351 rtx ax1 = valx1->val_entry->addr.rtl;
24352 rtx ay1 = valy1->val_entry->addr.rtl;
24353 return rtx_equal_p (ax1, ay1);
24354 }
24355 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
24356 return valx1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref
24357 && valx1->val_class == valy1->val_class
24358 && valx1->v.val_die_ref.die == valy1->v.val_die_ref.die
24359 && valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
24360 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
24361 return compare_loc_operands (valx1->v.val_loc, valy1->v.val_loc);
24362 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
24363 if (valx1->v.val_die_ref.die != valy1->v.val_die_ref.die
24364 || valx2->val_class != valy2->val_class)
24365 return false;
24366 switch (valx2->val_class)
24367 {
24368 case dw_val_class_const:
24369 return valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
24370 case dw_val_class_vec:
24371 return valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size == valy2->v.val_vec.elt_size
24372 && valx2->v.val_vec.length == valy2->v.val_vec.length
24373 && memcmp (valx2->v.val_vec.array, valy2->v.val_vec.array,
24374 valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size
24375 * valx2->v.val_vec.length) == 0;
24376 case dw_val_class_const_double:
24377 return valx2->v.val_double.low == valy2->v.val_double.low
24378 && valx2->v.val_double.high == valy2->v.val_double.high;
24379 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
24380 return *valx2->v.val_wide == *valy2->v.val_wide;
24381 default:
24382 gcc_unreachable ();
24383 }
24384 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
24385 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
24386 return valx1->v.val_int == valy1->v.val_int
24387 && valx2->v.val_die_ref.die == valy2->v.val_die_ref.die;
24388 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
24389 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
24390 if (valx1->val_class != valy1->val_class)
24391 return false;
24392 if (valx1->val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
24393 return valx1->v.val_unsigned == valy1->v.val_unsigned;
24394 return valx1->v.val_die_ref.die == valy1->v.val_die_ref.die;
24395 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
24396 return valx1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref
24397 && valx1->val_class == valy1->val_class
24398 && valx1->v.val_die_ref.die == valy1->v.val_die_ref.die;
24399 default:
24400 /* Other codes have no operands. */
24401 return true;
24402 }
24403 }
24404
24405 /* Return true if DWARF location expressions X and Y are the same. */
24406
24407 static inline bool
24408 compare_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref x, dw_loc_descr_ref y)
24409 {
24410 for (; x != NULL && y != NULL; x = x->dw_loc_next, y = y->dw_loc_next)
24411 if (x->dw_loc_opc != y->dw_loc_opc
24412 || x->dtprel != y->dtprel
24413 || !compare_loc_operands (x, y))
24414 break;
24415 return x == NULL && y == NULL;
24416 }
24417
24418 /* Hashtable helpers. */
24419
24420 struct loc_list_hasher : typed_noop_remove <dw_loc_list_struct>
24421 {
24422 typedef dw_loc_list_struct *value_type;
24423 typedef dw_loc_list_struct *compare_type;
24424 static inline hashval_t hash (const dw_loc_list_struct *);
24425 static inline bool equal (const dw_loc_list_struct *,
24426 const dw_loc_list_struct *);
24427 };
24428
24429 /* Return precomputed hash of location list X. */
24430
24431 inline hashval_t
24432 loc_list_hasher::hash (const dw_loc_list_struct *x)
24433 {
24434 return x->hash;
24435 }
24436
24437 /* Return true if location lists A and B are the same. */
24438
24439 inline bool
24440 loc_list_hasher::equal (const dw_loc_list_struct *a,
24441 const dw_loc_list_struct *b)
24442 {
24443 if (a == b)
24444 return 1;
24445 if (a->hash != b->hash)
24446 return 0;
24447 for (; a != NULL && b != NULL; a = a->dw_loc_next, b = b->dw_loc_next)
24448 if (strcmp (a->begin, b->begin) != 0
24449 || strcmp (a->end, b->end) != 0
24450 || (a->section == NULL) != (b->section == NULL)
24451 || (a->section && strcmp (a->section, b->section) != 0)
24452 || !compare_locs (a->expr, b->expr))
24453 break;
24454 return a == NULL && b == NULL;
24455 }
24456
24457 typedef hash_table<loc_list_hasher> loc_list_hash_type;
24458
24459
24460 /* Recursively optimize location lists referenced from DIE
24461 children and share them whenever possible. */
24462
24463 static void
24464 optimize_location_lists_1 (dw_die_ref die, loc_list_hash_type *htab)
24465 {
24466 dw_die_ref c;
24467 dw_attr_ref a;
24468 unsigned ix;
24469 dw_loc_list_struct **slot;
24470
24471 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
24472 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
24473 {
24474 dw_loc_list_ref list = AT_loc_list (a);
24475 /* TODO: perform some optimizations here, before hashing
24476 it and storing into the hash table. */
24477 hash_loc_list (list);
24478 slot = htab->find_slot_with_hash (list, list->hash, INSERT);
24479 if (*slot == NULL)
24480 *slot = list;
24481 else
24482 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = *slot;
24483 }
24484
24485 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, optimize_location_lists_1 (c, htab));
24486 }
24487
24488
24489 /* Recursively assign each location list a unique index into the debug_addr
24490 section. */
24491
24492 static void
24493 index_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
24494 {
24495 dw_die_ref c;
24496 dw_attr_ref a;
24497 unsigned ix;
24498
24499 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
24500 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
24501 {
24502 dw_loc_list_ref list = AT_loc_list (a);
24503 dw_loc_list_ref curr;
24504 for (curr = list; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
24505 {
24506 /* Don't index an entry that has already been indexed
24507 or won't be output. */
24508 if (curr->begin_entry != NULL
24509 || (strcmp (curr->begin, curr->end) == 0 && !curr->force))
24510 continue;
24511
24512 curr->begin_entry
24513 = add_addr_table_entry (xstrdup (curr->begin),
24514 ate_kind_label);
24515 }
24516 }
24517
24518 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, index_location_lists (c));
24519 }
24520
24521 /* Optimize location lists referenced from DIE
24522 children and share them whenever possible. */
24523
24524 static void
24525 optimize_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
24526 {
24527 loc_list_hash_type htab (500);
24528 optimize_location_lists_1 (die, &htab);
24529 }
24530 \f
24531 /* Output stuff that dwarf requires at the end of every file,
24532 and generate the DWARF-2 debugging info. */
24533
24534 static void
24535 dwarf2out_finish (const char *filename)
24536 {
24537 limbo_die_node *node, *next_node;
24538 comdat_type_node *ctnode;
24539 unsigned int i;
24540 dw_die_ref main_comp_unit_die;
24541
24542 /* PCH might result in DW_AT_producer string being restored from the
24543 header compilation, so always fill it with empty string initially
24544 and overwrite only here. */
24545 dw_attr_ref producer = get_AT (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_producer);
24546 producer_string = gen_producer_string ();
24547 producer->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
24548 producer->dw_attr_val.v.val_str = find_AT_string (producer_string);
24549
24550 gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies ();
24551 gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute ();
24552
24553 /* Add the name for the main input file now. We delayed this from
24554 dwarf2out_init to avoid complications with PCH.
24555 For LTO produced units use a fixed artificial name to avoid
24556 leaking tempfile names into the dwarf. */
24557 if (!in_lto_p)
24558 add_name_attribute (comp_unit_die (), remap_debug_filename (filename));
24559 else
24560 add_name_attribute (comp_unit_die (), "<artificial>");
24561 if (!IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (filename) || targetm.force_at_comp_dir)
24562 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die ());
24563 else if (get_AT (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_comp_dir) == NULL)
24564 {
24565 bool p = false;
24566 file_table->traverse<bool *, file_table_relative_p> (&p);
24567 if (p)
24568 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die ());
24569 }
24570
24571 if (deferred_locations_list)
24572 for (i = 0; i < deferred_locations_list->length (); i++)
24573 {
24574 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (
24575 (*deferred_locations_list)[i].die,
24576 (*deferred_locations_list)[i].variable,
24577 false,
24578 DW_AT_location);
24579 }
24580
24581 /* Traverse the limbo die list, and add parent/child links. The only
24582 dies without parents that should be here are concrete instances of
24583 inline functions, and the comp_unit_die. We can ignore the comp_unit_die.
24584 For concrete instances, we can get the parent die from the abstract
24585 instance. */
24586 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = next_node)
24587 {
24588 dw_die_ref die = node->die;
24589 next_node = node->next;
24590
24591 if (die->die_parent == NULL)
24592 {
24593 dw_die_ref origin = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin);
24594
24595 if (origin && origin->die_parent)
24596 add_child_die (origin->die_parent, die);
24597 else if (is_cu_die (die))
24598 ;
24599 else if (seen_error ())
24600 /* It's OK to be confused by errors in the input. */
24601 add_child_die (comp_unit_die (), die);
24602 else
24603 {
24604 /* In certain situations, the lexical block containing a
24605 nested function can be optimized away, which results
24606 in the nested function die being orphaned. Likewise
24607 with the return type of that nested function. Force
24608 this to be a child of the containing function.
24609
24610 It may happen that even the containing function got fully
24611 inlined and optimized out. In that case we are lost and
24612 assign the empty child. This should not be big issue as
24613 the function is likely unreachable too. */
24614 gcc_assert (node->created_for);
24615
24616 if (DECL_P (node->created_for))
24617 origin = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (node->created_for));
24618 else if (TYPE_P (node->created_for))
24619 origin = scope_die_for (node->created_for, comp_unit_die ());
24620 else
24621 origin = comp_unit_die ();
24622
24623 add_child_die (origin, die);
24624 }
24625 }
24626 }
24627
24628 limbo_die_list = NULL;
24629
24630 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
24631 {
24632 dw_die_ref die = comp_unit_die (), c;
24633 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, gcc_assert (! c->die_mark));
24634 }
24635 #endif
24636 resolve_addr (comp_unit_die ());
24637 move_marked_base_types ();
24638
24639 for (node = deferred_asm_name; node; node = node->next)
24640 {
24641 tree decl = node->created_for;
24642 /* When generating LTO bytecode we can not generate new assembler
24643 names at this point and all important decls got theirs via
24644 free-lang-data. */
24645 if (((!flag_generate_lto && !flag_generate_offload)
24646 || DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME_SET_P (decl))
24647 && DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl))
24648 {
24649 add_linkage_attr (node->die, decl);
24650 move_linkage_attr (node->die);
24651 }
24652 }
24653
24654 deferred_asm_name = NULL;
24655
24656 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
24657 emit full debugging info for them. */
24658 retry_incomplete_types ();
24659
24660 if (flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
24661 prune_unused_types ();
24662
24663 /* Generate separate COMDAT sections for type DIEs. */
24664 if (use_debug_types)
24665 {
24666 break_out_comdat_types (comp_unit_die ());
24667
24668 /* Each new type_unit DIE was added to the limbo die list when created.
24669 Since these have all been added to comdat_type_list, clear the
24670 limbo die list. */
24671 limbo_die_list = NULL;
24672
24673 /* For each new comdat type unit, copy declarations for incomplete
24674 types to make the new unit self-contained (i.e., no direct
24675 references to the main compile unit). */
24676 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
24677 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (ctnode->root_die);
24678 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (comp_unit_die ());
24679
24680 /* In the process of copying declarations from one unit to another,
24681 we may have left some declarations behind that are no longer
24682 referenced. Prune them. */
24683 prune_unused_types ();
24684 }
24685
24686 /* Generate separate CUs for each of the include files we've seen.
24687 They will go into limbo_die_list. */
24688 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
24689 break_out_includes (comp_unit_die ());
24690
24691 /* Traverse the DIE's and add add sibling attributes to those DIE's
24692 that have children. */
24693 add_sibling_attributes (comp_unit_die ());
24694 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
24695 add_sibling_attributes (node->die);
24696 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
24697 add_sibling_attributes (ctnode->root_die);
24698
24699 /* When splitting DWARF info, we put some attributes in the
24700 skeleton compile_unit DIE that remains in the .o, while
24701 most attributes go in the DWO compile_unit_die. */
24702 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
24703 main_comp_unit_die = gen_compile_unit_die (NULL);
24704 else
24705 main_comp_unit_die = comp_unit_die ();
24706
24707 /* Output a terminator label for the .text section. */
24708 switch_to_section (text_section);
24709 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
24710 if (cold_text_section)
24711 {
24712 switch_to_section (cold_text_section);
24713 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
24714 }
24715
24716 /* We can only use the low/high_pc attributes if all of the code was
24717 in .text. */
24718 if (!have_multiple_function_sections
24719 || (dwarf_version < 3 && dwarf_strict))
24720 {
24721 /* Don't add if the CU has no associated code. */
24722 if (text_section_used)
24723 add_AT_low_high_pc (main_comp_unit_die, text_section_label,
24724 text_end_label, true);
24725 }
24726 else
24727 {
24728 unsigned fde_idx;
24729 dw_fde_ref fde;
24730 bool range_list_added = false;
24731
24732 if (text_section_used)
24733 add_ranges_by_labels (main_comp_unit_die, text_section_label,
24734 text_end_label, &range_list_added, true);
24735 if (cold_text_section_used)
24736 add_ranges_by_labels (main_comp_unit_die, cold_text_section_label,
24737 cold_end_label, &range_list_added, true);
24738
24739 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, fde_idx, fde)
24740 {
24741 if (DECL_IGNORED_P (fde->decl))
24742 continue;
24743 if (!fde->in_std_section)
24744 add_ranges_by_labels (main_comp_unit_die, fde->dw_fde_begin,
24745 fde->dw_fde_end, &range_list_added,
24746 true);
24747 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && !fde->second_in_std_section)
24748 add_ranges_by_labels (main_comp_unit_die, fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
24749 fde->dw_fde_second_end, &range_list_added,
24750 true);
24751 }
24752
24753 if (range_list_added)
24754 {
24755 /* We need to give .debug_loc and .debug_ranges an appropriate
24756 "base address". Use zero so that these addresses become
24757 absolute. Historically, we've emitted the unexpected
24758 DW_AT_entry_pc instead of DW_AT_low_pc for this purpose.
24759 Emit both to give time for other tools to adapt. */
24760 add_AT_addr (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_low_pc, const0_rtx, true);
24761 if (! dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 4)
24762 add_AT_addr (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_entry_pc, const0_rtx, true);
24763
24764 add_ranges (NULL);
24765 }
24766 }
24767
24768 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
24769 add_AT_lineptr (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
24770 debug_line_section_label);
24771
24772 if (have_macinfo)
24773 add_AT_macptr (comp_unit_die (),
24774 dwarf_strict ? DW_AT_macro_info : DW_AT_GNU_macros,
24775 macinfo_section_label);
24776
24777 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
24778 {
24779 /* optimize_location_lists calculates the size of the lists,
24780 so index them first, and assign indices to the entries.
24781 Although optimize_location_lists will remove entries from
24782 the table, it only does so for duplicates, and therefore
24783 only reduces ref_counts to 1. */
24784 index_location_lists (comp_unit_die ());
24785
24786 if (addr_index_table != NULL)
24787 {
24788 unsigned int index = 0;
24789 addr_index_table
24790 ->traverse_noresize<unsigned int *, index_addr_table_entry>
24791 (&index);
24792 }
24793 }
24794
24795 if (have_location_lists)
24796 optimize_location_lists (comp_unit_die ());
24797
24798 save_macinfo_strings ();
24799
24800 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
24801 {
24802 unsigned int index = 0;
24803
24804 /* Add attributes common to skeleton compile_units and
24805 type_units. Because these attributes include strings, it
24806 must be done before freezing the string table. Top-level
24807 skeleton die attrs are added when the skeleton type unit is
24808 created, so ensure it is created by this point. */
24809 add_top_level_skeleton_die_attrs (main_comp_unit_die);
24810 debug_str_hash->traverse_noresize<unsigned int *, index_string> (&index);
24811 }
24812
24813 /* Output all of the compilation units. We put the main one last so that
24814 the offsets are available to output_pubnames. */
24815 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
24816 output_comp_unit (node->die, 0);
24817
24818 hash_table<comdat_type_hasher> comdat_type_table (100);
24819 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
24820 {
24821 comdat_type_node **slot = comdat_type_table.find_slot (ctnode, INSERT);
24822
24823 /* Don't output duplicate types. */
24824 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
24825 continue;
24826
24827 /* Add a pointer to the line table for the main compilation unit
24828 so that the debugger can make sense of DW_AT_decl_file
24829 attributes. */
24830 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
24831 add_AT_lineptr (ctnode->root_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
24832 (!dwarf_split_debug_info
24833 ? debug_line_section_label
24834 : debug_skeleton_line_section_label));
24835
24836 output_comdat_type_unit (ctnode);
24837 *slot = ctnode;
24838 }
24839
24840 /* The AT_pubnames attribute needs to go in all skeleton dies, including
24841 both the main_cu and all skeleton TUs. Making this call unconditional
24842 would end up either adding a second copy of the AT_pubnames attribute, or
24843 requiring a special case in add_top_level_skeleton_die_attrs. */
24844 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
24845 add_AT_pubnames (comp_unit_die ());
24846
24847 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
24848 {
24849 int mark;
24850 unsigned char checksum[16];
24851 struct md5_ctx ctx;
24852
24853 /* Compute a checksum of the comp_unit to use as the dwo_id. */
24854 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
24855 mark = 0;
24856 die_checksum (comp_unit_die (), &ctx, &mark);
24857 unmark_all_dies (comp_unit_die ());
24858 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
24859
24860 /* Use the first 8 bytes of the checksum as the dwo_id,
24861 and add it to both comp-unit DIEs. */
24862 add_AT_data8 (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_GNU_dwo_id, checksum);
24863 add_AT_data8 (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_GNU_dwo_id, checksum);
24864
24865 /* Add the base offset of the ranges table to the skeleton
24866 comp-unit DIE. */
24867 if (ranges_table_in_use)
24868 add_AT_lineptr (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_GNU_ranges_base,
24869 ranges_section_label);
24870
24871 switch_to_section (debug_addr_section);
24872 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_addr_section_label);
24873 output_addr_table ();
24874 }
24875
24876 /* Output the main compilation unit if non-empty or if .debug_macinfo
24877 or .debug_macro will be emitted. */
24878 output_comp_unit (comp_unit_die (), have_macinfo);
24879
24880 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && info_section_emitted)
24881 output_skeleton_debug_sections (main_comp_unit_die);
24882
24883 /* Output the abbreviation table. */
24884 if (abbrev_die_table_in_use != 1)
24885 {
24886 switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
24887 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, abbrev_section_label);
24888 output_abbrev_section ();
24889 }
24890
24891 /* Output location list section if necessary. */
24892 if (have_location_lists)
24893 {
24894 /* Output the location lists info. */
24895 switch_to_section (debug_loc_section);
24896 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, loc_section_label);
24897 output_location_lists (comp_unit_die ());
24898 }
24899
24900 output_pubtables ();
24901
24902 /* Output the address range information if a CU (.debug_info section)
24903 was emitted. We output an empty table even if we had no functions
24904 to put in it. This because the consumer has no way to tell the
24905 difference between an empty table that we omitted and failure to
24906 generate a table that would have contained data. */
24907 if (info_section_emitted)
24908 {
24909 unsigned long aranges_length = size_of_aranges ();
24910
24911 switch_to_section (debug_aranges_section);
24912 output_aranges (aranges_length);
24913 }
24914
24915 /* Output ranges section if necessary. */
24916 if (ranges_table_in_use)
24917 {
24918 switch_to_section (debug_ranges_section);
24919 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, ranges_section_label);
24920 output_ranges ();
24921 }
24922
24923 /* Have to end the macro section. */
24924 if (have_macinfo)
24925 {
24926 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
24927 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, macinfo_section_label);
24928 output_macinfo ();
24929 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
24930 }
24931
24932 /* Output the source line correspondence table. We must do this
24933 even if there is no line information. Otherwise, on an empty
24934 translation unit, we will generate a present, but empty,
24935 .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm' will then complain when
24936 examining the file. This is done late so that any filenames
24937 used by the debug_info section are marked as 'used'. */
24938 switch_to_section (debug_line_section);
24939 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_line_section_label);
24940 if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
24941 output_line_info (false);
24942
24943 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && info_section_emitted)
24944 {
24945 switch_to_section (debug_skeleton_line_section);
24946 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_skeleton_line_section_label);
24947 output_line_info (true);
24948 }
24949
24950 /* If we emitted any indirect strings, output the string table too. */
24951 if (debug_str_hash || skeleton_debug_str_hash)
24952 output_indirect_strings ();
24953 }
24954
24955 /* Reset all state within dwarf2out.c so that we can rerun the compiler
24956 within the same process. For use by toplev::finalize. */
24957
24958 void
24959 dwarf2out_c_finalize (void)
24960 {
24961 last_var_location_insn = NULL;
24962 cached_next_real_insn = NULL;
24963 used_rtx_array = NULL;
24964 incomplete_types = NULL;
24965 decl_scope_table = NULL;
24966 debug_info_section = NULL;
24967 debug_skeleton_info_section = NULL;
24968 debug_abbrev_section = NULL;
24969 debug_skeleton_abbrev_section = NULL;
24970 debug_aranges_section = NULL;
24971 debug_addr_section = NULL;
24972 debug_macinfo_section = NULL;
24973 debug_line_section = NULL;
24974 debug_skeleton_line_section = NULL;
24975 debug_loc_section = NULL;
24976 debug_pubnames_section = NULL;
24977 debug_pubtypes_section = NULL;
24978 debug_str_section = NULL;
24979 debug_str_dwo_section = NULL;
24980 debug_str_offsets_section = NULL;
24981 debug_ranges_section = NULL;
24982 debug_frame_section = NULL;
24983 fde_vec = NULL;
24984 debug_str_hash = NULL;
24985 skeleton_debug_str_hash = NULL;
24986 dw2_string_counter = 0;
24987 have_multiple_function_sections = false;
24988 text_section_used = false;
24989 cold_text_section_used = false;
24990 cold_text_section = NULL;
24991 current_unit_personality = NULL;
24992
24993 deferred_locations_list = NULL;
24994
24995 next_die_offset = 0;
24996 single_comp_unit_die = NULL;
24997 comdat_type_list = NULL;
24998 limbo_die_list = NULL;
24999 deferred_asm_name = NULL;
25000 file_table = NULL;
25001 decl_die_table = NULL;
25002 common_block_die_table = NULL;
25003 decl_loc_table = NULL;
25004 call_arg_locations = NULL;
25005 call_arg_loc_last = NULL;
25006 call_site_count = -1;
25007 tail_call_site_count = -1;
25008 //block_map = NULL;
25009 cached_dw_loc_list_table = NULL;
25010 abbrev_die_table = NULL;
25011 abbrev_die_table_allocated = 0;
25012 abbrev_die_table_in_use = 0;
25013 line_info_label_num = 0;
25014 cur_line_info_table = NULL;
25015 text_section_line_info = NULL;
25016 cold_text_section_line_info = NULL;
25017 separate_line_info = NULL;
25018 info_section_emitted = false;
25019 pubname_table = NULL;
25020 pubtype_table = NULL;
25021 macinfo_table = NULL;
25022 ranges_table = NULL;
25023 ranges_table_allocated = 0;
25024 ranges_table_in_use = 0;
25025 ranges_by_label = 0;
25026 ranges_by_label_allocated = 0;
25027 ranges_by_label_in_use = 0;
25028 have_location_lists = false;
25029 loclabel_num = 0;
25030 poc_label_num = 0;
25031 last_emitted_file = NULL;
25032 label_num = 0;
25033 file_table_last_lookup = NULL;
25034 tmpl_value_parm_die_table = NULL;
25035 generic_type_instances = NULL;
25036 frame_pointer_fb_offset = 0;
25037 frame_pointer_fb_offset_valid = false;
25038 base_types.release ();
25039 XDELETEVEC (producer_string);
25040 producer_string = NULL;
25041 }
25042
25043 #include "gt-dwarf2out.h"